vvEPA
              United States
              Environmental Protection
              Agency
             Office of Solid Waste
             and Emergency Response
             Washington, DC 20460
November 1986
SW-846 A
Third Edition
              Solid Waste
Test Methods
for Evaluating Solid Waste
              Volume IA:  Laboratory Manual
              Physical/Chemical Methods

-------
VOLUME  ONE,
     SECTION A

-------
   FINAL (PROMULGATED) UPDATES II  AND  MA
                        Cover Sheet

      THIS PACKET CONTAINS NEW AND REVISED MATERIAL
                       FOR INCLUSION IN:
         TEST METHODS FOR EVALUATING SOLID WASTE
                 PHYSICAL/CHEMICAL METHODS
                     (SW-846) THIRD EDITION
Contents:

 1.  Cover sheet.  (What you are currently reading)

 2.  Instructions.  This section explains how to put together your  SW-846
     manual.
      A. Instructions for New Subscribers.
      B. Instructions for Previous Subscribers.

 3.  Method  Status Table.  The Method Status Table is a sequentially
     numbered listing of all SW-846 methods and their current status.

 4.  Revised Update II Table of Contents.  The Table of Contents (dated
     September 1994) lists all of the methods (Third Edition, Update I, and
     Updates II and IIA) in the order in which they should appear in the
     manual.

 5.  Revised Chapter Two:  Choosing the Right Method

 6.  Revised Chapter Three and new/revised methods for metals analyses.

 7.  Revised Chapter Four and new/revised methods for organic analyses.

 8.  Revised  Chapter Five  and new/revised  methods  for miscellaneous
     analyses.

 9.  Revised Chapter Six and new/revised methods for properties analyses.

 10. Revised Chapter Seven: Introduction and Regulatory Definitions

 11. Revised Chapter Eight  (Revised section separation sheets only)

-------
                           INSTRUCTIONS

SW-846 is a "living" document that changes when new data and advances in
analytical techniques are incorporated  into the manual as new  or  revised
methods.  Periodically, the Agency issues these methods as updates to the
manual.  To date, the Agency has issued Final Updates I, II, and IIA. These
instructions include  directions  on getting the basic manual up-to-date and
incorporating Final Updates II and IIA into your SW-846.  The Agency will
release additional proposed and final updates in the future. New instructions,
to supersede these, will be included with each of those updates. However, in
general,  final  updates   should  always  be  incorporated  into SW-846 in
chronological order (e.g.  Update I should be incorporated before Update II).

If you have any difficulty with these directions, you may telephone the Methods
Information Communication Exchange (MICE) at 703-821-4789 for help. If
you have questions concerning your SW-846 U.S. Government Printing Office
(GPO) subscription, you  should telephone the GPO at 202-512-2303. If you
did not purchase your SW-846 from the GPO, the GPO will not be able to help
you.
FINAL UPDATE IIA:  Final Update IIA contains only one method, Method
4010, dated August 1993.  This method was promulgated on January 4, 1994
(59 FR 458).  It should be inserted into the manual according to the location
specified in the Final Update II Table of Contents (dated September 1994).
FINAL UPDATE II;   Final Update II has been  promulgated and is  now
officially part of SW-846.  These instructions for insertion of Final Update II
are divided into two (2) sections: Section A - Instructions for New Subscribers
and Section B - Instructions for Previous Subscribers.

    New subscribers are defined as individuals who have recently (6-8 weeks) placed an
    order with the GPO and have received new copies of the 4 (four) volume set of the
    Third Edition, a copy of Final Update I, and  a copy of Final Updates II and IIA.

    Previous subscribers are defined as individuals that have received copies of the Third
    Edition and other SW-846 Updates (including  proposed Updates) in the past and have
    just received their Final Update II and IIA package in the mail.


Update II and IIA               Instructions - 1                         Final

-------
Please  use  the  following  instructions  for new  subscribers  or  previous
subscribers in sequence to piece together your new SW-846 manual.
A.  INSTRUCTIONS FOR NEW SUBSCRIBERS

  i.  If you have not already done so, open the packages that contain the Third Edition of
     SW-846. The Third Edition should include 4 (four) volumes of material (i.e. Volumes
     LA, IB, 1C, and II) and will be dated "September 1986" in the lower right hand corner
     of each page.  Four 3-ring binders (one binder for each volume) and a set of tabs
     should  also  be included.   You  should  place  each volume of material in  the
     appropriately labeled 3-ring binder and insert the tabs. Check the Table of Contents
     (dated September 1986) if you have any questions about the order of the methods or
     about which volume the methods should be inserted into.

     You will be missing some methods from the  Third Edition since any Third Edition
     September 1986 material, that was superseded by Final Update I July 1992 material.
     has already been removed from your copy  of the Third Edition.
 ii.   If you have not already done so, open the package that contains Final Update I. Final
     Update I should be a single package printed on white paper with the date "July 1992"
     in the lower right hand corner of each page. This package contains new methods and
     revised methods. In order to have a complete SW-846 manual, you should insert the
     new and revised July 1992 material using the Table of Contents (dated July 1992) at
     the front  of Final Update I to identify the correct location  for each chapter  and
     method.

     Since you are a new  subscriber to SW-846, you need not be concerned about the
     removal or replacement of the previous version of Update I, as discussed in item (A)
     of the Final Update I instructions. Again, any Third Edition September 1986 material.
     that was superseded bv Final Update I July 1992 material, has already been removed
     from your copy of the Third Edition. For example, your copy of the Third Edition does
     not contain  a  copy of the September 1986 version of Chapter One  because it  was
     superseded by the July 1992 revision of Chapter One contained in your Final Update
     I package.

     Final Update I also includes copies of September 1986 "replacement methods" which
     are included with your copy of Final Update I and are discussed in item (E) in the
     Final Update I instructions.  You should not insert the replacement  methods!  The
     replacement methods were sent to subscribers before final Update II  was released.
Update II and IIA                 Instructions - 2                             Final

-------
    The Disclaimer and Chapter One at the front of Update I should also be photocopied
    3 times and inserted at the front of volumes IB, 1C, and II in order to complete the
    manual.

        Note:   Update I  does  not contain any changes to  Volume II other than the
        insertion of the Disclaimer and Chapter One.  Also, some methods will have an
        "A" after the method number. The "A" methods have been revised once.
iii.  Finally, open the package labeled Final Updates II and IIA.  Final Updates II and IIA
    should be a single package printed on white paper. Update II has the date "September
    1994" in the lower right hand corner of each page. Update IIA (Method 4010) has the
    date "August 1993" in the lower right hand corner of each page. This package contains
    new methods and revised methods. In order to have a complete SW-846 manual, you
    should insert the new methods  and use the revised September 1994 methods to replace
    older Third Edition and Final  Update I methods that are out of date. Use the Table
    of Contents (September 1994) at the front of Final Update II to identify the correct
    location for each chapter and  method.

    The Abstract and Table of Contents at the front of Final Update  II should also be
    photocopied 3 times  and inserted at the front of volumes IB, 1C, and II in order to
    complete the manual.

    Please Note:

       •  Update II does not contain any changes to Volume II other than the insertion of
         the Abstract and Table of Contents.

       •  Some methods  will have  an "A" or  a "B" after the method number.  The "A"
         methods have been revised  once. The "B" methods have been revised twice.

       •  Methods  5100,  5110,  and  9200A were  included in the Proposed Update II
         (November 1992) package but are not included in the Final Update II (September
         1994) package.  The final Federal Register Rule for Update II explains why these
         methods were not finalized  (promulgated).
Update II and IIA                 Instructions - 3                             Final

-------
 B.  INSTRUCTIONS FOR PREVIOUS SUBSCRIBERS

  i.  Background Information: A number of SW-846 update packages have been released
     to the public since the original Third Edition was released. The number and labels on
     these packages can be confusing.  The following table titled "A Brief History of the
     SW-846 Third Edition and Updates" has been provided as an aid.  Currently finalized
     (promulgated) methods have been printed in bold. An individual or organization that
     has held an SW-846 GPO subscription for several years may have received copies of
     any or all of the following documents:
A BRIEF HISTORY OF THE SW-846 THIRD EDITION AND UPDATES
Package
Third Edition
Proposed Update I
Final Update I
(Accidently Released)
Proposed Update II
(Accidently Released)
Final Update I
Proposed Update II
Proposed Update IIA*
(Available by request only.)
Final Update HA* (Included
with Final Update II.)
Final Update II
Date Listed on Methods
September 1986
December 1987
November 1990
November 1990
July 1992
November 1992
October 1992
August 1993
September 1994
Color of Paper
White
Green
White
Blue
White
Yellow
White
White
White
Status of Package
Finalized (Promulgated)
Obsolete
Obsolete! Never formally
finalized.
Obsolete! Never formally
proposed.
Finalized (Promulgated)
Obsolete
Obsolete
Finalized (Promulgated)
Finalized (Promulgated)
    * Contains only Method 4010.

 ii.  In order to begin updating the manual it is important to establish exactly what  is
    currently contained in the manual that you have.  If the manual has been properly
    updated, the ONLY white pages in the document should be dated September 1986
    (Third Edition) and July 1992 (Final Update I). Remove and discard (or archive) any
    white pages from your manual that have any date other than September 1986 and July
    1992.

    There may also be yellow pages dated September 1992 (Proposed Update II) inserted
    in the manual.  Remove and discard all yellow pages or other colored pages (green or
    blue) from the manual.  Some individuals may have chosen to keep their copy of
    Proposed Update II in a separate binder and removal will not be necessary.
Update II and IIA
Instructions - 4
Final

-------
iii.  Open the package labeled Final Updates II and IIA. Final Updates II and IIA should
    be a single package printed on white paper.  Update II has the date "September 1994"
    in the lower right hand corner of each page. Update IIA (Method 4010) has the date
    "August 1993" in the lower right hand corner of each page.  This package contains new
    methods and revised methods.  In order to have a complete SW-846 manual, you
    should insert the new methods and use the revised September 1994 methods to replace
    older Third Edition and Final Update I methods that are out of date. Use the Table
    of Contents (September 1994) at the front of Final Update II to identify  the correct
    location for each chapter and method.

    The Abstract and Table of Contents at the front of Final Update II should also be
    photocopied 3 times and inserted at the front of volumes IB, 1C, and II in  order to
    complete the manual.

    Please Note:

      •  Update II does not contain any changes to Volume II other than the insertion of
         the Abstract and Table of Contents.

      •  Some methods will have an "A" or a  "B" after the method number.  The "A"
         methods have been revised once. The  "B" methods have been revised twice.

      •  Methods  5100, 5110,  and 9200A were  included  in the Proposed  Update II
         (November 1992) package but are not included in the Final Update II (September
         1994) package. The final Federal Register Rule for Update II explains why these
         methods were not finalized (promulgated).
Update II and IIA                Instructions - 5                            Final

-------
             METHOD STATUS TABLE
SW-846, THIRD EDITION, UPDATES I, II, AND IIA
                  September  1994
      Use  this  table  as a reference guide to identify the
      promulgation status of SW-846 methods.

      The  methods in this table are listed sequentially by
      number.

      This table should not be used as a Table of Contents for
      SW-846.  Refer to the Table of Contents found in Final
      Update II (dated September 1994) for the order in which
      the methods appear in SW-846.

-------
SW-846 METHOD STATUS TABLE
      September 1994
METH NO.
THIRD ED
DATED
9/86
0010
0020
0030
1010
1020
1110
1310
— —
— —
METH NO.
FINAL
UPDATE I
DATED
7/92
— —
— —
- -
- -
1020A
— —
1310A
1311
_ _
METH NO.
FINAL
UPDT. II
DATED
9/94
~ ""
~ ~
~ —
~ •*
- -
_ —

_ ••
1312
METHOD TITLE
Modified Method 5
Sampling Train
Source Assessment
Sampling System
(SASS)
Volatile Organic
Sampling Train
Pensky-Martens
Closed-Cup Method
for Determining
Ignitability
Setaflash Closed-Cup
Method for
Determining
Ignitability
Corrosivity Toward
Steel
Extraction Procedure
(EP) Toxicity Test
Method and
Structural Integrity
Test
Toxicity
Characteristic
Leaching Procedure
Synthetic
Precipitation
Leaching Procedure
SW-846
VOLUME/
CHAPTER/
SECTION
LOCATION
Vol II
Chap 10
Vol II
Chap 10
Vol II
Chap 10
Vol 1C
Chap 8
Sec 8.1
Vol 1C
Chap 8
Sec 8.1
Vol 1C
Chap 8
Sec 8.2
Vol 1C
Chap 8
Sec 8.4
Vol 1C
Chap 8
Sec 8.4
Vol 1C
Chap 6
CURRENT
PROMUL-
GATED
METHOD
0010
Rev 0
9/86
0020
Rev 0
9/86
0030
Rev 0
9/86
1010
Rev 0
9/86
1020A
Rev 1
7/92
1110
Rev 0
9/86
1310A
Rev 1
7/92
1311
Rev 0
7/92
1312
Rev 0
9/94

-------
SW-846 METHOD STATUS TABLE (9/94), CONTINUED
HETH NO.
THIRD ED
DATED
9/86
1320
1330
3005
3010

3020
3040
3050
NETH NO.
FINAL
UPDATE I
DATED
7/92

1330A
3005A
3010A

3020A

3050A
NETH NO.
FINAL
UPDT. II
DATED
9/94




3015

"

METHOD TITLE
Multiple Extraction
Procedure
Extraction Procedure
for Oily Wastes
Acid Digestion of
Waters for Total
Recoverable or
Dissolved Metals for
Analysis by FLAA or
ICP Spectroscopy
Acid Digestion of
Aqueous Samples and
Extracts for Total
Metals for Analysis
by FLAA or ICP
Spectroscopy
Microwave Assisted
Acid Digestion of
Aqueous Samples and
Extracts
Acid Digestion of
Aqueous Samples and
Extracts for Total
Metals for Analysis
by GFAA Spectroscopy
Dissolution
Procedure for Oils,
Greases, or Waxes
Acid Digestion of
Sediments, Sludges,
and Soils
SW-846
VOLUME/
CHAPTER/
SECTION
LOCATION
Vol 1C
Chap 6
Vol 1C
Chap 6
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.2
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.2
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.2
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.2
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.2
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.2
CURRENT
PROMUL-
GATED
METHOD
1320
Rev 0
9/86
1330A
Rev 1
7/92
3005A
Rev 1
7/92
3010A
Rev 1
7/92
3015
Rev 0
9/94
3020A
Rev 1
7/92
3040
Rev 0
9/86
3050A
Rev 1
7/92

-------
SW-846 METHOD STATUS TABLE (9/94), CONTINUED
METH NO.
THIRD ED
DATED
9/86
~ ~
3500
3510
3520
3540
— —
3550
3580
3600
NETH NO.
FINAL
UPDATE I
DATED
7/92
™* ™*
3500A
3510A
3520A
3540A
	
— ~
3580A
3600A
NETH NO.
FINAL
UPDT. II
DATED
9/94
3051
"
3510B
3520B
3540B
3541
3550A
*"" ~
3600B
NETHOD TITLE
Microwave Assisted
Acid Digestion of
Sediments, Sludges,
Soils, and Oils
Organic Extraction
and Sample
Preparation
Separatory Funnel
Liquid-Liquid
Extraction
Continuous Liquid-
Liquid Extraction
Soxhlet Extraction
Automated Soxhlet
Extraction
Ultrasonic Extrac-
tion
Waste Dilution
Cleanup
SW-846
VOLUME/
CHAPTER/
SECTION
LOCATION
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.2
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.2.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.2.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.2.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.2.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.2.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.2.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.2.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.2.2
CURRENT
PROMUL-
GATED
NETHOD
3051
Rev 0
9/94
3500A
Rev 1
7/92
3510B
Rev 2
9/94
3520B
Rev 2
9/94
3540B
Rev 2
9/94
3541
Rev 0
9/94
3550A
Rev 1
9/94
3580A
Rev 1
7/92
3600B
Rev 2
9/94

-------
SW-846 METHOD STATUS TABLE (9/94),  CONTINUED
NETH NO.
THIRD ED
DATED
9/86
3610
3611
3620
3630
3640
3650
3660

3810
NETH NO.
FINAL
UPDATE I
DATED
7/92
3610A
3611A
3620A
3630A

3650A
3660A


NETH NO.
FINAL
UPDT. II
DATED
9/94
"
"
"
3630B
3640A
~ *™
"
3665

METHOD TITLE
Alumina Column
Cleanup
Alumina Column
Cleanup and
Separation of
Petroleum Wastes
Florisil Column
Cleanup
Silica Gel Cleanup
Gel -Permeation
Cleanup
Acid-Base Partition
Cleanup
Sulfur Cleanup
Sulfuric
Acid/Permanganate
Cleanup
Headspace
SW-846
VOLUME/
CHAPTER/
SECTION
LOCATION
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.2.2
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.2.2
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.2.2
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.2.2
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.2.2
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.2.2
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.2.2
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.2.2
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec 4.4
CURRENT
PROMUL-
GATED
METHOD
3610A
Rev 1
7/92
3611A
Rev 1
7/92
3620A
Rev 1
7/92
3630B
Rev 2
9/94
3640A
Rev 1
9/94
3650A
Rev 1
7/92
3660A
Rev 1
7/92
3665
Rev 0
9/94
3810
Rev 0
9/86

-------
SW-846 METHOD STATUS TABLE (9/94), CONTINUED
HETH NO.
THIRD ED
DATED
9/86
3820

5030
5040

	
6010
METH NO.
FINAL
UPDATE I
DATED
7/92
~ ~

5030A


— —
6010A
METH NO.
FINAL
UPDT. II
DATED
9/94
— —
4010
(Update
IIA,
dated
8/93)
— ~
5040A
5041
5050
"
METHOD TITLE
Hexadecane
Extraction and
Screening of
Purgeable Organics
Screening for
Pentachlorophenol
by Immunoassay
Purge-and-Trap
Analysis of Sorbent
Cartridges from
Volatile Organic
Sampling Train
(VOST) : Gas
Chromatography/Mass
Spectrometry
Technique
Protocol for
Analysis of Sorbent
Cartridges from
Volatile Organic
Sampling Train
(VOST): Wide-bore
Capillary Column
Technique
Bomb Preparation
Method for Solid
Waste
Inductively Coupled
Plasma-Atomic
Emission
Spectroscopy
SW-846
VOLUME/
CHAPTER/
SECTION
LOCATION
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec 4.4
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec 4.4
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.2.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.2.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.2.1
Vol 1C
Chap 5
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
CURRENT
PROMUL-
GATED
METHOD
3820
Rev 0
9/86
4010
Rev 0
8/93
5030A
Rev 1
7/92
5040A
Rev 1
9/94
5041
Rev 0
9/94
5050
Rev 0
9/94
6010A
Rev 1
7/92

-------
SW-846 METHOD STATUS TABLE (9/94), CONTINUED
NETH NO.
THIRD ED
DATED
9/86

7000
7020
7040
7041
7060
7061

7080
NETH NO.
FINAL
UPDATE I
DATED
7/92

7000A




7061A


NETH NO.
FINAL
UPDT. II
DATED
9/94
6020
"

"

7060A
"
7062
7080A
NETHOD TITLE
Inductively Coupled
Plasma - Mass
Spectrometry
Atomic Absorption
Methods
Aluminum (Atomic
Absorption, Direct
Aspiration)
Antimony (Atomic
Absorption, Direct
Aspiration)
Antimony (Atomic
Absorption, Furnace
Technique)
Arsenic (Atomic
Absorption, Furnace
Technique)
Arsenic (Atomic
Absorption, Gaseous
Hydride)
Antimony and Arsenic
(Atomic Absorption,
Borohydride
Reduction)
Barium (Atomic
Absorption, Direct
Aspiration)
SW-846
VOLUME/
CHAPTER/
SECTION
LOCATION
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
CURRENT
PROMUL-
GATED
METHOD
6020
Rev 0
9/94
7000A
Rev 1
7/92
7020
Rev 0
9/86
7040
Rev 0
9/86
7041
Rev 0
9/86
7060A
Rev 1
9/94
7061A
Rev 1
7/92
7062
Rev 0
9/94
7080A
Rev 1
9/94

-------
SW-846 METHOD STATUS TABLE (9/94), CONTINUED
METH NO.
THIRD ED
DATED
9/86
•* **
7090
7091
7130
7131
7140
7190
7191
7195
NETH NO.
FINAL
UPDATE I
DATED
7/92
7081
~ ~
"* ~
~* ~
•" *•
	
— —
~ ~
"
NETH NO.
FINAL
UPDT. II
DATED
9/94
~ ~
*™ *"

~ ~
7131A
_ .
	
~ ~
"
NETHOD TITLE
Barium (Atomic
Absorption, Furnace
Technique)
Beryllium (Atomic
Absorption, Direct
Aspiration)
Beryllium (Atomic
Absorption, Furnace
Technique)
Cadmium (Atomic
Absorption, Direct
Aspiration)
Cadmium (Atomic
Absorption, Furnace
Technique)
Calcium (Atomic
Absorption, Direct
Aspiration)
Chromium (Atomic
Absorption, Direct
Aspiration)
Chromium (Atomic
Absorption, Furnace
Technique)
Chromium, Hexavalent
(Coprecipitation)
SW-846
VOLUME/
CHAPTER/
SECTION
LOCATION
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
CURRENT
PROMUL-
GATED
NETHOD
7081
Rev 0
7/92
7090
Rev 0
9/86
7091
Rev 0
9/86
7130
Rev 0
9/86
7131A
Rev 1
9/94
7140
Rev 0
9/86
7190
Rev 0
9/86
7191
Rev 0
9/86
7195
Rev 0
9/86

-------
SW-846 METHOD STATUS TABLE (9/94), CONTINUED
HETH NO.
THIRD ED
DATED
9/86
7196
7197
7198
7200
7201
7210

7380

NETH NO.
FINAL
UPDATE I
DATED
7/92
7196A





7211

7381
NETH NO.
FINAL
UPDT. II
DATED
9/94
"
"
"

"
"



NETHOD TITLE
Chromium, Hexavalent
(Colorimetric)
Chromium, Hexavalent
(Chelation/Extrac-
tion)
Chromium, Hexavalent
(Differential Pulse
Polarography)
Cobalt (Atomic
Absorption, Direct
Aspiration)
Cobalt (Atomic
Absorption, Furnace
Technique)
Copper (Atomic
Absorption, Direct
Aspiration)
Copper (Atomic
Absorption, Furnace
Technique)
Iron (Atomic
Absorption, Direct
Aspiration)
Iron (Atomic
Absorption, Furnace
Technique)
SW-846
VOLUME/
CHAPTER/
SECTION
LOCATION
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
CURRENT
PROMUL-
GATED
METHOD
7196A
Rev 1
7/92
7197
Rev 0
9/86
7198
Rev 0
9/86
7200
Rev 0
9/86
7201
Rev 0
9/86
7210
Rev 0
9/86
7211
Rev 0
7/92
7380
Rev 0
9/86
7381
Rev 0
7/92

-------
SW-846 METHOD STATUS TABLE (9/94), CONTINUED
METH NO.
THIRD ED
DATED
9/86
7420
7421
•* ~
7450
7460
— —
7470
7471
7480
METH NO.
FINAL
UPDATE I
DATED
7/92
— —
_ _
7430
~ ~
— —
7461
— —
— —
™" *""
NETH NO.
FINAL
UPDT. II
DATED
9/94
~ —
— —
~" "~
~ ~
~ ~*
m. —
7470A
7471A
"
METHOD TITLE
Lead (Atomic
Absorption, Direct
Aspiration)
Lead (Atomic
Absorption, Furnace
Technique)
Lithium (Atomic
Absorption, Direct
Aspiration)
Magnesium (Atomic
Absorption, Direct
Aspiration)
Manganese (Atomic
Absorption, Direct
Aspiration)
Manganese (Atomic
Absorption, Furnace
Technique)
Mercury in Liquid
Waste (Manual Cold-
Vapor Technique)
Mercury in Solid or
Semi sol id Waste
(Manual Cold-Vapor
Technique)
Molybdenum (Atomic
Absorption, Direct
Aspiration)
SW-846
VOLUME/
CHAPTER/
SECTION
LOCATION
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
CURRENT
PROMUL-
GATED
METHOD
7420
Rev 0
9/86
7421
Rev 0
9/86
7430
Rev 0
7/92
7450
Rev 0
9/86
7460
Rev 0
9/86
7461
Rev 0
7/92
7470A
Rev 1
9/94
7471A
Rev 1
9/94
7480
Rev 0
9/86

-------
SW-846 METHOD STATUS TABLE (9/94),  CONTINUED
NETH NO.
THIRD ED
DATED
9/86
7481
7520
7550
7610
7740
7741
"
7760
"
NETH NO.
FINAL
UPDATE I
DATED
7/92

"
"
"
"
~ ~
"
7760A
7761
METH NO.
FINAL
UPDT. II
DATED
9/94
"
"
"
"
"
7741A
7742
"
"
METHOD TITLE
Molybdenum (Atomic
Absorption, Furnace
Technique)
Nickel (Atomic
Absorption, Direct
Aspiration)
Osmium (Atomic
Absorption, Direct
Aspiration)
Potassium (Atomic
Absorption, Direct
Aspiration)
Selenium (Atomic
Absorption, Furnace
Technique)
Selenium (Atomic
Absorption, Gaseous
Hydride)
Selenium (Atomic
Absorption,
Borohydride
Reduction)
Silver (Atomic
Absorption, Direct
Aspiration)
Silver (Atomic
Absorption, Furnace
Technique)
SW-846
VOLUME/
CHAPTER/
SECTION
LOCATION
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
CURRENT
PROMUL-
GATED
METHOD
7481
Rev 0
9/86
7520
Rev 0
9/86
7550
Rev 0
9/86
7610
Rev 0
9/86
7740
Rev 0
9/86
7741A
Rev 1
9/94
7742
Rev 0
9/94
7760A
Rev 1
7/92
7761
Rev 0
7/92
                                      10

-------
SW-846 METHOD STATUS TABLE (9/94), CONTINUED
METH NO.
THIRD ED
DATED
9/86
7770
- -
7840
7841
7870
7910
7911
7950
	
METH NO.
FINAL
UPDATE I
DATED
7/92
— ~
7780
- -
- -
~ —
— ~
— —
_ _
7951
METH NO.
FINAL
UPDT. II
DATED
9/94
_ _
~ ~
— —
— —
~ ~
— —
™" ~*
~ ~
"
METHOD TITLE
Sodium (Atomic
Absorption, Direct
Aspiration)
Strontium (Atomic
Absorption, Direct
Aspiration)
Thallium (Atomic
Absorption, Direct
Aspiration)
Thallium (Atomic
Absorption, Furnace
Technique)
Tin (Atomic
Absorption, Direct
Aspiration)
Vanadium (Atomic
Absorption, Direct
Aspiration)
Vanadium (Atomic
Absorption, Furnace
Technique)
Zinc (Atomic
Absorption, Direct
Aspiration)
Zinc (Atomic
Absorption, Furnace
Technique)
SW-846
VOLUME/
CHAPTER/
SECTION
LOCATION
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
Vol IA
Chap 3
Sec 3.3
CURRENT
PROMUL-
GATED
METHOD
7770
Rev 0
9/86
7780
Rev 0
7/92
7840
Rev 0
9/86
7841
Rev 0
9/86
7870
Rev 0
9/86
7910
Rev 0
9/86
7911
Rev 0
9/86
7950
Rev 0
9/86
7951
Rev 0
7/92
                                      11

-------
SU-846 METHOD STATUS TABLE (9/94), CONTINUED
NETH NO.
THIRD ED
DATED
9/86
8000
8010

8015
8020

8030

NETH NO.
FINAL
UPDATE I
DATED
7/92
8000A
8010A
8011
80 ISA

8021
8030A

NETH NO.
FINAL
UPDT. II
DATED
9/94
"
8010B

"
8020A
8021A
"
8031
METHOD TITLE
Gas Chromatography
Halogenated Volatile
Organics by Gas
Chromatography
1,2-Dibromoethane
and l,2-Dibromo-3-
chloropropane by
Microextraction and
Gas Chromatography
Nonhalogenated
Volatile Organics by
Gas Chromatography
Aromatic Volatile
Organics by Gas
Chromatography
Halogenated
Volatiles by Gas
Chromatography Using
Photoionization and
Electrolytic
Conductivity
Detectors in Series:
Capillary Column
Technique
Acrolein and
Acrylonitrile by Gas
Chromatography
Acrylonitrile by Gas
Chromatography
SU-846
VOLUME/
CHAPTER/
SECTION
LOCATION
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.1
CURRENT
PROMUL-
GATED
METHOD
8000A
Rev 1
7/92
8010B
Rev 2
9/94
8011
Rev 0
7/92
8015A
Rev 1
7/92
8020A
Rev 1
9/94
8021A
Rev 1
9/94
8030A
Rev 1
7/92
8031
Rev 0
9/94
                                      12

-------
SW-846 METHOD STATUS TABLE (9/94), CONTINUED
NETH NO.
THIRD ED
DATED
9/86
~ ~
8040
8060

*™ ~
8080

8090
HETH NO.
FINAL
UPDATE I
DATED
7/92
~ ~
8040A
"

8070



NETH NO.
FINAL
UPDT. II
DATED
9/94
8032
"
"
8061
~ ~
8080A
8081

NETHOD TITLE
Acryl amide by Gas
Chromatography
Phenols by Gas
Chromatography
Phthalate Esters
Phthalate Esters by
Capillary Gas
Chromatography with
Electron Capture
Detection (GC/ECD)
Nitrosamines by Gas
Chromatography
Organochlorine Pes-
ticides and
Polychlorinated
Biphenyls by Gas
Chromatography
Organochlorine
Pesticides and PCBs
as Aroclors by Gas
Chromatography:
Capillary Column
Technique
Nitroaromatics and
Cyclic Ketones
SW-846
VOLUME/
CHAPTER/
SECTION
LOCATION
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.1
CURRENT
PROMUL-
GATED
NETHOD
8032
Rev 0
9/94
8040A
Rev 1
7/92
8060
Rev 0
9/86
8061
Rev 0
9/94
8070
Rev 0
7/92
8080A
Rev 1
9/94
8081
Rev 0
9/94
8090
Rev 0
9/86
                                      13

-------
SW-846 METHOD STATUS TABLE (9/94), CONTINUED
NETH NO.
THIRD ED
DATED
9/86
8100
"
8120

8140

8150

METH NO.
FINAL
UPDATE I
DATED
7/92
"
8110
"

"" ™*
8141
8150A

METH NO.
FINAL
UPDT. II
DATED
9/94
"
"
8120A
8121
°™ ~
8141A
8150B
8151
METHOD TITLE
Polynuclear Aromatic
Hydrocarbons
Haloethers by Gas
Chromatography
Chlorinated
Hydrocarbons by Gas
Chromatography
Chlorinated
Hydrocarbons by Gas
Chromatography:
Capillary Column
Technique
Organophosphorus
Pesticides
Organophosphorus
Compounds by Gas
Chromatography:
Capillary Column
Technique
Chlorinated
Herbicides by Gas
Chromatography
Chlorinated
Herbicides by GC
Using Methyl ati on or
Pentafluorobenzyl-
ation Derivati-
zation: Capillary
Column Technique
SW-846
VOLUME/
CHAPTER/
SECTION
LOCATION
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.1
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.1
CURRENT
PROMUL-
GATED
METHOD
8100
Rev 0
9/86
8110
Rev 0
7/92
8120A
Rev 1
9/94
8121
Rev 0
9/94
8140
Rev 0
9/86
8141A
Rev 1
9/94
8150B
Rev 2
9/94
8151
Rev 0
9/94
                                      14

-------
SW-846 METHOD STATUS TABLE (9/94), CONTINUED
METH NO.
THIRD ED
DATED
9/86
8240
8250

8270

8280
NETH NO.
FINAL
UPDATE I
DATED
7/92
8240A

8260
8270A


NETH NO.
FINAL
UPDT. II
DATED
9/94
8240B
8250A
8260A
8270B
8275

METHOD TITLE
Volatile Organic
Compounds by Gas
Chromatography/Mass
Spectrometry (GC/MS)
Semivolatile Organic
Compounds
by Gas
Chromatography/Mass
Spectrometry (GC/MS)
Volatile Organic
Compounds by Gas
Chromatography/Mass
Spectrometry
(GC/MS): Capillary
Column Technique
Semivolatile Organic
Compounds by Gas
Chromatography/Mass
Spectrometry
(GC/MS): Capillary
Column Technique
Thermal
Chromatography/Mass
Spectrometry (TC/MS)
for Screening
Semivolatile Organic
Compounds
The Analysis of
Polychlorinated
Dibenzo-p-Dioxins
and Polychlorinated
Dibenzofurans
SW-846
VOLUME/
CHAPTER/
SECTION
LOCATION
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.2
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.2
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.2
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.2
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec 4.4
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.2
CURRENT
PROMUL-
GATED
METHOD
8240B
Rev 2
9/94
8250A
Rev 1
9/94
8260A
Rev 1
9/94
8270B
Rev 2
9/94
8275
Rev 0
9/94
8280
Rev 0
9/86
                                       15

-------
SW-846 METHOD STATUS TABLE (9/94),  CONTINUED
NETH NO.
THIRD ED
DATED
9/86

8310



NETH NO.
FINAL
UPDATE I
DATED
7/92





NETH NO.
FINAL
UPDT. II
DATED
9/94
8290

8315
8316
8318
NETHOD TITLE
Polychlorinated
Dibenzodioxins
(PCDDs) and
Polychlorinated
Dibenzofurans
(PCDFs) by High-
Resolution Gas
Chromatography/High-
Resolution Mass
Spectrometry
(HRGC/HRMS)
Polynuclear Aromatic
Hydrocarbons
Determination of
Carbonyl Compounds
by High Performance
Liquid
Chromatography
(HPLC)
Acryl amide,
Acrylonitrile and
Acrolein by High
Performance Liquid
Chromatography
(HPLC)
N-Methyl carbamates
by High Performance
Liquid Chroma-
tography (HPLC)
SW-846
VOLUME/
CHAPTER/
SECTION
LOCATION
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.2
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.3
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.3
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.3
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.3
CURRENT
PROMUL-
GATED
NETHOD
8290
Rev 0
9/94
8310
Rev 0
9/86
8315
Rev 0
9/94
8316
Rev 0
9/94
8318
Rev 0
9/94
                                      16

-------
SW-846 METHOD STATUS TABLE (9/94),  CONTINUED
METH NO.
THIRD ED
DATED
9/86




9010
9012
NETH NO.
FINAL
UPDATE I
DATED
7/92




9010A
_ •»
NETH NO.
FINAL
UPDT. II
DATED
9/94
8321
8330
8331
8410
~ ~
"
NETHOD TITLE
Solvent Extractable
Non-Volatile
Compounds by High
Performance Liquid
Chromatography/Ther-
mospray/Mass
Spectrometry
(HPLC/TSP/MS) or
Ultraviolet (UV)
Detection
Nitroaromatics and
Nitramines by High
Performance Liquid
Chromatography
(HPLC)
Tetrazene by Reverse
Phase High
Performance Liquid
Chromatography
(HPLC)
Gas Chroma-
tography/Fourier
Transform Infrared
(GC/FT-IR) Spec-
trometry for
Semi volatile
Organics: Capillary
Column
Total and Amenable
Cyanide
(Colorimetric,
Manual )
Total and Amenable
Cyanide
(Colorimetric,
Automated UV)
SW-846
VOLUME/
CHAPTER/
SECTION
LOCATION
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.3
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.3
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.3
Vol IB
Chap 4
Sec
4.3.4
Vol 1C
Chap 5
Vol 1C
Chap 5
CURRENT
PROMUL-
GATED
METHOD
8321
Rev 0
9/94
8330
Rev 0
9/94
8331
Rev 0
9/94
8410
Rev 0
9/94
9010A
Rev 1
7/92
9012
Rev 0
9/86
                                      17

-------
SW-846 METHOD STATUS TABLE (9/94), CONTINUED
METH NO.
THIRD ED
DATED
9/86

9020

9022
9030

9035
9036
9038
METH NO.
FINAL
UPDATE I
DATED
7/92
9013
9020A
9021

9030A
9031



METH NO.
FINAL
UPDT. II
DATED
9/94
"
9020B
"


"
"


METHOD TITLE
Cyanide Extraction
Procedure for Solids
and Oils
Total Organic
Hal ides (TOX)
Purgeable Organic
Hal ides (POX)
Total Organic
Hal ides (TOX) by
Neutron Activation
Analysis
Acid-Soluble and
Acid-Insoluble
Sulfides
Extractable Sulfides
Sulfate
(Colorimetric,
Automated,
Chi orani late)
Sulfate
(Colorimetric,
Automated,
Methyl thymol Blue,
AA II)
Sulfate
(Turbidimetric)
SW-846
VOLUME/
CHAPTER/
SECTION
LOCATION
Vol 1C
Chap 5
Vol 1C
Chap 5
Vol 1C
Chap 5
Vol 1C
Chap 5
Vol 1C
Chap 5
Vol 1C
Chap 5
Vol 1C
Chap 5
Vol 1C
Chap 5
Vol 1C
Chap 5
CURRENT
PROMUL-
GATED
METHOD
9013
Rev 0
7/92
9020B
Rev 2
9/94
9021
Rev 0
7/92
9022
Rev 0
9/86
9030A
Rev 1
7/92
9031
Rev 0
7/92
9035
Rev 0
9/86
9036
Rev 0
9/86
9038
Rev 0
9/86
                                      18

-------
SW-846 METHOD STATUS TABLE (9/94),  CONTINUED
METH NO.
THIRD ED
DATED
9/86
9040
9041
9045
9050
- -
9060
9065
9066
9067
NETH NO.
FINAL
UPDATE I
DATED
7/92
_ -
9041A
9045A
- -
— —
- -
*• ~
_ —
_ _
METH NO.
FINAL
UPDT. II
DATED
9/94
9040A
— —
9045B
— —
9056
~ ~
~ —
"
"
METHOD TITLE
pH Electrometric
Measurement
pH Paper Method
Soil and Waste pH
Specific Conductance
Determination of
Inorganic Anions by
Ion Chromatography
Total Organic Carbon
Phenol ics
(Spectrophotometric,
Manual 4-AAP with
Distillation)
Phenol ics
(Colorimetric,
Automated 4-AAP with
Distillation)
Phenol ics
(Spectrophotometric,
MBTH with
Distillation)
SW-846
VOLUME/
CHAPTER/
SECTION
LOCATION
Vol 1C
Chap 6
Vol 1C
Chap 6
Vol 1C
Chap 6
Vol 1C
Chap 6
Vol 1C
Chap 5
Vol 1C
Chap 5
Vol 1C
Chap 5
Vol 1C
Chap 5
Vol 1C
Chap 5
CURRENT
PROMUL-
GATED
METHOD
9040A
Rev 1
9/94
9041A
Rev 1
7/92
9045B
Rev 2
9/94
9050
Rev 0
9/86
9056
Rev 0
9/94
9060
Rev 0
9/86
9065
Rev 0
9/86
9066
Rev 0
9/86
9067
Rev 0
9/86
                                      19

-------
SW-846 METHOD STATUS TABLE (9/94), CONTINUED
METH NO.
THIRD ED
DATED
9/86
9070
9071



9080
9081
METH NO.
FINAL
UPDATE I
DATED
7/92







METH NO.
FINAL
UPDT. II
DATED
9/94

9071A
9075
9076
9077
"

METHOD TITLE
Total Recoverable
Oil & Grease
(Gravimetric,
Separatory Funnel
Extraction)
Oil and Grease
Extraction Method
for Sludge and
Sediment
Samples
Test Method for
Total Chlorine in
New and Used
Petroleum Products
by X-Ray
Fluorescence
Spectrometry (XRF)
Test Method for
Total Chlorine in
New and Used
Petroleum Products
by Oxi dative
Combustion and
Microcoulometry
Test Methods for
Total Chlorine in
New and Used
Petroleum Products
(Field Test Kit
Methods)
Cation-Exchange
Capacity of Soils
(Ammonium Acetate)
Cation-Exchange
Capacity of Soils
(Sodium Acetate)
SW-846
VOLUME/
CHAPTER/
SECTION
LOCATION
Vol 1C
Chap 5
Vol 1C
Chap 5
Vol 1C
Chap 5
Vol 1C
Chap 5
Vol 1C
Chap 5
Vol 1C
Chap 6
Vol 1C
Chap 6
CURRENT
PROMUL-
GATED
METHOD
9070
Rev 0
9/86
9071A
Rev 1
9/94
9075
Rev 0
9/94
9076
Rev 0
9/94
9077
Rev 0
9/94
9080
Rev 0
9/86
9081
Rev 0
9/86
                                      20

-------
SW-846 METHOD STATUS TABLE (9/94), CONTINUED
METH NO.
THIRD ED
DATED
9/86
9090
9095
— —
9100
9131
9132
9200
9250
9251
NETH NO.
FINAL
UPDATE I
DATED
7/92
9090A
	
_ _

- -
	
_ _
** "*
- ••
HETH NO.
FINAL
UPDT. II
DATED
9/94
~ ~
•™ —
9096

_ —
_ _

"
_ —
METHOD TITLE
Compatibility Test
for Wastes and
Membrane Liners
Paint Filter Liquids
Test
Liquid Release Test
(LRT) Procedure
Saturated Hydraulic
Conductivity,
Saturated Leachate
Conductivity, and
Intrinsic
Permeability
Total Col i form:
Multiple Tube
Fermentation
Technique
Total Col i form:
Membrane Filter
Technique
Nitrate
Chloride
(Colorimetric,
Automated
Ferricyanide AAI)
Chloride
(Colorimetric,
Automated
Ferricyanide AAII)
SW-846
VOLUME/
CHAPTER/
SECTION
LOCATION
Vol 1C
Chap 6
Vol 1C
Chap 6
Vol 1C
Chap 6
Vol 1C
Chap 6
Vol 1C
Chap 5
Vol 1C
Chap 5
Vol 1C
Chap 5
Vol 1C
Chap 5
Vol 1C
Chap 5
CURRENT
PROMUL-
GATED
METHOD
9090A
Rev 1
7/92
9095
Rev 0
9/86
9096
Rev 0
9/94
9100
Rev 0
9/86
9131
Rev 0
9/86
9132
Rev 0
9/86
9200
Rev 0
9/86
9250
Rev 0
9/86
9251
Rev 0
9/86
                                      21

-------
SW-846 METHOD STATUS TABLE (9/94), CONTINUED
NETH NO.
THIRD ED
DATED
9/86
9252

9310
9315
9320
HCN Test
Method
H2S Test
Method
METH NO.
FINAL
UPDATE I
DATED
7/92





HCN Test
Method
H2S Test
Method
METH NO.
FINAL
UPDT. II
DATED
9/94
9252A
9253
"
"
"
HCN Test
Method
H2S Test
Method
METHOD TITLE
Chloride
(Titrimetric,
Mercuric Nitrate)
Chloride
(Titrimetric, Silver
Nitrate)
Gross Alpha and
Gross Beta
Alpha-Emitting
Radium Isotopes
Radium-228
Test Method to
Determine Hydrogen
Cyanide Released
from Wastes
Test Method to
Determine Hydrogen
Sulfide Released
from Wastes
SW-846
VOLUME/
CHAPTER/
SECTION
LOCATION
Vol 1C
Chap 5
Vol 1C
Chap 5
Vol 1C
Chap 6
Vol 1C
Chap 6
Vol 1C
Chap 5
Vol 1C
Chap 7
Sec 7.3
Vol 1C
Chap 7
Sec 7.3
CURRENT
PROMUL-
GATED
METHOD
9252A
Rev 1
9/94
9253
Rev 0
9/94
9310
Rev 0
9/86
9315
Rev 0
9/86
9320
Rev 0
9/86
Guidance
Method
Only
Guidance
Method
Only
                                     22

-------
                                  DISCLAIMER


      Mention  of  trade  names  or  commercial  products  does  not  constitute
endorsement  or recommendation  for  use  by  the U.S.  Environmental  Protection
Agency.

      SW-846 methods are designed to be used with equipment from any manufacturer
that results in suitable method performance (as assessed by accuracy, precision,
detection limits and matrix compatibility). In several SW-846 methods, equipment
specifications and  settings  are given  for the specific instrument used during
method development,  or subsequently  approved for use  in the method.   These
references are made to provide the best possible guidance  to laboratories using
this manual.  Equipment not specified  in the method may be used as long as the
laboratory  achieves  equivalent  or  superior method performance.   If alternate
equipment is used, the laboratory must follow the manufacturer's instructions for
their particular instrument.

      Since  many  types and sizes of  glassware and  supplies  are  commercially
available, and since  it is  possible to prepare reagents and standards in many
different ways, those specified in these methods may  be  replaced by any similar
types as long as this  substitution does not  affect  the overall  quality of the
analyses.
                                DISCLAIMER  -  1                       Revision  0
                                                                     July  1992

-------
                                   ABSTRACT

Test Methods for  Evaluating Solid Waste, Physical/Chemical Methods  (SW-846)
provides test procedures and guidance which are recommended for use in conducting
the evaluations and measurements needed to comply with the Resource Conservation
and Recovery Act  (RCRA),  Public  Law 94-580, as  amended.   These  methods are
approved by  the U.S.  Environmental  Protection  Agency  for obtaining  data to
satisfy the requirements  of 40 CFR Parts 122  through  270 promulgated under RCRA,
as amended.  This manual presents the  state-of-the-art  in routine analytical
tested  adapted  for the  RCRA  program.    It  contains procedures for  field and
laboratory  quality  control, sampling,  determining  hazardous  constituents in
wastes,  determining   the   hazardous  characteristics   of  wastes  (toxicity,
ignitability,  reactivity,   and  corrosivity),   and  for  determining  physical
properties of wastes.  It  also  contains guidance on how to select appropriate
methods.

      Several of the hazardous waste regulations  under Subtitle C of RCRA require
that  specific  testing methods  described  in SW-846 be  employed  for certain
applications.  Refer to 40  Code of Federal Regulations (CFR),  Parts 260 through
270, for those  specific requirements. Any reliable analytical method may be used
to meet other requirements  under Subtitle C  of RCRA.
                                  ABSTRACT  -  1                        Revision  2
                                                                 September 1994

-------
                           TABLE   OF   CONTENTS
                                     VOLUME ONE

                                      SECTION  A
DISCLAIMER
ABSTRACT
TABLE OF CONTENTS
METHOD INDEX AND CONVERSION TABLE
PREFACE
ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS
                    PART I     METHODS  FOR ANALYTES  AND  PROPERTIES

CHAPTER ONE -- QUALITY CONTROL

      1.0   Introduction
      2.0   QA Project Plan
      3.0   Field Operations
      4.0   Laboratory Operations
      5.0   Definitions
      6.0   References

CHAPTER TWO -- CHOOSING THE CORRECT PROCEDURE

      2.1   Purpose
      2.2   Required Information
      2.3   Implementing the Guidance
      2.4   Characteristics
      2.5   Ground Water
      2.6   References

CHAPTER THREE -- METALLIC ANALYTES

      3.1   Sampling Considerations
      3.2   Sample Preparation Methods

            Method 3005A:     Acid  Digestion  of  Waters  for  Total   Recoverable  or
                              Dissolved Metals for  Analysis by Flame Atomic Absorption
                              (FLAA) or Inductively Coupled Plasma  (ICP) Spectroscopy
            Method 3010A:     Acid Digestion of Aqueous Samples and Extracts  for Total
                              Metals for Analysis by Flame Atomic Absorption  (FLAA) or
                              Inductively Coupled  Plasma (ICP) Spectroscopy
            Method 3015:      Microwave Assisted Acid Digestion of Aqueous Samples and
                              Extracts
                                    CONTENTS  - 1                          Revision 2
                                                                      September 1994

-------
      Method 3020A:
      Method 3040:
      Method 3050A:
      Method 3051:
           Acid Digestion of Aqueous Samples and Extracts  for Total
           Metals  for   Analysis   by  Graphite   Furnace  Atomic
           Absorption (GFAA)  Spectroscopy
           Dissolution Procedure for Oils, Greases, or Waxes
           Acid Digestion of Sediments, Sludges, and Soils
           Microwave Assisted Acid Digestion of Sediments, Sludges,
           Soils, and Oils
3.3   Methods for Determination of Metals
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
6010A:
6020:
7000A:
7020:
7040:
7041:
7060A:
7061A:
7062:
7080A:
7081:
7090:
7091:
7130:
7131A:
7140:
7190:
7191:
7195:
7196A:
7197:
7198:
7200:
7201:
7210:
7211:
7380:
7381:
7420:
7421:
7430:
7450:
7460:
7461:
7470A:
7471A:
      Method 7480:
      Method 7481:
      Method 7520:
      Method 7550:
      Method 7610:
      Method 7740:
Inductively Coupled Plasma-Atomic Emission Spectroscopy
Inductively Coupled Plasma - Mass Spectrometry
Atomic Absorption Methods
Aluminum (AA, Direct Aspiration)
Antimony (AA, Direct Aspiration)
Antimony (AA, Furnace Technique)
Arsenic (AA, Furnace Technique)
Arsenic (AA, Gaseous Hydride)
Antimony and Arsenic (AA, Borohydride Reduction)
Barium (AA, Direct Aspiration)
Barium (AA, Furnace Technique)
Beryllium (AA, Direct Aspiration)
Beryllium (AA, Furnace Technique)
Cadmium (AA, Direct Aspiration)
Cadmium (AA, Furnace Technique)
Calcium (AA, Direct Aspiration)
Chromium (AA, Direct Aspiration)
Chromium (AA, Furnace Technique)
Chromium, Hexavalent (Coprecipitation)
Chromium, Hexavalent (Colorimetric)
Chromium, Hexavalent (Chelation/Extraction)
Chromium, Hexavalent (Differential  Pulse Polarography)
Cobalt (AA, Direct Aspiration)
Cobalt (AA, Furnace Technique)
Copper (AA, Direct Aspiration)
Copper (AA, Furnace Technique)
Iron (AA, Direct Aspiration)
Iron (AA, Furnace Technique)
Lead (AA, Direct Aspiration)
Lead (AA, Furnace Technique)
Lithium (AA, Direct Aspiration)
Magnesium (AA, Direct Aspiration)
Manganese (AA, Direct Aspiration)
Manganese (AA, Furnace Technique)
Mercury in Liquid Waste (Manual Cold-Vapor Technique)
Mercury in Solid or Semisolid Waste (Manual Cold-Vapor
Technique)
Molybdenum (AA,  Direct Aspiration)
Molybdenum (AA,  Furnace Technique)
Nickel (AA, Direct Aspiration)
Osmium (AA, Direct Aspiration)
Potassium (AA, Direct Aspiration)
Selenium (AA, Furnace Technique)
                              CONTENTS - 2
                                                       Revision 2
                                                   September 1994

-------
            Method 7741A:     Selenium (AA, Gaseous Hydride)
            Method 7742:      Selenium (AA, Borohydride Reduction)
            Method 7760A:     Silver (AA, Direct Aspiration)
            Method 7761:      Silver (AA, Furnace Technique)
            Method 7770:      Sodium (AA, Direct Aspiration)
            Method 7780:      Strontium (AA, Direct Aspiration)
            Method 7840:      Thallium (AA, Direct Aspiration)
            Method 7841:      Thallium (AA, Furnace Technique)
            Method 7870:      Tin (AA, Direct Aspiration)
            Method 7910:      Vanadium (AA, Direct Aspiration)
            Method 7911:      Vanadium (AA, Furnace Technique)
            Method 7950:      Zinc (AA, Direct Aspiration)
            Method 7951:      Zinc (AA, Furnace Technique)
APPENDIX -- COMPANY REFERENCES
        NOTE;   A suffix of "A" in the method  number  indicates  revision one
        (the method  has been  revised once).  A suffix of  "B"  in  the method
        number  indicates revision two (the method  has  been revised twice). In
        order to properly  document the method  used for analysis,  the entire
        method  number Including the suffix letter designation (e.g., A or B)
        must be Identified by the analyst.   A  method  reference found within
        the  RCRA regulations  and the text  of SW-846 methods  and  chapters
        refers  to the latest promulgated revision of the method, even though
        the method number  does not include the appropriate letter suffix.
                                    CONTENTS - 3
    Revision 2
September 1994

-------
                                     VOLUME ONE

                                      SECTION  B
DISCLAIMER
ABSTRACT
TABLE OF CONTENTS
METHOD INDEX AND CONVERSION TABLE
PREFACE
ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS

CHAPTER ONE. REPRINTED -- QUALITY CONTROL

      1.0   Introduction
      2.0   QA Project Plan
      3.0   Field Operations
      4.0   Laboratory Operations
      5.0   Definitions
      6.0   References

CHAPTER FOUR -- ORGANIC ANALYTES

      4.1   Sampling Considerations
      4.2   Sample Preparation Methods

            4.2.1       Extractions and Preparations

            Method 3500A:     Organic Extraction and Sample Preparation
            Method 3510B:     Separatory Funnel  Liquid-Liquid Extraction
            Method 3520B:     Continuous Liquid-Liquid Extraction
            Method 3540B:     Soxhlet Extraction
            Method 3541:      Automated Soxhlet  Extraction
            Method 3550A:     Ultrasonic Extraction
            Method 3580A:     Waste Dilution
            Method 5030A:     Purge-and-Trap
            Method 5040A:     Analysis of  Sorbent  Cartridges from  Volatile  Organic
                              Sampling  Train   (VOST):     Gas   Chromatography/Mass
                              Spectrometry Technique
                              Protocol  for  Analysis  of  Sorbent  Cartridges  from
                              Volatile Organic  Sampling  Train   (VOST):    Wide-bore
                              Capillary Column Technique
                              Determination of the  Volatile Organic Concentration of
                              Waste Samples
                              Determination of Organic Phase Vapor Pressure in Waste
                              Samples
Method 5041:


Method 5100:

Method 5110:


4.2.2
                        Cleanup
            Method 3600B:
            Method 3610A:
                  Cleanup
                  Alumina Column Cleanup
                                    CONTENTS -  4
                                                              Revision 2
                                                          September 1994

-------
      Method 3611A:
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
      Method
3620A:
3630B:
3640A:
3650A:
3660A:
3665:
Alumina    Column
Petroleum Wastes
Florisil Column Cleanup
Silica Gel Cleanup
Gel-Permeation Cleanup
Acid-Base Partition Cleanup
Sulfur Cleanup
Sulfuric Acid/Permanganate Cleanup
                                Cleanup     and    Separation    of
4.3   Determination of Organic Analytes
      4.3.1
     Gas Chromatographic Methods
      Method 8000A:
      Method 8010B:
      Method 8011:

      Method 80ISA:
      Method 8020A:
      Method 8021A:
      Method 8030A:
      Method 8031:
      Method 8032:
      Method 8040A:
      Method 8060:
      Method 8061:

      Method 8070:
      Method 8080A:

      Method 8081:

      Method 8090:
      Method 8100:
      Method 8110:
      Method 8120A:
      Method 8121:

      Method 8140:
      Method 8141A:

      Method 8150B:
      Method 8151:
                                                    by
           Gas Chromatography
           Halogenated Volatile Organics by Gas Chromatography
           1,2-Dibromoethane  and  l,2-Dibromo-3-chloropropane
           Microextraction and Gas Chromatography
           Nonhalogenated Volatile Organics by Gas Chromatography
           Aromatic Volatile Organics by Gas Chromatography
           Halogenated  Volatiles  by  Gas  Chromatography  Using
           Photoionization and Electrolytic Conductivity Detectors
           in Series: Capillary Column Technique
           Acrolein and Acrylonitrile by Gas Chromatography
           Acrylonitrile by Gas Chromatography
           Acryl amide by Gas Chromatography
           Phenols by Gas Chromatography
           Phthalate Esters
           Phthalate Esters  by Capillary Gas Chromatography with
           Electron Capture Detection (GC/ECD)
           Nitrosamines by Gas Chromatography
           Organochlorine Pesticides and Polychlorinated Biphenyls
           by Gas Chromatography
           Organochlorine Pesticides  and PCBs  as Aroclors by Gas
           Chromatography:  Capillary Column Technique
           Nitroaromatics and  Cyclic Ketones
           Polynuclear Aromatic Hydrocarbons
           Haloethers by Gas Chromatography
           Chlorinated Hydrocarbons by Gas Chromatography
           Chlorinated   Hydrocarbons   by   Gas   Chromatography:
           Capillary Column Technique
           Organophosphorus Pesticides
           Organophosphorus   Compounds   by  Gas  Chromatography:
           Capillary Column Technique
           Chlorinated Herbicides  by Gas Chromatography
           Chlorinated  Herbicides  by  GC  Using Methylation   or
           Pentaf 1 uorobenzyl ati on Deri vati zati on : Capi 1 1 ary Col umn
           Technique
                               CONTENTS  -  5
                                                        Revision  2
                                                    September 1994

-------
 4.3.2
            Gas Chromatographic/Mass Spectroscopic Methods
Method 8240B:

Method 8250A:

Method 8260A:

Method 8270B:


Method 8280:

      Appendix A:
      Appendix B:

Method 8290:



      Appendix A:
                  Volatile Organic  Compounds  by Gas Chromatography/Mass
                  Spectrometry (GC/MS)
                  Semi volatile    Organic    Compounds     by    Gas
                  Chromatography/Mass Spectrometry (GC/MS)
                  Volatile Organic  Compounds  by Gas Chromatography/Mass
                  Spectrometry (GC/MS): Capillary Column Technique
                  Semivolatile    Organic    Compounds     by    Gas
                  Chromatography/Mass  Spectrometry  (GC/MS):  Capillary
                  Column Technique
                  The Analysis of  Polychlorinated  Dibenzo-p-Dioxins and
                  Polychlorinated Dibenzofurans
                        Signal-to-Noise Determination Methods
                        Recommended  Safety  and Handling  Procedures for
                        PCDDs/PCDFs
                  Polychlorinated    Dibenzodioxins     (PCDDs)    and
                  Polychlorinated Dibenzofurans (PCDFs) by High-Resolution
                  Gas  Chromatography/High-Resolution Mass  Spectrometry
                  (HRGC/HRMS)
                        Procedures   for   the   Collection,   Handling,
                        Analysis, and Reporting of  Wipe  Tests Performed
                        within the Laboratory
4.3.3

Method 8310:
Method 8315:
      Appendix A:

Method 8316:

Method 8318:

Method 8321:


Method 8330:

Method 8331:
            High Performance Liquid  Chromatographic Methods

                  Polynuclear Aromatic  Hydrocarbons
                  Determination of Carbonyl Compounds by High  Performance
                  Liquid Chromatography (HPLC)
                        Recrystallization  of 2,4-Dinitrophenylhydrazine
                        (DNPH)
                  Acrylamide,   Acrylonitrile   and   Acrolein   by  High
                  Performance Liquid Chromatography  (HPLC)
                  N-Methylcarbamates    by    High   Performance    Liquid
                  Chromatography  (HPLC)
                  Solvent Extractable  Non-Volatile  Compounds  by High
                  Performance  Liquid   Chromatography/Thermospray/Mass
                  Spectrometry (HPLC/TSP/MS) or Ultraviolet (UV) Detection
                  Nitroaromatics and Nitramines by High Performance Liquid
                  Chromatography  (HPLC)
                  Tetrazene  by  Reverse Phase  High  Performance  Liquid
                  Chromatography  (HPLC)
4.3.4       Fourier Transform Infrared Methods

Method 8410:
                  Gas Chromatography/Fourier Transform Infrared (GC/FT-IR)
                  Spectrometry  for  Semivolatile  Organics:    Capillary
                  Column
                        CONTENTS  -  6
                                                             Revision 2
                                                         September 1994

-------
      4.4   Miscellaneous Screening Methods

            Method 3810:      Headspace
            Method 3820:      Hexadecane  Extraction  and   Screening   of  Purgeable
                              Organics
            Method 4010:      Screening for Pentachlorophenol  by Immunoassay
            Method 8275:      Thermal  Chromatography/Mass  Spectrometry  (TC/MS)  for
                              Screening Semi volatile Organic Compounds

APPENDIX -- COMPANY REFERENCES
        NOTE;   A suffix of "A" in the method  number  indicates  revision one
        (the method  has been  revised once).  A suffix of  "B"  in  the method
        number  indicates revision two (the method  has been revised twice). In
        order to properly  document the method  used for  analysis,  the entire
        method  number Including the suffix letter designation (e.g., A or B)
        must be identified by the analyst.   A  method  reference found within
        the  RCRA regulations  and the text  of SW-846 methods  and  chapters
        refers  to the latest  promulgated revision of the method, even though
        the method number  does not include the appropriate letter suffix.
                                    CONTENTS  - 7                          Revision 2
                                                                      September  1994

-------
                                     VOLUME ONE

                                      SECTION  C
DISCLAIMER
ABSTRACT
TABLE OF CONTENTS
METHOD INDEX AND CONVERSION TABLE
PREFACE

CHAPTER ONE. REPRINTED -- QUALITY CONTROL

      1.0   Introduction
      2.0   QA Project Plan
      3.0   Field Operations
      4.0   Laboratory Operations
      5.0   Definitions
      6.0   References

CHAPTER FIVE -- MISCELLANEOUS TEST METHODS

            Method 5050:      Bomb Preparation Method for Solid Waste
            Method 9010A:     Total and Amenable Cyanide (Colorimetric, Manual)
            Method 9012:      Total and Amenable Cyanide  (Colorimetric, Automated UV)
            Method 9013:      Cyanide Extraction Procedure for Solids and Oils
            Method 9020B:     Total Organic Hal ides (TOX)
            Method 9021:      Purgeable Organic Hal ides (POX)
            Method 9022:      Total  Organic  Hal ides   (TOX)  by  Neutron  Activation
                              Analysis
                              Acid-Soluble and Acid-Insoluble Sulfides
                              Extractable Sulfides
                              Sulfate (Colorimetric,  Automated, Chloranilate)
                              Sulfate (Colorimetric, Automated, Methyl thymol Blue, AA

            Method 9038:      Sulfate (Turbidimetric)
            Method 9056:      Determination of Inorganic Anions by Ion  Chromatography
            Method 9060:      Total Organic Carbon
            Method 9065:      Phenolics   (Spectrophotometric,   Manual   4-AAP   with
                              Distillation)
            Method 9066:      Phenolics    (Colorimetric,   Automated    4-AAP   with
                              Distillation)
            Method 9067:      Phenolics (Spectrophotometric,  MBTH with Distillation)
            Method 9070:      Total Recoverable Oil & Grease (Gravimetric, Separatory
                              Funnel  Extraction)
            Method 9071A:     Oil  and Grease Extraction Method for Sludge and Sediment
                              Samples
            Method 9075:      Test Method  for Total Chlorine in  New and Used Petroleum
                              Products by X-Ray Fluorescence  Spectrometry (XRF)
            Method 9076:      Test Method  for Total Chlorine in  New and Used Petroleum
                              Products by Oxidative Combustion  and Microcoulometry
Method 9030A:
Method 9031:
Method 9035:
Method 9036:
                                    CONTENTS -  8
                                                              Revision 2
                                                          September 1994

-------
            Method 9077:

                  Method A:
                  Method B:

                  Method C:
            Method 9131:
            Method 9132:
            Method 9200:
            Method 9250:
            Method 9251:
            Method 9252A:
            Method 9253:
            Method 9320:

CHAPTER SIX -- PROPERTIES

            Method 1312:
            Method 1320:
            Method 1330A:
            Method 9040A:
            Method 9041A:
            Method 9045B:
            Method 9050:
            Method 9080:
            Method 9081:
            Method 9090A:
            Method 9095:
            Method 9096:
                  Appendix A:
            Method 9100:

            Method 9310:
            Method 9315:
Test  Methods  for  Total   Chlorine   in  New  and  Used
Petroleum Products (Field Test Kit Methods)
      Fixed End Point Test Kit Method
      Reverse Titration Quantitative End Point Test Kit
      Method
Direct Titration Quantitative End Point  Test Kit Method
Total Coliform:  Multiple Tube Fermentation Technique
Total Coliform:  Membrane Filter Technique
Nitrate
Chloride (Colorimetric, Automated Ferricyanide AAI)
Chloride (Colorimetric, Automated Ferricyanide AAII)
Chloride (Titrimetric, Mercuric Nitrate)
Chloride (Titrimetric, Silver Nitrate)
Radium-228
Synthetic Precipitation Leaching Procedure
Multiple Extraction Procedure
Extraction Procedure for Oily Wastes
pH Electrometric Measurement
pH Paper Method
Soil and Waste pH
Specific Conductance
Cation-Exchange Capacity of Soils  (Ammonium Acetate)
Cation-Exchange Capacity of Soils  (Sodium Acetate)
Compatibility Test for Wastes and  Membrane Liners
Paint Filter Liquids Test
Liquid Release Test (LRT) Procedure
      LRT Pre-Test
Saturated  Hydraulic  Conductivity,  Saturated  Leachate
Conductivity, and Intrinsic Permeability
Gross Alpha and Gross Beta
Alpha-Emitting Radium Isotopes
                              PART II   CHARACTERISTICS

CHAPTER SEVEN -- INTRODUCTION AND REGULATORY DEFINITIONS

      7.1   Ignitability
      7.2   Corrosivity
      7.3   Reactivity

            Test Method to Determine Hydrogen Cyanide  Released from Wastes
            Test Method to Determine Hydrogen Sulfide  Released from Wastes

      7.4   Toxicity Characteristic  Leaching Procedure
                                    CONTENTS  - 9
                                             Revision  2
                                         September  1994

-------
CHAPTER EIGHT -- METHODS FOR DETERMINING CHARACTERISTICS

      8.1   Ignitability

            Method 1010:      Pensky-Martens   Closed-Cup   Method   for  Determining
                              Ignitability
            Method 1020A:     Setaf 1 ash Closed-Cup Method for Determining Igni tabi 1 ity

      8.2   Corrosivity

            Method 1110:      Corrosivity Toward Steel

      8.3   Reactivity
      8.4   Toxicity

            Method 1310A:     Extraction  Procedure   (EP)  Toxicity  Test  Method  and
                              Structural Integrity Test
            Method 1311:      Toxicity Characteristic Leaching Procedure

APPENDIX -- COMPANY REFERENCES
        NOTE;  A  suffix  of "A" in the method number  indicates  revision one
        (the method  has  been  revised once).   A suffix of  "B"  in  the method
        number indicates revision two (the method has been revised twice). In
        order to  properly  document the method used  for analysis,  the entire
        method number Including the suffix letter designation (e.g., A or B)
        must be Identified by  the analyst.   A method  reference found within
        the  RCRA  regulations  and the text  of  SW-846 methods  and  chapters
        refers to the latest promulgated revision of the  method, even though
        the method number does not include the appropriate letter suffix.
                                    CONTENTS  -  10                          Revision 2
                                                                      September 1994

-------
                                     VOLUME   TWO
DISCLAIMER
ABSTRACT
TABLE OF CONTENTS
METHOD INDEX AND CONVERSION TABLE
PREFACE
CHAPTER ONE. REPRINTED -- QUALITY CONTROL

      1.0   Introduction
      2.0   QA Project Plan
      3.0   Field Operations
      4.0   Laboratory Operations
      5.0   Definitions
      6.0   References
                                 PART III    SAMPLING

CHAPTER NINE -- SAMPLING PLAN

      9.1   Design and Development
      9.2   Implementation

CHAPTER TEN -- SAMPLING METHODS

            Method 0010:      Modified Method 5 Sampling Train
                  Appendix A:        Preparation of XAD-2 Sorbent Resin
                  Appendix B:        Total Chromatographable Organic Material Analysis
            Method 0020:      Source Assessment Sampling System (SASS)
            Method 0030:      Volatile Organic Sampling Train
                                PART  IV   MONITORING

CHAPTER ELEVEN  -- GROUND WATER MONITORING

      11.1  Background and Objectives
      11.2  Relationship to the Regulations and to Other Documents
      11.3  Revisions and Additions
      11.4  Acceptable Designs and Practices
      11.5  Unacceptable Designs and  Practices


CHAPTER TWELVE  -- LAND TREATMENT MONITORING

      12.1  Background
      12.2  Treatment Zone
      12.3  Regulatory Definition
                                    CONTENTS - 11                         Revision 2
                                                                      September  1994

-------
      12.4  Monitoring and Sampling Strategy
      12.5  Analysis
      12.6  References and Bibliography

CHAPTER THIRTEEN - INCINERATION

      13.1  Introduction
      13.2  Regulatory Definition
      13.3  Waste Characterization Strategy
      13.4  Stack-Gas Effluent Characterization Strategy
      13.5  Additional Effluent Characterization Strategy
      13.6  Selection of Specific Sampling and Analysis Methods
      13.7  References

APPENDIX -- COMPANY REFERENCES
        NOTE;  A  suffix  of  "A"  in the method number indicates revision  one
        (the method has  been  revised  once).   A suffix of "B" in the  method
        number indicates revision two  (the method has been revised twice). In
        order to properly document the method used for analysis, the  entire
        method number Including the suffix letter  designation (e.g., A or B)
        must be Identified by the analyst.  A method reference found  within
        the  RCRA  regulations  and the  text of SW-846  methods and chapters
        refers to the latest promulgated revision  of  the  method,  even  though
        the method number does not include the appropriate letter suffix.
                                   CONTENTS - 12                          Revision  2
                                                                      September 1994

-------
                      METHOD INDEX AND CONVERSION TABLE
Method Number,
Third Edition
    0010
    0020
    0030
    1010
    1020

    1110
    1310
    1320
    1330
    3005

    3010
    3020
    3040
    3050
    3500

    3510
    3520
    3540
    3550
    3580

    3600
    3610
    3611
    3620
    3630

    3640
    3650
    3660
    3810
     3820

     5030
     5040
     6010
     7000
     7020
Chapter Number,
Third Edition
           Method Number,
Current Revision
   Ten
   Ten
   Ten
   Eight
   Eight
8.1)
8.1)
   Eight (8.2
   Eight (8.4
   Six
   Six
   Three
   Three
   Three
   Three
   Three
   Four  (4.2.1)
Four (4.2.1
Four (4.2.1
Four (4.2.1
Four (4.2.1
Four (4.2.1
Four (
Four (
Four (
4.2.2
4.2.2
4.2.2
Four (4.2.2
Four (4.2.2
Four (4.2.2)
Four
Four
Four
Four
Four
Four
Three
Three
Three
4.2.2)
4.2.2)
4.4)
4.4)
[4.2.1]
[4.2.1]



Second Edition
0010
0020
0030
1010
1020
1110
1310
1320
1330
3005
3010
3020
3040
3050
None (new method)
3510
3520
3540
3550
None (new method)
None (new method)
None (new method)
3570
None (new method)
None (new method)
None (new method)
None (new method)
None (new method)
5020
None (new method)
5030
3720
6010
7000
7020
Number
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
                               METHOD  INDEX - 1
                                                          Revision      0
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
                      METHOD INDEX AND CONVERSION TABLE
                                 (Continued)
Method Number.
Third Edition
Chapter Number,
Third Edition
Method Number.
Second Edition
                                      Current  Revision
                                          Number
    7040
    7041
    7060
    7061
    7080
    7090
    7091
    7130
    7131
    7140

    7190
    7191
    7195
    7196
    7197

    7198
    7200
    7201
    7380
    ^ i
    7420
    7421
    7450
    7470

    7471
    7480
    7481
    7520
    7550

    7610
    7740
    7741
    7760
 Three
 Three
 Three
 Three
 Three

 Three
 Three
 Three
 Three
 Three

 Three
 Three
 Three
 Three
 Three

 Three
 Three
 Three
 Three_
 Three

 Three
 Three
 Three
 Three_
 Three

 Three
 Three
 Three
 Three
Three

Three
Three
Three
Three
Three
                             -3
                       7040
                       7041
                       7060
                       7061
                       7080

                       7090
                       7091
                       7130
                       7131
                       7140

                       7190
                       7191
                       7195
                       7196
                       7197

                       7198
                       7200
                       7201
                       7210
                       7380

                       7420
                       7421
                       7450
                       7460
                       7470

                       7471
                       7480
                       7481
                       7520
                       7550

                       7610
                       7740
                       7741
                       7760
                       7770
                         0
                         0
                         0
                         0
                         0

                         0
                         0
                         0
                         0
                         0

                         0
                         0
                         0
                         0
                         0

                         0
                         0
                         0
                         0
                         0

                         0
                         0
                         0
                         0
                         0

                         0
                         0
                         0
                         0
                         0

                         0
                         0
                         0
                         0
                         0
                             METHOD   INDEX - 2
                                                        Revision      p
                                                        Date  September  1986

-------
                  METHOD INDEX AND CONVERSION TABLE
                             (Continued)
Method Number,
Third Edition
                Chapter Number,
                Third Edition
                 Method Number,
                 Second Edition
                               Current  Revision
                                   Number
7840
7841
7870
7910
7911

7950
8000
8010
8015
8020

8030
8040
8060
8080
8090

8100
8120
8140
8150
8240

8250
8270
8280
8310
9010

9020
9022
9030
9035
9036

9038
9040
9041
9045
9050
Three
Three
Three
Three
Three
Three
Four
Four
Four
Four
Four
Four






4.3.1)
4.3.1)
4.3.1)
4.3.1)
;4.3.1)

Four (4.3.1)
Four
Four
(4.3.1)
(4.3.1)
Four (4.3.1)
Four (4.3.1)
Four (4.3.1)
Four (4.3.1)
Four (4.3.2)
Four
Four
Four
4.3.2)
4.3.2
4.3.2
Four (4.3.3)
Five

Five
Five
Five
Five
Five

Five
Six
Six
Six
Six
                                           7840                   0
                                           7841                   0
                                           7870                   0
                                           7910                   0
                                           7911                   0

                                           7950                   0
                                           None  (new method)      0
                                           8010                   0
                                           8015                   0
                                           8020                   0

                                           8030                   0
                                           8040                   0
                                           8060                   0
                                           8080                   0
                                           8090                   0

                                           8100                   0
                                           8120                   0
                                           8140                   0
                                           8150                   0
                                           8240                   0

                                           8250                   0
                                           8270                   0
                                           None  (new method)      0
                                           8310                   0
                                           9010                   0

                                           9020                   0
                                           9022                   0
                                           9030                   0
                                           9035                   0
                                           9036                   0

                                           9038                   0
                                           9040                   0
                                           9041                   0
                                           9045                   0
                                           9050                   0
                           METHOD  INDEX - 3
                                                      Revision      0
                                                      Date  September 1986

-------
                      METHOD INDEX AND CONVERSION TABLE
                                 (Continued)


Method Number.      Chapter Number.      Method Number.      Current Revision
Third Edition       Third Edition        Second Edition          Number


    9060               Five                9060                   0
    9065               Five                9065                   0
    9066               Five                9066                   0
    9067               Five                9067                   0
    9070               Five                9070                   0

    9071               Five                9071                   0
    9080               Six                 9080                   0
    9081               Six                 9081                   0
    9090               Six                 9090                   0
    9095               Six                 9095                   0

    9100               Six                 9100                   0
    9131               Five                9131                   0
    9132               Five                9132                   0
    9200               Five                9200                   0
    9250               Five                9250                   0

    9251               Five                9251                   0
    9252               Five                9252                   0
    9310               Six                 9310                   0
    9315               Six                 9315                   0
    9320               Five                9320                   0

    HCN Test Method    Seven               HCN Test Method        0
        Test Method    Seven               H2S Test Method        0
                              METHOD  INDEX - 4
                                                         Revision
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
                            PREFACE AND OVERVIEW
PURPOSE OF THE MANUAL

     Test Methods for Evaluating Solid Waste (SW-846) 1s Intended to provide a
unified, up-to-date source of Information  on sampling and analysis related to
compliance with RCRA regulations.   It  brings together Into one reference all
sampling and testing methodology approved by the Office of Solid Waste for use
1n Implementing the RCRA regulatory  program.  The manual provides methodology
for collecting and testing representative samples of waste and other materials
to be monitored.  Aspects  of  sampling  and testing covered in SW-846 include
quality control, sampling  plan  development  and  implementation, analysis of
Inorganic and  organic  constituents,  the  estimation  of  intrinsic physical
properties, and the appraisal of waste characteristics.

     The procedures described in this manual are meant to be comprehensive and
detailed, coupled  with  the  realization  that  the  problems  encountered 1n
sampling and analytical situations  require  a  certain amount of flexibility.
The solutions  to these problems will  depend, 1n part, on the skill, training,
and experience of the analyst.    For  some  situations, it is possible to use
this manual  1n  rote  fashion.     In  other  situations,  1t  will  require  a
combination of technical abilities, using  the  manual as guidance rather than
in a step-by-step, word-by-word  fashion.    Although  this puts an extra burden
on the   user,  it  1s  unavoidable  because  of  the  variety  of sampling and
analytical conditions found with hazardous wastes.
 ORGANIZATION AND FORMAT


      This manual is divided into two  volumes.   Volume  I  focuses on  laboratory
 activities and is divided  for  convenience  into   three   sections.   Volume  IA
 deals  with  quality  control,  selection  of  appropriate  test   methods, and
 analytical methods for metallic species.     Volume   IB  consists of methods for
 organic  analytes.    Volume  1C  Includes  a  variety  of  test   methods  for
 miscellaneous  analytes  and  properties   for  use   1n  evaluating  the  waste
 characteristics.  Volume II deals with sample acquisition and Includes quality
 control,  sampling plan design and  Implementation,  and  field sampling methods.
 Included  for the convenience  of  sampling  personnel   are discussslons  of the
 ground water, land treatment, and Incineration monitoring regulations.

      Volume I begins with an overview  of the quality control precedures to  be
 imposed upon the sampling and  analytical methods.  The quality control  chapter
 (Chapter One) and the  methods  chapters  are  interdependent.  The  analytical
 procedures cannot be  used  without  a  thorough  understanding of the  quality
 control requirements and the means to  implement them.   This understanding  can
 be achieved only be reviewing Chapter One and the analytical methods together.
 It 1s expected that  individual  laboratories,  using  SW-846 as the reference
                                  PREFACE - 1
                                                          Revision      0
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
source, will  select  appropriate  methods  and  develop  a standard operating
procedure (SOP) to be followed by  the laboratory.   The SOP should Incorporate
the pertinent Information from this  manual   adopted to the specific needs and
circumstances of the Individual laboratory as  well   as to the materials to be
evaluated.

     The method  selection  chapter  (Chapter  Two)   presents  a comprehensive
discussion of the application  of  these  methods  to  various matrices 1n the
determination of groups of analytes or specific analytes.  It aids the chemist
in constructing the correct  analytical  method  from  the array of procedures
which may  cover  the  matrix/analyte/concentratlon  combination of interests.
The  section  discusses  the  objective   of   the  testing  program  and  Its
relationship to the choice of an analytical  method.   Flow charts are presented
along with  tables  to  guide  in  the  selection  of  the  correct analytical
procedures to form the appropriate method.

     The analytical methods are  separated Into distinct procedures describing
specific,  Independent  analytical  operations.    These  Include  extraction
digestion, cleanup, and  determination.    This  format  allows Unking of the
various steps 1n the analysis according  to:  the type of sample (e.g., water,
soil, sludge, still bottom); analytes(s)  of interest; needed sensitivity and
available analytical instrumentation.    The chapters describing Miscellaneous;
Test Methods and  Properties,  however,  give  complete  methods which are not
amenable to such segmentation to form discrete procedures.

     The introductory material  at  the  beginning  of each section containing
analytical   procedures   presents   Information   on   sample   handling  and
preservation, safety, and sample preparation.

     Part  II  of  Volume   I   (Chapters   Seven  and  Eight)  describes  the
characteristics of a waste.    Sections  following the regulatory descriptions
contain the methods used to  determine  1f  the  waste 1s hazardous because It
exhibits a particular characteristic.

     Volume II gives background  Information on statistical and nonstatlstlcal
aspects  of  sampling.    It   also  presents  practical  sampling  techniques
appropriate for situations presenting a variety of physical conditions.

     A discussion  of  the  regulatory  requirements  with  respect to several
monitoring categories is also  given  in  this  volume.   These include ground
water monitoring, land  treatment,  and  incineration.    The  purpose of this
guidance is to orient the user to the objective of the analysis, and to assist
in developing data quality objectives, sampling plans, and laboratory SOP's.

     Significant interferences, or  other  problems,  may  be encountered with
certain samples.  In these situations,  the   analyst is advised to contact the
Chief,  Methods Section (WH-562B) Technical  Assessment Branch, Office of Solid
Waste,  US EPA,  Washington,  DC    20460  (202-382-4761)  for assistance.  The
manual  1s intended to serve  all  those  with  a need to evaluate solid waste
Your comments, corrections, suggestions, and questions concerning any material
contained in, or omitted  from,  this  manual  will  be gratefully appreciated.
Please direct your comments to the above address.


                                 PREFACE - 2
                                                         Revision      0
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
PART I    METHODS FOR ANALYTES AND PROPERTIES
                                     Revision      0
                                     Date  September  1986

-------
                                  CHAPTER ONE
                               TABLE OF  CONTENTS
Section
2.0
3.0
on
INTRODUCTION 	
QA PROJECT PLAN 	
2.1 DATA QUALITY OBJECTIVES 	
2.2 PROJECT OBJECTIVES 	
2.3 SAMPLE COLLECTION 	
2.4 ANALYSIS AND TESTING 	
2.5 QUALITY CONTROL 	
2.6 PROJECT DOCUMENTATION 	
2.7 ORGANIZATION PERFORMING FIELD OR LABORATORY
OPERATIONS 	
2.7.1 Performance Evaluation 	
2.7.2 Internal Assessment by QA Function 	
2.7.3 External Assessment 	
2.7.4 On-Site Evaluation 	
2.7.4.1 Field Activities 	
2.7.4.2 Laboratory Activities 	
2.7.5 QA Reports 	
FIELD OPERATIONS 	
3.1 FIELD LOGISTICS 	
3.2 EQUIPMENT/INSTRUMENTATION 	
3.3 OPERATING PROCEDURES 	
3.3.1 Sample Management 	
3.3.2 Reagent/Standard Preparation 	
3.3.3 Decontamination 	
3.3.4 Sample Collection 	
3.3.5 Field Measurements 	
3.3.6 Equipment Calibration And Maintenance ....
3.3.7 Corrective Action 	
3.3.8 Data Reduction and Validation 	
3.3.9 Reporting 	
3.3.10 Records Management 	
3.3.11 Waste Disposal 	
3.4 FIELD QA AND QC REQUIREMENTS 	
3.4.1 Control Samples 	
3.4.2 Acceptance Criteria 	
3.4.3 Deviations 	
3.4.4 Corrective Action 	
3.4.5 Data Handling 	
3.5 QUALITY ASSURANCE REVIEW 	
3.6 FIELD RECORDS 	
Paae
. . . . 1
. . . . 1
. . . . 2
. . . . 2
. . . . 3
. . . . 3
. . . . 3
. . . . 3

. . . . 4
. . . . 5
. . . . 5
. . . . 5
. . . . 5
. . . . 5
. . . . 6
. . . . 7
. . . . 8
. . . . 8
. . . . 9
. . . . 9
. . . . 9
. . . . 9
. . . . 9
. . . . 10
. . . . 10
. . . . 10
. . . . 10
. . . . 11
. . . . 11
. . . . 11
. . . . 11
. . . . 11
. . . . 11
. . . . 12
. . . . 12
. . . . 12
. . . . 12
. . . . 13
. . . . 13
                                   ONE  -  i                          Revision 1
                                                                     July 1992

-------
                              TABLE OF CONTENTS
                                  (continued)
Section
4.0  LABORATORY OPERATIONS  	   14
      4.1  FACILITIES	   14





















5.0
6.0
INDEX
4.3 OPERATING PROCEDURES 	
4.3.1 Sample Management 	
4.3.2 Reagent/Standard Preparation 	
4.3.3 General Laboratory Techniques 	
4.3.4 Test Methods 	
4.3.5 Equipment Calibration and Maintenance ....
4.3.6 QC 	
4.3.7 Corrective Action 	
4.3.8 Data Reduction and Validation 	
4.3.9 Reporting 	
4.3.10 Records Management 	
4.3.11 Waste Disposal 	
4.4 LABORATORY QA AND QC PROCEDURES 	
4.4.1 Method Proficiency 	
4.4.2 Control Limits 	
4.4.3 Laboratory Control Procedures 	
4.4.4 Deviations 	
4.4.5 Corrective Action 	
4.4.6 Data Handling 	
4.5 QUALITY ASSURANCE REVIEW 	
4.6 LABORATORY RECORDS 	
DEFINITIONS 	
REFERENCES 	

. . . . 15
. . . . 16
. . . . 16
. . . . 16
. . . . 16
. . . . 17
. . . . 17
. . . . 17
. . . . 18
. . . . 18
. . . . 18
. . . . 18
. . . . 18
. . . . 18
. . . . 19
. . . . 19
. . . . 20
. . . 20
. . . . 20
. . . . 21
. . . . 21
. . . . 23
. . . . 29
. . . . 30
                                   ONE  -  ii                          Revision  1
                                                                      July 1992

-------
                                  CHAPTER ONE
                                QUALITY CONTROL
 1.0   INTRODUCTION
       It  is the  goal  of  the  U.S.  Environmental  Protection  Agency's  (EPA's)
quality assurance  (QA) program to ensure that all  data be  scientifically valid,
defensible,  and  of known  precision  and  accuracy.    The  data  should  be of
sufficient  known quality to withstand scientific and legal  challenge relative to
the use for which the data  are obtained.   The  QA program is  management's tool for
achieving this  goal.

       For RCRA  analyses, the recommended minimum  requirements for  a QA  program
and the associated quality  control (QC) procedures are provided in this chapter.

       The data  acquired  from QC procedures are used to estimate the quality of
analytical  data,  to determine the  need  for corrective action  in  response to
identified  deficiencies,  and  to  interpret  results  after corrective action
procedures  are  implemented.  Method-specific QC procedures  are incorporated in
the individual  methods since they are not applied universally.

       A total program to  generate data of acceptable quality should  include both
a QA component,  which encompasses the management procedures and  controls,  as well
as  an  operational  day-to-day QC component.  This chapter defines  fundamental
elements of  such a  data  collection program.  Data collection efforts involve:

       1.     design  of  a  project plan to achieve the  data quality objectives
             (DQOs);

       2.     implementation of the project plan; and

       3.     assessment of  the data to determine if the DQOs are met.

The project plan may be a sampling and analysis plan or a waste analysis  plan if
it  covers  the  QA/QC goals  of  the  Chapter,  or  it may be  a Quality Assurance
Project Plan as described  later in this chapter.

       This chapter  identifies the minimal QC components that should be used in
the performance  of sampling and analyses, including  the  QC information which
should be documented.  Guidance is provided to construct QA programs for field
and laboratory work conducted in support of the RCRA program.


2.0  QA PROJECT PLAN

       It is  recommended that all projects which generate environment-related data
in  support  of  RCRA have a QA Project  Plan  (QAPjP)  or  equivalent.    In  some
instances,   a sampling  and analysis  plan or  a  waste analysis plan  may  be
equivalent  if it covers  all  of the  QA/QC goals outlined  in this chapter.   In
addition,   a separate  QAPjP need  not  be prepared  for  routine   analyses  or
activities  where  the  procedures to  be  followed  are  described  in  a  Standard

                                   ONE -  1                          Revision  1
                                                                     July 1992

-------
Operating Procedures manual or similar document and  include  the  elements of a
QAPjP.  These documents should  be available and referenced in the documentation
and/or records for the  analysis activities.  The  term  "QAPjP"  in this chapter
refers to any of these QA/QC documents.

      The QAPjP should detail the QA/QC goals and protocols for a specific data
collection activity.   The QAPjP sets forth  a  plan for  sampling  and analysis
activities that will  generate data of a quality  commensurate with their intended
use.   QAPjP  elements  should  include  a description  of  the project  and  its
objectives; a statement of the  DQOs  of the project; identification of those in-
volved  in the  data collection  and their  responsibilities and  authorities;
reference  to  (or inclusion  of)  the specific  sample collection  and analysis
procedures that will be followed  for all  aspects of the project; enumeration of
QC  procedures  to  be followed;  and descriptions of all  project documentation.
Additional elements  should  be  included  in  the QAPjP if  needed to address all
quality  related  aspects of the data  collection  project.   Elements  should be
omitted only when  they  are inappropriate  for the project or when  absence of those
elements  will  not affect  the  quality  of data obtained  for the  project  (see
reference  1).

      The  role  and  importance  of DQOs and  project documentation are discussed
below in Sections 2.1 through 2.6.   Management  and organization play  a critical
role  in  determining  the effectiveness of a QA/QC program and ensuring that all
required  procedures  are followed.   Section 2.7 discusses the   elements of an
organization's QA program that have been found to ensure an  effective program.
Field operations and laboratory operations (along  with applicable  QC procedures)
are discussed  in  Sections 3 and 4, respectively.


2.1   DATA  QUALITY OBJECTIVES

      Data quality objectives  (DQOs) for the data collection activity describe
the overall level of uncertainty that a decision-maker is willing to accept in
results derived from environmental data.   This uncertainty is used to specify the
quality  of the measurement data required,  usually in  terms of objectives for
precision, bias,  representativeness, comparability and completeness.  The  DQOs
should be defined prior to the  initiation of the field and laboratory work.  The
field and  laboratory organizations  performing  the work should be aware  of the
DQOs so that their personnel may make informed decisions during the course of the
project  to attain those DQOs.   More detailed information on DQOs is available
from the U.S. EPA Quality Assurance Management Staff (QAMS) (see references 2 and
4).


2.2  PROJECT  OBJECTIVES

      A  statement of the project objectives and  how the objectives are to be
attained should be  concisely stated and sufficiently detailed to permit clear
understanding by all  parties  involved   in the data  collection  effort.   This
includes a statement of what problem is to be  solved and the information required


                                    ONE  - 2                          Revision  1
                                                                      July  1992

-------
 in the  process.   It  also  includes appropriate statements of the DQOs (i.e.,  the
 acceptable level  of uncertainty in  the information).


 2.3  SAMPLE COLLECTION

      Sampling procedures, locations,  equipment,  and sample preservation  and
 handling  requirements should  be  specified in the  QAPjP.   Further details  on
 quality assurance procedures for field operations are described in Section 3 of
 this  chapter.   The OSW is developing  policies  and  procedures  for  sampling in a
 planned revision  of Chapter  Nine  of this  manual.    Specific  procedures  for
 groundwater sampling are  provided in  Chapter  Eleven  of this manual.


 2.4  ANALYSIS  AND TESTING

      Analytes and properties  of concern,  analytical  and testing  procedures  to
 be employed, required detection limits, and requirements for precision  and bias
 should  be specified. All  applicable regulatory requirements and the project DQOs
 should  be considered when developing the specifications.  Further details on  the
 procedures  for analytical  operations are described  in Section  4 of this  chapter.


 2.5  QUALITY CONTROL

      The  quality assurance program  should address  both  field and laboratory
 activities.  Quality control procedures should be  specified for estimating the
 precision and bias of the  data.  Recommended minimum requirements for QC samples
 have  been established  by  EPA and should be met in  order to satisfy  recommended
 minimum criteria for acceptable data quality.  Further details  on procedures for
 field and laboratory operations are  described in Sections 3  and 4,  respectively,
 of  this chapter.


 2.6   PROJECT DOCUMENTATION

      Documents should be prepared  and maintained  in conjunction with  the data
 collection  effort.   Project documentation should be sufficient to allow review
 of  all  aspects of  the work being performed.  The QAPjP discussed  in Sections 3
 and 4 is one important document that  should be maintained.

      The  length  of  storage  time  for project  records  should  comply  with
 regulatory  requirements,  organizational   policy,   or  project  requirements,
whichever is more stringent.  It is recommended that documentation  be stored for
three years from submission of the project final  report.

      Documentation  should   be  secured   in   a  facility   that  adequately
addresses/minimizes  its deterioration  for the  length  of time  that it  is to  be
retained.   A system allowing for the expedient retrieval of information should
exist.
                                   ONE  - 3                          Revision 1
                                                                     July 1992

-------
      Access to  archived  information  should  be  controlled  to  maintain  the
integrity of  the data.    Procedures  should  be  developed  to identify  those
individuals  with access to the data.


2.7  ORGANIZATION PERFORMING FIELD OR LABORATORY  OPERATIONS

      Proper design  and structure  of the organization facilitates effective and
efficient transfer of  information and helps to prevent important procedures from
being overlooked.

      The organizational   structure,  functional   responsibilities,  levels  of
authority,  job  descriptions,  and  lines  of  communication  for  all  project
activities should be established and documented.  One person may cover more than
one  organizational  function.    Each  project  participant  should  have  a  clear
understanding of his or her duties and responsibilities and  the relationship of
those responsibilities to the overall data collection effort.

      The management of each organization participating in a project involving
data collection activities should  establish  that organization's operational and
QA policies. This information should be documented in the QAPjP.  The management
should ensure that (1) the appropriate methodologies are followed as documented
in   the  QAPjPs;   (2)   personnel   clearly   understand   their  duties  and
responsibilities;  (3) each  staff member  has access  to  appropriate  project
documents;  (4)  any  deviations from the QAPjP  are communicated  to the project
management  and documented; and  (5)  communication  occurs  between  the  field,
laboratory, and project management, as specified in the QAPjP.  In addition, each
organization should ensure that their activities do not  increase the risk to
humans or the environment  at or about  the project location.  Certain projects may
require specific policies or a Health and Safety Plan to provide this assurance.

      The management of the participating field or laboratory organization  should
establish personnel qualifications and training requirements  for the project.
Each  person participating in  the  project should  have the  education, training,
technical knowledge,  and  experience,  or  a combination  thereof,  to enable that
individual  to perform assigned functions.  Training  should be provided  for each
staff member  as  necessary to  perform their  functions   properly.   Personnel
qualifications  should be  documented in  terms of  education,  experience,  and
training,   and   periodically  reviewed   to  ensure   adequacy   to  current
responsibilities.

       Each  participating  field organization or laboratory  organization  should
have a designated QA  function  (i.e.,  a team  or  individual  trained in  QA) to
monitor  operations   to  ensure  that  the  equipment,  personnel,   activities,
procedures, and documentation conform with  the QAPjP.  To the extent possible,
the  QA monitoring function should  be  entirely separate from, and  independent of,
personnel   engaged  in  the work being  monitored.   The QA function should be
responsible for the QA review.
                                    ONE - 4                          Revision 1
                                                                      July 1992

-------
       2.7.1   Performance  Evaluation

       Performance evaluation studies are used to measure the performance of the
 laboratory  on unknown samples.   Performance  evaluation samples are  typically
 submitted to  the laboratory as  blind samples  by  an  independent  outside  source.
 The  results  are  compared  to   predetermined  acceptance limits.    Performance
 evaluation  samples  can also be submitted to  the laboratory as  part of  the QA
 function during internal  assessment of  laboratory performance.  Records  of all
 performance evaluation studies should be maintained by the laboratory.  Problems
 identified  through  participation in performance evaluation studies should be
 immediately investigated  and corrected.

       2.7.2   Internal  Assessment  bv QA  Function

       Personnel performing field  and laboratory  activities  are  responsible  for
 continually monitoring individual  compliance  with the QAPjP.  The QA function
 should review procedures, results and calculations to  determine  compliance  with
 the  QAPjP.    The  results of  this internal assessment  should  be  reported to
 management with requirements for  a plan to correct observed deficiencies.

       2.7.3   External  Assessment

       The field and laboratory activities  may  be  reviewed by personnel external
 to the organization.   Such an  assessment is  an  extremely  valuable method  for
 identifying overlooked problems.  The results  of  the external assessment  should
 be submitted  to  management with  requirements for a  plan  to correct observed
 deficiencies.

       2.7.4  On-Site Evaluation

      On-site evaluations may  be conducted as part of both internal  and external
 assessments.  The focus of an  on-site  evaluation is to  evaluate the degree of
 conformance of project  activities with the applicable QAPjP.   On-site evaluations
 may  include,  but are  not limited to,  a complete review of facilities,   staff,
 training, instrumentation, procedures,  methods, sample collection,  analyses, QA
 policies and procedures related to the generation  of environmental data.  Records
 of each evaluation should  include the date of the evaluation,  location, the areas
 reviewed, the person  performing  the  evaluation, findings  and problems,  and
 actions recommended  and taken to resolve problems. Any problems  identified that
 are  likely  to  affect  data  integrity   should  be brought  immediately  to  the
 attention of management.

            2.7.4.1   Field Activities

      The review of  field activities should be conducted by  one or more persons
 knowledgeable in the  activities  being  reviewed  and  include evaluating,  at a
minimum, the following subjects:

      Completeness   of  Field  Reports  --  This review  determines   whether  all
      requirements  for field activities in the QAPjP have been fulfilled, that
      complete records exist for  each  field activity, and  that  the procedures

                                   ONE  - 5                          Revision 1
                                                                     July 1992

-------
     specified  in  the   QAPjP  have  been  implemented.    Emphasis  on  field
     documentation will  help assure sample integrity and sufficient technical
     information  to  recreate  each  field  event.    The  results  of  this
     completeness check should be documented, and environmental data affected
     by incomplete records should be identified.

     Identification of Valid  Samples -- This review involves interpretation and
     evaluation of the  field records  to  detect  problems affecting the repre-
     sentativeness  of environmental  samples.   Examples of  items  that might
     indicate  potentially  invalid  samples  include improper  well development,
     improperly screened wells, instability of pH or conductivity, and collec-
     tion  of volatiles  near internal  combustion  engines.   The field records
     should  be evaluated against  the QAPjP and SOPs. The reviewer should docu-
     ment  the  sample  validity  and  identify the  environmental data associated
     with  any  poor or incorrect  field work.

     Correlation  of  Field Test  Data  --  This review involves  comparing any
     available results of field measurements obtained  by more than one method.
     For  example, surface geophysical  methods   should  correlate  with direct.
     methods  of  site  geologic  characterization  such  as   lithologic  logs
     constructed  during  drilling operations.

     Identification of Anomalous Field Test Data -- This review identifies any
     anomalous field  test data.  For example, a  water  temperature  for  one well
     that  is  5 degrees  higher than  any  other  well  temperature  in  the same
     aquifer should  be  noted.   The  reviewer should  evaluate  the  impact  of
     anomalous field  measurement results on the  associated environmental data.

     Validation  of Field Analyses  --  This review validates  and documents all
     data  from field analysis  that are generated  in  situ  or  from a mobile
     laboratory as  specified in Section 2.7.4.2.  The  reviewer should  document
     whether the  QC checks meet the acceptance criteria,  and  whether corrective
     actions were taken for any analysis  performed when acceptance  criteria
     were  exceeded.

            2.7.4.2  Laboratory Activities

     The  review  of laboratory  data  should  be conducted  by one or  more persons
knowledgeable in laboratory activities and include evaluating,  at a minimum, the
following  subjects:

      Completeness of Laboratory  Records -- This review determines  whether:  (1)
      all  samples and analyses required by the  QAPjP  have been  processed,  (2)
      complete records exist for each analysis  and  the  associated  QC  samples,
      and  that (3) the procedures specified in the QAPjP have been  implemented.
      The   results  of  the  completeness  check  should  be  documented,   and
      environmental data affected by incomplete  records  should be  identified.

      Evaluation  of Data with Respect to Detection  and  Quantitation  Limits  --
      This review compares analytical  results to required quantitation limits.
      Reviewers should document instances where detection or quantitation limits

                                   ONE  - 6                          Revision 1
                                                                     July 1992

-------
      exceed  regulatory  limits,  action  levels,  or  target  concentrations
      specified in the QAPjP.

      Evaluation of Data with Respect to Control  Limits  -- This review compares
      the   results of QC  and  calibration check samples  to  control  criteria.
      Corrective  action  should  be  implemented  for data  not within  control
      limits. The reviewer should check that  corrective  action reports, and the
      results  of  reanalysis,  are  available.    The  review   should  determine
      whether samples associated with out-of-control QC data are identified in
      a written  record  of the data  review,  and whether an  assessment  of the
      utility of such analytical results is recorded.

      Review of Holding Time Data -- This review compares sample holding times
      to those required by the QAPjP, and notes all deviations.

      Review of Performance Evaluation  (PE) Results -- PE study results can be
      helpful in evaluating the impact of out-of-control  conditions. This review
      documents any  recurring trends  or problems  evident  in PE  studies  and
      evaluates their effect on environmental data.

      Correlation  of  Laboratory Data  -- This  review  determines  whether  the
      results of data obtained from  related  laboratory  tests,  e.g.,  Purgeable
      Organic Hal ides (POX) and Volatile Organics,  are documented,  and whether
      the significance of any differences is discussed in the reports.

      2.7.5  QA Reports

      There should be periodic reporting of pertinent QA/QC  information to the
project management to allow assessment  of  the  overall effectiveness  of the QA
program.  There are three major types of QA reports to project management:

      Periodic Report  on Key QA Activities --  Provides  summary of key QA activi-
      ties during  the  period, stressing measures that are being taken to improve
      data  quality;   describes  significant   quality  problems   observed  and
      corrective actions taken;  reports information regarding any changes  in
      certification/accreditation status; describes involvement in resolution of
      quality issues with  clients  or agencies; reports any  QA  organizational
      changes; and provides  notice of  the  distribution of  revised  documents
      controlled by the QA organization (i.e.,  procedures).

      Report on  Measurement Quality  Indicators  -- Includes the assessment of QC
      data gathered over  the  period,  the frequency  of analyses repeated due to
      unacceptable QC performance, and, if possible, the reason  for  the  unac-
      ceptable performance and corrective action taken.

      Reports on QA Assessments --  Includes the results  of the assessments  and
      the  plan for correcting  identified deficiencies;  submitted  immediately
      following  any internal  or external on-site evaluation or upon receipt of
      the  results  of  any  performance evaluation studies.
                                   ONE - 7                          Revision  1
                                                                     July  1992

-------
3.0  FIELD OPERATIONS

      The field  operations  should be  conducted  in such  a  way as  to  provide
reliable information  that  meets the DQOs.   To achieve this,  certain  minimal
policies and procedures  should be implemented.  The  OSW is considering revisions
of Chapter Nine and Eleven of this manual.  Supplemental information and guidance
is available in  the  RCRA Ground-Water Monitoring Technical Enforcement Guidance
Document (TEGD)  (Reference  3).   The project documentation  should  contain the
information specified below.


3.1  FIELD LOGISTICS

      The QAPjP should describe the type(s)  of  field operations to be performed
and the  appropriate area(s) in which  to  perform  the work.   The  QAPjP should
address ventilation, protection from extreme weather and  temperatures, access to
stable power, and provision for water and gases of required purity.

      Whenever practical, the sampling site  facilities should  be examined prior
to the start of work to ensure that all  required items are available.  The actual
area of  sampling should  be  examined to ensure that trucks, drilling equipment,
and personnel have  adequate access to the site.

      The determination as to whether sample  shipping is necessary should be made
during planning  for the project.   This need is established by evaluating the
analyses to be performed, sample holding times, and location of the  site and the
laboratory.  Shipping or transporting of samples to a laboratory should be done
within a timeframe  such  that recommended holding times  are met.

      Samples should be packaged, labelled, preserved (e.g.,  preservative added,,
iced,  etc.),  and documented in  an  area which is free  of  contamination and
provides for secure storage. The level of custody  and whether  sample storage is
needed should be addressed  in  the  QAPjP.

      Storage areas for  solvents,  reagents,  standards,  and reference materials
should  be  adequate to  preserve   their  identity,  concentration,  purity,  and
stability prior  to  use.

      Decontamination  of sampling equipment may  be  performed at the  location
where  sampling  occurs,  prior to going to the  sampling  site,  or in designated
areas near the sampling site.  Project documentation should specify where and how
this work is accomplished.   If decontamination is  to be  done at the  site, water
and  solvents  of  appropriate   purity  should  be   available.    The  method of
accomplishing decontamination,  including  the required materials, solvents, and
water  purity  should be  specified.

       During  the sampling process  and during on-site or in situ analyses,  waste
materials are sometimes generated.  The method  for  storage and disposal  of these
waste  materials that   complies   with  applicable  local,  state   and   Federal
regulations should  be specified.  Adequate facilities should be provided for the
collection  and storage of all wastes,  and  these facilities should be operated  so

                                    ONE - 8                          Revision  1
                                                                      July 1992

-------
 as  to  minimize  environmental   contamination.    Waste  storage  and  disposal
 facilities should comply with applicable federal,  state,  and local  regulations.

      The location of long-term and short-term storage for field records, and the
 measures to ensure the  integrity of the data  should  be specified.


 3.2  EQUIPMENT/INSTRUMENTATION

      The equipment,  instrumentation, and  supplies at the sampling site  should
 be specified and should  be appropriate to accomplish the activities planned.  The
 equipment and  instrumentation  should  meet the requirements of  specifications,
 methods, and procedures as  specified  in the QAPjP.


 3.3  OPERATING  PROCEDURES

      The QAPjP  should describe  or make reference to all field  activities  that
 may affect data quality.  For routinely performed activities,  standard operating
 procedures (SOPs) are often prepared to  ensure consistency and to  save  time and
 effort in preparing QAPjPs.  Any  deviation from an established procedure  during
 a data  collection activity should  be documented.   The procedures  should be
 available for  the  indicated activities,  and  should  include, at  a minimum,  the
 information described below.

      3.3.1  Sample Management

      The numbering and labeling system, chain-of-custody procedures, and how the
 samples  are  to  be  tracked from collection  to  shipment   or  receipt  by  the
 laboratory should be specified. Sample management procedures should also specify
 the  holding  times,  volumes of  sample  required  by  the laboratory,  required
 preservatives, and shipping requirements.

      3.3.2  Reagent/Standard Preparation

      The procedures  describing  how  to prepare standards  and reagents should be
 specified.  Information  concerning specific grades of materials  used  in reagent
 and standard preparation,  appropriate glassware and containers for preparation
 and storage,  and labeling  and record keeping for stocks and dilutions should be
 included.

      3.3.3  Decontamination

      The procedures describing  decontamination of field equipment before and
during the sample  collection process should  be specified.    These procedures
should include  cleaning materials used, the order of washing  and rinsing  with the
cleaning materials, requirements  for protecting or covering cleaned equipment,
and procedures for disposing of cleaning materials.
                                   ONE  - 9                          Revision 1
                                                                     July 1992

-------
      3.3.4  Sample Collection

      The  procedures describing  how  the  sampling  operations  are  actually
performed  in  the  field  should be specified.   A simple reference  to  standard
methods is not sufficient,  unless  a procedure is performed exactly as described
in the published method.   Methods from  source  documents published  by  the EPA,
American Society for Testing  and  Materials, U.S. Department  of  the Interior,
National  Water  Well Association,  American   Petroleum  Institute,  or  other
recognized organizations with  appropriate expertise should be used, if possible.
The procedures for sample collection should include at least the following:

   •  Applicability  of the procedure,

   •  Equipment required,

   •  Detailed  description of  procedures  to  be followed  in collecting  the
      samples,

   •  Common  problems encountered and corrective actions to be followed, and

   •  Precautions to be taken.

      3.3.5   Field Measurements

      The  procedures describing  all  methods used in the field to  determine  a
chemical or  physical parameter  should  be  described  in  detail.  The procedures
should  address criteria from  Section 4, as  appropriate.

      3.3.6   Equipment Calibration And Maintenance

      The  procedures  describing  how  to  ensure that  field equipment  and
instrumentation  are  in  working  order  should  be  specified.    These  describe
calibration  procedures  and  schedules,  maintenance  procedures and schedules,
maintenance  logs,  and  service  arrangements for  equipment.    Calibration and
maintenance  of field equipment and instrumentation should be in accordance with
manufacturers'  specifications or  applicable test specifications and should be
documented.

      3.3.7   Corrective Action

      The  procedures describing how to identify and correct deficiencies in the
sample  collection  process  should  be specified.  These should  include specific
steps   to  take  in  correcting  deficiencies  such   as performing  additional
decontamination  of  equipment,  resampling,  or  additional  training  of  field
personnel.  The procedures should specify that  each corrective action  should be
documented with a description of the deficiency and the corrective action taken,
and  should  include  the  person(s)  responsible  for implementing the corrective
action.
                                    ONE -  10                          Revision 1
                                                                      July 1992

-------
      3.3.8  Data Reduction and Validation

      The procedures describing how to compute results from field measurements
and to review and validate these data should be  specified.  They  should  include
all  formulas  used to  calculate  results  and  procedures  used  to independently
verify that field measurement results are correct.

      3.3.9  Reporting

      The procedures describing the process for reporting the results of field
activities should be specified.

      3.3.10 Records Management

      The  procedures describing  the means  for generating,  controlling,  and
archiving  project-specific records  and  field  operations  records  should be
specified.  These procedures should detail record generation and control  and the
requirements for record retention, including type, time,  security, and retrieval
and disposal authorities.

      Pro.iect-specific  records  relate  to field work  performed  for a project.
      These records may include  correspondence, chain-of-custody  records, field
      notes, all reports issued as a result of the work, and procedures used.

      Field operations records document overall field operations and may  include
      equipment performance and maintenance logs, personnel  files, general field
      procedures, and corrective action reports.

      3.3.11 Waste Disposal

      The procedures  describing the methods  for disposal  of  waste materials
resulting from field operations should be specified.


3.4  FIELD QA AND QC REQUIREMENTS

      The QAPjP  should  describe how the  following   elements of the  field QC
program will be implemented.

      3.4.1  Control Samples

      Control  samples  are  QC samples  that  are  introduced  into a  process to
monitor the performance  of the system.  Control samples, which may  include blanks
(e.g.,  trip,   equipment,  and  laboratory),  duplicates,  spikes,   analytical
standards, and reference materials,  can be used  in different phases of the data
collection process beginning with sampling and continuing through transportation,
storage, and analysis.

      Each day  of sampling, at  least  one  field  duplicate and  one  equipment
rinsate should be collected for each matrix  sampled.  If this frequency is not
appropriate for the sampling equipment and method, then the appropriate changes

                                   ONE -  11                          Revision 1
                                                                     July 1992

-------
should be  clearly  identified in  the  QAPjP.   When  samples are  collected  for
volatile organic analysis, a trip blank is also  recommended  for  each day that.
samples are collected.   In addition, for each sampling batch (20 samples of one
matrix type),  enough  volume should be collected for at least one sample so as to
allow the laboratory  to prepare one matrix spike and either  one matrix duplicate
or one matrix spike duplicate for each analytical method employed.   This means
that the following control samples are recommended:

      •Field duplicate (one per day per matrix type)
      •Equipment rinsate  (one per day per matrix  type)
      •Trip blank (one per day, volatile organics only)
      •Matrix spike  (one per batch [20 samples of each matrix type])
      •Matrix duplicate or matrix spike duplicate (one per batch)

Additional control samples may be necessary in order to assure data quality to
meet the project-specific DQOs.

      3.4.2  Acceptance Criteria

      Procedures should  be in  place for  establishing acceptance criteria for
field activities described in the QAPjP.  Acceptance criteria may  be qualitative
or  quantitative.    Field  events  or  data that  fall  outside of  established
acceptance criteria may indicate a problem with the sampling process that should
be investigated.

      3.4.3  Deviations

      All  deviations  from plan should be documented  as  to the  extent of, and
reason  for,  the  deviation.    Any  activity not  performed in  accordance with
procedures or QAPjPs is considered a deviation from plan.   Deviations from plan
may or may not  affect data quality.

      3.4.4  Corrective Action

      Errors, deficiencies, deviations, certain field events,  or  data that fall
outside  established  acceptance criteria should  be investigated.   In some in-
stances,  corrective  action may be  needed to  resolve the  problem  and restore
proper  functioning  to the system.   The investigation of  the  problem and any
subsequent corrective action taken should be documented.

      3.4.5  Data Handling

      All  field measurement data  should be reduced according  to protocols
described or referenced in the  QAPjP.  Computer programs used  for  data reduction
should be validated before use  and verified on a regular basis.  All  information
used in the calculations  should be recorded to enable reconstruction of the final
result  at  a later date.

      Data should be reported in accordance with the requirements of the end-user
as described  in the  QAPjP.


                                   ONE  -  12                          Revision  1
                                                                     July  1992

-------
3.5  QUALITY ASSURANCE REVIEW

      The QA Review consists of  internal and external  assessments to ensure that
QA/QC procedures  are in use and  to  ensure that field  staff  conform to these
procedures.  QA review should be conducted as deemed  appropriate  and necessary.


3.6  FIELD RECORDS

      Records provide the direct evidence and support for the necessary technical
interpretations, judgments,  and discussions concerning project activities. These
records, particularly those  that are anticipated to be used as evidentiary data,
should directly support current  or ongoing technical  studies and  activities and
should provide  the  historical evidence  needed  for  later reviews and analyses.
Records should  be legible,  identifiable,  and retrievable and protected against
damage,  deterioration, or loss.   The discussion in this section  (3.6) outlines
recommended procedures for  record  keeping.   Organizations which conduct field
sampling should develop appropriate  record  keeping  procedures  which  satisfy
relevant technical and legal requirements.

      Field records generally consist  of bound  field  notebooks with prenumbered
pages, sample  collection  forms,  personnel  qualification  and  training  forms,
sample location maps,  equipment maintenance and calibration  forms,  chain-of-
custody forms,  sample  analysis  request  forms,  and  field change request forms.
All records should  be written in indelible ink.

      Procedures for reviewing,  approving, and  revising  field records should be
clearly defined, with the  lines  of authority included.   It is recommended that
all documentation  errors should be corrected by drawing a single  line through the
error so   it  remains  legible  and  should  be  initialed  by  the  responsible
individual, along with the  date of change.  The correction  should  be  written
adjacent to the error.

      Records should include (but are  not limited to) the following:

      Calibration Records &  Traceability of Standards/Reagents --  Calibration is
      a  reproducible  reference  point  to which  all  sample  measurements  can  be
      correlated.   A  sound  calibration  program should  include  provisions  for
      documentation of frequency,  conditions, standards, and records reflecting
      the  calibration  history of a measurement  system.   The accuracy  of  the
      calibration standards  is important because all  data will  be in  reference
      to the  standards used.   A  program for  verifying  and documenting  the
      accuracy of all  working standards  against primary grade standards  should
      be routinely followed.

      Sample Collection -- To ensure maximum utility of the sampling effort  and
      resulting data,  documentation of the sampling  protocol,  as performed  in
      the field, is essential.  It is recommended that sample collection  records
      contain,   at  a  minimum, the  names  of persons  conducting  the  activity,
      sample number,  sample location,  equipment  used,  climatic  conditions,
      documentation of adherence  to protocol,  and  unusual observations.   The

                                   ONE -  13                        Revision  1
                                                                     July 1992

-------
     actual sample collection record is usually one  of the  following:  a bound
     field  notebook  with  prenumbered  pages,  a pre-printed  form, or digitized
     information on  a computer tape or disc.

     Chain-of-Custodv Records -- The chain-of-custody  involving  the possession
     of  samples  from the time  they  are obtained until  they  are disposed or
     shipped off-site should be documented as specified in the  QAPjP and should
     include the following  information:  (1) the project name;  (2) signatures
     of  samplers;  (3) the sample number, date and time of collection,  and grab
     or  composite sample designation;  (4) signatures of individuals involved in
     sample transfer;  and (5) if applicable,  the air bill or other  shipping
     number.

     Maps and Drawings -- Project planning  documents and  reports often contain
     maps.   The maps are used  to document  the location  of sample collection
     points and monitoring wells and  as a  means of  presenting  environmental
     data.   Information used to prepare maps and drawings is normally  obtained
     through  field  surveys,  property surveys,  surveys  of monitoring wells,
     aerial photography  or  photogrammetric mapping.   The final,  approved maps
     and/or drawings should have a revision number and date and  should be sub-
     ject  to  the  same  controls as other project records.

     QC  Samples -- Documentation for generation of QC  samples,  such as trip  and
     equipment  rinsate  blanks,  duplicate samples, and any  field spikes  should
     be  maintained.

     Deviations --  All  deviations  from  procedural  documents  and  the  QAPjP
     should be  recorded  in  the site logbook.

     Reports -- A copy of any report  issued  and any  supporting documentation
     should be  retained.


4.0  LABORATORY  OPERATIONS

     The laboratory should conduct  its operations  in  such  a way as  to provide
reliable  information. To  achieve this, certain minimal policies and  procedures
should  be implemented.


4.1  FACILITIES

      The QAPjP  should address  all  facility-related  issues  that may  impact
project  data quality.    Each  laboratory  should   be of  suitable   size  and
construction to facilitate the proper conduct of the analyses.  Adequate bench
space or  working area per  analyst should be  provided.  The space requirement per
analyst depends  on  the equipment or apparatus that is being  utilized, the number
of samples that  the analyst is expected to handle at any one  time,  and the number
of operations that are  to be performed concurrently  by a  single analyst.  Other
issues  to be considered include,  but are not  limited to, ventilation,  lighting,


                                   ONE - 14                         Revision 1
                                                                      July 1992

-------
control of dust and drafts, protection from extreme temperatures,  and access  to
a source of  stable  power.

      Laboratories  should  be  designed so that there is adequate  separation  of
functions to ensure that no laboratory  activity  has  an  adverse effect on the
analyses.  The laboratory may require specialized facilities such as a perchloric
acid hood or glovebox.

      Separate space for laboratory operations and appropriate ancillary support
should  be provided,  as  needed,  for the performance of routine  and  specialized
procedures.

      As  necessary  to   ensure  secure  storage  and  prevent  contamination   or
misidentification,  there should be adequate facilities for receipt  and  storage
of  samples.   The level  of custody required and  any  special  requirements for
storage such  as refrigeration should  be  described  in planning documents.

      Storage areas for  reagents,  solvents, standards, and reference materials
should  be  adequate  to  preserve  their  identity,  concentration,  purity,  and
stability.

      Adequate facilities  should be provided for the collection and  storage  of
all wastes,  and these facilities should  be operated so as to minimize environ-
mental contamination.  Waste storage and disposal  facilities should  comply with
applicable federal, state, and local  regulations.

      The location of long-term and short-term storage of  laboratory  records and
the measures  to ensure the integrity  of  the data should be specified.


4.2  EQUIPMENT/INSTRUMENTATION

      Equipment and instrumentation should meet  the requirements and  specifica-
tions of the specific test methods  and other procedures as  specified in the
QAPjP.  The  laboratory should maintain an equipment/instrument description list
that includes the  manufacturer, model  number, year of purchase, accessories, and
any modifications, updates, or upgrades that have been made.


4.3  OPERATING PROCEDURES

      The QAPjP should describe or make reference to all  laboratory activities
that may affect data quality.  For routinely performed activities, SOPs are often
prepared to ensure consistency and  to  save time  and effort in preparing QAPjPs.
Any deviation from  an established  procedure  during a  data collection activity
should be documented.  It is recommended that procedures   be available for the
indicated activities,  and   include,  at a minimum, the  information described
below.
                                   ONE - 15                         Revision 1
                                                                     July 1992

-------
      4.3.1  Sample Management

      The procedures describing the receipt,  handling,  scheduling,  and storage
of samples should be specified.

      Sample Receipt and Handling -- These procedures describe the precautions;
      to be used in opening sample  shipment  containers  and  how to  verify that
      chain-of-custody has been maintained,  examine  samples  for damage,  check
      for  proper  preservatives  and  temperature,  and  log  samples   into  the
      laboratory sample streams.

      Sample Scheduling --  These procedures describe the sample scheduling in
      the  laboratory and  includes  procedures  used  to ensure that holding time
      requirements are met.

      Sample Storage -- These  procedures describe the  storage conditions for all
      samples, verification and documentation of daily storage temperature, and
      how  to  ensure that  custody  of the  samples  is maintained while  in the
      laboratory.

      4.3.2  Reagent/Standard  Preparation

      The  procedures describing how to prepare standards and  reagents  should be
specified.  Information concerning specific grades  of materials  used in reagent
and standard preparation,  appropriate glassware and  containers  for preparation
and storage, and labeling  and  recordkeeping for stocks  and dilutions  should be
included.

      4.3.3  General Laboratory Techniques

      The  procedures describing all  essentials of laboratory operations that are
not addressed  elsewhere should be  specified.  These  techniques  should  include,
but are  not limited to, glassware  cleaning procedures,  operation of analytical
balances,  pipetting techniques, and  use of volumetric glassware.

      4.3.4  Test  Methods

      Procedures  for  test methods describing  how the  analyses  are  actually
performed  in the laboratory should be specified.  A simple reference to standard
methods  is not sufficient, unless  the analysis is performed exactly as  described
in  the  published  method.   Whenever methods  from  SW-846 are not  appropriate,
recognized methods from source documents  published by the  EPA,  American  Public
Health Association (APHA), American Society for Testing and Materials (ASTM), the
National   Institute  for  Occupational  Safety and   Health  (NIOSH),  or   other
recognized organizations with appropriate expertise should be used,  if possible.
The  documentation of  the  actual  laboratory  procedures  for  analytical methods
should  include the following:

      Sample  Preparation   and  Analysis  Procedures  -- These  include  applicable
      holding  time,  extraction,  digestion,  or preparation  steps as appropriate
      to  the  method;  procedures  for determining  the  appropriate dilution  to

                                    ONE  -  16                          Revision  1
                                                                      July 1992

-------
      analyze;  and  any  other information  required to  perform the  analysis
      accurately and consistently.

      Instrument Standardization  -- This includes concentration(s) and frequency
      of analysis of  calibration standards,  linear range of the  method,  and
      calibration acceptance criteria.

      Sample Data -- This includes recording requirements and documentation in-
      cluding sample identification  number,  analyst, data verification, date of
      analysis and verification,  and computational  method(s).

      Precision and Bias -- This  includes all  analytes for which the method is
      applicable and the conditions for use of this information.

      Detection  and Reporting Limits  --  This  includes  all  analytes  in  the
      method.

      Test-Specific QC  --  This   describes QC  activities  applicable to  the
      specific test and references any applicable QC procedures.

      4.3.5  Equipment Calibration and Maintenance

      The procedures  describing  how to  ensure  that laboratory  equipment  and
instrumentation  are in working order  should  be specified.   These procedures
include  calibration  procedures   and   schedules,  maintenance  procedures  and
schedules,  maintenance logs, service arrangements for all  equipment, and spare
parts available in-house.  Calibration and maintenance of laboratory equipment
and instrumentation should be in  accordance with manufacturers'  specifications
or applicable test specifications and should be  documented.

      4.3.6  QC

      The type,  purpose,  and frequency  of QC  samples  to  be analyzed  in  the
laboratory and the acceptance criteria  should  be specified.  Information should
include  the  applicability  of  the QC  sample  to the  analytical process,  the
statistical  treatment  of the data, and the responsibility of laboratory  staff and
management in generating and using the  data.   Further details on development of
project-specific QC  protocols are described in Section 4.4.

      4.3.7  Corrective Action

      The procedures describing how  to  identify  and  correct deficiencies in the
analytical  process should be specified.  These should include specific steps to
take in  correcting  the deficiencies  such as preparation of  new standards  and
reagents,  recalibration  and  restandardization   of equipment,  reanalysis  of
samples,  or  additional   training  of  laboratory   personnel  in  methods  and
procedures.   The procedures  should specify that each  corrective action should be
documented with a description of the deficiency and the corrective action taken,
and should  include  the person(s) responsible  for  implementing  the corrective
action.
                                   ONE - 17                         Revision 1
                                                                     July 1992

-------
      4.3.8  Data Reduction and Validation

      The procedures describing how to review and validate  the  data should be
specified.  They should include procedures for  computing  and  interpreting the
results from QC samples, and independent procedures to verify  that the analytical
results are reported correctly.  In addition,  routine  procedures used to monitor
precision and bias, including evaluations of reagent,  equipment  rinsate, and trip
blanks,  calibration  standards, control  samples,  duplicate  and matrix  spike
samples, and surrogate  recovery,  should  be  detailed in the procedures.   More
detailed validation procedures  should be performed  when  required  in the contract
or QAPjP.

      4.3.9  Reporting

      The procedures describing the process for reporting the analytical results
should be specified.

      4.3.10 Records Management

      The  procedures  describing  the  means  for generating,  controlling,  and
archiving laboratory records should  be specified.  The procedures should detail
record generation and control, and  the requirements for record retention, includ-
ing type, time, security,  and retrieval  and disposal  authorities.

      Project-specific  records may  include   correspondence,  chain-of-custody
      records,  request for analysis, calibration data records, raw and finished
      analytical and QC data, data reports,  and  procedures used.

      Laboratory operations records may include laboratory notebooks, instrument
      performance logs and maintenance logs in bound  notebooks with prenumbered
      pages; laboratory  benchsheets;  software  documentation;  control  charts;
      reference material certification; personnel  files; laboratory procedures;
      and corrective action reports.

      4.3.11 Waste Disposal

      The procedures describing the  methods for  disposal of chemicals including
standard and reagent solutions, process waste, and samples should be specified.


4.4  LABORATORY QA AND QC PROCEDURES

      The  QAPjP should describe  how  the following  required  elements  of the
laboratory  QC program are to be implemented.

      4.4.1  Method Proficiency

      Procedures should  be in  place  for demonstrating proficiency with each
analytical  method  routinely  used in the laboratory.    These  should include
procedures  for demonstrating the  precision and  bias  of the method as performed
by  the  laboratory  and  procedures for  determining the method detection  limit

                                   ONE -  18                         Revision  1
                                                                     July  1992

-------
(MDL).  All terminology, procedures and frequency of determinations associated
with the laboratory's establishment of the MDL and the reporting limit should be
well-defined  and  well-documented.    Documented  precision,  bias,  and  MDL
information should be maintained for all methods performed in the laboratory.

      4.4.2  Control Limits

      Procedures should be in place for establishing and updating control limits
for  analysis.   Control  limits should  be  established  to  evaluate laboratory
precision and bias based on the analysis of control  samples.  Typically, control
limits for bias are  based  on the  historical  mean recovery plus  or minus three
standard deviation units, and control limits for precision range from zero (no
difference between duplicate control  samples)  to the historical  mean relative
percent difference plus three standard deviation units.  Procedures  should be in
place for monitoring  historical  performance and should include graphical (control
charts) and/or tabular presentations of the data.

      4.4.3  Laboratory  Control Procedures

      Procedures should be in place for demonstrating that  the laboratory is in
control during each  data collection  activity.   Analytical  data generated with
laboratory control samples that fall within prescribed  limits are judged to be
generated while the  laboratory was in control.  Data generated with laboratory
control samples that fall outside the established control limits are judged to
be  generated during  an "out-of-control" situation.   These data are considered
suspect and should be  repeated or reported with qualifiers.

      Laboratory  Control  Samples  --   Laboratory  control  samples  should  be
      analyzed for each  analytical  method  when appropriate for the method.   A
      laboratory control sample consists of either a control  matrix  spiked with
      analytes representative  of  the target analytes or a certified reference
      material.

      Laboratory control sample(s) should be analyzed with each batch of samples
      processed to verify that the precision and bias of the  analytical process
      are  within  control   limits.    The  results   of  the  laboratory  control
      sample(s) are  compared to  control limits established for both precision
      and  bias to determine usability of the data.

      Method Blank -- When appropriate for the method, a method blank should be
      analyzed  with  each  batch  of samples processed  to assess contamination
      levels in the  laboratory.  Guidelines should be in place for  accepting or
      rejecting data based  on  the  level  of contamination in  the blank.

      Procedures  should  be in place for documenting the effect of the matrix on
method  performance.   When  appropriate for  the  method,  there  should  be at least
one matrix spike  and either one matrix  duplicate or one matrix spike duplicate
per analytical batch.  Additional control samples may be  necessary to assure data
quality  to meet the  project-specific DQOs.
                                    ONE  -  19                          Revision  1
                                                                      July  1992

-------
      Matrix-Specific Bias -- Procedures should be  in  place for determining the
      bias of  the  method due to the matrix.   These  procedures  should include
      preparation and analysis of matrix spikes, selection and use of surrogates
      for organic methods,  and  the  method  of standard additions for metal and
      inorganic methods.  When the concentration of the analyte in the sample is
      greater  than 0.1%, no spike is necessary.

      Matrix-Specific Precision -- Procedures should be in place for determining
      the precision  of  the  method  for a  specific matrix.    These procedures
      should   include  analysis  of  matrix  duplicates  and/or  matrix  spike
      duplicates.  The frequency of use of these techniques should be based on
      the DQO  for the data collection activity.

      Matrix-Specific  Detection Limit  --  Procedures  should  be in  place for
      determining the MDL for  a  specific matrix type (e.g., wastewater treatment
      sludge,  contaminated soil, etc).

      4.4.4  Deviations

      Any activity not  performed in accordance with  laboratory  procedures or
QAPjPs is considered a deviation from plan.  All deviations from plan should be
documented as  to the extent of, and reason for, the deviation.

      4.4.5  Correctlye Action

      Errors,  deficiencies, deviations, or laboratory events or data that fall
outside  of  established  acceptance criteria  should be investigated.   In some
instances, corrective action  may be  needed  to  resolve the problem  and restore
proper functioning to the analytical system.  The investigation of the problem
and any subsequent corrective action taken should be  documented.

      4.4.6  Data Handling

      Data resulting  from the  analyses of samples should be reduced according to
protocols described  in the  laboratory  procedures.  Computer  programs used for
data reduction should be validated before use and verified on a regular basis..
All information  used in  the calculations (e.g., raw  data,  calibration files.,
tuning records, results of standard additions,  interference  check results, and
blank- or background-correction  protocols) should be recorded  in order to enable
reconstruction  of  the  final  result  at a  later  date.    Information  on  the
preparation of the sample  (e.g., weight or  volume  of  sample  used,  percent dry
weight for  solids,  extract  volume,  dilution  factor  used)    should  also  be
maintained in order to enable reconstruction  of  the final  result at a later date..

      All data  should be  reviewed by a second analyst or supervisor according to
laboratory procedures  to ensure that  calculations are  correct and  to detect
transcription errors.  Spot checks should be performed on computer calculations
to verify program  validity.   Errors detected  in the  review  process  should be
referred  to the analyst(s)  for  corrective action.  Data  should  be  reported in
accordance with the  requirements of  the end-user.  It is recommended that the
supporting documentation include at  a minimum:

                                   ONE - 20                         Revision 1
                                                                     July 1992

-------
      Laboratory name and address.

      Sample  information  (including  unique  sample  identification,   sample
      collection date and time, date of  sample  receipt,  and  date(s)  of sample
      preparation and analysis).

      Analytical results  reported  with  an  appropriate number of  significant
      figures.

      Detection limits that  reflect dilutions, interferences, or correction for
      equivalent dry weight.

      Method reference.

      Appropriate QC results (correlation with sample batch should be traceable
      and documented).

      Data qualifiers with appropriate references and narrative on the quality
      of the results.
4.5  QUALITY ASSURANCE REVIEW

      The QA review consists of internal and external  assessments to ensure that
QA/QC procedures are in use and to ensure that laboratory  staff conform to these
procedures.  QA review should  be  conducted  as deemed appropriate and necessary.


4.6  LABORATORY RECORDS

      Records provide the direct evidence and support for the necessary technical
interpretations,  judgements,  and  discussions  concerning project  activities.
These records, particularly those that are anticipated to  be used as evidentiary
data, should directly support  technical  studies and activities, and provide the
historical evidence  needed for later  reviews  and  analyses.   Records should be
legible,   identifiable,   and   retrievable,  and  protected   against  damage,
deterioration,  or  loss.    The  discussion  in  this  section  (4.6)  outlines
recommended procedures for record  keeping.   Organizations which  conduct field
sampling  should  develop  appropriate  record  keeping procedures which  satisfy
relevant technical and legal  requirements.

      Laboratory records generally consist of bound notebooks with prenumbered
pages,  personnel  qualification  and training forms,  equipment  maintenance and
calibration forms,  chain-of-custody forms,  sample analysis  request forms, and
analytical change request forms.  All records  should be written in indelible ink.

      Procedures for reviewing, approving, and revising laboratory records should
be clearly  defined,  with  the lines of  authority  included.   Any  documentation
errors should be corrected by  drawing  a single line through the  error  so that it
remains legible and should be initialed by the responsible  individual,  along with
the date of change.  The correction is written adjacent to the error.

                                   ONE - 21                         Revision 1
                                                                     July 1992

-------
      Strip-chart recorder printouts should be signed by the person who performed
the instrumental  analysis.  If corrections need  to be made  in computerized data,
a system parallel to the corrections for handwritten  data should be in place.

      Records of sample management should be available  to permit the re-creation
of an analytical  event for review  in the case of an audit or investigation of a
dubious result.

      Laboratory records should include,  at least, the following:

      Operating Procedures -- Procedures should  be available to those performing
      the task outlined.   Any  revisions to laboratory  procedures  should  be
      written, dated,  and distributed to  all  affected individuals  to ensure
      implementation  of  changes.   Areas  covered  by  operating  procedures  are
      given in Sections 3.3  and 4.3.

      Quality Assurance Plans -- The QAPjP should be  on file.

      Equipment Maintenance Documentation  -- A history  of the maintenance record
      of each  system serves  as an  indication  of the  adequacy  of maintenance
      schedules and parts  inventory.  As appropriate, the maintenance guidelines;
      of the  equipment  manufacturer  should  be  followed.    When  maintenance  is;
      necessary,  it  should  be  documented  in  either  standard  forms or  in
      logbooks.  Maintenance procedures should be clearly defined and written
      for each measurement system and required  support equipment.

      Proficiency -- Proficiency information on  all compounds reported should be
      maintained and should  include (1) precision; (2) bias;  (3) method detec-
      tion limits;  (4) spike recovery, where  applicable; (5) surrogate recovery,
      where applicable;  (6)  checks  on reagent  purity, where applicable;  and
      (7) checks on glassware cleanliness, where applicable.

      Calibration Records  & Traceability of Standards/Reagents -- Calibration is;
      a reproducible  reference  point  to  which  all sample  measurements can  be
      correlated.   A sound  calibration program should include  provisions  for
      documenting frequency,  conditions,  standards, and records  reflecting  the
      calibration  history of  a  measurement   system.    The  accuracy  of  the
      calibration standards  is important because all  data will  be in reference
      to the  standards used.   A  program for verifying  and documenting  the
      accuracy and  traceability of  all working standards  against appropriate
      primary grade standards  or the highest quality standards available should
      be routinely followed.

      Sample Management --All required records pertaining to sample management
      should  be  maintained  and  updated  regularly.   These include  chain-of-
      custody forms, sample  receipt forms, and  sample  disposition records.

      Original Data  --  The  raw data  and calculated  results  for  all  samples;
      should be maintained in  laboratory notebooks, logs,  benchsheets, files or
      other sample tracking or data entry  forms.   Instrumental output should be
      stored in a computer file or a hardcopy  report.

                                   ONE -  22                         Revision 1
                                                                     July 1992

-------
      QC Data  --  The raw  data and  calculated  results for  all  QC  and  field
      samples and  standards should  be maintained in the manner described in the
      preceding paragraph.   Documentation  should  allow correlation  of sample
      results with associated QC data.  Documentation  should also  include the
      source and lot numbers of standards for traceability.  QC samples include,
      but are not limited to, control  samples, method blanks, matrix spikes, and
      matrix spike duplicates.

      Correspondence --  Project correspondence can provide evidence supporting
      technical interpretations.  Correspondence pertinent to  the project should
      be kept and  placed in the project files.

      Deviations -- All deviations from procedural  and planning documents should
      be recorded  in  laboratory  notebooks.   Deviations from  QAPjPs  should be
      reviewed  and approved by  the  authorized personnel  who performed  the
      original technical review or by their designees.

      Final Report --  A  copy of any report issued and any supporting documenta-
      tion should be retained.
5.0  DEFINITIONS
      The following terms are defined for use in this document:
ACCURACY
BATCH:
BIAS:
The closeness of agreement between an observed value  and
an accepted  reference  value.   When  applied  to  a set  of
observed  values,  accuracy will  be  a combination  of  a
random  component  and of  a common  systematic  error  (or
bias) component.

A group of samples which behave similarly with respect to
the sampling or the testing procedures being  employed  and
which are processed as a unit (see Section 3.4.1  for  field
samples and Section 4.4.3  for laboratory samples).  For QC
purposes, if the number of samples in a  group is  greater
than 20, then each group of 20 samples or less will all be
handled as a separate batch.

The deviation due to matrix effects of the measured  value
(xs - xu)  from a known spiked amount.  Bias can be  assessed
by comparing  a measured  value  to  an accepted  reference
value in a sample  of known concentration or by determining
the recovery of a known amount  of contaminant spiked into
a sample  (matrix spike).   Thus, the bias  (B) due  to matrix
effects based on a  matrix spike  is calculated as:
                        where:
                                    B =  (x. - xu  )  -  K
                                   ONE  - 23
                                               Revision 1
                                                July 1992

-------
BLANK:

CONTROL SAMPLE:
DATA QUALITY
OBJECTIVES (DQOs)
DATA VALIDATION:
DUPLICATE:


EQUIPMENT BLANK:

EQUIPMENT RINSATE:
ESTIMATED
QUANTITATION
LIMIT (EQL):
                                    xs  =  measured  value  for  spiked  sample,
                                    xu  = measured value for unspiked sample, and
                                    K  =  known value of the spike  in the sample.

                      Using  the  following equation yields the percent recovery
              %R  =  100  (xs - xj/ K

see Equipment Rinsate, Method Blank, Trip Blank.

A  QC  sample  introduced  into a  process to  monitor  the
performance of the system.

A  statement  of  the overall  level  of uncertainty that  a
decision-maker  is  willing to accept  in results  derived
from environmental data (see reference  2, EPA/QAMS,  July
16, 1986).   This  is qualitatively distinct from  quality
measurements such  as precision, bias, and detection limit.

The process of evaluating the available data against the
project DQOs  to  make  sure that  the objectives are  met.
Data  validation  may  be  very  rigorous,  or  cursory,
depending on  project  DQOs.   The available data reviewed
will include analytical  results,  field  QC data  and lab QC
data,  and may also include field records.
see  Matrix  Duplicate,
Duplicate.

see Equipment Rinsate.
Field  Duplicate,   Matrix  Spike
A sample  of analyte-free media  which has  been  used to
rinse  the  sampling  equipment.    It   is  collected after
completion of decontamination and prior to sampling.  This
blank is useful in documenting adequate decontamination of
sampling equipment.

The  lowest  concentration  that can be reliably achieved
within specified limits of precision  and accuracy during
routine  laboratory operating  conditions.    The  EQL is
generally 5  to  10  times  the MDL.   However,  it  may be
nominally chosen  within these guidelines  to  simplify data
reporting.      For   many   analytes   the   EQL   analyte
concentration is  selected  as the  lowest non-zero standard
in the calibration curve.  Sample EQLs are highly matrix-
dependent.   The  EQLs in SW-846 are provided for guidance
and may not always be achievable.
                                   ONE -  24
                                              Revision 1
                                               July 1992

-------
FIELD DUPLICATES:
LABORATORY CONTROL
SAMPLE:
MATRIX:


MATRIX DUPLICATE:


MATRIX SPIKE:
MATRIX SPIKE
DUPLICATES:
METHOD BLANK:
METHOD DETECTION
LIMIT (MDL):
Independent  samples  which  are  collected  as  close  as
possible to the same point  in  space  and time.  They are
two separate samples taken from the same source,  stored in
separate containers, and  analyzed independently.   These
duplicates are useful  in documenting  the precision of the^
sampling process.

A known matrix spiked with compound(s)  representative of
the target analytes.  This is used to document laboratory
performance.

The component or substrate (e.g.,  surface water, drinking
water) which contains the analyte of interest.

An intralaboratory split sample which is used  to document
the precision of a method in a given sample matrix.

An aliquot of sample spiked with a known concentration of
target  analyte(s).   The  spiking  occurs prior to sample
preparation  and  analysis.   A  matrix  spike  is  used to
document the bias of a method in a given sample matrix.

Intralaboratory  split  samples   spiked   with   identical
concentrations of target  analyte(s).   The  spiking occurs
prior to sample preparation and analysis.  They are  used
to document the precision and bias of a method in a given
sample matrix.

An analyte-free matrix to which all reagents  are added in
the  same  volumes  or  proportions  as  used   in  sample
processing.   The  method blank  should  be  carried through
the complete sample preparation and analytical  procedure.
The  method  blank  is   used to  document contamination
resulting from the analytical process.

For  a method  blank  to be  acceptable  for  use with the
accompanying  samples,  the concentration in the blank of
any  analyte of concern should  not  be  higher  than the
highest of either:

(l)The method detection limit,  or

(2)Five percent of the regulatory limit for that analyte,
or

(3)Five  percent  of  the  measured concentration  in the
sample.

The  minimum concentration  of   a  substance that  can be
measured and reported with 99% confidence that the analyte
concentration is greater than zero and is determined  from
                                   ONE - 25
                                               Revision  1
                                                July 1992

-------
analysis of  a  sample  in a given matrix type   containing
the analyte.

For  operational  purposes,  when   it   is   necessary   to
determine  the  MDL  in  the  matrix, the  MDL  should   be
determined by multiplying  the appropriate one-sided 99% t-
statistic  by  the  standard  deviation  obtained  from  a
minimum of three analyses  of a matrix spike containing  the
analyte of interest  at a concentration three to five times
the estimated MDL, where the  t-statistic is obtained from
standard references or the table below.
No. of samples:            t-statistic
      3                       6.96
      4                       4.54
      5                       3.75
      6                       3.36
      7                       3.14
      8                       3.00
      9                       2.90
     10                       2.82

Estimate the MDL as follows:
Obtain the concentration value that corresponds to:

a) an instrument  signal/noise  ratio  within the range  of
2.5 to 5.0, or

b) the  region of  the standard  curve where  there is  a
significant change  in  sensitivity  (i.e.,  a break  in the
slope of the standard curve).

Determine the variance (S2)  for each  analyte as follows:
                      n-1
where X; = the ith measurement of the variable x
and x = the average value of x;
             ONE - 26                         Revision 1
                                               July 1992

-------
                      Determine  the  standard deviation (s)  for each analyte as
                      follows:
                                            1/2
                      Determine the  MDL for each  analyte as  follows:
ORGANIC-FREE
REAGENT WATER:
PRECISION:
                                    MDL = t
                                           (n-1. flt = .99)
                                (S)
where t(n.,,     wx is the one-sided t-statistic  appropriate
for the number'of samples used to determine (s), at the 99
percent level.

For  volatiles,  all  references  to water  in  the  methods
refer to water in which an  interferant is  not  observed at
the method detection limit of the compounds of interest.
Organic-free reagent water  can be generated by passing tap
water through a  carbon  filter bed containing about 1 pound
of activated carbon.   A water purification system may be
used   to   generate   organic-free    deionized    water.
Organic-free reagent water  may also be prepared by boiling
water for 15 minutes and, subsequently, while  maintaining
the temperature  at 90°C, bubbling a contaminant-free inert
gas through the water  for  1 hour.

For  semivolatiles   and  nonvolatiles,   all  references  to
water  in  the  methods  refer   to  water  in  which  an
interferant is not observed at  the method  detection limit
of the compounds of interest.   Organic-free reagent water
can  be  generated  by passing tap water through  a carbon
filter bed containing  about 1 pound of activated carbon.
A  water purification  system  may  be  used  to  generate
organic-free deionized water.

The  agreement  among   a  set  of  replicate measurements
without  assumption  of  knowledge  of  the  true  value.
Precision  is  estimated by means of  duplicate/replicate
analyses.  These samples should contain concentrations of
analyte above the MDL, and may  involve the use of matrix
spikes.  The most commonly  used estimates of precision are
the  relative standard  deviation  (RSD)  or  the  coefficient
of variation (CV),

               RSD = CV =  100  S/x,
                                   ONE  - 27
                                               Revision 1
                                                July 1992

-------
PROJECT:
QUALITY ASSURANCE
PROJECT PLAN
(QAPjP):
RCRA:

REAGENT BLANK:

REAGENT GRADE:




REAGENT WATER:
REFERENCE MATERIAL:
SPLIT SAMPLES:
STANDARD ADDITION:
STANDARD CURVE:
wjiere:
 x = the  arithmetic mean  of  the x( measurements,  and  S  ==
variance; and the relative percent difference  (RPD)  when
only two  samples are available.

               RPD = 100 [(x,  -  x2)/{(Xl + x2)/2}].

Single  or multiple data  collection  activities that  are
related through the same planning sequence.

An orderly assemblage of detailed procedures designed to
produce  data of  sufficient  quality  to  meet  the  data
quality   objectives   for   a   specific  data   collection
activity.

The Resource Conservation and Recovery Act.

See Method Blank.

Analytical  reagent  (AR)  grade,  ACS  reagent  grade,  and
reagent  grade  are  synonymous  terms  for  reagents  which
conform to the current specifications of the Committee on
Analytical Reagents of the American Chemical  Society.

Water that  has  been generated  by any method which  would
achieve the  performance  specifications for ASTM  Type II
water.    For organic  analyses, see  the  definition  of
organic-free reagent water.

A material containing  known quantities of  target analytes
in solution  or  in a homogeneous matrix.   It  is  used to
document the bias of the analytical  process.

Aliquots  of sample taken from  the   same  container  and
analyzed  independently.    In  cases  where  aliquots  of
samples are impossible to obtain, field duplicate  samples
should be taken for the matrix  duplicate analysis.  These
are usually taken  after mixing or compositing  and are used
to document intra- or interlaboratory precision.

The practice of adding a known  amount of  an analyte  to  a.
sample  immediately  prior  to  analysis.   It is typically
used to evaluate interferences.

A plot of concentrations of known analyte standards versus
the  instrument  response  to  the  analyte.   Calibration
standards are prepared by successively diluting  a standard
solution  to  produce working  standards which  cover  the
working  range  of the  instrument.    Standards  should  be
prepared  at  the frequency specified  in the appropriate
                                   ONE - 28
                                               Revision  1
                                               July  1992

-------
                      section.   The  calibration  standards should  be prepared
                      using the same type  of  acid  or solvent and  at the same
                      concentration  as  will  result  in  the  samples  following
                      sample preparation.  This  is applicable  to  organic and
                      inorganic chemical  analyses.

SURROGATE:            An   organic  compound  which  is  similar  to  the  target
                      analyte(s)  in chemical  composition  and behavior  in the
                      analytical  process,  but which  is not  normally found in
                      environmental  samples.

TRIP BLANK:           A sample  of analyte-free media taken from the laboratory
                      to   the  sampling  site   and  returned  to  the  laboratory
                      unopened.   A trip  blank  is used to document contamination
                      attributable  to shipping and  field  handling  procedures.
                      This type of blank is useful in documenting contamination
                      of  volatile organics  samples.


6.0  REFERENCES

1.   Interim Guidelines  and  Specifications   for  Preparing  Quality  Assurance
     Project Plans, QAMS-005/80, December 29,  1980,  Office  of  Monitoring Systems
     and Quality Assurance, ORD, U.S.  EPA,  Washington,  DC  20460.

2.   Development of Data Quality Objectives, Description of Stages I  and II, July
     16, 1986,  Quality Assurance Management Staff, ORD,  U.S. EPA, Washington, DC
     20460.

3.   RCRA  Ground-Water Monitoring  Technical   Enforcement Guidance  Document,
     September, 1986, Office of Waste Programs Enforcement.   OSWER,  U.S. EPA,
     Washington, DC,  20460.

4.   DQO  Training  Software, Version  6.5,  December,  1988,  Quality  Assurance
     Management Staff, ORD, U.S. EPA,  Washington, DC 20460.

5.   Preparing   Perfect Project  Plans,   EPA/600/9-89/087,  October  1989,  Risk
     Reduction  Engineering Laboratory (Guy  Simes),  Cincinnati OH.

6.   ASTM Method D 1129-77, Specification for Reagent Water.   1991  Annual Book
     of ASTM Standards.  Volume 11.01  Water and Environmental Technology.

7.   Generation of Environmental  Data Related to  Waste  Management Activities
     (Draft).  February 1989.   ASTM.
                                   ONE - 29                         Revision 1
                                                                     July 1992

-------
                                     INDEX

Accuracy  1, 13, 22, 23", 24
Batch  12, 19, 21, 23*
Bias  2, 3, 17-20, 22, 23*-25, 28
Blank  11, 12, 14, 18-20, 23", 24, 25, 28, 29
   Equipment Rinsate  11, 12,  14,  18, 24"
   Method Blank  19, 24, 25*, 28
   Reagent Blank  28*
   Trip Blank  12, 18, 24, 29*
Chain-of-Custody  9, 11, 13,  14,  18,  21,  22
Control Chart  18, 19
Control Sample  11, 12,  18,  19, 23, 24*
Data Quality Objectives  (DQO)  1-3, 8, 12, 19,  20,  24", 28
Decision-maker  2, 24
Duplicate  11, 12, 14, 18-20,  23,  24*, 25, 27,  28
   Field Duplicate  11,  12,  24, 25",  28
   Matrix Duplicate  12, 19,  20,  24,  25", 28
   Matrix Spike Duplicate  12, 19,  20, 23, 24,  25*
Equipment Blank  11, 24*
Equipment Rinsate  11, 12, 14, 18,  24*
Estimated Quantitation Limit  (EQL)  24"
Field Duplicate  12, 24, 25", 28
Laboratory Control Sample  19, 25"
Matrix  11, 12, 18-20, 23-25", 26-28
Matrix Duplicate  12, 19, 20,  24,  25", 28
Matrix Spike  12, 18-20, 23,  25*,  26, 27
Matrix Spike Duplicate   12,  19, 20, 23,  24, 25*
Method Blank  19, 24, 25*,  28
Method Detection Limit (MDL)  18-20, 22,  24, 25*-27
Organic-Free Reagent Water   27*,  28
Precision  1-3, 17-20, 22, 24, 25,  27",  28
Project  1-5, 7, 8, 11-14, 17-19,  21, 23, 24,  28"
Quality Assurance Project Plan (QAPjP)  1-9,  11, 12,  14, 15,  18, 20, 22, 23, 28*
RCRA  1, 8, 28*
Reagent Blank  28*
Reagent Grade  28*
Reagent Water  27, 28*
Reference Material  8, 11, 15, 18,  19, 28*
Split Samples  25, 28*
Standard Addition  20, 28*
Standard Curve  26, 28*
Surrogate  18, 20, 22, 29"
Trip Blank  12, 18, 24,  29*
   Definition of term.
                                    ONE  -  30                          Revision 1
                                                                      July 1992

-------
                                  ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS

     The Office of Solid Waste thanks the following Individuals and groups for
their efforts, assistance and advice 1n the preparation of this manual:

          Dr. William Loy, Chemist, Analytical Support Branch, EPA Region IV;
          Mr. Theodore Martin, Research Chemist, EMSL-CI;
          Dr. Nancy Rothman, Assistant Director, ERCO/A Division of ENSECO;
          Ms. Ann Soule, Technical Editor, ERCO/A Division of ENSECO;
          Ms. Dorothy Bell, Technical Editor, ERCO/A Division of ENSECO;
          Ms. Margaret Layne, Technical Program Manager, Research Triangle
              Institute;
          Mr. Alvia Gaskill, Senior Environmental Scientist, Research Triangle
              Institute;
          Mr. Ronald Ramsey, Technical Program Manager, Dynamac Corp.;
          Mr. Gene E. Fax, Managing Director, The Cadmus Group, Inc.;
          Mr. Robert Hirsch, New Jersey Department of Environmental
              Protection;
          Mr. Henry Hoffman, New Jersey Department of Environmental
              Protection;
          Mr. David Bennett, Hazardous Substance Branch, EPA;
          The EPA SW-846 Work Group.
                                 ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS - 1
                                                          Revision
                                                          Date   September  1986

-------
                                 CHAPTER TWO

                        CHOOSING THE CORRECT PROCEDURE
2.1  PURPOSE
      This chapter  aids  the analyst  in  choosing the appropriate  methods for
samples, based upon sample matrix and the analytes to be determined.

      2.1.1  Trace Analysis vs. Macroanalvsis

      The methods presented  in  SW-846  were  designed  through sample sizing and
concentration procedures to address the problem of "trace"  analyses  (<1000 ppm),
and have been developed for an  optimized  working  range.  These methods are also
applicable to "minor"  (1000 ppm - 10,000 ppm) and "major"  (>10,000 ppm) analyses,
as well as to  "trace"  analyses,  through  use of appropriate sample preparation
techniques that result  in analyte concentration within that optimized range. Such
sample preparation techniques include:

      1) adjustment of size of sample prepared for analysis,
      2) adjustment of injection volumes,
      3) dilution or concentration of sample,
      4) elimination of concentration steps prescribed for  "trace" analyses,
      5) direct injection (of samples to be analyzed for volatile constituents).

      The performance data presented in each of these methods were generated from
"trace" analyses,  and  may not  be applicable to "minor"  and "major" analyses.
Generally, extraction  efficiency improves as concentration  increases.

CAUTION;     Care  should  be  taken  when  analyzing samples  for  trace analyses
             subsequent   to  analysis   of  concentrated   samples   due  to  the
             possibility  of contamination.

      2.1.2  Choice of Apparatus and Preparation of Reagents

      Since  many  types and  sizes  of glassware  and  supplies  are  commercially
available,  and since  it is possible to prepare reagents  and standards in many
different ways, those  specified in these methods may  be  replaced by any similar
types  as  long as  this substitution does not affect the overall quality of the
analyses.


2.2  REQUIRED INFORMATION

      In  order to  choose the  correct  combination  of  methods  to  form the
appropriate  analytical  procedure,  some basic  information  is required.
                                    TWO - 1                      Revision 2
                                                             September 1994

-------
      2.2.1  Physical State(s) of Sample

      The phase characteristics of the sample must be known.   There are several
 general  categories  of phases  in which  the  sample  may be  categorized:

               Aqueous                 Oil  and Organic Liquid
               Sludges                 Solids
               Multiphase Samples       EP and TCLP Extracts
               Ground Water

      2.2.2  Analvtes

      Analytes are divided into classes based on the determinative methods which
 are used to identify and quantify  them.  Table 2-1 lists the organic analytes of
 SW-846 methods, Table 2-2  lists the analytes that may  be prepared  using Method
 3650,  and Table  2-3  lists  the   analytes  that are  collected from  stack gas
 effluents  using  VOST  methodology.   Tables  2-4  through 2-31  list the target
 analytes of each organic determinative method.  Some of the  analytes appear on
 more  than  one  table, as they may be determined  using any of several  methods.
 Table 2-32 indicates which methods are  applicable  to  inorganic target analytes.

      2.2.3  Detection  Limits Required

      Regulations may require a specific sensitivity or detection  limit for an
 analysis,  as in the determination of  analytes for the Toxicity Characteristic
 (TC)  or  for  delisting petitions.   Drinking  water  detection  limits, for those
 specific organic and  metallic analytes covered by the National Interim Primary
 Drinking Water Standards,  are desired  in the analysis of ground water.

      2.2.4  Analytical Objective

      Knowledge of  the analytical objective will  be useful  in  the choice of
 aliquoting procedures and  in the selection of a determinative method.  This is
 especially true when the  sample  has  more than one  phase.  Knowledge of the
 analytical objective may not be possible  or desirable at all management levels,
 but  that  information  should  be  transmitted to the analytical  laboratory
 management to  ensure  that the correct  techniques are  being  applied  to  the
 analytical effort.

      2.2.5  Detection and Monitoring

      The strategy for detection of compounds  in environmental  or process samples
may be contrasted with the strategy for monitoring samples.  Detection samples
define initial  conditions.  When there is  little information available about the
composition of the sample source,  e.g., a well or process stream,  mass spectral
 identification of  organic analytes leads to fewer  false  positive results.  Thus,
the most practical  form of  detection for organic analytes, given the analytical
requirements,  is mass spectral  identification.   The choice of  technique  for
metals  is  governed   by   the  detection   limit   requirements  and  potential
 interferents.

      Monitoring samples, on the other hand, are analyzed to  confirm  existing and
on-going conditions,  tracking  the presence  or absence of constituents  in an


                                   TWO - 2                     Revision 2
                                                            September 1994

-------
environmental  or process  matrix.    In  well  defined  and  stable  analytical
conditions and matrices less compound-specific detection modes may be used.

      2.2.6  Sample Containers. Preservations, and Holding Times

      Appropriate sample containers,  sample  preservation techniques, and sample
holding times for aqueous matrices are listed in Table 2-33, near the end of this
chapter.   Similar  information may  be  found  in  Table 3-1  of  Chapter  Three
(inorganic analytes) and Table 4-1 of Chapter Four  (organic analytes).  Samples
must be extracted/analyzed  within  the specified holding times for the results to
be considered  reflective  of total concentrations.  Analytical  data  generated
outside of the specified holding times must be considered to be minimum values
only.  Such data may be used to demonstrate that a waste is hazardous where it
shows the concentration of  a constituent to be above the regulatory threshold but
cannot be used to demonstrate that a waste is not hazardous.


2.3  IMPLEMENTING THE GUIDANCE

      The  choice  of  the   appropriate  sequence  of  methods   depends  on  the
information required and on the experience of the analyst.  Figure 2-1 summarizes
the organic analysis options available.  Appropriate selection  is confirmed by
the quality control  results.  The use  of the recommended procedures, whether they
are approved or mandatory, does not release the analyst from demonstrating the
correct execution of the method.

      2.3.1  Extraction and Sample Preparation Procedures

      Methods  for preparing organic  analytes are  shown in Table 2-34.   Method
3500 and associated methods should be consulted for further details on preparing
the sample for analysis.

            2.3.1.1  Aqueous Samples

            The choice  of  a preparative method depends on the sample.  Methods
      3510  and 3520 may  be used  for  extraction  of  the  semivolatile  organic
      compounds.  Method 3510,  a separatory funnel extraction,  is appropriate
      for samples which will not  form a persistent emulsion interphase between
      the sample and the extraction solvent.  The  formation of  an emulsion that
      cannot   be  broken  up  by  mechanical   techniques   will   prevent  proper
      extraction  of  the   sample.    Method   3520,  a  liquid-liquid  continuous
      extraction, may be used for any aqueous sample;  this method will minimize
      emulsion formation.

                  2.3.1.1.1  Basic or Neutral Extraction  of Semivolatiles

                  The  solvent extract obtained by  performing either Method 3510
            or 3520 at a  neutral  or basic  pH  will contain  the compounds of
             interest.   Refer to Table 1 in  the extraction methods (3510 and/or
            3520) for  guidance on the pH requirements for extraction prior to
            analysis.
                                    TWO - 3                     Revision 2
                                                            September  1994

-------
             2.3.1.1.2  Acidic Extraction of Phenols and Acids

             The extract obtained by performing either  Method 3510  or 3520
       at  a  pH  less  than  or equal  to 2 will  contain the phenols and acid
       extractables.

       2.3.1.2  Solid Samples

       Soxhlet  (Methods  3540 and  3541)  and  ultrasonic   (Method 3550)
extractions  are used with  solid samples.  Consolidated samples should be
ground finely  enough  to  pass  through  a  1  mm  sieve.     In   limited
applications,  waste dilution (Method  3580)  may  be  used  if the  entire
sample is soluble in the specified solvent.

       Methods 3540^ and 3541 and 3550 are neutral-pH extraction techniques
and therefore,  depending  on the analysis requirements,  acid-base partition
cleanup (Method 3650) may  be necessary.  Method 3650 will only be needed
if chromatographic interferences are  severe enough to prevent detection of
the analytes of interest.  This  separation will  be most important  if a GC
method is chosen for  analysis of the sample.   If GC/MS is used,  the ion
selectivity  of   the  technique  may   compensate  for  chromatographic
interferences.

       2.3.1.3  Oils and Organic Liquids

       Method 3580, waste dilution,  may  be  used  and  the resultant sample
analyzed  directly by  GC  or GC/MS.    To  avoid  overloading  the analytical
detection system, care must be exercised to ensure that proper dilutions
are made.  Method 3580 gives guidance on performing waste dilutions.

       To  remove  interferences,  Method 3611 may be  performed on  an oil
sample directly,  without prior sample preparation.

       Method 3650 is  the only other preparative  procedure  for  oils and
other  organic  liquids.   This procedure  is  a  back  extraction into  an
aqueous phase.   It  is generally  introduced  as a cleanup  procedure for
extracts rather than as  a  preparative procedure.  Oils generally  have a
high concentration of semivolatile compounds  and, therefore, preparation
by Method 3650  should be done on a  relatively  small aliquot of the sample..
Generally,  extraction  of  1  ml  of  oil  will  be  sufficient  to obtain  a
saturated aqueous phase and avoid  emulsions.

       2.3.1.4  Sludge Samples

      There is no set ratio of liquid to solid which enables the analyst
to determine which  of the three  extraction  methods  cited  is the  most
appropriate.   If the  sludge  is  an  organic  sludge  (solid  material  and
organic liquid, as  opposed to an  aqueous sludge), the sample  should  be
handled as a multiphase sample.

      Determining the  appropriate  methods for  analysis  of sludges  is
complicated  because  of the lack of  precise  definition of  sludges  with
respect to the  relative percent of liquid and solid components.  They may
be classified into three categories  but with  appreciable  overlap.

                             TWO - 4                     Revision 2
                                                      September 1994

-------
            2.3.1.4.1  Liquids

            Use of Method 3510 or Method 3520 may be applicable to sludges
      that behave  like and  have  the  consistency  of aqueous  liquids.
      Ultrasonic  extraction   (Method  3550) and  Soxhlet  (Method  3540)
      procedures  will,  most  likely,  be  ineffective  because  of  the
      overwhelming presence of the liquid aqueous  phase.

            2.3.1.4.2  Solids

            Soxhlet  (Methods  3540 and  3541)  and  ultrasonic  extraction
      (Method 3550)  will be more effective when applied to sludge samples
      that resemble solids.  Samples may be dried  or centrifuged to form
      solid  materials  for  subsequent  determination  of  semi volatile
      compounds.

            Using Method 3650, Acid-Base Partition  Cleanup, on the extract
      may be necessary, depending on whether chromatographic interferences
      prevent determination of the analytes of interest.

            2.3.1.4.3  Emulsions

            Attempts should be made to break up and separate the phases of
      an emulsion.   Several techniques are effective  in breaking emulsions
      or separating the phases of emulsions.

      1.  Freezing/thawing:  Certain emulsions  will separate if exposed to
          temperatures below 0°C.

      2.  Salting out:  Addition of a salt to make the  aqueous phase of an
          emulsion  too  polar  to  support  a  less polar phase  promotes
          separation.

      3.  Centrifugation:     Centrifugal   force may  separate  emulsion
          components by density.

      4.  Addition  of water  or  ethanol:    Emulsion polymers  may  be
          destabilized when a preponderance of  the aqueous phase is added.

            If techniques  for breaking  emulsions  fail,  use  Method 3520.
      If the emulsion can be broken, the different phases (aqueous, solid,
      or organic liquid)  may then be analyzed  separately.

      2.3.1.5  Multiphase Samples

      Choice of  the procedure for aliquoting  multiphase  samples is very
dependent on the objective of the analysis.  With  a  sample in which some
of the phases  tend  to  separate  rapidly,  the percent weight  or volume of
each  phase  should be calculated  and  each phase should  be  individually
analyzed for the required analytes.

      An alternate approach is to  obtain  a homogeneous sample and attempt
a single analysis on the combination of phases.  This approach will give


                              TWO  -  5                      Revision 2
                                                      September 1994

-------
      no information on the abundance of the analytes in the individual phases
      other than what can be implied by solubility.

            A third alternative is to select phases of interest and to analyze
      only  those  selected phases.   This tactic  must be consistent  with the
      sampling/analysis objectives or it will yield insufficient information for
      the time and resources expended.   The phases selected should be compared
      with Figure 2-1 and Tables 2-34 through 2-36 for further guidance.

      2.3.2  Cleanup Procedures

      Each  category  in  Table  2-35,  Cleanup  of Organic  Analyte  Extracts,
corresponds to one of the possible  determinative methods available in the manual.
Cleanups employed are determined by the analytes of interest within  the extract.
However, the necessity of performing cleanup  may also depend upon the matrix from
which the extract was developed.   Cleanup of a sample may be  done exactly as
instructed  in  the  cleanup method  for  some  of the  analytes.    There  are some
instances when  cleanup  using one  of the methods  may only proceed  after the
procedure is  modified to optimize  recovery and  separation.    Several  cleanup
techniques may be possible for each  analyte  category.  The information provided
is not  meant  to  imply that any or  all  of these methods must  be  used  for the
analysis  to be  acceptable.   Extracts  with  components  which  interfere  with
spectral  or chromatographic determinations  are  expected to  be  subjected  to
cleanup procedures.

      The  analyst's  discretion   must  determine  the  necessity   for  cleanup
procedures,  as there are no clear cut criteria for  indicating their  use.  Method
3600 and associated methods should be consulted for further details on extract
cleanup.

      2.3.3  Determinative Procedures

      The determinative  methods for organic analytes have been divided into three
categories,  shown in Table 2-36:  gas chromatography/mass spectrometry (GC/MS);
specific detection methods,  i.e.,  gas chromatography (GC); and high performance
liquid  chromatography (HPLC).   This division  is  intended to  help an  analyst
choose which determinative method will apply.  Under each analyte column, SW-846
method numbers have  been indicated, if appropriate,  for the determination of the
analyte.  A blank has been left if  no  chromatographic determinative  method is
available.

      Generally,  the MS  procedures are more specific but less sensitive than the
appropriate gas chromatographic/specific detection method.

      Method  8000   gives   a  general  description  of  the  technique  of  gas
chromatography.  This method  should  be consulted prior to application of any of
the gas chromatographic  methods.

      Methods 8080  and 8081,  for  organochlorine pesticides and polychlorinated
biphenyls, Methods  8140  and 8141,  for organophosphorus pesticides,  and Methods
8150 and 8151, for  chlorinated  herbicides, are preferred  over  GC/MS because of
the  combination  of  selectivity   and  sensitivity  of  the  flame  photometric,
nitrogen-phosphorus, and electron  capture detectors.


                                   TWO -  6                      Revision 2
                                                           September 1994

-------
      Methods 8240 and 8260 are both GC/MS methods for volatile analytes.  Method
8240 uses a packed column whereas Method 8260 employs a capillary column.  Better
chromatographic separation of the  volatile compounds  may  be obtained by using
Method 8260  rather than 8240.  Performance criteria will be based on Method 8260.
Method 5030  has been combined with  both Method 8240 and 8260, with which it was
used  exclusively.   A  GC with  a  selective  detector is  also useful  for  the
determination of volatile organic compounds in a monitoring scenario, described
in Sec. 2.2.5.

      Methods 8250  and 8270  are both  GC/MS methods  for semivolatile analytes.
Method 8250  uses a packed column whereas Method 8270 employs  a capillary column.
Better chromatographic separation of the semivolatile  compounds may be obtained
by using Method 8270 rather  than 8250.   Performance  criteria will  be based on
Method 8270.


2.4  CHARACTERISTICS

      Figure 2-2 outlines a sequence for determining  if a  waste exhibits one or
more of the characteristics of  a hazardous waste.

      2.4.1  EP and TCLP extracts

      The leachate  obtained from using either the EP  (Figure 2-3A) or the TCLP
(Figure  2-3B)  is  an aqueous  sample,  and therefore,  requires further solvent
extraction prior  to the analysis of semivolatile compounds.

      The TCLP leachate is solvent extracted with methylene chloride at a pH > 11
and at a pH <2 by either Method  3510 or 3520.   Method 3510 should  be used unless
the  formation  of emulsions between the sample and  the  solvent  prevent proper
extraction.   If this problem  is  encountered, Method 3520  should be employed.

      The solvent extract obtained by performing either Method 3510  or 3520 at
a basic or neutral pH will contain the  base/neutral compounds of interest.  Refer
to  the  specific determinative method for guidance  on the pH requirements for
extraction prior  to analysis.

      Due  to the  high concentration of  acetate in  the TCLP extract,  it is
recommended that purge-and-trap be  used to introduce the volatile sample into the
gas  chromatograph.


2.5   GROUND  WATER

      Appropriate analysis  schemes for the determination  of analytes in ground
water are presented in  Figures 2-4A, 2-4B,  and 2-4C.  Quantitation limits for the
metallic analytes  should  correspond  to the  drinking water limits  which are
available.
                                    TWO - 7                      Revision  2
                                                             September 1994

-------
      2.5.1 Special Techniques for Metal Analvtes

      All  atomic  absorption analyses  should  employ  appropriate  background
correction systems whenever  spectral  interferences  could be present.   Several
background  correction  techniques  are  employed in  modern  atomic  absorption
spectrometers.  Matrix modification can complement background correction in some
cases.  Since no approach to  interference correction  is  completely effective  in
all cases, the analyst should attempt to verify the adequacy of correction.    If
the interferant is known (e.g. high concentrations of iron  in the determination
of selenium), accurate analyses of synthetic  solutions of the interferant (with
and without analyte)  could establish  the efficacy of  the  background correction.
If the nature of the interferant is not established, good  agreement of analytical
results  using two substantially different wavelengths  could  substantiate the
adequacy of the background correction.

      To reduce  matrix interferences,  all  graphite  furnace atomic  absorption
(GFAA) analyses should be performed using techniques which maximize an isothermal
environment within the furnace cell. Data indicate  that two  such  techniques,
L'vov platform and the Delayed Atomization Cuvette (DAC), are equivalent in this
respect, and  produce  high quality results.

      All furnace atomic absorption analysis should be carried out using the best
matrix modifier for the analysis.  Some  examples of modifiers are listed below.
(See also the appropriate methods.)

            Elementfs)           Modifierfs)

            As and Se         Nickel  nitrate, palladium
            Pb                Phosphoric acid, ammonium phosphate,  palladium
            Cd                Ammonium phosphate,  palladium
            Sb                Ammonium nitrate, palladium
            Tl                Platinum,  palladium

      The ICP calibration  standards must match the acid composition and strength
of the acids  contained  in the samples.  Acid strengths  in  the ICP  calibration
standards should be stated in the raw data.

      2.5.2  Special  Techniques for  Indicated Analvtes and Anions

      If  an   Auto-Analyzer   is  used  to read  the   cyanide  distillates,  the
spectrophotometer must  be used with  a 50 mm  path length cell.  If a  sample  is
found to  contain  cyanide, the  sample must  be  redistilled a second  time  and
analyzed to confirm the presence of  the cyanide. The second distillation must
fall  within the 14-day holding time.

2.6  REFERENCES

1.   Barcelona,  M.J.  "TOC Determinations in  Ground Water";  Ground Water 1984,
     22(1),  18-24.
                                   TWO - 8                      Revision 2
                                                            September 1994

-------
Riggin, R.; et al.  Development and Evaluation  of  Methods  for Total Organic
Halide  and Purgeable  Organic Halide  in Wastewater;  U.S.  Environmental
Protection  Agency.  Office  of  Research  and   Development.  Environmental
Monitoring and Support  Laboratory.  ORD Publication Offices of Center for
Environmental Research Information: Cincinnati, OH, 1984;  EPA-600/4-84-008.

McKee,  G.; et  al.  Determination  of  Inorganic  Anions  in  Water  by Ion
Chromatographv; (Technical  addition to Methods  for  Chemical  Analysis  of
Water  and Wastewater,  EPA  600/4-79-020), U.S.  Environmental Protection
Agency. Environmental  Monitoring  and Support  Laboratory. ORD  Publication
Offices of Center  for  Environmental  Research  Information: Cincinnati, OH,
1984; EPA-600/4-84-017.
                               TWO  - 9                      Revision 2
                                                        September 1994

-------
                                   TABLE  2-1
            DETERMINATIVE ANALYTICAL METHODS FOR ORGANIC COMPOUNDS
Compound
Applicable Method(s)
Acenaphthene
Acenaphthylene
Acetaldehyde
Acetone
Acetonitrile
Acetophenone
2-Acetylaminofluorene
1-Acetyl-2-thiourea
Acifluorfen
Acrolein (Propenal)

Acrylamide
Acrylonitrile
Alachlor
Aldicarb (Temik)
Aldicarb Sulfone
Aldrin
Allyl alcohol
Allyl chloride
2-Aminoanthraquinone
Aminoazobenzene
4-Aminobiphenyl
2-Amino-4,6-dinitrotoluene (2-Am-DNT)
4-Amino-2,6-dinitrotoluene (4-Am-DNT)
3-Amino-9-ethylcarbazole
Anilazine
Aniline
o-Anisidine
Anthracene
Aramite
Aroclor-1016 (PCB-1016)
Aroclor-1221 (PCB-1221)
Aroclor-1232 (PCB-1232)
Aroclor-1242 (PCB-1242)
Aroclor-1248 (PCB-1248)
Aroclor-1254 (PCB-1254)
Aroclor-1260 (PCB-1260)
Aspon
Asulam
Atrazine
Azinphos-ethyl
Azinphos-methyl
Barban
Bentazon
8100, 8250/8270, 8310, 8410
8100, 8250/8270, 8310, 8410
8315
8240/8260, 8315
8240/8260
8250/8270
8270
8270
8151
8030/8031, 8240/8260, 8315,
8316
8032, 8316
8030/8031, 8240/8260, 8316
8081
8318
8318
8080/8081, 8250/8270, 8275
8240/8260
8010, 8240/8260
8270
8270
8250/8270
8330
8330
8270
8270
8250/8270
8270
8100, 8250/8270, 8310, 8410
8270
8080/8081, 8250/8270
8080/8081, 8250/8270
8080/8081, 8250/8270
8080/8081, 8250/8270
8080/8081, 8250/8270
8080/8081, 8250/8270
8080/8081, 8250/8270
8141
8321
8141
8141
8140/8141, 8270
8270
8151
                                   TWO - 10
                   Revision 2
               September  1994

-------
                                  TABLE 2-1.
                                  (Continued)
Compound
Applicable Method(s)
Benzal chloride
Benzaldehyde
Benz(a)anthracene
Benzene
Benzidine
Benzo(b)fluoranthene
Benzo(j)f1uoranthene
Benzo(k)fluoranthene
Benzoic acid
Benzo(g,h,i)perylene
Benzo(a)pyrene

p-Benzoquinone
Benzotrichloride
Benzyl alcohol
Benzyl benzoate
Benzyl chloride
BHC (Hexachlorocyclohexane)
a-BHC  (alpha-Hexachlorocyclohexane)
/3-BHC (beta-Hexachlorocyclohexane)
S-BHC  (delta-Hexachlorocyclohexane)
7-BHC  (Lindane, gamma-Hexachlorocyclohexane)
Bis(2-Chloroethoxy)methane
Bi s(2-Chloroethyl)ether
Bis(2-Chloroethyl)sulfide
Bis(2-Chloroisopropyl) ether
Bis(2-Ethylhexyl) phthalate
Bolstar (Sulprofos)
Bromoacetone
Bromobenzene
Bromochloromethane
Bromodi chloromethane
4-Bromofluorobenzene
Bromoform
Bromomethane
4-Bromophenyl phenyl ether
Bromoxynil
Butanal
n-Butanol
2-Butanone (Methyl ethyl ketone, MEK)
n-Butylbenzene
sec-Butyl benzene
tert-Butylbenzene
Butyl  benzyl phthalate
8121
8315
8100, 8250/8270, 8310, 8410
8020, 8021, 8240/8260
8250/8270
8100, 8250/8270, 8310
8100
8100, 8250/8270, 8275, 8310
8250/8270, 8410
8100, 8250/8270, 8310
8100, 8250/8270, 8275, 8310,
8410
8270
8121
8250/8270
8061
8010, 8121, 8240/8260
8120
8080/8081, 8121, 8250/8270
8080/8081, 8121, 8250/8270
8080/8081, 8121, 8250/8270
8080/8081, 8121, 8250/8270
8010, 8110, 8250/8270, 8410
8110, 8250/8270, 8410
8240/8260
8010, 8110, 8250/8270, 8410
8060/8061, 8250/8270, 8410
8140/8141
8010, 8240/8260
8010, 8021, 8260
8021, 8240/8260
8010, 8021, 8240/8260
8240/8260
8010, 8021, 8240/8260
8010, 8021, 8240/8260
8110, 8250/8270, 8410
8270
8315
8260
8015, 8240/8260
8021, 8260
8021, 8260
8021, 8260
8060/8061, 8250/8270, 8410
                                   TWO - 11
                    Revision 2
               September  1994

-------
                                  TABLE 2-1.
                                  (Continued)
Compound
Applicable Method(s)
2-sec-Butyl-4,6-dinitrophenol (DNBP, Dinoseb)
Captafol
Captan
Carbaryl (Sevin)
Carbazole
Carbofuran (Furaden)
Carbon disulfide
Carbon tetrachloride
Carbophenothion (Carbofenthion)
Chloral hydrate
Chloramben
Chlordane (technical)
a-Chlordane
7-Chlordane
Chlorfenvinphos
Chloroacetonitrile
4-Chloroaniline
Chlorobenzene
Chiorobenzilate
2-Chloro-l,3-butadiene
1-Chlorobutane
Chiorodi bromomethane (Dibrotnochloromethane)
Chloroethane
2-Chloroethanol
2-Chloroethyl vinyl ether
Chloroform
1-Chlorohexane
Chioromethane
5-Chloro-2-methylaniline
Chloromethyl  methyl ether
4-Chloro-3-methylphenol
Chloroneb
3-(Chloromethyl)pyridine hydrochloride
1-Chioronaphthalene
2-Chloronaphthalene
2-Chlorophenol
4-Chlorophenol
4-Chloro-l,2-phenylenediamine
4-Chloro-l,3-phenylenediamine
4-Chlorophenyl phenyl ether
Chloroprene
3-Chloropropene
3-Chloropropionitrile
Chloropropylate
8040, 8150/8151, 8270, 8321
8081, 8270
8081, 8270
8270, 8318
8275
8270, 8318
8240/8260
8010, 8021, 8240/8260
8141, 8270
8240/8260
8151
8080, 8250/8270
8081
8081
8141, 8270
8260
8250/8270, 8410
8010, 8020, 8021, 8240/8260
8081, 8270
8260
8260
8010, 8021, 8240/8260
8010, 8021, 8240/8260
8010, 8240/8260
8010, 8240/8260
8010, 8021, 8240/8260
8010, 8260
8010, 8021, 8240/8260
8270
8010
8040, 8250/8270, 8275, 8410
8081
8270
8250/8270, 8275
8120/8121, 8250/8270, 8410
8040, 8250/8270, 8275, 8410
8410
8270
8270
8110, 8250/8270, 8410
8010, 8240/8260
8260
8240/8260
8081
                                   TWO - 12
                   Revision 2
               September  1994

-------
                                  TABLE 2-1.
                                  (Continued)
Compound
Applicable Method(s)
Chlorothalonil
2-Chlorotoluene
4-Chlorotoluene
Chlorpyrifos
Chlorpyrifos methyl
Chrysene
Coumaphos
Coumarin Dyes
p-Cresidine
o-Cresol (2-Methylphenol)
m-Cresol (3-Methylphenol)
p-Cresol (4-Methylphenol)
Cresols (Methylphenols, Cresylic acids)
Crotonaldehyde
Crotoxyphos
Cyclohexanone
2-Cyclohexyl-4,6-dinitrophenol
2,4-D
Dalapon
2,4-DB
DBCP
2,4-D, butoxyethanol ester
DC PA
DCPA diacid
4,4'-DDD
4,4'-DDE
4,4'-DDT
Decanal
Demeton-0, and -S
2,4-D,ethylhexyl ester
Dial!ate
2,4-Diaminotoluene
Diazinon
Dibenz(a,h)acridine
Dibenz(a,j)acridine
Dibenz(a,h)anthracene
7H-Dibenzo(c,g)carbazole
Dibenzofuran
Dibenzo(a,e)pyrene
Dibenzo(a,h)pyrene
Dibenzo(a,i jpyrene
Dibenzothiophene
Di bromochloromethane (Chiorodi bromomethane)
1,2-Di bromo-3-chloropropane
8081
8021, 8260
8010, 8021, 8260
8140/8141
8141
8100, 8250/8270, 8310, 8410
8140/8141, 8270
8321
8270
8250/8270, 8410
8270
8250/8270, 8275, 8410
8040
8260, 8315
8141, 8270
8315
8040, 8270
8150/8151, 8321
8150/8151, 8321
8150/8151, 8321
8081
8321
8081
8151
8080/8081, 8250/8270
8080/8081, 8270
8080/8081, 8250/8270
8315
8140/8141, 8270
8321
8081, 8270
8270
8140/8141
8100
8100, 8250/8270
8100, 8250/8270, 8310
8100
8250/8270, 8410
8100, 8270
8100
8100
8275
8010, 8021, 8240/8260
8010, 8011, 8240/8260, 8270
                                   TWO - 13
                   Revision 2
               September 1994

-------
                                  TABLE 2-1.
                                  (Continued)
Compound
Applicable Method(s)
1,2-Dibromoethane  (Ethylene dibromide)
Di bromof1uoromethane
Dibromomethane
Di-n-butyl phthalate
Dicamba
Dichlone
1,2-Dichlorobenzene

1,3-Dichlorobenzene

1,4-Dichlorobenzene

3,3'-Dichlorobenzidine
3,5-Dichlorobenzoic acid
l,4-Dichloro-2-butene
cis-l,4-Dichloro-2-butene
trans-l,4-Dichloro-2-butene
Di chl orodi f1uoromethane
1,1-Dichloroethane
1,2-Dichloroethane
1,1-Dichloroethene (Vinylidene chloride)
cis-l,2-Dichloroethene
trans-1,2-Dichloroethene
Dichlorofenthion
Dichloromethane (Methylene chloride)
2,4-Dichlorophenol
2,6-Dichlorophenol
Dichlorprop
1,2-Dichloropropane
1,3-Dichloropropane
2,2-Dichloropropane
l,3-Dichloro-2-propanol
1,1-Di chloropropene
cis-l,3-Dichloropropene
trans-l,3-Dichloropropene
Dichlorvos (Dichlorovos)
Dichrotophos
Dicofol
Dieldrin
1,2,3,4-Diepoxybutane
Diethyl  ether
Diethyl  phthalate
Diethylstilbestrol
Diethyl  sulfate
8010, 8011, 8021, 8240/8260
8260
8010, 8021, 8240/8260
8060/8061, 8250/8270, 8410
8150/8151, 8321
8081, 8270
8010, 8020, 8021, 8120/8121,
8250/8270, 8260, 8410
8010, 8020, 8021, 8120/8121,
8250/8270, 8260, 8410
8010, 8020, 8021, 8120/8121,
8250/8270, 8260, 8410
8250/8270
8151
8010, 8240
8260
8260
8010, 8021, 8240/8260
8010, 8021, 8240/8260
8010, 8021, 8240/8260
8010, 8021, 8240/8260
8021, 8260
8010, 8021, 8240/8260
8141
8010, 8021, 8240/8260
8040, 8250/8270, 8275, 8410
8040, 8250/8270
8150/8151, 8321
8010, 8021, 8240/8260
8021, 8260
8021, 8260
8010, 8240/8260
8021, 8260
8010, 8021, 8240/8260
8010, 8021, 8240/8260
8140/8141, 8270, 8321
8141, 8270
8081
8080/8081, 8250/8270
8240/8260
8015, 8260
8060/8061, 8250/8270, 8410
8270
8270
                                   TWO - 14
                   Revision 2
               September  1994

-------
                                  TABLE 2-1.
                                  (Continued)
Compound
                                                 Applicable Method(s)
1,4-Difluorobenzene
Dihydrosaffrole
Dimethoate
3,3'-Dimethoxybenzidine
Dimethyl aminoazobenzene
2,5-Dimethylbenzaldehyde
7,12-Dimethylbenz(a)anthracene
3,3'-Dimethylbenzidine
a,a-Dimethylphenethylami ne
2,4-Dimethyl phenol
Dimethyl phthalate
Dinitrobenzene
1,2-Dinitrobenzene
1,3-Dinitrobenzene (1,3-DNB)
1,4-Dinitrobenzene
4,6-Dinitro-2-methylphenol
2,4-Dinitrophenol
2,4-Dinitrotoluene (2,4-DNT)

2,6-Dinitrotoluene (2,6-DNT)
Dinocap
Dinoseb (2-sec-Butyl-4,6-dinitrophenol,  DNBP)
Di-n-octyl phthalate
Di-n-propyl phthalate
Dioxacarb
1,4-Dioxane
Dioxathion
Diphenylamine
5,5-Diphenylhydantoin
1,2-Di phenylhydrazi ne
Disperse Blue 3
Disperse Blue 14
Disperse Brown 1
Disperse Orange 3
                30
Disperse
Disperse
Disperse
Disperse
Disperse
Disperse
Orange
Red 1
Red 5
Red 13
Red 60
Yellow
Disulfoton
Endosulfan
Endosulfan
Endosulfan
           I
           II
           sulfate
8240/8260
8270
8141, 8270, 8321
8270
8250/8270
8315
8250/8270
8270
8250/8270
8040, 8250/8270
8060/8061, 8250/8270, 8410
8090
8270
8270, 8330
8270
8250/8270, 8410
8040, 8250/8270, 8410
8090, 8250/8270, 8275, 8330,
8410
8090, 8250/8270, 8330, 8410
8270
8040, 8150/8151, 8270, 8321
8060/8061, 8250/8270, 8410
8410
8318
8240/8260
8141, 8270
8250/8270, 8275
8270
8250/8270
8321
8321
8321
8321
8321
8321
8321
8321
8321
8321
8140/8141, 8270, 8321
8080/8081, 8250/8270
8080/8081, 8250/8270
8080/8081, 8250/8270
                                   TWO - 15
                                                                    Revision 2
                                                                September 1994

-------
                                  TABLE 2-1.
                                  (Continued)
Compound
Applicable Method(s)
Endrin
Endrin aldehyde
Endrin ketone
Epichlorohydrin
EPN
Ethanol (Ethyl alcohol)
Ethion
Ethoprop
Ethyl acetate
Ethyl benzene
Ethyl carbamate
Ethylene dibromide
Ethylene oxide
Ethyl methacrylate
Ethyl methanesulfonate
Ethyl parathion
Etridiazole
Famphur
Fenitrothion
Fensulfothion
Fenthion
Fluchloralin
Fluoranthene
Fluorene

Fluorescent Brightener 61
Fluorescent Brightener 236
Fluorobenzene
2-Fluorobiphenyl
2-Fluorophenol
Fonophos
Formaldehyde
Halowax-1000
Halowax-1001
Halowax-1013
Halowax-1014
Halowax-1051
Halowax-1099
Heptachlor
Heptachlor epoxide
Heptanal
Hexachlorobenzene
8080/8081, 8250/8270
8080/8081, 8250/8270
8081, 8250/8270
8010, 8240/8260
8141, 8270
8015, 8240/8260
8141, 8270
8140/8141
8260
8020, 8021, 8240/8260
8270
8010, 8011, 8021, 8240/8260
8240/8260
8240/8260
8250/8270
8270
8081
8141, 8270, 8321
8141
8140/8141, 8270, 8321
8140/8141, 8270
8270
8100, 8250/8270, 8310, 8410
8100, 8250/8270, 8275, 8310,
8410
8321
8321
8260
8250/8270
8250/8270
8141
8315
8081
8081
8081
8081
8081
8081
8080/8081, 8250/8270
8080/8081, 8250/8270
8315
8081, 8120/8121, 8250/8270,
8275, 8410
                                   TWO - 16
                   Revision 2
               September  1994

-------
                                  TABLE 2-1.
                                  (Continued)
Compound
                                                Applicable Method(s)
Hexachlorobutadiene (1,3-Hexachlorobutadiene)

Hexachlorocyclohexane
a-Hexachlorocyclohexane  (a-BHC)

/3-Hexachl orocycl ohexane  (/3-BHC)

£-Hexachlorocyclohexane  (5-BHC)

7-Hexachlorocyclohexane  (7-BHC)

Hexachlorocyclopentadi ene

Hexachloroethane

Hexachlorophene
Hexachloropropene
Hexahydro-l,3,5-trinitro-l,3,5-triazine (RDX)
Hexamethylphosphoramide  (HMPA)
Hexanal
2-Hexanone
HMX
1,2,3,4,6,7,8-HpCDD
1,2,3,4,6,7,8-HpCDF
1,2,3,4,7,8,9-HpCDF
1,2,3,4,7,8-HxCDD
1,2,3,6,7,8-HxCDD
1,.
  2,3,7,8,9-HxCDD
1,2,3,4,7
1,2,3,6,7
  2,3,7,
1
          8-HxCDF
          8-HxCDF
        8,9-HxCDF
2,3,4,6,7,8-HxCDF
Hydroquinone
3-Hydroxycarbofuran
5-Hydroxydicamba
2-Hydroxypropionitrile
Indeno(l,2,3-cd)pyrene
lodomethane
Isobutyl alcohol (2-Methyl-l-propanol)
Isodrin
Isophorone
Isopropylbenzene
p-Isopropyltoluene
Isosafrole
8021, 8120/8121, 8250/8270,
8260, 8410
8120
8080/8081, 8120/8121, 8250,
8270
8080/8081, 8120/8121, 8250,
8270
8080/8081, 8120/8121, 8250,
8270
8080/8081, 8120/8121, 8250,
8270
8081, 8120/8121, 8250/8270,
8410
8120/8121, 8250/8270, 8260,
8410
8270
8270
8330
8141, 8270
8315
8240/8260
8330
8280/8290
8280/8290
8280/8290
8280/8290
8280/8290
8280/8290
8280/8290
8280/8290
8280/8290
8280/8290
8270
8318
8151
8240/8260
8100, 8250/8270, 8310
8240/8260
8240/8260
8081, 8270
8090, 8250/8270, 8410
8021, 8260
8021, 8260
8270
                                   TWO  -  17
                                                                    Revision 2
                                                                September 1994

-------
                                   TABLE  2-1.
                                  (Continued)
Compound
Applicable Method(s)
 Isovaleraldehyde
 Kepone
 Leptophos
 Malathion
 Maleic anhydride
 Malononitrile
 MCPA
 MCPP
 Merphos
 Mestranol
 Methacrylonitrile
 Methanol
 Methapyrilene
 Methiocarb (Mesurol)
 Methomyl (Lannate)
 Methoxychlor (4,4'-Methoxychlor)
 Methyl acrylate
 Methyl-t-butyl ether
 3-Methylcholanthrene
 2-Methyl-4,6-dinitrophenol
 4,4'-Methylenebis(2-chloroaniline)
 4,4'-Methylenebis(N,N-dimethylaniline)
 Methyl ethyl ketone (MEK, 2-Butanone)
 Methylene chloride (Dichloromethane)
 Methyl iodide
 Methyl isobutyl ketone (4-Methyl-2-pentanone)
 Methyl methacrylate
 Methyl methanesulfonate
 2-Methylnaphthalene
 2-Methyl-5-nitroaniline
 Methyl parathion
 4-Methyl-2-pentanone (Methyl isobutyl ketone)
 2-Methylphenol  (o-Cresol)
 3-Methylphenol  (m-Cresol)
 4-Methylphenol  (p-Cresol)
 2-Methylpyridine
Methyl-2,4,6-trinitrophenylnitramine (Tetryl)
Mevinphos
Mexacarbate
Mi rex
Monochrotophos
Naled
Naphthalene
8315
8081, 8270
8141, 8270
8141, 8270
8270
8240/8260
8150/8151, 8321
8150/8151, 8321
8140/8141, 8321
8270
8240/8260
8260
8270
8318
8318, 8321
8080/8081, 8250/8270
8260
8260
8100, 8250/8270
8040
8270
8270
8015, 8240/8260
8010, 8021, 8240/8260
8010, 8240/8260
8015, 8240/8260
8240/8260
8250/8270
8250/8270, 8410
8270
8270, 8321
8015, 8240/8260
8250/8270, 8410
8270
8250/8270, 8275, 8410
8270
8330
8140/8141, 8270
8270
8081, 8270
8141, 8270, 8321
8140/8141, 8270, 8321
8021, 8100, 8250/8270, 8260,
8275, 8310, 8410
                                   TWO - 18
                    Revision  2
               September  1994

-------
                                  TABLE 2-1.
                                  (Continued)
Compound
Applicable Method(s)
Naphthoquinone
1,4-Naphthoquinone
1-Naphthylamine
2-Naphthylamine
Nicotine
5-Nitroacenaphthene
2-Nitroaniline
3-Nitroaniline
4-Nitroaniline
5-Nitro-o-anisidine
Nitrobenzene (NB)

4-Nitrobiphenyl
Nitrofen
2-Nitrophenol
4-Nitrophenol
2-Nitropropane
Nitroquinoline-1-oxide
N-Ni trosod i butyl ami ne
N-Ni trosodi ethyl ami ne
N-Nitrosodimethylamine
N-Ni trosodi phenylami ne
N-Nitrosodi-n-propylamine
N-Nitrosomethylethyl amine
N-Nitrosomorpholine
N-Nitrosopiperidine
N-Nitrosopyrrolidine
o-Nitrotoluene (2-NT)
m-Nitrotoluene (3-NT)
p-Nitrotoluene (4-NT)
5-Nitro-o-toluidine
trans-Nonachlor
Nonanal
OCDD
OCDF
Octahydro-l,3,5,7-tetranitro-l,3,5,7-tetrazocine
                            (HMX)
Octamethyl pyrophosphoramide
Octanal
4,4'-Oxydianiline
Parathion
Parathion, ethyl
Parathion, methyl
PCB-1016  (Aroclor-1016)
8090
8270
8250/8270
8250/8270
8270
8270
8250/8270, 8410
8250/8270, 8410
8250/8270, 8410
8270
8090, 8250/8270, 8260, 8330,
8410
8270
8081, 8270
8040, 8250/8270, 8410
8040, 8151, 8250/8270, 8410
8260
8270
8250/8270
8270
8070, 8250/8270, 8410
8070, 8250/8270, 8410
8070, 8250/8270, 8410
8270
8270
8250/8270
8270
8330
8330
8330
8270
8081
8315
8280/8290
8280/8290

8330
8270
8315
8270
8270
8141
8140/8141
8080/8081, 8250/8270
                                   TWO  - 19
                    Revision  2
                September 1994

-------
                                  TABLE  2-1.
                                  (Continued)
Compound
 Applicable  Method(s)
 PCB-1221  (Aroclor-1221)
 PCB-1232  (Aroclor-1232)
 PCB-1242  (Aroclor-1242)
 PCB-1248  (Aroclor-1248)
 PCB-1254  (Aroclor-1254)
 PCB-1260  (Aroclor-1260)
 PCNB
 1,2,3,4,7-PeCDD
 1,2,3,7,8-PeCDD
 1,2,3,7,8-PeCDF
 2,3,4,7,8-PeCDF
 Pentachlorobenzene
 Pentachloroethane
 Pentachlorohexane
 Pentachloronitrobenzene
 Pentachlorophenol
 Pentaf1uorobenzene
 Pentanal
 trans-Permethrin
 Perthane
 Phenacetin
 Phenanthrene

 Phenobarbital
 Phenol
 1,4-Phenylenedi ami ne
 Phorate
 Phosalone
 Phosmet
 Phosphamidion
 Phthalic anhydride
 Picloram
 2-Picoline
 Piperonyl  sulfoxide
 Promecarb
 Pronamide
 Propachlor
 Propanal
 Propargyl  alcohol
 B-Propiolactone
 Propionitrile
 Propoxur (Baygon)
n-Propylamine
n-Propylbenzene
 8080/8081,  8250/8270
 8080/8081,  8250/8270
 8080/8081,  8250/8270
 8080/8081,  8250/8270
 8080/8081,  8250/8270
 8080/8081,  8250/8270
 8081
 8280/8290
 8280/8290
 8280/8290
 8280/8290
 8121, 8250/8270
 8240/8260
 8120
 8250/8270
 8040, 8151, 8250/8270, 8410
 8260, 4010
 8315
 8081
 8081
 8250/8270
 8100, 8250/8270, 8275, 8310,
 8410
 8270
 8040, 8250/8270, 8410
 8270
 8140/8141, 8270, 8321
 8270
 8141, 8270
 8141, 8270
 8270
 8151
 8240/8260, 8250/8270
 8270
 8318
 8250/8270
 8081
 8315
 8240/8260
8240/8260
8240/8260
8318
8240/8260
8021, 8260
                                   TWO - 20
                   Revision 2
               September  1994

-------
                                  TABLE 2-1.
                                  (Continued)
Compound
                                                Applicable Method(s)
Propylthiouracil
Pyrene

Pyridine
RDX
Resorcinol
Ronnel
Safrole
Simazine
Solvent Red 3
Solvent Red 23
Stirophos (Tetrachlorvinphos)
Strobane
Strychnine
Styrene
Sulfall ate
Sulfotepp
2,4,5-T
2,4,5-T, butoxyethanol ester
2,4,5-T, butyl  ester
1,2,3,4-TCDD
1,2,7,8-TCDD
1,2,8,9-TCDD
   3,6,8-TCDD
       8-TCDD
       9-TCDD
       8-TCDD
       8-TCDF
1
1,3,7,
1,3,7,
2,3,7,
1,2,7,
2,3,7,8-TCDF
TEPP
Terbuphos (Terbufos)
Terphenyl
1,2,3,4-Tetrachlorobenzene
1,2,3,5-Tetrachlorobenzene
1,2,4,5-Tetrachlorobenzene
Tetrachlorobenzenes
1,1,1,2-Tetrachloroethane
1,1,2,2-Tetrachloroethane
Tetrachloroethene
2,3,4,6-Tetrachlorophenol
Tetrachlorophenol s
Tetrachlorvinphos (Stirophos)
Tetraethyl dithiopyrophosphate
Tetraethyl pyrophosphate
8270
8100, 8250/8270, 8275, 8310,
8410
8240/8260, 8270
8330
8270
8140/8141
8270
8141
8321
8321
8140/8141, 8270
8081
8270, 8321
8021, 8240/8260
8270
8141
8150/8151, 8321
8321
8321
8280
8280
8280
8280
8280
8280
8280/8290
8280
8280/8290
8141
8141, 8270
8250/8270
8121
8121
8121, 8250/8270
8120
8010, 8021,  8240/8260
8010, 8021,  8240/8260
8010, 8021,  8240/8260
8250/8270
8040
8140/8141, 8270
8270
8270
                                    TWO -  21
                                                                    Revision 2
                                                                September 1994

-------
                                   TABLE 2-1.
                                   (Continued)
 Compound
 Applicable Method(s)
 Tetrazene
 Thiofanox
 Thionazine
 Thiophenol  (Benzenethiol)
 TOCP (Tri-o-cresylphosphate)
 Tokuthion (Prothiofos)
 m-Tolualdehyde
 o-Tolualdehyde
 p-Tolualdehyde
 Toluene
 Toluene  diisocyanate
 o-Toluidine
 Toxaphene
 2,4,5-TP (Silvex)
 2,4,6-Tri bromophenol
 1,2,3-Trichlorobenzene
 1,2,4-Trichlorobenzene

 1,3,5-Trichlorobenzene
 1,1,1-Trichloroethane
 1,1,2-Trichloroethane
 Trichloroethene
 Tri chlorof1uoromethane
 Trichlorfon
 Trichloronate
 2,4,5-Trichlorophenol
 2,4,6-Trichlorophenol
 Trichlorophenols
 1,2,3-Trichloropropane
 0,0,0-Triethyl phosphorothioate
 Trifluralin
 2,4,5-Trimethylaniline
 1,2,4-Trimethylbenzene
 1,3,5-Trimethylbenzene
 Trimethyl phosphate
 1,3,5-Trinitrobenzene (1,3,5-TNB)
 2,4,6-Trinitrotoluene (2,4,6-TNT)
Tri-o-cresyl phosphate (TOCP)
Tri-p-tolyl phosphate
Tris(2,3-Dibromopropyl) phosphate (Tris-BP)
Vinyl acetate
Vinyl chloride
 8331
 8321
 8141,  8270
 8270
 8141
 8140/8141
 8315
 8315
 8315
 8020,  8021,  8240/8260
 8270
 8270
 8080/8081, 8250/8270
 8150/8151, 8321
 8250/8270
 8021,  8121,  8260
 8021,  8120/8121, 8250/8270,
 8260,  8410
 8121
 8010,  8021,  8240/8260
 8010,  8021,  8240/8260
 8010,  8021,  8240/8260
 8010,  8021,  8240/8260
 8141,  8321
 8140/8141
 8250/8270, 8410
 8040,  8250/8270, 8410
 8040
 8010,  8021,  8240/8260
 8270
 8081,  8270
 8270
 8021,  8260
 8021,  8260
 8270
 8270,  8330
 8330
8141
8270
8270, 8321
8240/8260
8010, 8021, 8240/8260
                                   TWO - 22
                   Revision 2
               September 1994

-------
                                  TABLE 2-1.
                                  (Continued)
Compound                                         Applicable Method(s)


o-Xylene                                         8021,  8260
m-Xylene                                         8021,  8260
p-Xylene                                         8021,  8260
Xylene (Total)                                   8020,  8240
                                  TABLE 2-2A.
                      METHOD 3650 -  BASE/NEUTRAL FRACTION


Benz(a)anthracene                               Hexachlorobenzene
Benzo(a)pyrene                                  Hexachlorobutadi ene
Benzo(b)fluoranthene                            Hexachloroethane
Chlordane                                       Hexachlorocyclopentadiene
Chlorinated dibenzodioxins                      Naphthalene
Chrysene                                        Nitrobenzene
Creosote                                        Phorate
Dichlorobenzene(s)                              2-Picoline
Dinitrobenzene                                  Pyridine
2,4-Dinitrotoluene                              Tetrachlorobenzene(s)
Heptachlor                                      Toxaphene
                                  TABLE 2-2B.
                          METHOD 3650 - ACID FRACTION

2-Chlorophenol                                  4-Nitrophenol
Cresol(s)                                       Pentachlorophenol
Creosote                                        Phenol
Dichlorophenoxyacetic acid                      Tetrachlorophenol(s)
2,4-Dimethylphenol                              Trichlorophenol(s)
4,6-Dinitro-o-cresol                            2,4,5-TP  (Silvex)
                                   TWO  - 23                         Revision 2
                                                                September 1994

-------
                                  TABLE 2-3.
                    METHOD 5041 - SORBENT CARTRIDGES FROM
                    VOLATILE ORGANIC SAMPLING TRAIN (VOST)

Acetone                                         1,2-Dichloropropane
Acrylonitrile                                   cis-l,3-Dichloropropene
Benzene                                         trans-1,3-Dichloropropene
Bromodichloromethane                            Ethyl benzene3
Bromoform3                                      lodomethane
Bromomethane                                    Methylene chloride
Carbon disulfide                                Styrene3
Carbon tetrachloride                            1,1,2,2-Tetrachloroethane3
Chlorobenzene                                   Tetrachloroethene
Chlorodibromomethane                            Toluene
Chloroethane                                    1,1,1-Tri chloroethane
Chloroform                                      1,1,2-Trichloroethane
Chloromethane                                   Trichloroethene
Di bromomethane                                  Tri chlorof1uoromethane
1,1-Dichloroethane                              1,2,3-Trichloropropane3
1,2-Dichloroethane                              Vinyl  chloride15
1,1-Dichloroethene                              Xylenes3
trans-1,2-Dichloroethene


3  Boiling point of this compound is above 132°C.   Method  0030  is  not
appropriate for quantitative sampling of this analyte.

b  Boiling point of this compound is below 30°C.   Special  precautions  must  be
taken when sampling for this analyte by Method 0030.  Refer to Sec. 1.3 of
Method 5041 for discussion.
                                   TWO - 24                         Revision 2
                                                                September 1994

-------
                                  TABLE 2-4.
                      METHOD 8010 -  HALOGENATED VOLATILES
Ally! chloride
Benzyl chloride
Bi s(2-chloroethoxy)methane
Bis(2-chloroisopropyl) ether
Bromoacetone
Bromobenzene
Bromodi chloromethane
Bromoform
Bromomethane
Carbon tetrachloride
Chlorobenzene
Chloroethane
2-Chloroethanol
2-Chloroethyl vinyl ether
Chloroform
1-Chlorohexane
Chloromethane
Chloromethyl methyl ether
Chloroprene
4-Chlorotoluene
Di bromochloromethane
l,2-Dibromo-3-chloropropane
Dibromomethane
1,2-Di chlorobenzene
1,3-Dichlorobenzene
1,4-Di chlorobenzene
l,4-Dichloro-2-butene
Di chlorodi f1uoromethane
1,1-Dichloroethane
1,2-Dichloroethane
1,1-Dichloroethene (Vinylidene chloride)
trans-1,2-Di chl oroethene
Dichloromethane (Methylene Chloride)
1,2-Dichloropropane
l,3-Dichloro-2-propanol
cis-l,3-Dichloropropene
trans-l,3-Dichloropropene
Epichlorhydrin
Ethylene dibromide
Methyl iodide
1,1,2,2-Tetrachloroethane
1,1,1,2-Tetrachloroethane
Tetrachloroethene
1,1,1-Trichloroethane
1,1,2-Trichloroethane
Trichloroethene
Tri chlorof1uoromethane
1,2,3-Tri chloropropane
Vinyl chloride
                     For Method 8011,   see Table 2-7
             TABLE  2-5.
 METHOD  8015  -  NONHALOGENATED VOLATILES
                   TABLE 2-6.
           METHOD 8020 - AROMATIC VOLATILES
 Diethyl  ether
 Ethanol
 Methyl  ethyl ketone (MEK)
 Methyl  isobutyl  ketone (MIBK)
           Benzene
           Chlorobenzene
           1,2-Dichlorobenzene
           1,3-Dichlorobenzene
           1,4-Dichlorobenzene
           Ethyl benzene
           Toluene
           Xylenes
                                    TWO -  25
                                  Revision 2
                              September 1994

-------
                                        TABLE 2-7.
              METHOD 8021 (METHOD 8011*)  - HALOGENATED AND AROMATIC VOLATILES

Benzene                                         1,3-Dichloropropane
Bromobenzene                                    2,2-Dichloropropane
Bromochloromethane                              1,1-Di chloropropene
Bromodi chloromethane                            ci s-1,3-Di chloropropene
Bromoform                                       trans-1,3-Di chloropropene
Bromomethane                                    Ethyl benzene
n-Butylbenzene                                  Hexachlorobutadi ene
sec-Butyl benzene                                Isopropylbenzene
tert-Butylbenzene                               p-Isopropyltoluene
Carbon tetrachloride                            Methylene chloride (DCM)
Chlorobenzene                                   Naphthalene
Chlorodibromomethane                            n-Propylbenzene
Chloroethane                                    Styrene
Chloroform                                      1,1,1,2-Tetrachloroethane
Chloromethane                                   1,1,2,2-Tetrachloroethane
2-Chlorotoluene                                 Tetrachloroethene
4-Chlorotoluene                                 Toluene
1,2-Di bromo-3-chloropropane*                    1,2,3-Tri chlorobenzene
1,2-Di bromoethane*                              1,2,4-Tri chlorobenzene
Di bromomethane                                  1,1,1-Tri chloroethane
1,2-Di chlorobenzene                             1,1,2-Tri chloroethane
1,3-Di chlorobenzene                             Tri chloroethene
1,4-Di chlorobenzene                             Tri chlorof1uoromethane
Di chlorodi f1uoromethane                         1,2,3-Tri chloropropane
1,1-Dichloroethane                              1,2,4-Trimethylbenzene
1,2-Di chloroethane                              1,3,5-Trimethylbenzene
1,1-Dichloroethene (Vinylidene chloride)         Vinyl  chloride
cis-l,2-Dichloroethene                          o-Xylene
trans-1,2-Di chloroethene                        m-Xylene
1,2-Dichloropropane                             p-Xylene

      *  Indicates the only two target analytes  of Method 8011.   These constituents are
                                 also target analytes  of Method 8021.
           TABLE 2-8.                                            TABLE 2-9
      METHODS 8030/8031  -                                      METHOD 8032 -
      ACROLEIN,  ACRYLONITRILE                                   ACRYLAMIDE

      Acrolein (Propenal)*                                  Acrylamide
      Acrylonitrile

  *  Target analyte of Method 8030 only.
                                         TWO - 26                         Revision 2
                                                                      September 1994

-------
                                        TABLE  2-10.
                                  METHOD 8040 - PHENOLS
2-sec-Butyl-4,6-dinitrophenol (DNBP, Dinoseb)
4-Chloro-3-methylphenol
2-Chlorophenol
Cresols (Methylphenols)
2-Cyclohexyl-4,6-dinitrophenol
2,4-Dichlorophenol
2,6-Dichlorophenol
2,4-Dimethylphenol
2,4-Dinitrophenol
    2-Methyl-4,6-dinitrophenol
    2-Nitrophenol
    4-Nitrophenol
    Pentachlorophenol
    Phenol
    Tetrachlorophenols
    2,4,6-Trichlorophenol
    Trichlorophenols
            TABLE 2-11.
   METHODS 8060/8061 - PHTHALATE ESTERS

Benzyl benzoate*
Butyl benzyl phthalate
Bis(2-ethylhexyl) phthalate
Di-n-butyl phthalate
Diethyl phthalate
Dimethyl phthalate
Di-n-octyl phthalate

*  Target analyte of Method 8061 only.
       TABLE 2-12.
METHOD 8070 - NITROSAMINES

    N-Nitrosodimethyl amine
    N-Nitrosodiphenylamine
    N-Nitrosodi-n-propylamine
                                          TWO  -  27
                    Revision 2
                September  1994

-------
                                  TABLE 2-13.
             METHODS  8080/8081  -  ORGANOCHLORINE  PESTICIDES AND  PCBs
Aroclor-1016  (PCB-1016)
Aroclor-1221  (PCB-1221)
Aroclor-1232  (PCB-1232)
Aroclor-1242  (PCB-1242)
Aroclor-1248  (PCB-1248)
Aroclor-1254  (PCB-1254)
Aroclor-1260  (PCB-1260)
Alachlor*
Aldrin
a-BHC
0-BHC
5-BHC
7-BHC (Lindane)
Captafol*
Captan*
Chiorobenzilate*
Chlordane  (technical)**
a-Chlordane*
y-Chlordane*
Chloroneb*
Chloropropylate*
Chlorothalonil*
DBCP*
DC PA*
4,4'-DDD
4,4'-DDE
4,4'-DDT
Dial late*
Dichlone*
Dicofol*
Dieldrin
Endosulfan I
Endosulfan II
Endosulfan sulfate
Endrin
Endrin aldehyde
Endrin ketone*
Etridiazole*
Halowax-1000*
Halowax-1001*
Halowax-1013*
*  Target analyte of Method 8081 only.
** Target analyte of Method 8080 only.
Halowax-1014*
Halowax-1051*
Halowax-1099*
Heptachlor
Heptachlor epoxide
Hexachlorobenzene*
Hexachlorocyclo-
  pentadiene*
Isodrin*
Kepone*
Methoxychlor
Mi rex*
Nitrofen*
trans-Nonachlor*
PCNB*
trans-Permethrin*
Perthane*
Propachlor*
Strobane*
Toxaphene
Trifluralin*
                               TABLE 2-14.
                        METHOD 8090 - NITROAROMATICS AND
                              CYCLIC KETONES

                              Dinitrobenzene
                              2,4-Dinitrotoluene
                              2,6-Dinitrotoluene
                              Isophorone
                              Naphthoquinone
                              Nitrobenzene
                                   TWO -  28
                                          Revision  2
                                      September  1994

-------
                  METHODS 8100 -
            TABLE 2-15.
         POLYNUCLEAR  AROMATIC  HYDROCARBONS
   Acenaphthene
   Acenaphthylene
   Anthracene
   Benzo(a)anthracene
   Benzo(b)fluoranthene
   Benzo(j)f 1uoranthene
   Benzo(k)fluoranthene
   Benzo (g,h,i)perylene
   Benzo(a)pyrene
   Chrysene
   Dibenz(a,h)acridine
   Dibenz(a,j)acridine
   Di benzo(a,h)anthracene
                           7H-Dibenzo(c,g)carbazole
                           Dibenzo(a,e)pyrene
                           Dibenzo(a,h)pyrene
                           Dibenzo(a,i)pyrene
                           Fluoranthene
                           Fluorene
                           Indeno(l,2,3-cd)pyrene
                           3-Methylcholanthrene
                           Naphthalene
                           Phenanthrene
                           Pyrene
                                     TABLE 2-16
                              METHOD 8110  - HALOETHERS
         Bi s(2-Chloroethoxy)methane
         Bis(2-Chloroethyl)  ether
         Bis(2-Chloroisopropy1)  ether
                           4-Bromophenyl phenyl ether
                           4-Chlorophenyl phenyl ether
                                     TABLE  2-17.
                     METHODS 8120/8121  - CHLORINATED HYDROCARBONS
Benzal chloride*
Benzotrichloride*
Benzyl chloride*
2-Chloronaphthalene
1,2-Dichlorobenzene
1,3-Dichlorobenzene
1,4-Dichlorobenzene
Hexachlorobenzene
Hexachlorobutadiene
Hexachlorocyclohexane**
a-Hexachlorocyclohexane
/3-Hexachl orocycl ohexane
(a-BHC)*
()8-BHC)*
6-Hexachlorocyclohexane (6-BHC)*
Y-Hexachlorocyclohexane (y-BHC)*
Hexachlorocyclopentadi ene
Hexachloroethane
Pentachlorobenzene*
Pentachlorohexane**
Tetrachlorobenzenes**
1,2,3,4-Tetrachlorobenzene*
1,2,3,5-Tetrachlorobenzene*
1,2,4,5-Tetrachlorobenzene*
1,2,3-Trichlorobenzene*
1,2,4-Tri chlorobenzene
1,3,5-Trichlorobenzene*
*  Target analyte of Method 8121 only.
** Target analyte of Method 8120 only.
                                        TWO  -  29
                                                Revision 2
                                            September 1994

-------
                                   TABLE  2-18.
                 METHODS 8140/8141 - ORGANOPHOSPHORUS COMPOUNDS
                         (PACKED AND CAPILLARY COLUMNS)
  Aspon*
  Atrazine*
  Azinphos ethyl*
  Azinphos methyl
  Bolstar (Sulprofos)
  Carbophenothion*
  Chlorofenvinphos*
  Chlorpyrifos
  Chlorpyrifos methyl*
  Coumaphos
  Crotoxypos*
  Demeton-0,  and -S
  Diazinon
  Dichlorofenthion*
  Dichlorvos  (DDVP)
  Dichrotophos*
  Dimethoate*
  Dioxathion*
  Disulfoton
  EPN*
  Ethion*
  Ethoprop
  Famphur*
  Fenitrothion*
  Fensulfothion
             Fenthion
             Fonophos*
             Hexamethylphosphoramide* (HMPA)
             Leptophos*
             Malathion*
             Merphos
             Mevinphos
             Monochrotophos*
             Naled
             Parathion,  ethyl*
             Parathion,  methyl
             Phorate
             Phosmet*
             Phosphamidon*
             Ronnel
             Simazine*
             Stirophos (Tetrachlorvinphos)
             Sulfotep*
             TEPP*
             Terbufos*
             Thionazin*
             Tokuthion (Prothiofos)
             Trichlorfon*
             Trichloronate
             Tri-o-cresylphosphate  (TOCP)*
      *  Target analyte of Method 8141 only.
                                  TABLE  2-19.
                  METHODS 8150/8151 - CHLORINATED HERBICIDES
Acifluorfen*
Bentazon*
Chloramben*
2,4-D
Dalapon
2,4-DB
DCPA diacid*
 Dicamba
 3,5-Dichlorobenzoic  acid*
"Dichlorprop
 Dinoseb  (DNBP)
 5-Hydroxydicamba*
   *  Target analyte of Method 8151  only.
MCPA
MCPP
4-Nitrophenol*
Pentachlorophenol*
Picloram*
2,4,5-TP (Silvex)
2,4,5-T
                                   TWO -  30
                                           Revision 2
                                       September 1994

-------
                                        TABLE 2-20.
                               METHODS 8240/8260 -  VOLATILES
Acetone
Acetonitrile
Acrolein (Propenal)
Acrylonitrile
Ally! alcohol
Ally! chloride
Benzene
Benzyl chloride
Bis(2-chloroethyl) sulfide
Bromoacetone
Bromobenzene*
Bromochloromethane
Bromodi chloromethane
4-Bromof1uorobenzene
Bromoform
Bromomethane
n-Butanol*
2-Butanone (Methyl ethyl
ketone)
n-Butylbenzene*
sec-Butyl benzene*
tert-Butylbenzene*
Carbon disulfide
Carbon tetrachloride
Chloral hydrate
Chloroacetonitrile*
Chlorobenzene
2-Chloro-1,3-butadiene*
1-Chlorobutane*
Chlorodi bromomethane
Chloroethane
2-Chloroethanol
2-Chloroethyl vinyl ether
Chloroform
1-Chlorohexane*
Chloromethane
Chloroprene
3-Chloropropene*
3-Chloropropionitrile
2-Chlorotoluene*
4-Chlorotoluene*
Crotonaldehyde*
l,2-Dibromo-3-
 chloropropane
1,2-Dibromoethane
Dibromomethane
Di bromof1uoromethane*
1,2-Di chlorobenzehe*
1,3-Di chlorobenzene*
1,4-Di chlorobenzene*
l,4-Dichloro-2-butene**
cis-1,4-Dichloro-
 2-butene*
trans-l,4-Dichloro-2-
  butene*
1,4-Dichloro-2-butene**
Di chlorodi f1uoromethane
1,1-Dichloroethane
1,2-Dichloroethane
1,1-Dichloroethene
cis-1,2-Dichloroethene*
trans-1,2-Dichloroethene
1,2-Dichloropropane
1,3-Dichloropropane*
2,2-Di chloropropane*
1,3-Dichloro-2-propanol
1,1-Di chloropropene*
cis-1,3-Dichloropropene
trans-1,3-Dichloropropene
1,2,3,4-Diepoxybutane
Diethyl ether*
1,4-Di f1uorobenzene
1,4-Dioxane
Epichlorohydrin
Ethanol
Ethyl acetate*
Ethyl benzene
Ethylene oxide
Ethyl methacrylate
Fluorobenzene*
Hexachlorobutadiene*
Hexachloroethane*
2-Hexanone
2-Hydroxypropionitrile
lodomethane
Isobutyl alcohol
Isopropylbenzene*
p-Isopropyltoluene*
Malononitrile
Methacrylonitrile
Methanol*
Methyl acrylate*
Methyl-t-butyl ether*
Methylene chloride (DCM)
Methyl iodide
Methyl methacrylate
4-Methyl-2-pentanone
  (MIBK)
Naphthalene*
Nitrobenzene*
2-Nitropropane*
Pentachloroethane
Pentaf1uorobenzene*
2-Picoline
Propargyl alcohol
6-Propiolactone
Propionitrile
n-Propylamine
n-Propylbenzene*
Pyridine
Styrene
1,1,1,2-Tetrachloroethane
1,1,2,2-Tetrachloroethane
Tetrachloroethene
Toluene
1,2,3-Tri chlorobenzene*
1,2,4-Tri chlorobenzene*
1,1,1-Trichloroethane
1,1,2-Trichloroethane
Trichloroethene
Tri chlorof1uoromethane
1,2,3-Tri chloropropane
1,2,4-Trimethylbenzene*
1,3,5-Trimethylbenzene*
Vinyl acetate
Vinyl chloride
Xylene  (Total)**
o-Xylene*
m-Xylene*
p-Xylene*
* Target analyte of Method 8260  only.
** Target analyte  of Method  8240 only.
                                          TWO  -  31
                                           Revision  2
                                       September  1994

-------
                                        TABLE 2-21.
                             METHODS 8250/8270 -  SEMIVOLATILES
Acenaphthene
Acenaphthylene
Acetophenone
2-Acetylami nof1uorene*
l-Acetyl-2-thiourea*
Aldrin
2-Ami noanthraqui none*
Ami noazobenzene*
4-Aminobiphenyl
3-Amino-9-ethylcarbazole*
Anilazine*
Aniline
o-Anisidine*
Anthracene
Aramite*
Aroclor-1016 (PCB-1016)
Aroclor-1221 (PCB-1221)
Aroclor-1232 (PCB-1232)
Aroclor-1242 (PCB-1242)
Aroclor-1248 (PCB-1248)
Aroclor-1254 (PCB-1254)
Aroclor-1260 (PCB-1268)
Azinphos-methyl*
Barban*
Benz(a)anthracene
Benzidine
Benzo(b)fluoranthene
Benzo(k)fluoranthene
Benzoic acid
Benzo(g,h,i)perylene
Benzo(a)pyrene
p-Benzoquinone*
Benzyl alcohol
a-BHC
)8-BHC
6-BHC
7-BHC (Lindane)
Bis(2-chloroethoxy)methane
Bis(2-chloroethyl) ether
Bis(2-chloroisopropyl) ether
Bis(2-ethylhexyl) phthalate
4-Bromophenyl  phenyl ether
Bromoxynil*
Butyl benzyl phthalate
2-sec-Butyl-4,6-dinitrophenol (Dinoseb)*
Captafol*
Captan*
Carbaryl*
Carbofuran*
Carbophenothion*
Chlordane (technical)
Chlorfenvinphos*
4-Chloroaniline
Chiorobenzilate*
5-Chloro-2-methylaniline*
4-Chloro-3-methylphenol
3-(Chloromethyl)pyridine hydrochloride*
1-Chloronaphthalene
2-Chloronaphthalene
2-Chlorophenol
4-Chloro-l,2-phenylenediamine*
4-Chloro-1,3-phenylenedi amine*
4-Chlorophenyl phenyl ether
Chrysene
Coumaphos*
p-Cresidine*
Crotoxyphos*
2-Cyclohexyl-4,6-dinitrophenol*
4,4'-DDD
4,4'-DDE*
4,4'-DDT
Demeton-0*
Demeton-S*
Diallate (cis or trans)*
2,4-Diaminotoluene*
Dibenz(a,j)acridine
Dibenz(a,h)anthracene
Dibenzofuran
Dibenzo(a,e)pyrene*
l,2-Dibromo-3-chloropropane*
Di-n-butyl phthalate
Dichlone*
1,2-Dichlorobenzene
1,3-Dichlorobenzene
1,4-Dichlorobenzene
3,3'-Dichlorobenzidine
2,4-Dichlorophenol
2,6-Dichlorophenol
Dichlorovos*
Dicrotophos*
Dieldrin
Diethyl phthalate
Diethylstilbestrol*
Diethyl sulfate*
Dihydrosaffrole*
Dimethoate*
3,3'-Dimethoxybenzidine*
Dimethyl aminoazobenzene
                                         TWO - 32
                          Revision 2
                      September 1994

-------
                                        TABLE  2-21.
                       METHODS  8250/8270 -  SEMIVOLATILES  (CONTINUED)
7,12-Dimethylbenz(a)anthracene
3,3'-Dimethylbenzidine*
a,a-Dimethylphenethylamine
2,4-Dimethylphenol
Dimethyl phthalate
1,2-Dinitrobenzene*
1,3-Dinitrobenzene*
1,4-Dinitrobenzene*
4,6-Dinitro-2-methylphenol
2,4-Dinitrophenol
2,4-Dinitrotoluene
2,6-Dinitrotoluene
Dinocap*
Dioxathion*
Diphenylamine
5,5-Diphenylhydantoin*
1,2-Di phenylhydrazi ne
Di-n-octyl phthalate
Disulfoton*
Endosulfan I
Endosulfan II
Endosulfan sulfate
Endrin
Endrin aldehyde
Endrin ketone
EPN*
Ethion*
Ethyl carbamate*
Ethyl methanesulfonate
Ethyl parathion*
Famphur*
Fensulfothion*
Fenthion*
Fluchloralin*
Fluoranthene
Fluorene
2-Fluorobiphenyl
2-Fluorophenol
Heptachlor
Heptachlor epoxide
Hexachlorobenzene
Hexachlorobutadi ene
Hexachlorocyclopentadi ene
Hexachloroethane
Hexachlorophene*
Hexachloropropene*
Hexamethylphosphoramide*
Hydroquinone*
Indeno(l,2,3-cd)pyrene
Isodrin*
Isophorone
Isosafrole*
Kepone*
Leptophos*
Malathion*
Maleic anhydride*
Mestranol*
Methapyrilene*
Methoxychlor
3-Methylcholanthrene
4,4'-Methylenebis(2-chloroaniline)*
4,4'-Methylenebis(N,N-dimethylaniline)*
Methyl methanesulfonate
2-Methylnaphthalene
2-Methyl-5-nitroaniline*
Methyl parathion*
2-Methylphenol  (o-Cresol)
3-Methylphenol  (m-Cresol)*
4-Methylphenol  (p-Cresol)
2-Methylpyridine*
Mevinphos*
Mexacarbate*
Mi rex*
Monocrotophos*
Naled*
Naphthalene
1,4-Naphthoquinone*
1-Naphthylamine
2-Naphthylamine
Nicotine*
5-Nitroacenaphthene*
2-Nitroaniline
3-Nitroaniline
4-Nitroaniline
5-Nitro-o-anisidine*
Nitrobenzene
4-Nitrobiphenyl*
Nitrofen*
2-Nitrophenol
4-Nitrophenol
Nitroquinoline-1-oxide*
N-Nitrosodibutyl amine
N-Nitrosodiethyl amine*
N-Nitrosodimethylamine
N-Nitrosodiphenylamine
N-Nitrosodi-n-propylamine
                                          TWO -  33
                           Revision  2
                       September  1994

-------
                                        TABLE 2-21.
                       METHODS 8250/8270 -  SEMIVOLATILES (CONTINUED)
N-Ni trosomethylethyl ami ne*
N-Nitrosomorpholine*
N-Nitrosopiperi dine
N-Nitrosopyrrolidine*
5-Nitro-o-toluidine*
Octamethyl pyrophosphoramide*
4,4'-Oxydianiline*
Parathion*
Pentachlorobenzene
Pentachloroni trobenzene
Pentachlorophenol
Phenacetin
Phenanthrene
Phenobarbital*
Phenol
1,4-Phenylenedi ami ne*
Phorate*
Phosalone*
Phosmet*
Phosphamidion*
Phthalic anhydride*
2-Picoline
Piperonyl sulfoxide*
Pronamide
Propylthiouracil*
^yrene
'yridine*
Resorcinol*
Safrole*
Strychnine*
Sulfall ate*

*  Target analyte of Method 8270 only.
                  Terbuphos*
                  Terphenyl
                  1,2,4,5-Tetrachlorobenzene
                  2,3,4,6-Tetrachlorophenol
                  Tetrachlorvinphos  (Stirophos)*
                  Tetraethyl  dithiopyrophosphate*
                  Tetraethyl  pyrophosphate*
                  Thionazine*
                  Thiophenol  (Benzenethiol)*
                  Toluene  diisocyanate*
                  o-Toluidine*
                  Toxaphene
                  2,4,6-Tri bromophenol
                  1,2,4-Tri chlorobenzene
                  2,4,5-Trichlorophenol
                  2,4,6-Trichlorophenol
                  0,0,0-Triethyl  phosphorothioate*
                  Trifluralin*
                  2,4,5-Trimethylaniline*
                  Trimethyl  phosphate*
                  1,3,5-Trinitrobenzene*
                  Tris(2,3-dibromopropyl) phosphate*
                  Tri-p-tolyl phosphate*
                                        TABLE  2-22.
                          METHOD 8275  -  SEMIVOLATILES  (SCREENING)
Aldrin
Benzo(k)fluoranthene
Benzo(a)pyrene
Carbazole
4-Chloro-3-methylphenol
1-Chloronaphthalene
2-Chlorophenol
Dibenzothiophene
2,4-Dichlorophenol
2,4-Dinitrotoluene
Diphenylamine
Fluorene
Hexachlorobenzene
4-Methylphenol
Naphthalene
Phenanthrene
Pyrene
                                         TWO - 34
                                            Revision 2
                                        September 1994

-------
2,3,7,8-TCDD
1,2,3,4-TCDD*
1,3,6,8-TCDD*
1,3,7,9-TCDD*
1,3,7,8-TCDD*
1,2,7,8-TCDD*
1,2,8,9-TCDD*
                                TABLE  2-23.
               METHODS  8280/8290 -  DIOXINS AND DIBENZOFURANS
1,2,3,4,7-PeCDD
1,2,3,7,8-PeCDD
1,2,3,4,7,8-HxCDD
1,2,3,6,7,8-HxCDD
1,2,3,7,8,9-HxCDD
1,2,3,4,6,7,8-HpCDD
OCDD
     *  Target  analyte  of 8280  only
1,2,7,8-TCDF
2,3,7,8-TCDF
1,2,3,7,8-PeCDF
2,3,4,7,8-PeCDF
1,2,3,4,7,8-HxCDF
1,2,3,6,7,8-HxCDF
1,2,3,7,8,9-HxCDF
2,3,4,6,7,8-HxCDF
1,2,3,4,6,7,8-HpCDF
1,2,3,4,7,8,9-HpCDF
OCDF
                                TABLE  2-24.
              METHOD 8310 -  POLYNUCLEAR AROMATIC  HYDROCARBONS
              Acenaphthene
              Acenaphthylene
              Anthracene
              Benzo(a)anthracene
              Benzo(a)pyrene
              Benzo(b)f1uoranthene
              Benzo(g,h,i)perylene
              Benzo(k)fl uoranthene
                     Chrysene
                     Dibenzo(a,h)anthracene
                     Fluoranthene
                     Fluorene
                     Indeno(1,2,3-cd)pyrene
                     Naphthalene
                     Phenanthrene
                     Pyrene
                                 TWO - 35
                                         Revision 2
                                     September 1994

-------
                           TABLE 2-25.
                 METHOD  8315  -  CARBONYL  COMPOUNDS

   Acetaldehyde                  Heptanal
   Acetone                       Hexanal (Hexaldehyde)
   Acrolein (Propanol)           Isovaleraldehyde
   Benzaldehyde                  Nonanal
   Butanal (Butyraldehyde)       Octanal
   Crotonaldehyde                Pentanal (Valeraldehyde)
   Cyclohexanone                 Propanal (Propionaldehyde)
   Decanal                       m-Tolualdehyde
   2,5-Dimethylbenzaldehyde      o-Tolualdehyde
   Formaldehyde                  p-Tolualdehyde
       TABLE 2-26.                                  TABLE  2-27.
METHOD 8316 - ACRYLAMIDE,                 METHOD  8318  -  N-METHYLCARBAMATES
ACRYLONITRILE AND ACROLEIN
                                                Aldicarb  (Temik)
       Acrolein (Propanol)                      Aldicarb Sulfone
       Acrylamide                               Carbaryl  (Sevin)
       Acrylonitrile                            Carbofuran (Furadan)
                                                Dioxacarb
                                                3-Hydroxycarbofuran
                                                Methiocarb (Mesurol)
                                                Methomyl  (Lannate)
                                                Promecarb
                                                Propoxur  (Baygon)
                             TWO -  36                         Revision 2
                                                          September 1994

-------
                                        TABLE  2-28.
                                METHOD 8321 - NONVOLATILES
    Azo Dves
Disperse Red 1
Disperse Red 5
Disperse Red 13
Disperse Yellow 5
Disperse Orange 3
Disperse Orange 30
Disperse Brown 1
Solvent Red 3
Solvent Red 23

Anthraauinone Dves
Disperse Blue 3
Disperse Blue 14
Disperse Red 60
Coumarin Dyes

(Fluorescent Brighteners)
Fluorescent Brightener 61
Fluorescent Brightener 236

Chlorinated Phenoxvacid Compounds
2,4-D
2,4-D, butoxyethanol ester
2,4-D, ethylhexyl ester
2,4-DB
Dalapon
Dicamba
Dichlorprop
Dinoseb
MCPA
MCPP
Silvex (2,4,5-TP)
2,4,5-T
2,4,5-T, butyl ester
2,4,5-T, butoxyethanol ester
Alkaloids
Strychnine
Organophosphorus Compounds
Asulam
Dichlorvos
Dimethoate
Disulfoton
Famphur
Fensulfothion
Merphos
Methomyl
Methyl parathion
Monocrotophos
Naled
Phorate
Trichlorfon
Thiofanox
Tris-(2,3-dibromopropyl) phosphate,
  (Tris-BP)
                                         TWO - 37
                    Revision 2
                September 1994

-------
                           TABLE 2-29.
           METHOD 8330 - NITROAROMATICS AND NITRAMINES

4-Amino-2,6-dinitrotoluene (4-Am-DNT)
2-Amino-4,6-dinitrotoluene (2-Am-DNT)
1,3-Dinitrobenzene (1,3-DNB)
2,4-Dinitrotoluene (2,4-DNT)
2,6-Dinitrotoluene (2,6-DNT)
Hexahydro-l,3,5-trinitro-l,3,5-triazine (RDX)
Methyl-2,4,6-trinitrophenylnitramine (Tetryl)
Nitrobenzene (NB)
2-Nitrotoluene (2-NT)
3-Nitrotoluene (3-NT)
4-Nitrotoluene (4-NT)
Octahydro-1,3,5,7-tetrani tro-1,3,5,7-tetrazoci ne (HMX)
1,3,5-Trinitrobenzene (1,3,5-TNB)
2,4,6-Trinitrotoluene (2,4,6-TNT)
                           TABLE 2-30.
                     METHOD 8331 - TETRAZENE

                             Tetrazene
                            TWO  - 38                          Revision  2
                                                         September  1994

-------
                              TABLE 2-31
                     METHOD 8410  -  SEMIVOLATILES
Acenaphthene
Acenaphthylene
Anthracene
Benzo(a)anthracene
Benzo(b)pyrene
Benzoic acid
Bis(2-chloroethoxy)methane
Bis(2-chloroethyl)ether
Bis(2-chloroisopropyl)ether
Bi s(2-ethylhexylJphthalate
4-Bromophenyl phenyl ether
Butyl benzyl phthalate
4-Chloroaniline
4-Chloro-3-methylphenol
2-Chloronaphthalene
2-Chlorophenol
4-Chlorophenol
4-Chlorophenyl phenyl ether
Chrysene
Dibenzofuran
Di-n-butyl phthalate
1,2-Dichlorobenzene
1,3-Di chlorobenzene
1,4-Dichlorobenzene
2,4-Dichlorophenol
Diethyl phthalate
Dimethyl phthalate
4,6-Dinitro-2-methylphenol
2,4-Dinitrophenol
2,4-Dinitrotoluene
2,6-Dinitrotoluene
Di-n-octyl phthalate
Di-n-propyl phthalate
Fluoranthene
Fluorene
Hexachlorobenzene
1,3-Hexachlorobutadi ene
Hexachlorocyclopentadiene
Hexachloroethane
Isophorone
2-Methylnaphthalene
2-Methylphenol
4-Methylphenol
Naphthalene
2-Nitroaniline
3-Nitroaniline
4-Nitroaniline
Nitrobenzene
2-Nitrophenol
4-Nitrophenol
N-Ni trosodimethyl ami ne
N-Nitrosodiphenylamine
N-Nitroso-di-n-propylamine
Pentachlorophenol
Phenanthrene
Phenol
Pyrene
1,2,4-Tri chlorobenzene
2,4,5-Trichlorophenol
2,4,6-Trichlorophenol
                               TWO - 39
                              Revision 2
                          September 1994

-------
              TABLE  2-32.
ANALYSIS METHODS FOR INORGANIC COMPOUNDS
Compound
Aluminum
Antimony
Arsenic
Barium
Beryl 1 i urn
Bromide
Cadmium
Calcium
Chloride
Chromium
Chromium, hexavalent
Cobalt
Copper
Cyanide
Fluoride
Iron
Lead
Lithium
Magnesium
Manganese
Mercury
Molybdenum
Nickel
Nitrate
Nitrite
Osmium
Phosphate
Phosphorus
Potassium
Selenium
Silver
Sodium
Strontium
Sulfate
Sulfide
Thallium
Tin
Vanadium
Zinc
Applicable Method(s)
6010,
6010,
6010,
6010,
6010,
9056
6010,
6010,
9056,
6010,
7195,
6010,
6010,
9010,
9056
6010,
6010,
6010,
6010,
6010,
7470,
6010,
6010,
9056,
9056
7550
9056
6010
6010,
6010,
6010,
6010,
6010,
9035,
9030,
6010,
7870
6010,
6010,
6020,
6020,
6020,
6020,
6020,

6020,
7140
9250,
6020,
7196,
6020,
6020,
9012,

7380,
6020,
7430
7450
6020,
7471
7480,
6020,
9200




7610
7740,
6020,
7770
7780
9036,
9031
6020,

7910,
6020,
7020
7040,
7060,
7080,
7090,

7130,

9251,
7190,
7197,
7200,
7210,
9013

7381
7420,


7460,

7481
7520






7741,
7760,


9038,

7840,

7911
7950,

7041,
7061,
7081
7091

7131

9252,
7191
7198
7201
7211



7421


7461









7742
7761


9056

7841


7951

7062
7062





9253






























                TWO - 40
    Revision 2
September 1994

-------
                                                       TABLE 2-33.
                        CONTAINERS, PRESERVATION TECHNIQUES, AND HOLDING TIMES  FOR AQUEOUS MATRICES*
Name
Bacterial Tests:
Co I i form, total
Inorganic Tests:
Chloride
Cyanide, total and amenable
to ch I or i nation





Hydrogen ion (pH)
Nitrate
Sulfate
Sulfide
Metals:
Chromium VI
Mercury
Metals, except chromium VI
and mercury
Organic Tests:
Acrolein and acrylonitri le

Benzi dines


Chlorinated hydrocarbons

Dioxins and Furans

Haloethers

Nitroaromatics and
cyclic ketones
Nitrosamines

Oil and grease
Organic carbon, total (TOC)
PCBs

Pesticides

Phenols

Phthalate esters

Polynuclear aromatic
hydrocarbons
Purgeable aromatic
hydrocarbons
Purgeable Halocarbons

Total organic ha I ides (TOX)

Radiological Tests:
Alpha, beta and radium
Container

P. G

P, G
P, G






P, G
P, G
P, G
P, G

P, G
P, G
P, G


G, Teflon- lined
septum
G, Teflon- lined
cap

G, Teflon- lined
cap
G, Teflon- lined
cap
G, Teflon- lined
cap
G, Teflon- lined
cap
G, Teflon- lined
cap
G
P, G
G, Teflon- lined
cap
G, Teflon- lined
cap
G, Teflon-lined
cap
G, Teflon-lined
cap
G, Teflon- lined
cap
G, Teflon- lined
septum
G, Teflon- lined
septum
G, Teflon- lined
cap

P, G
Preservation

Cool, 4°C, 0.008% NaaS203

None required
Cool, 4°C; if oxidizing
agents present add 5 ml
0.1N NaAs02 per L or 0.06 g
of ascorbic acid per L;
adjust pH>12 with 50% NaOH.
See Method 9010 for other
interferences.
None required
Cool, 4°C
Cool, 4°C
Cool, 4°C, add zinc acetate

Cool, 4°C
HN03 to pH<2
HN03 to pH<2


Cool, 4°C, 0.008% Na2S2033,
Adjust pH to 4-5
Cool, 4°C, 0.008% Na2S2033,
Adjust pH to 6-9, store in
dark
Cool, 4°C, 0.008% Na2S2033
Q
Cool, 4°C, 0.008% Na2S203
Q
Cool, 4°C, 0.008% Na2S203
o
Cool, 4°C, 0.008% Na2S203
store in dark
Cool, 4°C, 0.008% NazS203,
store in dark
Cool, 4°C,
Cool, 4°CZ
Cool, 4°C

Cool, 4°C

Cool, 4°C, 0.008% Na2S2033

Cool, 4°C
o
Cool, 4°C, 0.008% Na2S203
store in dark
Cool, 4°C, 0.008% Na2S203 '3

Cool, 4°C, 0.008% Na2S2033
A
Cool, 4°C^


HN03 to pH<2
Maximum holding time

6 hours

28 days
14 days






24 hours
48 hours
28 days
7 days

24 hours
28 days
6 months


14 days

7 days until extraction.
after extraction

7 days until extraction,
after extraction
7 days until extraction,
after extraction
7 days until extraction.
after extraction
7 days until extraction,
after extraction
7 days until extraction,
after extraction
28 days
28 days
7 days until extraction.
after extraction
7 days until extraction.
after extraction
7 days until extraction.
after extraction
7 days until extraction.
after extraction
7 days until extraction,
after extraction
14 days

14 days

28 days


6 months
























40 days


40 days

40 days

40 days

40 days

40 days



40 days

40 days

40 days

40 days

40 days









1
Table excerpted,  in part, from Table II,  49  FR 209, October 26,  1984, p 28.
Polyethylene  (P)  or Glass (G)
Adjust to pH<2 with H2S04, HCl or solid NaHSO«.
Free chlorine must be removed prior to addition of HCl by the appropriate addition of Na2S203.
                                                       TWO -  41
                                                                                                 Revision  2
                                                                                            September 1994

-------
                   TABLE  2-34.   PREPARATION METHODS FOR ORGANIC ANALYTES

Acids
Acrolein
Acrylonitrile
Acetonitrile
Aromatic Volatiles
Base/Neutral
Chlorinated
Herbicides
Chlorinated
Hydrocarbons
Halogenated
Volatiles
Nitroaromatic and
Cyclic Ketones
Non-halogenated
Volatiles
Organochlorine
Pesticides and PCBs
Organophosphorus
Pesticides
Phenols
Phthalate Esters
Polynuclear
Aromatic
Hydrocarbons
Volatile Organics
Aqueous (pH)3
3510
3520
(PH <2)
5030
5030
3510
3520
(PH >H)
8150
8151
(PH <2)
3510
3520
(pH 7)
5030
3510
3520
(pH 5-9)
5030
3510
3520
3665
(pH 5-9)
3510
3520
(pH 6-8)
3510
3520
(PH <2)
3510
3520
(pH 7)
3510
3520
(PH 7)
5030
Solids
3540, 3541
3550
35802
5030
5030
3540
3541
3550
35802
8150
8151
35802
3540
3541
3550
35802
5030
3540
3541
3550
35802
5030
3540
3541
35802
3665
3540
3541
35802
3540
3541
3550
35802
3540
3541
3550
35802
3540, 3541
3550
35802
5030
SI udges
Emulsions1 (pH)
3520
(pH <2)
5030
5030
3520
(PH >H)
8150
8151
(PH <2)
3520
(pH 7)
5030
3520
(pH 5-9)
5030
3520
(pH 5-9)
3520
(pH 6-8)
3520
(PH <2)
3520
(PH 7)
3520
(pH 7)
5030
Oils
3650
35802
5030
5030
3650
35802
35802
35802
5030
35802
5030
35802
35802
3650
35802
35802
3560
35802
5030
1  If attempts  to break up emulsions  are  unsuccessful,
2  Method 3580  is only appropriate if the sample  is  sol
3  pH at which  extraction  should  be performed.
these methods may be used.
uble in the specified solvent.
                                         TWO - 42
                    Revision 2
                September 1994

-------
            TABLE 2-35.
CLEANUP OF ORGANIC ANALYTE EXTRACTS
Analyte Type
Acids
Base/Neutral
Chlorinated
Herbicides
Chlorinated
Hydrocarbons
Nitroaromatics &
Cyclic Ketones
Organophosphorus
Pesticides
Organochlorine
Pesticides &
PCBs
Phenols
Phthalate
Esters
Polynuclear
Aromatic
Hydrocarbons
Method(s)
3650
3650
8150
8151
3620
3640
3620
3640
3620
3620
3630
3640
3660
3665
3630
3640
3650
3610
3611
3620
3640
3610
3611
3630
3640
              TWO  -  43
    Revision 2
September 1994

-------
                                      TABLE  2-36.
                          DETERMINATION OF  ORGANIC  ANALYTES

SEMIVOLATILES
Acids
Base/Neutral
Carbamates
Chlorinated Herbicides
Chlorinated Hydrocarbons
Dyes
Explosives
Haloethers
Nitroaromatics and Cyclic
Ketones
Nitrosoamines
Organochlorine Pesticides and
PCBs
Organophosphorous Pesticides
Phenols
Phthalate Esters
Polynuclear Aromatic
Hydrocarbons
6C/MS Determination
Methods

8270
8250
8270
8250

8270*
8270
8250


8270
8250
8270
8250
8270
8250
8270*
8270*
8270
8250
8270
8250
8270
8250
Specific GC Detection
Methods




8150
8151
8120
8121


8110
8090
8070
8080
8081
8140
8141
8040
8060
8061
8100
HPLC



8318


8321
8330
8331




8321


8310
VOLATILES
Acrolein, Acrylonitrile,
Acetonitrile
Acryl amide
Aromatic Volatiles
Formaldehyde
Halogenated Volatiles
Non-halogenated Volatiles
Volatile Organics
8240
8260

8240
8260

8240
8260
8240
8240
8260
8030
8031
8032
8020
8021

8010
8011
8021
8015
8010
8011
8020
8021
8030
8031
8316
8315
8316

8315


8315
8316
*This method is an alternative confirmation method.  It is not the method of choice.
                                       TWO - 44
     Revision  2
September  1994

-------
                                                                           FIGURE  2-1.
                                                                 ORGANIC  ANALYSIS  OPTIONS
                                                         Sampl
                                                     to be Analyzed
                                                     lor Extractables
                                                       r Volatile* ?
                                                                                                                                          Does the
                                                                                                                                        Sample need
                                                                                                                                          xtraclion?
              Solid, Oil, or Sludge
      Preparation:  5030
                 Preparation: 5030
                                                   GC/MS Analysis
                                                   Procedure:
                                                   Packed Column:  6240
                                                  Capillary Column:  8260
 Analysis
Procedure?
          GC Analysis Procedure
          Halogenated Volatile Organics:         8010
          EDB and DBCP:                    8011
          Nonhalogenated Volatile Organics      8015
          Aromatic Volatile Organics:            8020
          Halogenated Volatile Compounds:      8021
          Acrolein, Acrylonitrile:                8030
          Acrylarnide     	8032
                                                             Cleanup Procedure:
                                                              Alumina Column:
                                                              Alumina Column for Petroleum Wastes:
                                                              Florisil Column:
                                                              Silica Gel Column:
                                                             Gel Permeation:
                                                              Acid Base Partitioning:
                                                              Sulfur:
3610
3611
3620
3630
3640
3650
3660
                                       HPLC Analysis Procedures:
                                       8310, 8318, 8321, 8330, 8331
HPLC Analysis Procedures:
Acrolein, Acrylonitrile, Acrylarnide: 8316
Formaldehyde:                 8315
                                                                                                             iC/MS
                                                                        GC/MS Procedures:
                                                                        Packed Column:   8250
                                                                        Capillary Column: 8270
  GC Analysis Procedures:
  Phenols:                           8040
  Phthalate Esters:                    8060
  Nitrosamines:                       8070
  Organochtorine Pesticides and PCBs:   8080
  Nltroaromatics and Cyclic Ketones:     8090
  Polynuclear Aromatic Hydrocarbons:    8100
  Haloethers:                        8110
  Chlorinated Hydrocarbons:            8120,8121
  Organophosphorus Pesticides:         8140, 8141
  Chlorinated Herbicides:               8150.8151
                                                                         TWO   -   45
                                                                                                                                   Revision  2
                                                                                                                            September  1994

-------
                                 FIGURE 2-2.
                  SCHEMATIC OF  SEQUENCE  TO  DETERMINE
              IF A  WASTE  IS  HAZARDOUS  BY  CHARACTERISTIC
                                                DOT(49CFR 173.300)
                                         Is waste
                                        ignitable?
        Is
      waste
    reactive to
     air and/or
      water?
                                                                 Nonhazardous by
                                                                    reason of
                                                                    ignitability
                                                                  characteristic
      Is waste
     explosive?
                                                Generator Knowledge
                                                DOT (49 CFR 173.151)
       What is
     physical state
      of waste?
                                   Is waste
                                   ignitable?
Hazardous^}
     Perform Paint
      Filter Test
    (Method 9095)
             Methods 1110 and 9040

                    Yes
 Is waste
corrosive?
f    Nonhazardous  ^v
(     for corrosivity    )
 X^characteristic _/
            	-^
               Methods 1010 or 1020

                    Yes	
                                   TWO  -  46
                                                                         Revision  2
                                                                    September 1994

-------
        FIGURE  2-2.
        (Continued)
    Nonhazardous
    for ignitability
    characteristic
             Reactive CN
             and Sulfide Tests
     Does waste
    generate toxic
       gas?
   Nonhazardous
for toxic gas generation
(reactivity) characteristic
    Is total
   concen. of TC
   constituents-:-20 <
   TC regulatory
       limit?
Nonhazardous
  for toxicity
     Is waste
   teachable and
      toxic?
   (Method 1311)
Nonhazardous
  for toxicity
           TWO  -  47
                      Revision 2
                 September  1994

-------
                                FIGURE 2-3A.
                                     EP
                                  Sample
                                   1310
    3010
  (7760  Ag)
    6010
               7470
               Hg
   3510
 Neutral
   8150
   8151
Herbicides
 Ba--




Cr --


Ag --
-- As




-- Cd


-- Pb


-- Se
   8080
   8081
Pesticides
                                  TWO - 48
                                                            Revision 2
                                                        September 1994

-------
                                FIGURE 2-3B.
          RECOMMENDED SW-846 METHODS OF ANALYSIS FOR TCLP LEACHATES
                              Sample
                              TCLP
1
3010

1
7470
Hg



3510
Neutral



8240
8260
Volatile
Organ ics



3510
(Acidic
and
Basic)

1
8150
8151
Herbic-
ides
   6010
Ba -


Cr -


Ag -
- As


- Cd


- Pb


- Se
                                  TWO - 49
                                                             Revision  2
                                                         September 1994

-------
                                FIGURE  2-4A.
                           GROUND WATER ANALYSIS
Organic
Sample

1 p
VGA
1
8240 or
8260


\
Semivolatiles
\
3510 or
3520
i
8270 or
8250




\

1 1 ' W
Pesticides
I
Herbicides Dioxins
1 I
3510 or
3520
Neutral
, I

1 3620, 3640
and/or 3660
\

8080
81 50 8280


1 -Optional: Cleanup required only if interferences prevent analysis
                                    TWO  -  50
     Revision 2
September  1994

-------
       FIGURE  2-4B.
     INDICATOR ANALYTE
(     Indicator
V^    Analyte(s)
1
POC
                        1 - Barcelona, 1984, (See Reference 1)
                        2 - Riggin, 1984, (See Reference 2)
            TWO  - 51
     Revision  2
September 1994

-------
                                    FIGURE  2-4C.
                                    GROUND  WATER
                                   GROUND WATER1
                                      SAMPLE
i
             SAMPLE PREPARATION
                 3005 OR 301 5
  1
  i
Ag, Al, As, Ba, Be,
Cd, Co, Cr, Cu, Fe,
Mg, Mn, Mo, Ni, Pb,
Sb, Se, Tl, V, Zn

Ag, Al, As, Ba, Be,
Cd, Co, Cr, Cu, Mn,
Ni, Pb. Sb, Tl, Zn
                                                               1
                                   SAMPLE PREPARATION
                                       3015 OR 3020
Ag - 7760
Ba - 7080
Cd-7130
Cr-7190
Fe -7380
Mn - 7460
Ni - 7520
Sb - 7040
Tl - 7840
Zn - 7950
Al - 7020
Be -7090
Co - 7200
Cu-7210
Mg - 7450
Mo - 7480
Pb - 7420
Sn - 7870
V - 7910
                                           i
Ag
Ba
Be
Cd
Co
Cr
Cu
Fe
- 7761 "
- 7081 *
-7091
-7131
-7201
-7191
-7211*
-7381*
Mn
Mo
Pb
Tl-
Sb
V-
Zn
- 7461 '
-7481
-7421
7841
-7041*
7062*
7911
- 7951*
*  Follow the digestion procedures as detailed in the individual
  determinative methods.

1  When analyzing for total dissolved metals, digestion is not
  necessary if the samples are filtered at the time of
  collection, and then acidified to the same concentration as the standards.
                                       TWO  -  52
                                                              Revision  2
                                                         September 1994

-------
                                 CHAPTER  THREE

                               METALLIC ANALYTES
3.1  SAMPLING CONSIDERATIONS

3.1.1  Introduction

      This manual  contains procedures for the analysis of metals in  a variety of
matrices.  These methods are written as specific steps in the overall analysis
scheme -- sample handling  and preservation, sample digestion  or  preparation, and
sample analysis for specific metal  components.   From these methods, the analyst
must assemble a total  analytical protocol which is appropriate for the sample to
be analyzed and for the information required.  This introduction discusses the
options  available  in general  terms,  provides  background   information  on the
analytical techniques, and highlights some of the considerations to  be made when
selecting a total  analysis protocol.


3.1.2  Definition of Terms

      Optimum  concentration  range:   A  range,  defined by limits  expressed in
concentration,  below  which  scale expansion  must be used and above which curve
correction should be considered.  This range will vary with the sensitivity of
the instrument  and the operating conditions employed.

      Sensitivity:   a) Atomic  Absorption:   The concentration in milligrams of
metal per liter that  produces an absorption of 1%; b)  Inductively Coupled Plasma
(ICP):   The  slope of the  analytical curve,  i.e.,  the functional   relationship
between emission intensity and concentration.

      Method detection limit  (MDL):  The  minimum concentration of a substance
that  can  be  measured  and  reported  with  99%  confidence  that   the  analyte
concentration  is greater  than  zero.  The  MDL is determined  from analysis of a
sample in a given  matrix containing analyte which has been processed through the
preparative procedure.

      Total  recoverable metals:  The concentration of metals in an unfiltered
sample following treatment with hot dilute mineral acid  (Method 3005).

      Dissolved metals:  The concentration of metals determined in a  sample  after
the sample is  filtered through a 0.45-um filter  (Method  3005).

      Suspended metals:   The concentration of metals determined in the
portion of a sample  that  is retained by a 0.45-um  filter (Method 3005).

      Total metals:  The concentration of metals determined in a  sample following
digestion by Methods  3010, 3015, 3020, 3050 or 3051.
                                   THREE - 1                      Revision 2
                                                                  September 1994

-------
       Instrument detection limit (IDL):  The concentration equivalent to a signal
 due  to the analyte which is equal to  three times  the standard deviation  of  a
 series of 7  replicate  measurements  of  a  reagent  blank's  signal  at the  same
 wavelength.

       Interference  check  sample  (ICS):   A  solution containing  both  interfering
 and analyte elements of  known concentration that can be used to verify background
 and  interelement correction factors.

       Initial  calibration  verification   standard   (ICV):     A  certified or
 independently  prepared  solution  used  to  verify the accuracy of  the  initial
 calibration.   For  ICP analysis,  it must be run at  each wavelength used  in the
 analysis.

       Continuing calibration  verification  (CCV):   Used  to assure calibration
 accuracy during each analysis  run.  It must be run for each  analyte as described
 in the particular analytical method.  At a minimum, it  should be analyzed at the
 beginning  of  the run and  after the  last analytical  sample.  Its concentration
 should be  at or near the mid-range levels  of the calibration curve.

       Calibration standards:  A series of  known standard solutions used  by the
 analyst for calibration of the instrument  (i.e., preparation of the analytical
 curve).

       Linear dynamic range:  The concentration range over which the analytical
 curve  remains linear.

      Method  blank:  A  volume of reagent  water processed  through  each  sample
 preparation procedure.

      Calibration blank:   A volume of  reagent water acidified with  the  same
 amounts of acids as were the standards and samples.

      Laboratory control standard: A  volume of reagent water spiked with known
 concentrations of  analytes  and carried  through  the preparation  and analysis
 procedure as a sample.   It is  used to  monitor loss/recovery values.

      Method  of  standard  addition  (MSA):    The  standard-addition  technique
 involves the use of the unknown and the  unknown plus  several  known  amounts of
 standard.   See Method 7000,  Section  8.7 for detailed instructions.

      Sample holding time:  The storage time allowed between sample  collection
and sample analysis  when the designated preservation and storage techniques are
employed.
                                  THREE - 2                       Revision 2
                                                                  September 1994

-------
      3.1.3  Sample Handling and Preservation

      Sample holding times, digestion procedures and suggested collection volumes
are listed in Table 1.   The  sample  volumes  required  depend upon the number of
different digestion procedures necessary for analysis.  This may be determined
by the application of  graphite-furnace  atomic  absorption spectrometry (GFAA),
flame atomic absorption  spectrometry (FLAA),  inductively coupled argon plasma
emission spectrometry  (ICP), hydride-generation atomic absorption spectrometry
(HGAA),  inductively  coupled plasma  mass  spectrometry (ICP-MS)  or cold-vapor
atomic absorption  spectrometry (CVAA)  techniques,  each  of which  may require
different digestion procedures.  The indicated volumes in Table 3-1 refer to that
required  for  the  individual   digestion  procedures and  recommended  sample
collection volumes.

      In  the  determination of  trace metals,  containers  can  introduce either
positive  or  negative  errors   in  the  measurement  of  trace  metals by  (a)
contributing  contaminants  through   leaching  or  surface  desorption,  and  (b)
depleting concentrations through adsorption.  Thus  the collection and  treatment
of the sample  prior  to  analysis require  particular  attention.   The  following
cleaning  treatment sequence has  been  determined  to be  adequate  to minimize
contamination  in  the   sample  bottle,  whether   borosilicate  glass,  linear
polyethylene, polypropylene, or Teflon:   detergent, tap water,  1:1  nitric acid,
tap water, 1:1 hydrochloric acid, tap water, and reagent water.

            NOTE: Chromic acid should not  be used to clean glassware,  especially
            if chromium  is to be included  in the analytical  scheme.  Commercial,
            non-chromate products  (e.g., Nochromix)  may be  used  in place of
            chromic  acid if adequate cleaning is  documented  by an  analytical
            quality control program.  (Chromic acid should also not be used with
            plastic bottles.)

      3.1.4  Safety

      The toxicity or  carcinogenicity of each reagent used in  these methods has
not been  precisely defined.  However, each  chemical  compound  should  be treated
as a potential health  hazard.  From this viewpoint, exposure to these chemicals
must be  reduced  to the lowest  possible  level  by whatever means  available.  The
laboratory  is responsible  for maintaining  a  current awareness  file of OSHA
regulations  regarding the  safe handling of the chemicals specified  in these
methods.  A reference  file of material data-handling sheets should also be made
available  to  all  personnel  involved  in the  chemical   analysis.    Additional
references to  laboratory safety are  available.  They are:

1.     "Carcinogens -  Working  with  Carcinogens,"   Department  of Health,
Education,  and Welfare,  Public Health  Service,  Center  for Disease
Control,  National Institute  for  Occupational Safety and Health,
Publication  No.  77-206,  August 1977.
                                   THREE - 3                       Revision 2
                                                                   September 1994

-------
                                  TABLE 3-1.

  SAMPLE HOLDING  TIMES,  REQUIRED  DIGESTION  VOLUMES  AND RECOMMENDED COLLECTION
         VOLUMES  FOR  METAL  DETERMINATIONS  IN  AQUEOUS  AND  SOLID SAMPLES
 Measurement
                            Digestion
                            Vol.  Req."
                             (ml)
Collection
Volume (mL)'
 Treatment/
 Preservative
Holding Time0
 Metals (except hexavalent chromium and mercury):


                                100           600
Aqueous
      Total
       Dissolved
       Suspended
 Solid
       Total

 Chromium  VI:b

       Aqueous

       Solid

 Mercury:

 Aqueous
       Total


       Dissolved
                               100
                               100
                               2g
                               100
Solid
      Total
                               100
                               100
                               0.2g
  600
  600
  200g
 400
 400
 200g
 HN03 to pH <2
 6 months

 Filter on  site;
 HN03 to pH <2
 6 months

 Filter on  site
 6 months

 6 months
  400           24  hr

  200g          	
HN03 to pH <2
28 days

Filter;
HN03 to pH <2
28 days

28 days
"Unless stated otherwise.
bThe holding time for the analysis of hexavalent chromium in solid samples  has
not yet been determined.  A holding time of "as soon as possible"  is recommended.
CA11  non-aqueous samples and  all  aqueous samples that are  to  be analyzed  for
mercury and  hexavalent chromium must be stored at  4°C  ±  2°C  until  analyzed,
either glass or plastic containers may be used.
                                   THREE  -  4
                                                                  Revision  2
                                                                  September 1994

-------
2.        "OSHA Safety and Health Standards,  General  Industry" (29 CFR 1910),
Occupational Safety  and  Health Administration, OSHA  2206,  revised
January 1976.

3.        "Proposed OSHA Safety and Health Standards, Laboratories," Occupational
Safety and Health Administration, Federal Register,  July 24, 1986, p. 26660.

4.        "Safety in Academic Chemistry Laboratories,"  American Chemical Society
Publication, Committee on Chemical Safety, 3rd edition, 1979.
3.2  SAMPLE PREPARATION METHODS

          The  methods  in  SW-846  for  sample digestion  or preparation  are as
follows1:

          Method 3005 prepares ground  water and  surface water  samples for total
recoverable and dissolved  metals determination by FLAA, ICP-AES, or ICP-MS.  The
unfiltered or filtered sample is heated with dilute HC1  and HN03  prior to metal
determination.

          Method 3010 prepares  waste  samples  for  total  metal  determination by
FLAA, ICP-AES, or ICP-MS.   The samples are vigorously digested with  nitric  acid
followed by dilution with  hydrochloric acid. The method is applicable to  aqueous
samples, EP and mobility-procedure extracts.

          Method 3015 prepares aqueous samples, mobility-procedure extracts, and
wastes that contain suspended  solids for total metal determination by FLAA, GFAA,
ICP-AES, or ICP-MS.   Nitric acid is  added to the sample in a Teflon digestion
vessel and heated  in  a microwave  unit prior to  metals determination.

          Method 3020 prepares waste samples for total metals determination by
furnace  GFAA  or ICP-MS.   The samples  are vigorously digested with  nitric  acid
followed  by  dilution with  nitric  acid.   The method  is  applicable to  aqueous
samples, EP and mobility-procedure extracts.

          Method 3040 prepares  oily waste  samples for determination  of  soluble
metals by FLAA, GFAA,  and  ICP-AES methods.  The samples are dissolved and  diluted
in  organic solvent  prior  to analysis.  The method  is  applicable  to  the  organic
extract  in the oily waste  EP procedure and  other samples high in oil, grease, or
wax content.

          Method 3050 prepares  waste  samples for total metals  determination by
FLAA and ICP-AES, or ICP-MS.  The samples are vigorously digested in nitric  acid
and hydrogen  peroxide followed by dilution with either nitric or  hydrochloric
acid.  The method  is  applicable to soils,  sludges,  and  solid  waste  samples.

          Method 3051  prepares  sludges,  sediments,  soils and  oils for total
metals determination  by FLAA, GFAA, ICP-AES or  ICP-MS.  Nitric acid is  added to


                                   THREE - 5                       Revision 2
                                                                   September 1994

-------
the representative sample in  a Teflon digestion vessel and heated in a microwave
unit prior to metals determination.

1  Please note that  chlorine  is  an interferent in  ICP-MS  analyses and its  use
should be discouraged except when absolutely necessary.
                                  THREE -  6                       Revision  2
                                                                  September 1994

-------
                                 METHOD 3005A

               ACID  DIGESTION  OF  WATERS  FOR TOTAL  RECOVERABLE  OR
           DISSOLVED METALS  FOR ANALYSIS BY FLAA OR  ICP  SPECTROSCOPY
1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

      1.1   Method 3005 is an acid digestion procedure used to prepare surface
and ground water  samples  for  analysis  by flame atomic absorption spectroscopy
(FLAA) or  by inductively  coupled argon  plasma  spectroscopy (ICP).   Samples
prepared by Method 3005 may be analyzed by AAS  or ICP for the following metals:

            Aluminum                      Magnesium
            Antimony**                    Manganese
            Arsenic*                      Molybdenum
            Barium                        Nickel
            Beryllium                     Potassium
            Cadmium                       Selenium*
            Calcium                       Silver
            Chromium                      Sodium
            Cobalt                        Thallium
            Copper                        Vanadium
            Iron                          Zinc
            Lead

            * ICP only
            **May be analyzed by  ICP, FLAA,  or GFAA

      1.2   When analyzing for total  dissolved  metals  filter the sample, at the
time of collection, prior to acidification with nitric acid.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

      2.1   Total recoverable  metals  - The entire sample is acidified at the time
of collection with nitric  acid.   At  the time  of  analysis  the sample is heated
with acid and substantially reduced  in  volume.   The digestate is filtered and
diluted to volume, and is then ready for analysis.

      2.2   Dissolved metals - The sample is filtered through a  0.45-/Ltm filter
at the time of collection and  the liquid phase  is then acidified at the time of
collection with  nitric  acid.   Samples  for dissolved metals do  not  need  to be
digested as  long as the  acid concentrations  have  been  adjusted to  the  same
concentration as in the standards.
3.0  INTERFERENCES

      3.1   The analyst should be cautioned that this digestion procedure may not
be sufficiently vigorous to destroy some metal complexes.
                                   3005A  -  1                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
Precipitation will  cause  a lowering of the silver concentration and therefore an
inaccurate analysis.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

      4.1   Griffin beakers of assorted sizes or equivalent.

      4.2   Watch glasses or equivalent.

      4.3   Qualitative filter paper and filter funnels.

      4.4   Graduated cylinder or equivalent.

      4.5   Electric  hot  plate  or  equivalent -  adjustable  and  capable  of
maintaining a temperature of 90-95°C.


5.0  REAGENTS

      5.1   Reagent grade chemicals  shall be used in all  tests. Unless otherwise
indicated, it is intended that all reagents shall conform to the specifications
of the Committee on Analytical  Reagents of the American Chemical Society, where
such specifications are available. Other grades  may be used,  provided it is first
ascertained that the reagent  is  of  sufficiently high  purity to  permit  its use
without lessening the accuracy of the determination.

      5.2   Reagent  Water.   Reagent  water  shall   be  interference  free.   All
references  to water in  the method  refer to  reagent water  unless  otherwise
specified.  Refer to Chapter One for a definition of reagent water.

      5.3   Nitric  acid   (concentrated),  HNO,.   Acid  should  be  analyzed  to
determine level  of impurities.  If method blank is < MDL, then  acid  can be used.

      5.4   Hydrochloric acid (concentrated), HC1.   Acid should be analyzed to
determine level  of impurities.  If method blank is < MDL, then  acid  can be used.


6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

      6.1   All   samples  must  have been  collected  using a  sampling  plan that
addresses the considerations discussed in Chapter Nine of this manual.

      6.2   All  sample containers must be prewashed  with detergents, acids, and
water.  Both plastic and glass containers are suitable.

      6.3   Sampling

            6.3.1    Total recoverable metals -  All  samples  must  be  acidified at
      the time of collection with HN03 (5 ml/I).

            6.3.2    Dissolved  metals  -  All  samples must be filtered through a
      0.45-^m filter and  then  acidified  at the time of  collection with HNO,
      (5 ml/I).

                                  3005A  - 2                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
7.0  PROCEDURE

      7.1   Transfer a 100-mL aliquot of well-mixed sample to a beaker.

      7.2   For metals that  are to be analyzed,  add 2 ml of concentrated HN03 and
5 ml of concentrated HC1.   The sample  is  covered with a ribbed watch glass or
other suitable covers  and  heated on a steam bath,  hot  plate  or other heating
source at 90 to 95°C until  the volume has  been  reduced to 15-20 ml.

      CAUTION:    Do not boil.  Antimony is easily  lost by volatilization from
                  hydrochloric acid media.

      7.3   Remove the beaker and allow to cool.  Wash down the beaker walls and
watch glass with water and, when necessary, filter  or centrifuge the sample to
remove silicates  and  other  insoluble material  that  could clog  the nebulizer.
Filtration should be done only if there is concern that  insoluble materials may
clog the nebulizer;  this  additional step is liable to  cause sample contamination
unless the filter and filtering apparatus are thoroughly cleaned and prerinsed
with dilute HN03.

      7.4   Adjust the final volume to 100 ml with  reagent water.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

      8.1   All quality  control  measures described  in Chapter One  should be
followed.

      8.2   For each  analytical  batch  of samples processed,  blanks  should be
carried throughout the entire sample preparation and  analytical process.  These
blanks will be useful in determining if samples are being contaminated.  Refer
to Chapter One for the proper protocol  when analyzing blanks.

      8.3   Replicate  samples should  be  processed  on  a routine  basis.    A
replicate sample  is a  sample  brought through the whole sample preparation and
analytical process.   Replicate samples will be used  to determine precision.  The
sample load will dictate  the frequency, but 5% is  recommended.  Refer to Chapter
One for the proper protocol when analyzing replicates.

      8.4   Spiked samples or  standard reference materials should be employed to
determine accuracy.   A spiked sample should be  included  with each batch.  Refer
to Chapter One for the proper protocol  when analyzing spikes.


9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

      9.1   No data provided.
                                   3005A  -  3                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
10.0  REFERENCES

1.    Rohrbough, W.G.;  et  al.  Reagent Chemicals.  American Chemical  Society
Specifications, 7th ed.; American Chemical  Society:  Washington,  DC, 1986.

2.    1985 Annual Book of ASTM Standards. Vol. 11.01;  "Standard Specification for
Reagent Water"; ASTM: Philadelphia, PA, 1985; D1193-77.
                                   3005A -  4                      Revision  1
                                                                  July  1992

-------
                        METHOD 3005A
     ACID DIGESTION OF WATERS  FOR  TOTAL RECOVERABLE OR
DISSOLVED METALS  FOR  ANALYSIS BY FLAA OR  ICP  SPECTROSCOPY
                         Start
7 . 1 Transfer
aliquot of
aaapl* to
b>ak*r

7.2

Add
concentrated
UNO, and HC1
7
si

2 H.at
>npl« to


7


3 Cool
filt.r if
nccciiarjr
                       7.4 Kdjutt
                       final voluM
                          Stop
                         3005A -  5
Revision 1
July 1992

-------
                                 METHOD 3010A

              ACID DIGESTION OF AQUEOUS SAMPLES AND EXTRACTS FOR
             TOTAL  METALS  FOR ANALYSIS  BY  FLAA  OR  ICP  SPECTROSCOPY
1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

      1.1   This digestion  procedure  is used  for  the preparation  of aqueous
samples, EP and mobility-procedure extracts, and wastes that contain suspended
solids  for  analysis,   by  flame   atomic  absorption  spectroscopy  (FLAA)  or
inductively coupled argon plasma spectroscopy (ICP).  The procedure is used to
determine total metals.

      1.2   Samples prepared by Method 3010 may be analyzed by FLAA or ICP for
the following:

            Aluminum                      Magnesium
            *Arsenic                      Manganese
            Barium                        Molybdenum
            Beryllium                     Nickel
            Cadmium                       Potassium
            Calcium                       *Selenium
            Chromium                      Sodium
            Cobalt                        Thallium
            Copper                        Vanadium
            Iron                          Zinc
            Lead

      * Analysis by ICP

      NOTE: See Method 7760 for the digestion and FLAA analysis of Silver.

      1.3   This digestion procedure is not suitable for samples which will be
analyzed by graphite furnace atomic absorption spectroscopy  because hydrochloric
acid can cause interferences during furnace atomization.  Consult Method 3020A
for samples requiring graphite furnace analysis.


2.0   SUMMARY OF METHOD

      2.1   A mixture of nitric acid and the material to be  analyzed  is refluxed
in a covered Griffin beaker.  This step is repeated  with  additional portions of
nitric  acid until  the digestate  is  light  in  color or until  its  color has
stabilized.  After the  digestate has been brought to  a low volume,  it  is refluxed
with hydrochloric acid  and brought up to volume.   If sample should  go  to dryness,
it must be discarded and  the sample reprepared.


3.0   INTERFERENCES

      3.1   Interferences are discussed in the  referring analytical method.
                                   3010A - 1                      Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
4.0   APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

      4.1   Griffin beakers - 150-mL or equivalent.

      4.2   Watch glasses - Ribbed and plain or equivalent.

      4.3   Qualitative filter paper or centrifugation equipment.

      4.4   Graduated cylinder or equivalent - lOOmL.

      4.5   Funnel or equivalent.

      4.6   Hot plate or equivalent heating source - adjustable and capable of
maintaining a temperature of 90-95°C.


5.0   REAGENTS

      5.1   Reagent grade chemicals  shall be used in all tests. Unless otherwise
indicated, it is intended that  all reagents  shall conform to the specifications
of the Committee on Analytical  Reagents of the American Chemical Society, where
such specifications are  available.   Other grades may be used,  provided it is
first ascertained that the reagent is  of sufficiently high purity to permit its
use without lessening the accuracy of the determination.

      5.2   Reagent Water.   Reagent  water will  be  interference  free.   All
references  to  water  in  the method  refer to  reagent  water  unless  otherwise
specified.  Refer to Chapter One for a definition of reagent water.

      5.3   Nitric  acid   (concentrated),   HN03.    Acid  should  be  analyzed  to
determine levels of impurities.   If method blank is < MDL, the  acid  can be used,,

      5.4   Hydrochloric acid (1:1), HC1.  Prepared  from water and hydrochloric
acid.  Hydrochloric acid  should  be  analyzed to  determine  level  of impurities,,
If method blank is < MDL, the acid can be used.


6.0   SAMPLE COLLECTION,  PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

      6.1   All samples  must  have been collected  using  a  sampling  plan that
addresses the considerations discussed in Chapter Nine of this manual.

      6.2   All sample containers must be prewashed with detergents, acids, and
water.  Plastic and glass containers are both suitable.  See  Chapter Three, Step
3.1.3, for further information.

      6.3   Aqueous wastewaters must be acidified to a pH of < 2 with HN03.


7.0   PROCEDURE

      7.1   Transfer a 100-mL representative aliquot of the well-mixed sample to
a 150-mL Griffin beaker and add 3 mL  of concentrated HNO,.  Cover the beaker with
a  ribbed  watch glass  or  equivalent.   Place  the  beaker  on a  hot  plate  or

                                  3010A - 2                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
equivalent heating source and cautiously evaporate to a low volume (5 ml), making
certain that the sample does not boil and that no portion of the bottom of the
beaker is allowed to go dry.   Cool  the  beaker and add another 3-mL portion of
concentrated HNO,.   Cover the beaker with a nonribbed watch glass and return to
the hot plate.  Increase the temperature of the hot plate so that  a gentle reflux
action occurs.

      NOTE: If a sample is  allowed to go to dryness, low recoveries will result.
            Should this occur,  discard the sample and reprepare.

      7.2   Continue heating,  adding additional  acid  as  necessary,  until  the
digestion is complete (generally indicated when the digestate  is light in color
or does not change in appearance with continued refluxing).  Again, uncover the
beaker or use a  ribbed watch glass,  and  evaporate to  a low volume (3 ml),  not
allowing any portion of the bottom  of the beaker to  go dry.   Cool the beaker.
Add a  small  quantity of 1:1 HC1  (10 mL/100  mL of final  solution),  cover  the
beaker, and reflux for an additional  15 minutes to dissolve any precipitate or
residue resulting from evaporation.

      7.3   Wash down  the  beaker walls  and  watch glass with water  and,  when
necessary,  filter or  centrifuge the sample  to remove  silicates  and  other
insoluble material  that could clog the nebulizer.  Filtration should be done only
if there  is concern that  insoluble materials may clog  the  nebulizer.   This
additional step can cause sample contamination unless the filter and filtering
apparatus are thoroughly cleaned.   Rinse the filter  and  filter apparatus with
dilute nitric acid and discard  the  rinsate.   Filter  the  sample and adjust  the
final  volume to  100  ml with reagent water and the final  acid concentration to
10%.  The sample is now ready for analysis.


8.0   QUALITY CONTROL

      8.1   All  quality  control measures described  in Chapter One  should be
followed.

      8.2   For  each  analytical  batch of samples processed,  blanks  should be
carried throughout the entire sample-preparation  and analytical  process.  These
blanks will be useful in determining  if samples are being contaminated.  Refer
to Chapter One for the proper protocol when  analyzing blanks.

      8.3   Replicate  samples   should be processed  on  a routine  basis.    A
replicate sample is  a  sample brought through the whole sample preparation  and
analytical process.  A  replicate  sample should be  processed with  each analytical
batch or every 20 samples,  whichever  is greater.   Refer to Chapter One for the
proper protocol when analyzing replicates.

      8.4   Spiked samples  or standard reference materials should be employed to
determine  accuracy.   A spiked  sample should be  included with each  batch of
samples processed and whenever  a new sample matrix is  being analyzed.  Refer to
Chapter One for the proper protocol  when analyzing spikes.

      8.5   The method of standard addition shall  be used for the analysis of all
EP extracts and  delisting  petitions (see Method  7000, Step 8.7). Although  not
required, use of the method of standard addition is recommended for any sample

                                  3010A - 3                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
that is suspected of having an interference.


9.0   METHOD PERFORMANCE

      9.1   No data provided.


10.0  REFERENCES

1.    Rohrbough, W.G.;  et  al.  Reagent Chemicals.  American Chemical  Society
Specifications. 7th ed.; American Chemical  Society:  Washington, DC, 1986.

2.    1985 Annual Book of ASTM Standards. Vol.  11.01;  "Standard Specification for
Reagent Water"; ASTM: Philadelphia, PA, 1985; D1193-77.
                                  3010A  - 4                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
                         METHOD 3010A
    ACID  DIGESTION  OF AQUEOUS  SAMPLES  AND  EXTRACTS
FOR TOTAL METALS ANALYSIS  BY  FLAA OR  ICP  SPECTROSCOPY
                             Start
                       7.1 Transfer vampli
                       aliquot to baakar,
                       add concantratad
                            HNO.
                          7.1 Haat  to
                       avaporata to low
                       voluma, cool, and
                       add concantratad
                            HNO.
                          7.1 Rahaat,
                          incraaca
                        taaparatura to
                         craata gantla
                         raflux action
                         7.2 Haat to
                      conplata digaation,
                         avaporata,add
                        HC1,warm  baakar
                         7.3 Filtar if
                         nacanary and
                         adjust voluaa
                           Mathodi
                           7000 or
                            6010
                          3010A  -  5
Revision 1
July 1992

-------
                                 METHOD 3015

                MICROWAVE ASSISTED ACID DIGESTION OF AQUEOUS
                            SAMPLES AND EXTRACTS
1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

        1.1   This  digestion procedure is used for the  preparation  of aqueous
samples, mobility-procedure extracts, and wastes that contain suspended solids
for analysis, by flame atomic absorption spectroscopy (FLAA), graphite furnace
absorption spectroscopy (GFAA),  inductively  coupled  argon  plasma spectroscopy
(ICP),  or  inductively coupled argon  plasma  mass spectrometry  (ICP-MS).   The
procedure is  a hot acid leach for  determining  available metals.  Due to the rapid
advances  in   microwave  technology,  consult   your  manufacturer's  recommended
instructions for guidance on their microwave digestion system and refer to the
SW-846  "DISCLAIMER" when conducting analyses using Method 3015.

        1.2   Samples prepared by Method 3015  using  nitric acid digestion may be
analyzed by FLAA, GFAA, ICP-AES,  or ICP-MS for the following:

                          Aluminum             Lead
                          Antimony             Magnesium
                          Arsenic*             Manganese
                          Barium               Molybdenum
                          Beryllium            Nickel
                          Cadmium              Potassium
                          Calcium              Selenium*
                          Chromium             Silver
                          Cobalt               Sodium
                          Copper               Thallium
                          Iron                 Vanadium
                                               Zinc


                          *Cannot be  analyzed by FLAA

2.0   SUMMARY  OF  METHOD

         2.1    A  representative 45 mL aqueous sample  is  digested  in  5 mL of
concentrated  nitric acid in a fluorocarbon (PFA or TFM)  digestion vessel  for 20
minutes using microwave heating.  After  the digestion  process, the sample is
cooled, and  then filtered,  centrifuged, or allowed to settle in a clean  sample
bottle  prior  to  analysis.

3.0   INTERFERENCES

         3.1    Many samples that contain  organics, such as TCLP extracts,  will
result  in  higher vessel pressures which  have the potential to  cause venting of
the vessels.  Venting can result  in either loss of analytes and/or sample, which
must  be avoided.  A  smaller sample size  can  be  used  but the  final water volume

                                   3015  - 1                       Revision 0
                                                                  September 1994

-------
prior to nitric acid addition must remain  at  45 ml.  This is required to retain
the heat characteristics of the calibration procedure.  Limits of quantitation
will change with sample quantity (dilution) as with instrumentation."

4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

        4.1  Microwave  apparatus requirements

              4.1.1   The  microwave  unit  provides  programmable power  with  a
        minimum  of 574 W,  which  can be  programmed to within  +  10 W  of the
        required  power.   Typical  units provide a  nominal  600 W to  1200  W of
        power.   Temperature monitoring  and control of the microwave unit are
        desirable.

              4.1.2   The  microwave  unit  cavity   is  corrosion resistant  and
        well ventilated.

              4.1.3  All electronics are  protected against corrosion for  safe
        operation.

              4.1.4  The system requires  fluorocarbon (PFA or  TFM)  digestion
        vessels  (120 mL capacity) capable of withstanding pressures  up  to 7.5
        ± 0.7 atm (110 ± 10 psig)  and capable of controlled pressure relief at
        pressures exceeding 7.5 ± 0.7 atm (110 ±  10 psig).

              4.1.5  A  rotating turntable is  employed to insure  homogeneous
        distribution of microwave  radiation within  the unit.   The  speed  of the
        turntable should be a minimum of 3 rpm.

              CAUTION:  Those laboratories  now using or contemplating the  use of
              kitchen type microwave ovens for this method should  be aware of
              several significant safety  issues.  First,  when  an acid such as
              nitric is used to assist sample digestion  in microwave units in
              open vessels, or sealed vessels equipped with venting  features,
              there is the  potential for the acid  gases released to  corrode the
              safety devices that prevent the microwave magnetron from shutting
              off when the  door is opened.  This can  result in operator exposure
              to microwave  energy. Use of a unit with corrosion  resistant  safety
              devices prevents this  from occurring.

              CAUTION:  The  second  safety concern  relates to the use  of  sealed
              containers without pressure  relief valves  in the  unit.  Tempera-
              ture is the important variable controlling the reaction.   Pressure
              is needed  to  attain elevated temperatures but must be  safely  con-
              tained.  However, many digestion vessels  constructed from certain
              fluorocarbons may crack,  burst,  or  explode  in   the  oven  under
              certain pressures.     Only  unlined  fluorocarbon (PFA  or  TFM)
              containers with pressure  relief  mechanisms or  containers with
              fluorocarbon  (PFA  or TFM)  liners  and  pressure relief mechanisms
              are considered acceptable  at present.


                                  3015 - 2                       Revision  0
                                                                 September  1994

-------
              Users are therefore  advised not to  use  kitchen type  microwave
              ovens or to  use sealed containers without pressure  relief valves
              for microwave acid digestions by this method.   Use  of  laboratory
              grade microwave equipment is required to  prevent safety hazards.
              For further information consult reference 1.

              CAUTION:  In  addition,  there are  many  safety  and operational
              recommendations specific  to the model and  manufacturer  of  the
              microwave equipment   used  in  individual  laboratories.    These
              specific  suggestions  are beyond the scope of  this method  and
              require  the  analyst  to consult  the  specific equipment  manual,
              manufacturer and literature for proper and safe operation of the
              microwave equipment and vessels.

        4.2  Volumetric graduated cylinder, 50 or  100 ml capacity or equivalent.

        4.3  Filter paper, qualitative or equivalent.

        4.4  Analytical balance, 300 g capacity,  minimum accuracy ±  0.01 g.

        4.5  Filter funnel, glass or disposable polypropylene.

5.0  REAGENTS

        5.1   Reagent  grade  chemicals  shall  be used  in all  tests.   Unless
otherwise indicated,  it is  intended  that all reagents  shall conform  to  the
specifications of the  Committee  on Analytical Reagents of the American Chemical
Society, where such specifications  are available.    Other grades may be used,
provided it is first ascertained that the reagent  is of  sufficiently high purity
to permit its use without lessening the accuracy  of the determination.  If the
purity of a reagent is questionable, analyze the reagent to determine the level
of impurities.   The reagent blank must be less than  the  MDL in  order to be used.

        5.2   Reagent  Water.  Reagent  water shall  be  interference  free.   All
references to water in the method refer to reagent  water  unless  otherwise  specif-
ied (Ref. 2).

        5.3   Concentrated  nitric  acid,  HNO,.   Acid   should be analyzed to
determine levels of impurities.   If the method blank is less than the MDL, the
acid can be used.

6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

         6.1   All samples must have  been  collected using  a  sampling plan  that
addresses the considerations discussed in Chapter  Nine of this manual.

         6.2  All sample containers must be prewashed with detergents,  acids, and
water.  Plastic  containers are preferable.  See Chapter Three, Step 3.1.3 of  this
manual, for further information.

         6.3   Aqueous  waste  waters must  be acidified to a  pH of < 2  with HN03.

                                    3015 - 3                       Revision 0
                                                                  September 1994

-------
7.0  PROCEDURE

        7.1  Calibration of Microwave Equipment

              NOTE;  If  the microwave unit  uses temperature feedback  control
              capable  of replicating the performance  specifications  of  the
              method, then the calibration procedure may be omitted.

              7.1.1  Measurement  of  the  available  power  for   heating   is
        evaluated so that absolute power  in watts may be transferred from  one
        microwave unit to another.  For cavity  type microwave  equipment, this
        is  accomplished  by measuring the  temperature  rise in  1  kg of  water
        exposed to microwave radiation for a fixed period of time.   The  analyst
        can relate power in watts to the  partial  power setting of the unit.  The
        calibration format required for laboratory microwave units  depends on
        the  type  of electronic  system  used  by the manufacturer to  provide
        partial microwave power.   Few  units have an accurate and precise linear
        relationship between percent power settings  and  absorbed power.   Where
        linear circuits have been  utilized, the calibration curve can be deter-
        mined  by  a  three-point  calibration  method (7.1.3),  otherwise,  the
        analyst must use the multiple point calibration  method  (7.1.2).

              7.1.2  The multiple point calibration  involves  the  measurement
        of absorbed power over a large range of power settings.   Typically,  for
        a 600 W unit,  the following  power  settings are measured; 100,99,98,97,
        95,90,80,70,60,50, and 40%  using  the procedure  described in  section
        7.1.4.   This data is clustered  about the customary working power  ranges.
        Nonlinearity has  been  commonly  encountered at  the upper  end  of  the
        calibration.    If  the unit's electronics are known to  have nonlinear
        deviations in  any region  of  proportional  power control,  it  will   be
        necessary to make a  set of  measurements  that  bracket  the  power to  be
        used.   The final  calibration point  should be  at the  partial power
        setting that  will  be used  in the test.   This setting should be checked
        periodically  to  evaluate  the  integrity of  the calibration.    If a
        significant change  is detected  (±10  W), then the  entire calibration
        should  be  reevaluated.

              7.1.3  The three-point calibration involves  the  measurement   of
        absorbed power  at  three different power settings.  Measure  the power at
        100% and  50% using  the   procedure  described  in  section  7.1.4,   and
        calculate  the power setting corresponding to the required power in watts
        specified   in  the procedure  from  the  (2-point)  line.    Measure   the
        absorbed power at that partial  power setting.  If the measured absorbed
        power does not  correspond  to the specified power within ±10 W, use  the
        multiple point  calibration in  7.1.2.  This point should also be  used to
        periodically  verify the integrity  of the calibration.

             7.1.4  Equilibrate  a large volume of water to  room temperature
        (23  ±2 °C).   One kg of reagent water is weighed  (1,000.0 g ± 0.1   g)
        into a  fluorocarbon  (PFA or TFM) beaker or a beaker made of some other
        material  that does  not  significantly  absorb microwave  energy  (glass

                                  3015 - 4                       Revision 0
                                                                 September 1994

-------
absorbs  microwave  energy  and   is  not  recommended).    The  initial
temperature of the water should be 23 ± 2 °C measured to ± 0.05 °C.  The
covered beaker is  circulated continuously  (in  the  normal  sample path)
through the microwave field for 2 minutes at the desired partial power
setting with  the  unit's exhaust  fan on maximum  (as  it will  be  during
normal  operation).   The  beaker  is removed  and the  water  vigorously
stirred.   Use  a  magnetic stirring  bar  inserted  immediately  after
microwave  irradiation  and record the  maximum temperature within  the
first 30 seconds  to  ±  0.05 °C.   Use a new  sample  for each  additional
measurement.  If the water is reused both the water and the beaker must
have returned to  23  ±  2 "C.  Three  measurements at each  power setting
should  be made.

The absorbed  power is determined by the following  relationship

                     P • (K) (Cp)  (m)  (AT)

Eq. 1


Where:

P  =  the  apparent  power  absorbed  by  the  sample  in  watts  (W).
(W=joule-sec  )

K  =  the conversion  factor  for  thermochemical  calories-sec"1  to watts
(=4.184)

C  = the heat capacity, thermal  capacity, or specific heat
(cal-g'1"C"1), of water

m  - the mass  of the  water  sample  in grams  (g)

AT =  the final temperature  minus  the  initial temperature  (°C)

t  = the time  in seconds (s)

Using  the  experimental conditions of 2 minutes  and 1 kg of distilled
water  (heat  capacity at 25 eC  is  0.9997 cal-g" -'C'1) the calibration
equation simplifies  to:

                        P =  (AT) (34.86)

       NOTE: Stable line voltage is necessary for accurate and reproduc-
       ible calibration  and operation.  The line voltage should be within
       manufacturer's specification, and during measurement and operation
       not  vary by  more than ±2  V.  A  constant  power  supply  may be
       necessary for  microwave use if the source  of the line voltage is
       unstable.
                           3015  - 5                       Revision 0
                                                          September 1994

-------
         Electronic components  in most microwave units are matched to the  units'
         function and output.   When  any  part of the high  voltage  circuit, power
         source,   or  control  components in  the  unit  have  been  serviced or
         replaced, it will be necessary to recheck the units' calibration  power.
         If the power output has changed significantly  (±10 W), then  the  entire
         calibration should  be  reevaluated.

         7.2  All digestion  vessels  and volumetric ware must be  carefully  acid
washed  and rinsed  with  reagent water.   When  switching between  high  solids
(concentrated) samples and low solids  (low concentration)  samples all digestion
vesselsoshould be cleaned by leaching  with hot (1:1)  hydrochloric acid  (greater
than 80 C, but less than boiling)  for a minimum of two hours followed with hot
(1:1) nitric acid (greater than 80°C, but less than boiling) for a  minimum  of two
hours,  rinsed with  reagent water,  and  dried  in a  clean environment.   This
cleaning procedure should also be used whenever the prior use of the digestion
vessels is unknown or cross  contamination from vessels  is  suspected.  Polymeric
or glass volumetric  ware  and storage  containers  should be cleaned by leaching
with more  dilute acids  (approximately  10%  V/V)  appropriate for the specific
plastics used and then rinsed  with reagent water and dried in a clean environ-
ment.   In  addition,  to avoid precipitation of silver,  ensure  that all  HC1  has
been rinsed from the vessels.

         7.3   Sample  Digestion

               7.3.1   Weigh the fluorocarbon (PFA or TFM) digestion vessel, valve
         and cap  assembly  to 0.01 g  prior to use.

               7.3.2   A 45 ml aliquot  of a well shaken  sample  is  measured in a
        graduated  cylinder.  This aliquot is poured  into the  digestion vessel
        with  the  number of the vessel recorded on the preparation sheet.

               7.3.3  A blank  sample of reagent water  is treated in the same
        manner along with spikes and duplicates.

               7.3.4  Add  5 ml of concentrated nitric acid to each  vessel that
        will  be used.  Check to make sure the  pressure  relief disks  are in  the
        caps  with  the  smooth  side toward the  sample and  start the  caps  a  few
        turns on the vessels.  Finish tightening the caps in the capping  station
        which will tighten them to a uniform torque pressure of  12 ft-lbs.
        (16 N-m)  or to the manufacturers recommended specifications.  Weigh each
        capped vessel to the nearest 0.01 g.

              CAUTION: Toxic nitrogen  oxide fumes may be evolved,  therefore  all
              work must be performed in a properly operating ventilation  system.
              The analyst should also be aware of the potential for  a vigorous
              reaction.   If a  vigorous  reaction  occurs,  allow to cool  before
              capping the vessel.

              7.3.5  Evenly distributed the vessels  in the carousel  according
        to the manufacturer's  recommended specifications.   Blanks are  treated
        as samples for the  purpose  of balancing  the  power input.   When  fewer

                                  3015  - 6                        Revision  0
                                                                  September 1994

-------
than the  recommended number  of samples are  digested,  the  remaining
vessels should be filled with  45 ml of reagent water and 5 ml of nitric
acid to achieve the full compliment of vessels.  This provides an energy
balance since the microwave  power absorbed is proportional to the total
mass in the cavity (Ref. 1).

      7.3.6  Program the microwave unit according to the manufacturer's
recommended specifications  and, if used, connect  the  pressure vessels
to the central overflow vessel with PFA-fluorocarbon tubes.  The chosen
sequence will  bring  the  samples to 160°C ±  48C  in 10  minutes and will
permit a slow rise to 165-170  °C during the second 10 minutes (Ref. 3).
Start the turntable  motor and be sure the vent  fan  is running on high
and the turntable is turning.   Start the microwave generator.

               7.3.6.1    Newer microwave units  are  capable  of higher
      power  that permit digestion of a  larger number  of  samples per
      batch.   If the analyst  wishes  to  digest  more  samples at a time,
      the  analyst may  use  different power settings  as long  as they
      result  in  the same time  and temperature conditions  defined in
      7.3.6.  That is,  any sequence of power that  brings the samples to
       160°C  ± 4°C in 10 minutes and permits a  slow  rise to 165-170°C
      during  the second  10  minutes (Ref. 2).

       Issues  of  safety,  structural   integrity  (both  temperature and
       pressure  limitations),  heat  loss,   chemical  compatibility,
      microwave  absorption of vessel material, and energy transport will
       be  considerations made  in choosing alternative vessels.   If all
       of  the  considerations are met and the appropriate power  settings
       are provided  to  reproduce the  reaction conditions  defined in
       7.3.6,  then these alternative  vessels may be  used (Ref.  1,3)

       7.3.7   At  the end of the microwave  program,  allow the vessels
 to cool for  at  least  5 minutes  in  the unit before  removal  to  avoid
 possible  injury  if a vessel vents  immediately after microwave  heating.
 The samples may  be cooled outside the unit by  removing the  carousel and
 allowing  the samples to  cool  on the bench or in a water bath.   When the
 vessels have  cooled  to room temperature, weigh and record the weight of
 each vessel  assembly.    If the weight  of  the sample plus  acid has
 decreased by more than 10% discard the  sample.

       7.3.8  Complete   the  preparation  of  the  sample  by  carefully
 uncapping and venting  each  vessel  in  a  fume hood.  Transfer the  sample
 to an  acid-cleaned   bottle.   If the  digested  sample contains  par-
 ticulates which  may clog nebulizers  or  interfere  with injection  of the
 sample into the instrument, the sample may be  centrifuged,  allowed to
 settle or filtered.

           7.3.8.1   Centrifugation:   Centrifugation at  2,000-3,000 rpm
       for 10 minutes is usually sufficient  to clear the supernatant.
                            3015 -  7                        Revision 0
                                                           September 1994

-------
                   7.3.8.2    Settling:    Allow  the  sample  to  stand  until  the
               supernatant is clear.   Allowing  a  sample to  stand  overnight will
               usually accomplish this.   If it does not, centrifuge or filter the
               sample.

                   7.3.8.3   Filtering: The  filtering  apparatus  must be
               thoroughly cleaned and prerinsed with dilute  (approximately 10%
               V/V) nitric acid.   Filter the  sample  through   qualitative  filter
               paper into a second acid-cleaned container.

               7.3.9  The concentration  values obtained from analysis must  be
         corrected for the dilution factor from  the acid addition.  If  the  sample
         will   be  analyzed  by ICP-MS  additional  dilution  will  generally  be
         necessary.  For example, the sample may be diluted by a factor  of  20
         with  reagent water and the acid strength adjusted  back to 10%  prior  to
         analysis.  The  dilutions used should be recorded and the measured con-
         centrations adjusted accordingly (e.g., for  a  45 ml  sample and 5  ml  of
         acid  the  correction factor  is  1.11).

8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

         8.1   All   quality  control measures described  in Chapter  One,  of  this
Manual, should be  followed.

         8.2  For each analytical  batch of samples processed, analytical reagent
blanks (also field blanks if they were taken) should be carried throughout the
entire sample preparation and analytical process.  These blanks will  be useful
in determining if  samples are being contaminated.

         8.3   Duplicate  samples  should  be  processed on a  routine  basis.   A
duplicate sample is a real sample brought through the whole sample preparation
and  analytical  process.   A duplicate  sample  should  be  processed  with each
analytical batch or every 20 samples, whichever is  the greater number.

         8.4  Spiked  samples or standard  reference materials should be employed
to determine accuracy.  A  spiked sample  should be  included with each group of
samples processed and whenever a  new sample matrix  is being analyzed.

9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

         9.1    Refer  to  Table  1 for a summary of performance data.
                                   3015 -  8                       Revision 0
                                                                  September 1994

-------
10.0  REFERENCES

1.       Introduction  to Microwave  Sample  Preparation:  Theory  and  Practice,
         Kingston,  H.  M.; Jassie,  L.  B.,  Eds.;  ACS Professional Reference Book
         Series: American Chemical Society,  Washington, DC,  1988;  Ch  6  & 11.

2.       1985 Annual Book of ASTM Standards,  Vol.  11.01; "Standard Specification
         for Reagent Water";  ASTM: Philadelphia,  PA,  1985;  D1193-77.

3.       Kingston,  H.  M.,  Final  Report EPA IAG #DWI3932541-01-I, September 30,
         1988,  Appendix  A.

4.       Shannon,  M.,  Alternate  Test  Procedure  Application,  USEPA Region Y,
         Central Regional  Laboratory,  536 S.  Clark Street,  Chicago,  IL  60606,
         1989.

5.       Kingston,  H.  M.,  Walter,   P.   J.,  "Comparison  of  Microwave  Versus
         Conventional  Dissolution for Environmental Applications ,  Spectroscopy,
         vol.  7 No. 9,20-27,1992.

6        Sosinski,  P., and Sze C., "Absolute Accuracy Study,  Microwave Digestion
         Method 3015  (Nitric  acid  only)";  EPA  Region  III  Central  Regional
         Laboratory,  1991.
                                    3015 - 9                       Revision 0
                                                                   September 1994

-------
                      TABLE 1
MICROWAVE DIGESTION METHOD  3015  (Nitric Acid Only)
Ele*
Al
Al
Al
Al
Ba
Ba
Ba
Cd
Cd
Cd
Cd
Zn
Zn
Zn
Zn
As
As
Co
Co
K
K
Ni
Ni
Ni
Pb
Pb
Pb
Pb
Sb
Sb
Se
Se
Tl
Tl
V
V
Be
Be
Ca
Ca
Material
Tm-11
Tm-12
T-107
T-109
Tm-11
Tm-12
T-107
Tm-11
Tm-12
T-107
T-109
Tm-11
Tm-12
T-107
T-109
T-107
T-109
Tm-11
Tm-12
T-95
T-109
Tm-11
Tm-12
T-109
Tm-11
Tm-12
T-107
T-109
WP980-1
WP980-2
T-95
T-107
UP980-1
UP980-2
Tm-11
Tm-12
T-107
T-109
T-107
T-109
Certified
Mean
510.0
2687.0
220.0
113.0
450.0
2529.0
192.0
40.8
237.0
14.3
12.1
55.4
314.0
75.8
74.0
10.8
8.15
227.0
1067.0
4700.0
2330.0
264.0
1234.0
57.0
275.0
1326.0
26.0
34.9
16.9
101.5
60.1
11.0
50.0
6.3
491.0
2319.0
11.0
22.1
11700.0
35400.0
Observed
Mean
485.5
2770.6
213.5
117.7
441.4
2431.4
196.6
44.6
242.3
12.4
10.3
55.9
316.5
81.6
69.9
12.8
90.6
242.6
1153.3
5080.3
2601.5
284.3
1293.0
60.8
275.9
1359.0
30.0
39.3
18.3
108.9
65.9
13.0
55.1
7.0
532.6
2412.8
11.3
25.6
12364.0
38885.0
Std. Dev.
26.3
88.2
19.3
30.6
23.4
70.3
15.9
2.1
8
0.9
1.7
2.6
8.9
3.3
4.1
0.84
11.0
14.1
35.9
784
383.4
16.5
39.4
3.09
32.2
35.0
0.2
1.2
0.47
34.4
2.6
0.9
2
0.52
26.1
60.6
0.53
0.91
783.6
999
Relative
Standard
5.4
3.2
9.0
2.6
5.3
2 9
8.1
4.7
3.3
7.2
16.5
4.6
2.8
4.0
5.8
6.5
12.2
5.8
3.1
15.4
14.7
5.8
3.0
5.0
11.7
2.6
0.66
3.0
2.6
31.6
3.94
6.9
3.6
7.4
4.9
2.5
4.7
3.6
6.3
2.6
Relative
Bias
-4. 80%
3.11%

4.16%
-1.90%
-3.86%
2.44%
9.46%
2.25%
-12.94%
-14.55%
1.06%
0.82%
7.68%
-5.46%
19.26%
11.26%
6.90%
8.09%
8.09%
11.65%
7.71%
4.79%
6.72%
0.36%
2.49%
15.65%
12.69%
8.27%
7.33%
9.77%
19.00%
10.26%
11.66%
8.48%
4.05%
3.00%
15.97%
5.68%
9.84%
                    3015 - 10
Revision 0
September 1994

-------
TABLE 1 (continued)
El em

P
_Mg 	

Mg
Na
Na

Cr
Cr

Cr
Cu
Cu
Cu

Fe
Fe
Fe
Fe
Mn
Mn
Mn

Ag
Material
T-107
T-109
T-95
T-107
T-109
T-95
T-107
T-109
Tm-11
Tm-12
T-107
T-109
Tm-11
Tm-12
T-107
T-109
Tm-11
Tm-12
T-107
T-109
Tm-11
Tm-12
T-107
T-109
WS378-1
Certified
Mean
11700.0
35400.0
32800.0
2100.0
9310.0
190000.0
20700.0
12000.0
52.1
299.0
13.0
18.7
46.3
288.0
30.0
21.4
249.0
1089.0
52.0
106.0
46.0
263.0
45.0
34.0
46.0
Observed
Mean
12364.0
38885.0
35002.0
2246.7
10221.7
218130.0
22528.0
13799.5
64.3
346.0
22.3
32.6
76.5
324.0
42.3
54.0
289.3
1182.5
63.8
134.0
60.9
304.4
52.6
46.6
19.4
Std. Dev.
783.6
999
1900
110.5
218.6
10700
1060
516.2
4.1
9.8
1.5
6.4
4.4
8.9
4.0
3.6
16.4
43.5
8.7
6.6
3.2
9.1
3.1
3.0
5.6
Relative
Standard
Deviation
6.3
2.6
5.4
4.9
2.1
4.9
4.7
3.7
6.4
2.8
6.7
19.6
5.7
2.7
9.4
6.7
5.7
3.7
13.6
4.9
5.2
3.0
5.9
6.4
2.9
Relative
Bias
5.68%
9.84%
6.71%
6.99%
9.79%
14.81%
8.83%
15.00%
23.51%
15.74%
71.77%
74.71%
65.36%
12.52%
41.17%
152.38%
16.18%
8.59%
22 . 69%
26.50%
32.48%
15.77%
17.09%
37.18%
-57.83%
       3015 -  11
Revision 0
Septeirter 1994

-------
                                       METHOD  3015
MICROWAVE  ASSISTED  ACID  DIGESTION  OF  AQUEOUS  SAMPLES AND EXTRACTS
              7.1 Calibrate
             tho mierowava
               oquipmant.
              7.2 AeM waa
              and Hf> rinaa
              •II dlgaatian
               gtaaawara.
7.32 Maaouro
46 ml aliquot
   Into tho
  dl«aotlan
7.1.3 Uaa blank
  aamplao of
 roagont HJp In
 othar ««Mtlon
                                        7.3.4 Add
                                      oonoontratad
                                      HNOata
                                         vocool.
                                       7.3.1 Plaoa
                                      oarouoal; uoo
                                    blank* If noeaaaarv
                                    to aalanoa powor.
                                       7.3.6 Plooo
                                       tho oarouool
                                       in ovon, naat
                                       •ooordlna. to
                                      powor program.
                                       7.3.7 Allow
                                       •amploo to
                                       oool •» thoy
                                       aro not not
                                        to touch.
                                       7.3.t Plaoo
                                        •amplo in
                                       •cid-e loaned
                                         bonlo.
                                             7.3.S - 7 S.8.3
                                               Contrlfugo.
                                               •ottlo. and
                                              flrtor aampla.
                                                             7.3.9 Corraot
                                                             aanoont ration
                                                              vakiM for
                                                              tho dilution
                                                                factor.
                                      3015  -  12
                                               Revision 0
                                               September  1994

-------
                                 METHOD 3020A

                ACID DIGESTION OF AQUEOUS SAMPLES AND EXTRACTS
              FOR TOTAL METALS FOR ANALYSIS BY GFAA SPECTROSCOPY


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

      1.1   This digestion  procedure  is used  for the preparation  of  aqueous
samples, mobility-procedure extracts,  and wastes that contain suspended solids
for analysis  by  furnace atomic absorption spectroscopy  (GFAA)  for  the metals
listed below.  The procedure is used to  determine  the total amount of the metal
in the sample.

      1.2   Samples prepared  by Method 3020 may  be analyzed by GFAA  for the
following metals:

            Beryllium                     Lead
            Cadmium                       Molybdenum
            Chromium                      Thallium
            Cobalt                        Vanadium

      NOTE: For  the digestion and GFAA analysis  of arsenic  and selenium, see
            Methods 7060 and  7740.   For  the  digestion  and  GFAA  analysis of
            silver, see  Method  7761.


2.0  SUMMARY  OF  METHOD

      2.1   A mixture of nitric acid and the material to be analyzed  is  refluxed
in a covered  Griffin beaker.  This step is  repeated with  additional  portions of
nitric  acid  until  the  digestate  is  light  in color  or until   its color has
stabilized.   After the digestate has been brought to a low volume, it is cooled
and brought  up  in  dilute nitric acid  such that the final dilution  contains 3%
(v/v) nitric  acid.   This percentage will  vary depending on the amount of  acid
used to complete the digestion.  If the sample contains suspended solids, it must
be centrifuged,  filtered,  or  allowed  to settle.


3.0   INTERFERENCES

      3.1    Interferences  are discussed in the referring analytical method.


4.0   APPARATUS  AND  MATERIALS

      4.1    Griffin  beakers - 150-mL,  or  equivalent.

      4.2    Watch  glasses  - ribbed or equivalent.


                                   3020A - 1                      Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
       4.3    Qualitative  filter  paper  or  centrifugation equipment.

       4.4    Funnel  or  equivalent.

       4.5    Graduated  Cylinder  -  lOOmL.

       4.6    Electric  hot  plate  or  equivalent  -  adjustable  and  capable  of
maintaining  a  temperature  of  90-95°C.


5.0  REAGENTS

       5.1    Reagent grade chemicals shall be used in all  tests.  Unless otherwise
indicated, it  is intended that all reagents shall conform  to the specifications
of the Committee on Analytical Reagents of the  American Chemical Society, where
such specifications are available. Other grades may  be used, provided it  is first
ascertained  that the reagent  is of sufficiently high  purity to permit its use
without lessening the  accuracy  of the determination.

       5.2    Reagent  Water.  Reagent  water  will be  interference  free.    All
references  to  water in  the  method  refer to  reagent  water  unless otherwise
specified.   Refer to Chapter  One for a definition of reagent water.

       5.3    Nitric  acid   (concentrated),  HN03.   Acid  should  be  analyzed  to
determine levels of impurities.   If method blank is  < MDL,  the  acid  can  be used.


6.0  SAMPLE  COLLECTION, PRESERVATION,  AND HANDLING

      6.1    All  samples  must have been  collected  using  a  sampling plan that
addresses the  considerations  discussed in Chapter Nine of this manual.

      6.2    All sample  containers must be prewashed with detergents, acids, and
water.   Plastic and  glass containers are both suitable.  See Chapter Three, Step
3.1.3,  for further information.

      6.3   Aqueous wastewaters must be acidified to a pH of < 2 with HN03.


7.0  PROCEDURE

      7.1   Transfer a  100-mL  representative aliquot of the well-mixed sample to
a 150-mL Griffin  beaker and add 3 mL of concentrated HNO,.   Cover the beaker with
a ribbed watch  glass.   Place  the beaker on a hot plate and cautiously evaporate
to a  low volume (5 mL),  making certain  that the  sample does not  boil  and that no
portion of the bottom of the beaker is allowed  to go dry.   Cool the beaker and
add another  3-mL portion  of  concentrated HN03.   Cover the beaker  with a non-
ribbed  watch  glass and  return  to the hot plate.   Increase the temperature of the
hot plate so that a  gentle reflux action occurs.


                                  3020A  - 2                       Revision 1
                                                                  July  1992

-------
      7.2   Continue heating,  adding  additional  acid as  necessary,  until  the
digestion is complete (generally indicated  when the digestate is light in color
or does not  change  in appearance with continued refluxing). When the  digestion
is complete, evaporate  to  a low volume (3 ml); use  a ribbed watch glass,  not
allowing any portion of the bottom of the beaker to go dry.  Remove the beaker
and add approximately 10 ml of water,  mix,  and continue warming the beaker for
10 to 15 minutes to allow additional sol utilization of any residue to occur.

      7.3   Remove the beaker from the hot  plate and  wash  down the beaker walls
and watch glass with water.   When  necessary, filter or centrifuge the sample to
remove silicates and other  insoluble material  that may interfere with injecting
the sample into the graphite atomizer.  (This additional step can cause sample
contamination unless the filter and filtering apparatus are thoroughly cleaned
and prerinsed  with dilute  HN03.)   Adjust  to  the  final  volume of  100  ml with
water.  The sample is now ready for analysis.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

      8.1   All quality control  measures  described  in  Chapter One  should be
followed.

      8.2   For each batch  of samples processed, method blanks should be carried
throughout the entire sample preparation and analytical  process.   These blanks
will  be  useful in  determining if samples  are  being contaminated.   Refer to
Chapter One for the proper protocol when analyzing blanks.

      8.3   Replicate samples should be  processed on a routine basis.  Replicate
samples  will  be used to determine precision.  The  sample load  will  dictate
frequency, but 5% is recommended.   Refer to Chapter One  for the proper protocol
when analyzing replicates.

      8.4   Spiked samples  or standard reference materials should be employed to
determine accuracy.   A  spiked sample  should  be  included with each  batch of
samples  processed  or 5% and whenever  a new sample  matrix  is  being analyzed.
Refer to Chapter One for the proper protocol when analyzing spikes.

      8.5   The concentration  of  all  calibration  standards should be verified
against a quality control check sample  obtained from an outside source.  Refer
to Chapter One for the  proper  protocol.

      8.6   The method of standard addition shall be used for the analysis  of all
EP extracts.  See Method 7000, Step 8.7, for further information.


9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

      9.1   No data provided.
                                   3020A -  3                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
10.0  REFERENCES

1.     Rohrbough, W.G.;  et  al.  Reagent Chemicals.  American Chemical  Society
Specifications. 7th ed.; American Chemical  Society:  Washington,  DC, 1986.

2.     1985 Annual Book of ASTM Standards. Vol. 11.01;  "Standard Specification for
Reagent Water"; ASTM: Philadelphia,  PA, 1985; D1193-77.
                                  3020A  - 4                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
                       METHOD  3020A
  ACID  DIGESTION FOR  AQUEOUS  SAMPLES AND EXTRACTS
FOR  TOTAL METALS  FOR ANALYSIS BY GFAA SPECTROSCOPY
                          Start
                     7.1 Put sample
                       aliquot in
                       beaker,add
                      concentrated
                    HMO*,evaporate to
                       low volume
                    7.1 Cool beaker,add
                      concentrated
                     KNO,,heat until
                      gentle reflux
                      action occur*
                       7.2 Heat to
                   complete digestion,
                    evaporate to low
                       volume,cool
                     7.2 Add reagent
                      water,warm to
                      dissolve any
                     precipitate or
                         residue
                      7.3  Filter or
                      centrifuge if
                      necessary and
                      adjust volume
                         3020A -  5
Revision  1
July 1992

-------
                                 METHOD 3040

              DISSOLUTION PROCEDURE FOR OILS,  GREASES.  OR WAXES


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  Method 3040 is used for  the preparation of samples containing oils,
greases, or waxes  for  analysis  by  atomic  absorption spectroscopy (AAS) or
inductively coupled argon plasma emission spectroscopy (ICP) for the following
metals:


                 Antimony                    Iron
                 Beryllium                   Manganese
                 Cadmium                     Nickel
                 Chromium                    Vanadium
                 Copper


      1.2   This method  is  a   solvent   dissolution  procedure,  not a digestion
procedure.  This procedure can  be   very  useful  1n  the  analysis of crude  oil,
but  with  spent or  used oil high in particulate material  1t  1s less effective;
most particulate material 1s  not dissolved,   and therefore the analysis  is not
a  "total"  metal determination.   Because  the  highest percentage of metals  1s
expected  to be  contained  1n  the particulate  material,   oil analysis using
Method 3040   will   not  provide an  adequate estimate   of   the  total  metals
concentration.


2.0   SUMMARY  OF METHOD

      2.1   A representative   sample  is  dissolved  in  an  appropriate solvent
 (e.g., xylene  or  methyl   isobutyl  ketone).    Organometal11c  standards are
 prepared  using the same solvent, and the samples and standards are  analyzed by
 AAS or ICP.

 3.0   INTERFERENCES

       3.1  Diluted  samples   and  diluted  organometalUc  standards  are often
 unstable.  Once standards and  samples  are diluted, they should be analyzed as
 soon  as possible.

       3.2  Solvent  blanks  should  be  used  to  rinse   nebulizers  thoroughly
 following aspiration  of high concentration standards  or samples.

       3.3  Viscosity   differences   can result  1n   different rates  of sample
 introduction; therefore, all  analyses  shall  be   performed by the method of
 standard  addition.    Peristaltic   pumps  often  prove  useful when analysis is
 performed by ICP.
                                    3040 - 1
                                                           Revision
                                                           Date  September 1986

-------
 4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

      4.1   Volumetric glassware.

      4.2   Balance.


 anri a4:Lhf°m1VbS£rp£10n  sPectrom*tftr:   With  an auxiliary oxidant  control
 and a mechanism for background correction.

      4:4   Inductively coupled argon plasma emission spectrometer system-  With
 a   mechanismforbackground   correctionand  Interelement  Interference
 correction.   A peristaltic pump  is optional.                      mterrerence


 5.0  REAGENTS

      5.1   Methyl  isobutyl ketone  (MIBK).

      5.2   Xylene.

 m  <  f'3   Organometa111c  standards    (two   possible   sources  are  Conostan
 Division,  Conoco  Speciality  Products,  Inc.,  P.O.  Box  1267  Ponra ntv  M
 7Afifi1  anrl 4- h  11 C    r\                 *••%*• f  i • w •  UUA  lc.u/ | rUilv-d vl tV • Ul\
 WashJng?Sl  Sc 20234).  ^^  °f  C°mmerCe'  Nat1onal Bureau of Standards,


 6.0  SAMPLE  COLLECTION. PRESERVATION. AND HANDLING

 aHHv.J'1   Ji1  samp^s  m**   have  been  collected  using  a sampling plan that
 addresses  the considerations discussed in Chapter Nine of this manual.

      6.2   Samples  shall be stored in an undiluted state at room temperature.

      6.3   Samples  should be processed and analyzed as soon as possible.


 7.0   PROCEDURE

      7.1   Weigh out a  2-g  representative  sample  of  the  waste or extract
Separate and  weigh the phases 1f more than one phase is present.       exiract-

      7.2  Weigh an aliquot of the organic  phase  and dilute the aliquot in the
appropriate solvent.  Warming  facilitates  the subsampling of crude-type oils
and greases and wax-type wastes.    Xylene is usually the preferred solvent for
longer-chain  hydrocarbons and for most analyses performed by ICP.   The lonqer-
chain hydrocarbons usually require a  minimum  of a 1:10 dilution,  and llqhtpr
oils may require only a 1:5 dilution if low detection  limits are  required.  "

     7-34.,All metals must be  analyzed  by  the  method of standard  addition-;.
Because the method of standard  additions   can  account  only for multiplicative
interferences  (matrix or physical   interferences),  the  analytical  program must
                                  3040 - 2
                                                         Revision
                                                         Date   September  1986

-------
account for additive Interference (nonspecific absorption and scattering 1n
MS  and  nonspecific  emission  and  1nterelement  Interference  1n  ICP)   by
employing background correction.

     7.4  Sample preparation  for  the  method  of  standard  additions can be
performed on a weight  or  volume  basis.    Sample allquots of viscous wastes
should be weighed.  Weigh  Identical  amounts  of  the sample Into three wide-
mouth vials.  Dilute the first vial such that the final concentration falls on
the lower end of the linear portion of the calibration curve and significantly
above the detection limit.  Add  sufficient  standard to the second aliquot to
Increase the sample  concentration  by  approximately  50%.   Adjust the third
sample concentration so that 1t  1s approximately twice that of the first.  The
second and third allquots are  then  diluted  to  the same final volume as the
first aliquot.

     7.5  Set up and calibrate the analytical Instrumentation according to the
manufacturer's directions for nonaqueous samples.

     7.6  Report data  as the weighted  average for all  sample phases.


8.0 QUALITY CONTROL

     8.1   Preparation  blanks  (e.g.,  Conostan   base   oil   or  mineral  oil  plus
 reagents)   should   be   carried   through  the complete  sample-preparation  and
 analytical  process on   a   routine   basis.     These   blanks will   be  useful  1n
 detecting  and determining  the magnitude  of any  sample contamination.

     8.2   Duplicate samples should be  processed on a routine  basis.   Duplicate
 samples  will be  used to determine  precision. The  sample load will  dictate the
 frequency,  but 20% 1s  recommended.

     8.3   Samples and  standards should  be  diluted   as  closely as possible to
 the time of analysis.

     8.4  All analyses must be performed  by the method  of standard additions.
 See Method 7000,  Section 8.7,  for further  Information.

     8.5  Data must be corrected  for  background absorption and emission and
 1nterelement Interferences.


 9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

      9.1  No data provided.


 10.0  REFERENCES

      10.1  None required.
                                   3040 - 3
                                                          Revision      0
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
                                        METHOD 3040

                     OISSOLUTION PROCEDURE FOR OILS.  GREASE.  OR  WAXES
!• more than
  on* phase
  prevent?
                          Separate  and
                          weigh phases
                                                                           7.4
                                                                                Weigh cample
                                                                                into 3 vials;
                                                                           dilute  ist vial:  add
                                                                           standard to 2nd vial
                                                                           to increase cone. by
                                                                           SOX;   adjust 3rd vial
                                                                           cone,  to twice the
                                                                         cone,  of the ist vial
 7.4
     I  Dilute
     second and
 third  aliquot*
 to same volume
     as first
       Weigh
      aliquot
    Of organic
 phase:  dilute
 with appropr.
     solvent
7.3
 7.51

       Set up
  and calibrate
    analytical
instrumentation
      Analyze
     metals by
     standard
     additions
      -method
                                                                             7.6
 Report date  as
   weighted
   average
                                                                           f     stop      J
                                   3040 - 4
                                                              Revision       0
                                                              Date  September  1986

-------
                                 METHOD 3050A

               ACID  DIGESTION OF SEDIMENTS,  SLUDGES, AND SOILS


1.0   SCOPE AND APPLICATION

      1.1   This method  is an acid digestion procedure used to prepare sediments,
sludges, and soil  samples  for  analysis by flame or  furnace  atomic absorption
spectroscopy (FLAA and GFAA, respectively)  or by inductively  coupled argon plasma
spectroscopy (ICP).  Samples prepared by this method may be analyzed by ICP for
all the listed metals, or by FLAA or GFAA as indicated below  (see also Step 2.1):

                         FLAA                               GFAA
            Aluminum                Magnesium               Arsenic
            Barium                  Manganese               Beryllium
            Beryllium               Molybdenum              Cadmium
            Cadmium                 Nickel                  Chromium
            Calcium                 Osmium                  Cobalt
            Chromium                Potassium               Iron
            Cobalt                  Silver                  Lead
            Copper                  Sodium                  Molybdenum
            Iron                    Thallium                Selenium
            Lead                    Vanadium                Thallium
                                    Zinc                    Vanadium

      NOTE: See Method 7760 for FLAA preparation for Silver.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

      2.1  A representative 1- to  2-g  (wet weight) sample is digested in nitric
acid and hydrogen peroxide.  The digestate is then refluxed with either nitric
acid or  hydrochloric acid.  Hydrochloric acid  is  used for  flame AA  and ICP
analyses and nitric acid is used for furnace AA work.  Dilute hydrochloric acid
is used as the final  reflux acid for (1)  the  ICP  analysis of As and Se, and (2)
the flame AA or ICP analysis of Ag, Al, Ba,  Be, Ca,  Cd, Co, Cr, Cu, Fe, K, Mg,
Mn, Mo, Na, Ni, Os,  Pb,  Tl,  V,  and Zn.   Dilute nitric acid is employed as the
final dilution acid for the furnace AA analysis of As, Be,  Cd, Cr, Co, Fe, Pb,
Mo, Se, Tl, and V.  The diluted samples have an approximate acid concentration
of  5.0%  (v/v).    A   separate  sample  shall  be  dried  for a  total  % solids
determination.
3.0  INTERFERENCES

      3.1   Sludge samples can contain diverse matrix types, each of which may
present its own analytical  challenge.   Spiked  samples  and any relevant standard
reference material should be  processed to aid in determining whether Method 3050
is applicable to  a given waste.
                                   3050A -  1                      Revision 1
                                                                 July 1992

-------
4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

      4.1   Conical Phillips beakers - 250-mL,  or equivalent.

      4.2   Watch glasses ribbed or equivalent.

      4.3   Drying ovens - That can be maintained at 30° C.

      4.4   Thermometer - That covers range of 0-200°C.

      4.5   Filter paper - Whatman No. 41 or equivalent.

      4.6   Centrifuge and centrifuge tubes.

      4.7   Analytical Balance - Capable of accurately weighing to the
nearest 0.01 g.

      4.8   Electric  Hot Plate  or  equivalent  -  Adjustable  and capable  of
maintaining a temperature of 90-95°C.

      4.9   Glass Funnel or equivalent.

      4.10  Graduated cylinder or equivalent.


5.0  REAGENTS

      5.1   Reagent grade chemicals shall be used in all  tests. Unless otherwise
indicated, it is intended that all  reagents  shall conform to  the specifications
of the Committee on Analytical  Reagents of the  American  Chemical Society, where
such specifications are  available. Other grades  may  be used, provided it  is first
ascertained that the  reagent  is  of sufficiently high  purity to permit its use
without lessening the accuracy of the determination.  If the  purity of a reagent
is questionable, analyze the reagent to determine the level  of impurities.  The
reagent blank must be less than the MDL in order to be  used.

      5.2   Reagent  Water.   Reagent  water  will be  interference  free.    All
references  to water  in the  method  refer  to  reagent   water  unless  otherwise
specified.  Refer to Chapter One for a definition of reagent water.

      5.3   Nitric  acid  (concentrated),  HN03.   Acid   should  be  analyzed  to
determine level of impurities.  If method blank is  < MDL, the acid  can  be used..

      5.4   Hydrochloric acid  (concentrated),  HC1.  Acid should be analyzed to
determine level of impurities.  If method blank is  < MDL, the acid  can  be used..

      5.4   Hydrogen  peroxide  (30%),  H202.    Oxidant   should  be  analyzed  to
determine level of impurities.
                                   3050A - 2                     Revision  1
                                                                 July  1992

-------
6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

      6.1   All samples  must  have been  collected  using a  sampling  plan that
addresses the considerations discussed in Chapter Nine of this manual.

      6.2   All sample containers must be prewashed with detergents, acids, and
water.  Plastic and  glass containers are both suitable.   See  Chapter Three, Step
3.1.3, for further  information.

      6.3   Nonaqueous samples shall  be refrigerated upon receipt and analyzed
as soon as possible.


7.0  PROCEDURE

      7.1   Mix the  sample thoroughly to achieve homogeneity.  For each digestion
procedure, weigh to  the nearest 0.01 g and transfer to a  conical beaker 1.00-2.00
g of sample.   For samples with  low percent  solids  a  larger sample size may be
used as long as digestion is completed.

      7.2   Add 10 mL of  1:1 HN03, mix the slurry,  and cover  with a watch glass.
Heat the sample to 95°C and reflux' for  10 to 15 minutes without boiling.  Allow
the sample to cool,  add 5 mL  of concentrated HN03, replace the watch glass, and
reflux for  30  minutes.   Repeat  this  last step to ensure  complete oxidation.
Using a  ribbed watch glass,  allow the solution  to evaporate to  5 mL without
boiling, while maintaining a covering of solution over the bottom of the beaker.

      7.3   After Step 7.2 has been completed and the sample has cooled, add 2 mL
of water and 3 mL of 30% H202.   Cover the beaker with a watch glass and return
the covered  beaker  to the  hot  plate  for warming and  to   start  the  peroxide
reaction.   Care  must  be taken  to  ensure  that  losses  do  not  occur  due  to
excessively vigorous effervescence.  Heat until effervescence  subsides and cool
the beaker.

      7.4   Continue to  add  30% H202  in 1-mL  aliquots with  warming  until  the
effervescence is minimal  or until the general  sample appearance is unchanged.

      NOTE: Do not  add more than a total of 10 mL 30% H202.

      7.5   If the  sample is being prepared for (a) the ICP analysis of As and
Se, or (b) the flame AA or ICP analysis of Ag, Al, Ba,  Be,  Ca, Cd, Co, Cr, Cu,
Fe, K, Mg, Mn,  Mo, Na,  Ni, Os,  Pb,  Tl,  V,  and  Zn, then add 5 mL of concentrated
HC1 and 10 mL of water, return the covered beaker to the hot plate, and reflux
for an additional  15 minutes without boiling.  After cooling, dilute to a 100 mL
volume with water.  Particulates  in  the  digestate  that may clog  the nebulizer
should be removed  by filtration, by centrifugation, or by allowing  the sample to
settle.

            7.5.1    Filtration - Filter through Whatman No.  41 filter paper (or
      equivalent).
                                   3050A  -  3                      Revision 1
                                                                 July 1992

-------
            7.5.2   Centrifugation  - Centrifugation  at  2,000-3,000 rpm  for
      10 minutes is usually sufficient to clear the supernatant.

            7.5.3   The diluted sample has an approximate acid concentration of
      5.0% (v/v) HC1  and 5.0%  (v/v) HN03.  The sample is now ready for analysis.

      7.6   If the sample  is being prepared for the furnace analysis of As, Be,
Cd, Co,  Cr,  Fe,  Mo, Pb, Se, Tl, and V, cover the  sample  with a ribbed watch glass
and continue  heating the  acid-peroxide digestate until  the  volume  has  been
reduced to  approximately  5 ml.  After  cooling,  dilute  to 100 ml  with  water.
Particulates  in  the  digestate  should  then   be  removed  by  filtration,  by
Centrifugation, or by allowing the sample to settle.

            7.6.1    Filtration - Filter through Whatman  No. 41 filter paper (or
      equivalent).

            7.6.2    Centrifugation  - Centrifugation  at  2,000-3,000 rpm  for
      10 minutes is usually sufficient to clear the supernatant.

            7.6.3   The diluted  digestate solution contains  approximately 5%
      (v/v) HN03.   For analysis, withdraw aliquots of appropriate volume and add
      any required reagent or matrix modifier.   The  sample is now  ready for
      analysis.

      7.7   Calculations

            7.7.1    The concentrations  determined are  to  be reported  on the
      basis of  the actual  weight  of the sample.   If  a  dry  weight  analysis is
      desired,  then the percent solids of the sample must also be provided.

            7.7.2    If  percent solids  is desired, a  separate determination of
      percent solids must  be performed on a homogeneous aliquot of the sample.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

      8.1   All  quality control  measures described  in  Chapter One  should be
followed.

      8.2   For each  batch of samples  processed,  preparation  blanks should be
carried throughout the entire  sample preparation  and analytical process.  These
blanks will be  useful in determining if samples are being contaminated.  Refer
to Chapter One  for the proper protocol when analyzing blanks.

      8.3   Replicate samples  should be  processed on a routine  basis.  Replicate
samples will  be used to  determine  precision.    The  sample load will  dictate
frequency, but  5% is recommended.  Refer to Chapter One  for the proper protocol
when analyzing  replicates.

      8.4   Spiked samples or  standard reference materials must be employed to
determine  accuracy.   A spiked sample should  be  included with each  batch of
                                   3050A -  4                     Revision 1
                                                                 July 1992

-------
samples processed and whenever a new sample matrix is being analyzed.  Refer to
Chapter One for the proper protocol when analyzing spikes.

      8.5   The concentration of all  calibration  standards  should be verified
against a quality control check sample obtained from an outside source.


9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

      9.1   No data provided.


10.0  REFERENCES

1.    Rohrbough,  W.G.;  et  al.  Reagent  Chemicals,  American  Chemical  Society
Specifications, 7th ed.; American Chemical Society:  Washington, DC, 1986.

2.    1985 Annual  Book of ASTM Standards, Vol. 11.01;  "Standard  Specification for
Reagent Water"; ASTM: Philadelphia, PA, 1985; D1193-77.

3.    Edgell, K.; USEPA Method Study 37 - SW-846 Method 3050 Acid Digestion of
Sediments, Sludges, and Soils.  EPA Contract No. 68-03-3254, November 1988.
                                   3050A -  5                      Revision 1
                                                                 July 1992

-------
                         METHOD 3050A
  ACID  DIGESTION  OF  SEDIMENTS,  SLUDGES,  AND SOILS
                             Start
                            7.1 Mix
                          •ample;  take
                          1-2 9 portion
                           for each
                           digestion
                          7.2 Add HNOt|
                          reflux;repeat
                          HNO, reflux
                         until solution
                            is 5 ml
                         7 . 3 Add reagent
                         water and HtOt;
                         heat beaker to
                         start peroxide
                           reaction
            Furnace
            analysis
            for As, Be,
            Cd,  Co, Cr,
            Fa,  Mo, Pb,
            Sm,  Tl, V
 7.6 Continue
  heating  to
 reduce volume
7.6 Dilute with
 reagent water
  and filter
particulates in
   digestate
                          7 . 4 Continue
                          adding H.O.
                          with heating
 7.7.1 Report
concentration*,
and % solids of
sample for dry
weight analysis
                          7.7.2 If %
                            solids
                         required,use
                          homogeneous
                        sample aliquot
                                        ICP or Flame AA
                                        analysis for
A*
B«
Cr
Mg
Ni
Tl
Ag
Ca
Cu
Hn
0.
V,
M,
Cd,
f«,
Ho,
Pb,
Zn
Ba,
Co,
K,
Na,
s«,

                            7.5 Add
                         concentrated
                            HC1 and
                            reagent
                         water; reflux
7.5 Cool;dilute
 with reagent
 water,  filter
partculates in
   digestate
                             Stop
                            3050A -  6
                                            Revision  1
                                            July  1992

-------
                                 METHOD 3051

               MICROWAVE ASSISTED ACID DIGESTION OF SEDIMENTS,
                           SLUDGES,  SOILS,  AND OILS
1.0   SCOPE AND APPLICATION

      1.1  This method is applicable to the microwave assisted acid digestion of
sludges, sediments, soils,  and oils for the following  elements:

      Aluminum    Cadmium        Iron          Molybdenum         Sodium
      Antimony    Calcium        Lead          Nickel              Strontium
      Arsenic     Chromium       Magnesium     Potassium          Thallium
      Boron       Cobalt         Manganese     Selenium           Vanadium
      Barium      Copper         Mercury       Silver              Zinc
      Beryllium

      1.2  This  method  is  provided as  an alternative to Method 3050.   It is
intended to provide a rapid multielement acid leach digestion prior to analysis
so that  decisions  can be  made  about site  cleanup  levels,  the need  for TCLP
testing  of  a waste and  whether  a  BOAT process   is  providing  acceptable
performance.    If a decomposition including hydrochloric acid  is  required for
certain elements, it is recommended that Method 3050A be  used.  Digests produced
by the  method are  suitable  for analysis  by  flame atomic  absorption (FLAA),
graphite furnace atomic absorption (GFAA), inductively coupled plasma emission
spectroscopy (ICP-ES) and inductively coupled plasma mass spectrometry  (ICP-MS).
Due to the rapid advances  in microwave technology, consult your manufacturer's
recommended instructions for  guidance  on  their microwave  digestion system and
refer to the SW-846  "DISCLAIMER" when conducting analyses using Method 3051.

2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

      2.1  A representative  sample  of up  to  0.5 g  is  digested  in  10  mL of
concentrated  nitric  acid  for 10 min  using microwave  heating with  a suitable
laboratory microwave unit.  The sample and  acid  are placed in  a fluorocarbon (PFA
or TFM)  microwave vessel.  The vessel  is  capped  and heated in  the microwave unit.
After cooling,  the vessel  contents  are filtered, centrifuged, or  allowed to
settle and then diluted  to  volume and  analyzed  by  the  appropriate SW-846 method
(Ref. 1).

3.0  INTERFERENCES

      3.1  Very  reactive or  volatile  materials that may create high pressures
when heated may cause venting of the vessels with potential  loss of sample and
analytes.  The complete decomposition  of either carbonates, or  carbon based
samples, may  cause enough  pressure to  vent the vessel  if  the  sample size is
greater than  0.25 g when used in  the 120  mL vessels with a pressure relief device
that has an upper  limit of 7.5±  0.7  atm (110 ± 10 psi).
                                   3051 - 1                       Revision 0
                                                                  September 1994

-------
4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

      4.1  Microwave apparatus requirements.

            4.1.1   The  microwave  unit  provides  programmable  power with  a
      minimum of 574 W, which can be programmed to within  ±  10 W of the required
      power.   Typical units  provide  a  nominal  600  W  to 1200  W of  power.
      Pressure,  or especially  temperature,   monitoring  and  control  of  the
      microwave unit are  desirable.

            4.1.2   The microwave  unit  cavity is corrosion resistant  and well
      ventilated.

            4.1.3  All electronics are  protected against  corrosion for safe
      operation.

            4.1.4   The system  requires  fluorocarbon  (PFA or TFM)  digestion
      vessels (120 mL capacity)  capable of withstanding  pressures  up  to  7.5  ±
      0.7 atm  (110 ±  10  psi)  and  capable  of  controlled  pressure relief  at
      pressures exceeding 7.5  ±  0.7  atm (110  ± 10 psi).

            4.1.5  A  rotating  turntable  is   employed  to  insure  homogeneous
      distribution of microwave radiation within  the  unit.  The  speed of  the
      turntable should be a minimum  of  3  rpm.

                  CAUTION:   Those laboratories now using or contemplating  the
                  use  of  kitchen type microwave ovens for this  method should be
                  aware of  several signifant safety issues.  First, when an acid
                  such as nitric is used to assist sample digestion in microwave
                  units in  open vessels, or sealed vesselsequippedres,  there is
                  the  potential   for the  acid  gases  released  to corrode  the
                  safety  devices  that  prevent  the microwave  magnetron  from
                  shutting  off when the  door is opened.    This  can result  in
                  operator  exposure  to  microwave energy.   Use of a unit with
                  corrosion  resistant   safety  devices  prevents   this   from
                  occurring.

                  CAUTION:   The  second safety concern relates  to the use of
                  sealed  containers without pressure relief valves in the  unit.
                  Temperature   is   the   important  variable  controlling   the
                  reaction.  Pressure is needed to attain  elevated temperatures
                  but  must be safely  contained.  However, many digestion vessels
                  constructed  from certain  fluorocarbons  may crack, burst, or
                  explode  in  the  unit  under certain pressures.    Only unlined
                  fluorocarbon  (PFA or TFM)  containers  with  pressure relief
                  mecahnisms  or containers  with  PFA-fluorocarbon liners  and
                  pressure  relief  mechanisms  are  considered  acceptable  at
                  present.

                  Users are therefore advised not to use kitchen  type microwave
                  ovens or to use sealed containers  without  pressure relief

                                  3051 - 2                        Revision  0
                                                                  September 1994

-------
                  valves for microwave acid digestions  by this method.   Use of
                  laboratory-grade microwave equipment is required  to  prevent
                  safety hazards.   For further details  consult reference 2.

                  CAUTION:      There   are   many   safety   and   operational
                  recommendations  specific  to  the model and manufacturer of the
                  microwave equipment used in  individual  laboratories.   These
                  specific  suggestions are  beyond  the scope  of this method and
                  require the analyst  to consult the specific equipment manual,
                  manufacturer and literature  for  proper and safe operation of
                  the microwave equipment  and  vessels.

      4.2   Volumetric graduated cylinder,  50  or 100 ml capacity or equivalent.

      4.3   Filter paper, qualitative or equivalent.

      4.4  Filter funnel, glass or disposable  polypropylene.

      4.5  Analytical balance, 300 g capacity, and minimum ± 0.01 g.

5.0  REAGENTS

      5.1  All  acids  should be sub-boiling  distilled where possible to minimize
the blank  levels due  to metallic contamination.   Other grades may  be used,
provided it  is  first ascertained  that the reagent is  of sufficient purity to
permit its  use  without lessening the  accuracy of the determination.   If the
purity of a reagent is questionable,  analyze the reagent  to determine the level
of impurities.   The reagent blank  must be less  than the  MDL in  order to be used.

            5.1.1  Concentrated nitric acid, HN03.  Acid should be analyzed to
      determine levels of  impurity.  If the method blank is  less than the MDL,
      the acid can be used.

      5.2   Reagent  Water.    Reagent  water shall   be  interference free.   All
references  to  water  in  the  method  refer  to  reagent  water  unless  otherwise
specified (Ref. 3).

6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

      6.1   All  samples  must have been collected  using a  sampling  plan that
addresses the considerations  discussed in Chapter Nine of this manual.

      6.2   All  sample containers  must be  prewashed with detergents, acids and
water.  Plastic and glass containers are both suitable.   See  Chapter Three,  sec.
3.1.3 of this manual,  for  further information.

     6.3   Samples must be  refrigerated  upon  receipt  and analyzed  as  soon as
possible.
                                   3051 - 3                       Revision 0
                                                                  September 1994

-------
7.0  PROCEDURE

      7.1  Calibration of Microwave Equipment

            NOTE:   If  the  microwave unit  uses  temperature  feedback  control
            capable of replicating the performance specifications of the method,
            then the calibration procedure may be omitted.

            7.1.1   Measurement of the available power for heating  is evaluated
      so that absolute power in watts may be transferred from one microwave unit
      to another.   For cavity  type microwave equipment, this is accomplished by
      measuring the temperature  rise in  1 kg of  water  exposed  to  microwave
      radiation for a fixed period  of  time.   The analyst can  relate  power in
      watts to the partial power setting of the  unit.  The calibration format
      required for laboratory  microwave  units depends on the type of electronic
      system used  by the manufacturer to provide  partial  microwave power.   Few
      units have  an accurate  and precise linear relationship  between  percent
      power  settings  and  absorbed  power.    Where linear  circuits  have  been
      utilized, the  calibration  curve   can  be  determined  by  a  three-point
      calibration  method (7.1.3), otherwise,  the  analyst  must  use  the multiple
      point calibration  method (7.1.2).

            7.1.2   The multiple  point calibration  involves the measurement of
      absorbed power over a large range  of power  settings.  Typically,  for a
      600 W unit,  the following  power settings are measured; 100, 99,  98,  97,
      95,  90, 80,  70,  60,  50,  and 40% using the procedure described  in  section
      7.1.4.   This data  is clustered about  the  customary  working power  ranges.
      Nonlinearity has  been  commonly  encountered  at  the  upper  end  of  the
      calibration.   If  the unit's  electronics  are  known to  have  nonlinear
      deviations  in  any  region  of  proportional  power  control,  it  will  be
      necessary to make  a set of measurements  that bracket the power to be used.
      The final calibration point should be at the partial power  setting  that
      will  be used in  the test.  This setting  should be checked  periodically to
      evaluate the integrity of  the  calibration.   If a significant change is
      detected (±10 W),  then the  entire  calibration  should be reevaluated.

            7.1.3    The  three-point  calibration  involves the  measurement  of
      absorbed power at  three  different power settings.  Measure  the power at
      100% and 50% using athe  procedure  described  in  section 7.1.4.    From the
      2-point line calculate the power  setting corresponding  to  the  required
      power in watts specified  in the procedure.  Measure  the absorbed  power at
      that  partial power  setting.    If  the measured absorbed  power does  not
      correspond to the  specified power  within ±10  W,  use the multiple  point
      calibration  in 7.1.2.   This  point should  also  be  used  to  periodically
      verify  the integrity  of  the calibration.

            7.1.4   Equilibrate  a  large volume of  water  to room  temperature
      (23  ± 2°C).   One kg  of reagent  water  is weighed  (1,000.0  g + 0.1  g)  into
      a  fluorocarbon  beaker or a beaker made  of some other material that  does
      not  significantly  absorb microwave energy (glass absorbs microwave energy
      and  is  not recommended).  The  initial temperature of the  water  should be

                                  3051  - 4                        Revision  0
                                                                  September 1994

-------
23  ± 2°C  measured  to  ±  0.05°C.    The  covered  beaker  is  circulated
continuously (in the normal sample path) through the microwave field for
2 minutes at the desired  partial power setting with the  unit's  exhaust fan
on maximum (as  it will  be during normal operation).  The beaker is removed
and the water vigorously stirred.   Use  a magnetic stirring bar inserted
immediately after microwave irradiation and record the maximum  temperature
within  the  first 30  seconds  to ±  0.05°C.    Use  a new  sample  for each
additional measurement.   If the water is reused  both  the water and the
beaker must have returned to 23 ± 2°C.  Three measurements at each  power
setting should be made.

The absorbed power is determined by the following  relationship:

                       P =  (K)  (CJ  (m)  (AT)
Eq. 1
Where:

P = the apparent power absorbed by the sample  in watts  (W)
(W=joule-sec"1)

K  =  the  conversion  factor for  thermochemical  calories-sec"1  to  watts
(=4.184)

Cp = the heat capacity, thermal capacity, or specific heat
(cal-g"1 °C'1)  of water

m = the mass of the water  sample  in grams  (g)

AT  =  the  final temperature minus  the  initial  temperature (°C)

t = the time in seconds  (s)


Using the experimental conditions of 2 minutes  and 1 kg of distilled water
(heat  capacity  at 25  °C is 0.9997 cal-g 1-°C"1) the calibration  equation
simplifies to:

Eq. 2                    P  = (AT)  (34.86)

       NOTE:    Stable  line  voltage   is  necessary  for   accurate  and
       reproducible calibration and operation.  The line voltage should be
       within  manufacturer's specification,  and during measurement  and
       operation  should not vary  by more  than ±2 V.   A constant  power
       supply may be necessary  for microwave  use if the  source  of the
       line voltage is  unstable.

       Electronic  components in most  microwave units  are matched  to the
       units'  function and  output.    When  any part of  the high  voltage


                             3051  - 5                       Revision 0
                                                             September 1994

-------
            circuit, power source, or control components in the unit have been
            serviced or  replaced,  it  will  be necessary  to  recheck the units'
            calibration.  If the power output has changed  significantly  (±10 W),
            then the entire calibration should be reevaluated.

      7.2   All  digestion vessels  and  volumetric ware must  be  carefully acid
washed and rinsed with reagent water.  When  switching between high concentration
samples and low concentration samples, all  digestion vessels should be cleaned
by leaching with hot (1:1) hydrochloric acid (greater than 80°C, but less than
boiling) for a minimum of two hours followed with hot (1:1) nitric acid  (greater
than 80°C, but less than boiling)  for a minimum of two  hours  and  rinsed with
reagent water and dried  in  a clean  environment.  This cleaning procedure should
also be used whenever the prior use of the digestion vessels  is unknown  or cross
contamination from vessels  is suspected.  Polymeric or glass volumetric  ware and
storage  containers should  be  cleaned  by  leaching  with  more dilute  acids
(approximately 10% V/V)  appropriate for the  specific  plastics used  and then
rinsed  with  reagent  water  and  dried  in  a  clean  environment.    To  avoid
precipitation of silver, ensure that all HC1 has been  rinsed from the vessels.

      7.3  Sample Digestion

            7.3.1  Weigh the fluorocarbon (PFA or TFM)  digestion vessel,  valve
      and capassembly to 0.001  g prior to use.

            7.3.2  Weigh a  well-mixed  sample to the nearest 0.001  g  into the
      fluorocarbon  sample  vessel  equipped  with  a  single-ported   cap and  a
      pressure relief valve.  For soils, sediments, and  sludges use no more than
      0.500 g.  For oils use no more than 0.250 g.

            7.3.3  Add  10  ±  0.1  mL concentrated nitric acid in a  fume hood.
      If a vigorous reaction occurs,  allow  the  reaction to stop before capping
      the vessel.  Cap the vessel  and torque the cap to  12  ft-lbs  (16 N-m)  or
      according to  the unit manufacturer's directions.   Weigh the vessels to the
      nearest 0.001 g.   Place the vessels in the microwave carousel.

            CAUTION:  Toxic nitrogen oxide fumes may be evolved,  therefore all
            work  must  be performed in  a properly operating ventilation system.
            The  analyst   should also be  aware of the potential  for  a  vigorous
            reaction.    If  a vigorous  reaction occurs,  allow  to cool  before
            capping the  vessel.

            CAUTION:  When  digesting  samples  containing volatile  or  easily
            oxidized organic compounds,  initially weigh no more than 0.10 g and
            observe the  reaction  before capping  the  vessel.   If  a  vigorous
            reaction occurs, allow the reaction to cease before capping  the
            vessel.  If  no appreciable reaction occurs,  a sample weight  up  to
            0.25  g  can be used.
                                   3051  -  6                        Revision 0
                                                                  September 1994

-------
      CAUTION: All samples known or suspected of containing more than 5-
      10% organic material  should be predigested in a hood for  at least 15
      minutes.

      7.3.4   Properly place  the carousel  in the microwave unit according
to the manufacturer's  recommended specifications and, if used,  connect the
pressure  vessels  to the  central  overflow vessel  with PFA-fluorocarbon
tubes.  Any vessels containing 10 ml of nitric acid for analytical blank
purposes are counted as sample vessels.  When fewer than the recommended
number of  samples are to  be  digested,  the remaining  vessels should be
filled with  10  ml  of  nitric acid to  achieve  the full  complement of
vessels.    This  provides  an  energy  balance  since the  microwave power
absorbed  is  proportional  to the  total  mass  in  the  cavity  (Ref.  4).
Irradiate each group of sample vessels for 10 minutes.   The temperature of
each  sample  should  rise to 175 °C  in  less than 5.5 minutes  and remain
between 170-180  °C  for  the balance of  the 10 minute irradiation period.
The pressure  should peak  at  less  than  6 atm  for most  soil,  sludge,  and
sediment samples  (Ref. 5).  The pressure will exceed these limits in the
case of high concentrations of carbonate or organic compounds.  In these
cases the pressure will  be limited by the relief pressure of the vessel to
7.5 ± 0.7 atm (110 ± 10 psi).  All  vessels should be sealed according to
the manufacturers recommended specifications.

            7.3.4.1 Newer microwave units are capable of higher power (W)
      that permits digestion  of a larger  number  of  samples per batch.  If
      the analyst wishes to digest more samples at a time, the  analyst may
      use different values of power  as long as they result  in  the same
      time and  temperature  conditions  defined  in  7.3.4.  That  is,  any
      sequence of power that  brings the  samples to 175°C in  5.5 minutes
      and permits  a slow rise  to  175  - 180°C during  the  remaining  4.5
      minutes (Ref.  5).

      Issues  of  safety,   structural   integrity  (both  temperature  and
      pressure limitations),  heat loss, chemical compatibility, microwave
      absorption  of  vessel   material,   and   energy transport  will   be
      considerations made in  choosing alternative vessels.  If all of the
      considerations are met and the appropriate power settings provided
      to reproduce the  reaction conditions  defined in  7.3.4,  then these
      alternative vessels may be used (Ref. 1,2).

      7.3.5  At  the end of the microwave program,  allow the  vessels to
cool for a minimum  of  5 minutes before  removing them from the microwave
unit.  When the vessels have  cooled to room temperature, weigh and record
the weight of each vessel assembly. If the weight of acid plus    sample
has decreased by more  than 10 percent from the original     weight,
discard the sample.  Determine the  reason  for  the weight loss.  These are
typically attributed to loss  of vessel  seal  integrity,  use of a digestion
time  longer  than 10  minutes,  too  large  a  sample, or  improper  heating
conditions.  Once the  source of the loss has been     corrected,  prepare
a new sample or set of samples for  digestion beginning at 7.3.1.


                             3051  - 7                       Revision 0
                                                            September  1994

-------
            7.3.6  Complete the preparation of the sample by carefully uncapping
      and venting each vessel  in  a fume hood.   Transfer the sample to an acid-
      cleaned  bottle.  If the digested sample contains particulates which may
      clog  nebulizers or  interfere with  injection  of  the  sample  into  the
      instrument, the sample may be centrifuged, allowed to settle, or filtered.

                  7.3.6.1   Centrifugation:  Centrifugation  at 2,000-3,000 rpm
            for 10 minutes  is  usually sufficient to clear  the supernatant.

                  7.3.6.2   Settling:   Allow  the  sample  to  stand  until  the
            supernatant is  clear.   Allowing  a sample  to stand  overnight will
            usually accomplish this.  If it does not,  centrifuge or filter the
            sample.

                  7.3.6.3    Filtering:    The  filtering   apparatus  must  be
            thoroughly cleaned and prerinsed with dilute (approximately 10% V/V)
            nitric acid.  Filter the sample through   qualitative filter paper
            into a second acid-cleaned  container.

            7.3.7  Dilute  the digest to a known volume  ensuring that the samples
      and standards are matrix matched.  The  digest is now  ready for analysis
      for elements of interest using the appropriate SW-846 method.

      7.4 Calculations:  The concentrations determined are to be  reported on the
basis of the actual weight of  the original  sample.

8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

      8.1   All  quality  control   data  must  be maintained  and   available  for
reference or inspection for  a  period of three years.  This  method is restricted
to  use  by,   or  under  supervision  of,  experienced analysts.    Refer to  the
appropriate  section of Chapter One for  additional quality  control guidance.

      8.2 Duplicate samples should be processed on a routine basis.  A duplicate
sample is a  sample brought through the  whole sample preparation  and analytical
process.  A  duplicate sample should be  processed with  each  analytical batch or
every 20 samples,  whichever  is the greater number.  A duplicate sample should be
prepared for each matrix type  (i.e., soil,  sludge,  etc.).

      8.3 Spiked  samples or standard reference materials should be included with
each group of samples processed or  every 20 samples,  whichever  is  the greater
number.   A spiked sample should also be  included whenever a new sample matrix is
being analyzed.

9.0  METHOD  PERFORMANCE

      9.1   Precision:   Precision data for Method  3051,  as determined  by the
statistical  examination of inter!aboratory test results, is located in Tables 1
and 2.


                                   3051 - 8                       Revision 0
                                                                  September 1994

-------
      9.2  Repeatability:  If successive results are obtained by the  same analyst
with the same  apparatus under  constant operating  conditions on identical test
material, then the difference between these successive results will not, with 95%
probability, exceed the repeatability value.   For  example,  in  the case of lead,
an average of only 1 case in 20 would exceed

                                    0.206 x

in the long run, where x is one result  in /yg/g (Ref. 6).

      9.3  Reproducibility: If two successive measurements are made independently
by each of two different analysts working in different  laboratories  on identical
test material, then the difference between the average result  for  each analyst
will not, with 95% probability, exceed the reproducibility  value.   For example,
in the case of lead, an average of only  1  case in 20 would exceed

                                    0.303 x

in the long run, where x is the average  of two successive  measurements  in yug/g
(Ref. 2).

      As can be seen in Table 1, repeatability and reproducibility differ between
elements,  and usually depend on that element's concentration.   Table 2 provides
an  example of how  users  of  the method  can determine   expected  values  for
repeatability and reproducibil ity; nominal  values of lead have been used for this
model  (Ref. 6).

      9.4  Bias:  In the case  of  SRM  1085 - Wear Metals in Oil, the  bias  of this
test method  is different  for  each element.   An  estimate  of bias,  as shown  in
Table 3,  is:

                    Bias = Amount found -  Amount  expected.

      However,  the  bias  estimate   inherits  both   the   uncertainty   in  the
measurements  made  using Method 3051  and the uncertainty on the certificate,  so
whether  the bias is real  or  only due  to  measurement  error must   also be con-
sidered.   The concentrations  found  for  Al, Cr,  and Cu using  Method 3051 fall
within their  certified  ranges  on  SRM 1085,  and 95%  confidence intervals  for  Fe
and  Ni overlap with their  respective certified ranges;  therefore,  the observed
biases for these  elements  are probably due to chance and  should be considered
insignificant.  Biases should not be  estimated at all for Ag and Pb because these
elements were not certified.  Therefore,  the only  two elements considered in this
table  for  which the bias estimates are significant  are  Mg  and Mo.

10.0  REFERENCES

1.     Test Methods for Evaluating Solid Waste. Physical/Chemical  Methods, 3rd
       ed;  U.S.  Environmental  Protection  Agency, Office  of  Solid  Waste and
       Emergency Response.   U.S.  Government  Printing  Office:    Washington, DC,
       1986;  SW-846.


                                    3051 - 9                        Revision 0
                                                                   September 1994

-------
2.    Kingston, H. M.  and  L. B. Jassie, "Safety Guidelines for Microwave Systems
      in  the  Analytical   Laboratory".    In  Introduction  to  Microwave  Acid
      Decomposition:  Theory  and  Practice;  Kingston,  H.  M.  and Jassie, L. B.,
      eds.; ACS Professional Reference Book Series; American Chemical Society:
      Washington, DC,  1988.

3.    1985 Annual Book of ASTM  Standards,  Vol.  11.01; "Standard Specification
      for Reagent Water ;  ASTM,  Philadelphia, PA, 1985, D1193-77.

4.    Introduction  to  Microwave   Sample   Preparation:   Theory   and  Practice.
      Kingston, H. M.  and Jassie,  L. B., Eds.; ACS Professional Reference Book
      Series; American Chemical  Society:  Washington, DC, 1988.

5.    Kingston,  H.  M.   EPA  IAG  #DWI-393254-01-0 January  1-March  31,  1988,
      quarterly Report.

6.    Binstock, D. A., Yeager, W.  M.,  Grohse,  P.  M. and Gaskill, A.  Validation
      of a Method for Determining  Elements  in  Solid  Waste by  Microwave Diges-
      tion,  Research  Triangle Institute Technical  Report Draft,  RTI  Project
      Number 321U-3579-24,  November,  1989, prepared  for the  Office  of Solid
      Waste, U.S. Environmental  Protection  Agency, Washington,  DC 20460.

7.    Kingston,  H.   M.,   Walter,   P.   J.,   "Comparison  of  Microwave  Versus
      Conventional Dissolution for  Environmental  Applications",  Spectroscopy,
      vol.  7 No. 9,20-27,1992.
                                  3051 - 10                       Revision 0
                                                                  September 1994

-------
                                  TABLE  1.
         EQUATIONS  RELATING  REPEATABILITY AND  REPRODUCIBILITY  TO MEAN
     CONCENTRATION OF DUPLICATE DETERMINATION WITH 95 PERCENT CONFIDENCE
            Element           Repeatability           Reproducibility
Ag
Al
B
Ba
Be
Ca
Cd
Co
Cr
Cu
Fe
Mg
Mn
Mo
Ni
Pb
Sr
V
Zn
0.195X8
0.232X
12. 9b
0.238X
0.082b
0.356X
0.385X
0.291X
0.187X
0.212X
0.257X
0.238X
1.96X1/2°
0.701X
0.212X
0.206X
0.283X
1.03X1/2
3.82X1/2
0.314X
0.444X
22. 6b
0.421X
0.082b
1.27X
0.571X
0.529X
0.195X
0.322X
0.348X
0.399X
4.02X1/2
0.857X
0.390X
0.303X
0.368X
2.23X1/2
7.69X1/2
"Log  transformed variable based on one-way analysis of variance.
Repeatability and reproducibility were independent of concentration.
°Square root transformed variable based on one-way analysis of variance.
                                  3051 - 11                       Revision 0
                                                                  September 1994

-------
                                    TABLE  2.
                  REPEATABILITY  AND REPRODUCIBILITY FOR LEAD
                                 BY  METHOD 3051
         Average Value       Repeatability       Reproducibilitv
50
100
200
300
400
500
10.3
20.6
41.2
61.8
82.4
103
15.2
30.3
60.6
90.9
121
152
All results are in mg/Kg
                                   3051  -  12                        Revision 0
                                                                   September 1994

-------
                                   TABLE 3.
           RECOVERY AND BIAS DATA FOR SRM 1085 - WEAR METALS IN OIL
     Element
 Amount
 Expected
(Certified
  Range)
 Amount
  Found*
(95% Conf
Interval)
                                        Absolute
                                          Bias
         Relative
          Bias
        (Percent)
         Significant
         (due to more
         than chance)
       Ag
       Al
       Cr
       Cu
       Fe
       Mg
       Mo
       Ni
       Pb
  (291)**
  296+4
  298±5
  295±10
  300+4
  297+3
  292+11
  303+7
  (305)**
All values in mg/Kg
 234±16
 295+12
 293±10
 289±9
 311+14
 270+11
 238+11
 293±9
 279±8
-1
-5
-6
+11
-27
-54
-10
 0
-2
-2
+4
-9
-18
-3
No
No
No
No
Yes
Yes
No
 *Results taken from table 4-7, Ref. 2.

 **Value not certified, so should  not be used in bias detection and  estimation.
                                   3051 - 13
                                                    Revision 0
                                                    September 1994

-------
                                    METHOD  3051
(MICROWAVE ASSISTED ACID DIGESTION OF SEDIMENTS, SLUDGES,  SOILS,  AND OILS)
                            H«
                           weight
                         decreased >
                          10% from
                           original?
7.3.6 Place
 eample in
acid-cleaned
  bottle.
                                   3051 -  14
                                Revision  0
                                September 1994

-------
3.3  METHODS FOR DETERMINATION OF METALS

          This  section of the manual contains  seven  analytical  techniques for
trace metal  determinations:  inductively coupled argon  plasma  atomic emission
spectrometry (ICP-AES), inductively coupled plasma mass spectrometry (ICP-MS),
direct-aspiration  or  flame  atomic  absorption  spectrometry  (FLAA),  graphite-
furnace  atomic  absorption  spectrometry  (GFAA),  hydride-generation  atomic
absorption spectrometry (HGAA), cold-vapor atomic absorption spectrometry (CVAA),
and  several  procedures for  hexavalent  chromium analysis.   Each of  these is
briefly discussed below in terms of  advantages, disadvantages, and cautions for
analysis of wastes.

          ICP's  primary advantage  is  that  it allows  simultaneous  or  rapid
sequentiaf~determination  of many  elements  in  a  short   time.   The  primary
disadvantage of  ICP is  background radiation from other elements and the plasma
gases   Although all  ICP instruments utilize high-resolution optics and back-
ground correction to minimize these  interferences, analysis for traces of meta  s
in the presence of a large excess of a single metal  is difficult. Examples would
be traces  of metals  in an alloy or  traces  of metals in a  limed (high calcium
waste   ICP and Flame AA have comparable detection limits (within a factor  of 4)
except that  ICP  exhibits greater sensitivity for refractories (Al,  Ba, etc.).
Furnace AA,  in general, will  exhibit lower detection  limits  than  either ICP or
FLAA  Detection limits are drastically improved when ICP-MS is used.   In general
ICP-MS exhibits  greater sensitivity than either GFAA of FLAA  for most elements.
The  greatest disadvantage of ICP-MS is isobaric elemental  interferences.   These
are  caused by different elements forming atomic ions with the  same  nominal  mass-
to-charge ratio.  Mathematical correction for interfering ions can minimize  these
interferences.

          Flame AAS (FLAA) direct aspiration  determinations,  as  opposed to ICP,
are  normally completed as single element  analyses  and are  relatively free of
interelement  spectral  interferences.   Either  a  nitrous-oxide/acetylene or
air/acetylene  flame  is used  as  an energy source  for dissociating  the aspirated
sample into  the  free  atomic  state making analyte atoms available for absorption
of light   In the analysis of some elements the  temperature or type of flame used
 is  critical.   If the  proper  flame  and analytical  conditions  are not  used,
chemical  and ionization interferences  can  occur.

           Graphite  Furnace AAS  (GFAA)  replaces the  flame  with  an electrically
heated graphite  furnace.   The furnace allows for gradual  heating  of the  sample
 aliquot   in  several  stages.   Thus,  the  processes  of   desolvation, drying,
decomposition  of organic  and  inorganic molecules and salts, and formation  ot
 atoms which  must occur in  a flame or ICP in a few milliseconds may be allowed to
 occur over  a  much longer time period and  at  controlled temperatures in the
 furnace.  This allows an experienced analyst to remove unwanted matrix components
 by using  temperature programming and/or matrix modifiers. The major advantage
 of this technique is  that it affords extremely low detection limits.  It  is the
 easiest  to perform on  relatively clean  samples.  Because this  technique  is so
 sensitive, interferences can be a real  problem; finding the optimum combination
 of  digestion, heating times and temperatures,  and matrix modifiers can  be  a

                                    THREE - 7                       Revision 2
                                                                   September 1994

-------
challenge for complex matrices.

          Hydride AA utilizes a chemical  reduction to reduce and separate arsenic
or selenium selectively  from a sample digestate.  The technique therefore has the
advantage of being able  to  isolate these two elements from complex  samples which
may  cause   interferences  for   other  analytical   procedures.    Significant
interferences have been  reported when any of the following is present:   1) easily
reduced metals (Cu, Ag,  Hg);  2) high concentrations of transition metals (>200
mg/L);  3)  oxidizing agents  (oxides of  nitrogen)  remaining  following  sample
digestion.                                                                 r

          Cold-Vapor AA  uses a chemical reduction to reduce mercury selectively
The procedure is extremely sensitive but is subject to interferences from some
volatile organics, chlorine,  and sulfur compounds.
                                  THREE  -  8                       Revision 2
                                                                 September 1994

-------
                                 METHOD 6010A

            INDUCTIVELY  COUPLED  PLASMA-ATOMIC  EMISSION  SPECTROSCOPY
1.0   SCOPE AND APPLICATION

      1.1   Inductively  coupled  plasma-atomic  emission  spectroscopy  (ICP)
determines  trace  elements,   including  metals,  in  solution.  The  method  is
applicable to  all  of the elements listed in Table  1.  All  matrices,  including
ground water,  aqueous samples, TCLP  and  EP extracts,  industrial  and organic
wastes, soils,  sludges,  sediments,  and other  solid  wastes,  require  digestion
prior to analysis.

      1.2   Elements for which Method 6010 is applicable are listed in Table 1.
Detection limits, sensitivity, and optimum ranges of the metals will  vary with
the matrices  and model  of spectrometer.  The  data  shown  in  Table  1  provide
estimated  detection   limits   for  clean  aqueous   samples   using  pneumatic
nebulization.  Use of  this method  is restricted  to spectroscopists  who  are
knowledgeable   in  the  correction   of   spectral,  chemical,   and   physical
interferences.
2.0   SUMMARY OF METHOD

      2.1   Prior to  analysis,  samples must be solubilized  or  digested using
appropriate Sample Preparation Methods  (e.g. Methods 3005-3050).  When analyzing
for dissolved constituents, acid digestion is not necessary if the samples are
filtered and acid preserved prior to analysis.

      2.2   Method 6010 describes the simultaneous, or sequential, multielemental
determination of elements by ICP. The method measures element-emitted light by
optical  spectrometry.    Samples are  nebulized  and  the  resulting  aerosol  is
transported to the plasma torch. Element-specific atomic-line emission spectra
are produced by a radio-frequency inductively coupled plasma.  The spectra are
dispersed  by  a grating  spectrometer,  and  the  intensities  of  the  lines  are
monitored by photomultiplier tubes.  Background correction  is required for trace
element determination. Background must be measured  adjacent to analyte lines on
samples during  analysis.   The  position  selected  for the background-intensity
measurement, on either or both  sides of the  analytical line, will be determined
by the complexity of  the  spectrum adjacent  to the  analyte line.   The position
used must  be free  of spectral  interference  and  reflect  the same  change  in
background intensity as occurs  at the analyte wavelength measured.  Background
correction  is  not  required  in  cases  of line  broadening where  a  background
correction  measurement would  actually  degrade  the  analytical  result.   The
possibility of  additional  interferences  named  in  Section 3.0 should  also  be
recognized  and  appropriate  corrections  made;  tests for  their  presence  are
described in Step 8.5.
                                   6010A -  1                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
                                   TABLE 1.
      RECOMMENDED  WAVELENGTHS  AND  ESTIMATED INSTRUMENTAL  DETECTION  LIMITS
Detection
Element
Aluminum
Antimony
Arsenic
Barium
Beryllium
Cadmium
Calcium
Chromium
Cobalt
Copper
Iron
Lead
Lithium
Magnesium
Manganese
Molybdenum
Nickel
Phosphorus
Potassium
Selenium
Silver
Sodium
Strontium
Thallium
Vanadium
Zinc
Wavelength8 (nm)
308.215
206.833
193.696
455.403
313.042
226.502
317.933
267.716
228.616
324.754
259.940
220.353
670.784
279.079
257.610
202.030
231.604
213.618
766.491
196.026
328.068
588.995
407.771
190.864
292.402
213.856
Estimated
Limit (ug/L)
45
32
53
2
0.3
4
10
7
7
6
7
42
5
30
2
8
15
51
See note c
75
7
29
0.3
40
8
2
           wavelengths listed are recommended because of their sensitivity and
overall acceptance. Other wavelengths may be substituted if they can provide
the needed sensitivity and are treated with the same corrective techniques for
spectral interference (see Step 3.1). In time, other elements may be added as
more information becomes available and as required.

      n"he estimated instrumental detection limits shown are taken from
Reference 1 in Section 10.0 below. They are given as a guide for an
instrumental limit. The actual method detection limits are sample dependent
and may vary as the sample matrix varies.

      °Highly dependent on operating conditions and plasma position.


                                  6010A  -  2                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
3.0   INTERFERENCES

      3.1  Spectral  interferences  are caused by:  (1)  overlap of a spectral line
from another element at the analytical or background measurement wavelengths; (2)
unresolved overlap of molecular band spectra; (3) background contribution from
continuum or recombination phenomena; and (4) stray light from the line emission
of high-concentration  elements.   Spectral  overlap can be compensated  for by
computer-correcting the raw data after monitoring  and measuring the interfering
element.  Unresolved  overlap  requires  selection  of  an  alternate  wavelength.
Background  contribution  and stray light can  usually be compensated  for  by  a
background correction adjacent to the analyte line.

      Users  of  all   ICP   instruments  must  verify  the absence  of  spectral
interference  from  an element  in  a sample  for which  there  is no  instrument
detection channel.  Recommended wavelengths are listed in Table 1  and potential
spectral interferences for the recommended wavelengths are given in Table 2. The
data in  Table 2 are  intended  as  rudimentary guides for  indicating  potential
interferences;  for  this purpose,  linear  relations between concentration and
intensity for the analytes and the interferents can be assumed.

            3.1.1  Element-specific  interference  is   expressed   as   analyte
      concentration equivalents (i.e. false analyte concentrations) arising from
      100 mg/L of the  interference element. For example, assume that As is to be
      determined (at 193.696 nm) in a sample containing  approximately 10 mg/L of
      Al. According to Table 2, 100 mg/L of Al  would yield a false signal for As
      equivalent to approximately 1.3 mg/L. Therefore,  the  presence of 10 mg/L
      of Al would result  in a false signal  for  As equivalent  to  approximately
      0.13  mg/L.  The  user is cautioned  that  other  instruments  may  exhibit
      somewhat different levels of interference than those shown in Table 2. The
      interference effects  must  be evaluated  for each  individual  instrument
      since the intensities will vary with operating conditions,  power, viewing
      height, argon flow rate, etc.  The user should be  aware of the possibility
      of interferences other than  those specified in  Table  2  and  that  analysts
      should be aware of these interferences when conducting  analyses.

            3.1.2  The  dashes  in  Table   2   indicate  that  no   measurable
      interferences were  observed  even  at  higher  interferent  concentrations.
      Generally, interferences  were discernible  if  they  produced peaks,  or
      background shifts, corresponding to 2  to 5% of the peaks generated by the
      analyte concentrations.

            3.1.3  At present, information  on the  listed silver and  potassium
      wavelengths is not available,  but  it  has been reported  that  second-order
      energy from the magnesium 383.231-nm wavelength  interferes with the listed
      potassium line at 766.491  nm.
                                  6010A - 3                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
                                    TABLE 2.

                 ANALYTE  CONCENTRATION  EQUIVALENTS ARISING FROM
                        INTERFERENCE AT  THE  100-mg/L LEVEL
                                                Interferent
                                                           a,b
 Analyte
Wavelength  --•

   (nm)     Al
Ca    Cr
Cu
Fe    Mg    Mn
Ni
Tl
Aluminum
Antimony
Arsenic
308.215
206.833
193.696

0.47 --
1.3 --

2.9 -- 0.08 --
0.44 --
0.21 -- -- 1.4
0.25 0.45
1.1
 Barium     455.403
 Beryllium  313.042
                                                            0.04  0.05
Cadmium
Calcium
Chromium
Cobalt
Copper
Iron
Lead
Magnesium
Manganese
Molybdenum
Nickel
Selenium
Sodium
Thallium
Vanadium
Zinc
226.
317.
267.
228.
324.
259.
220.
279.
257.
202.
231.
196.
588.
190.
292.
213.
502
933
716
616
754
940
353
079
610
030
604
026
995
864
402
856

_ _
_ _

- -
— —
0.17 --
0.02
0.005 --
0.05 --
__
0.23 --

0.30 --
__

--
0.08
--
0.03
--

--
0.11
0.01

--
--
--
--
0.05

0
0
0
0
0
_ _
_.
0
0
0
__
0
__
-_
0
0.14 -
.03 --
.01 0.01
.003 --
.005 --
.003 --
_
.
.13 --
.002 0.002
.03 --
_
.09 --
_
_
.005 --
-
--
0.04
0.04
--

0.12
--
0.25
—

--
--
--
--
--

0.02 -
0

0.03 0
0

__
0
—
- _
--
__
0
__
0
0.29 -
-
.03
-
.15
.05
-
-
.07
-
-
-
-
.08
-
.02
-
-
0
0
-
0
..
-
0
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
.03
.04
-
.02
-
-
.12
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Cashes indicate that no interference was  observed  even  when  interferents were
introduced at the following levels:
      Al  -
      Ca  -
      Cr  -
      Cu  -
      Fe  -
 1000 mg/L
 1000 mg/L
 200 mg/L
 200 mg/L
 1000 mg/L
         Mg
         Mn
         Tl
          V
  1000 mg/L
   200 mg/L
   200 mg/L
   200 mg/L
     figures recorded as analyte concentrations are not the actual  observed
concentrations; to obtain those figures,  add the listed concentration to the
interferent figure.
                                  6010A  - 4
                                                      Revision  1
                                                      July  1992

-------
      3.2   Physical  interferences  are effects  associated  with  the  sample
nebulization and transport processes. Changes in viscosity and surface tension
can  cause  significant  Inaccuracies,  especially  in  samples  containing  high
dissolved solids or high acid concentrations. Differences in solution volatility
can  also  cause inaccuracies when  organic  solvents are  involved.  If physical
interferences  are  present,  they must be reduced by diluting  the  sample or by
using a peristaltic pump.  Another problem that can occur  with high dissolved
solids is salt buildup at the tip of the nebulizer, which affects aerosol flow
rate and causes instrumental drift. The problem can be  controlled by  wetting the
argon  prior to  nebulization,   using  a tip  washer,   or  diluting the  sample.
Changing the nebulizer and removing salt buildup at the tip of the torch sample
injector can be used as an additional measure to control  salt  buildup.  Also, it
has been reported that better control of the argon  flow rate improves instrument
performance; this  is  accomplished with the use of mass flow controllers.

      3.3   Chemical  interferences   include   molecular  compound  formation,
ionization effects, and solute vaporization effects. Normally,  these  effects are
not significant with  the  ICP technique.  If observed,  they  can be  minimized by
careful selection of operating conditions (incident power, observation position,
and so forth), by  buffering of the sample,  by matrix  matching, and by standard
addition procedures. Chemical  interferences are highly dependent on matrix type
and the specific analyte element.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

      4.1   Inductively coupled argon plasma emission  spectrometer:

            4.1.1   Computer-controlled  emission spectrometer  with  background
      correction.

            4.1.2  Radio frequency generator compliant with FCC regulations.

            4.1.3  Argon gas supply - Welding grade or better.

      4.2   Operating  conditions -  The analyst should follow  the  instructions
provided by  the instrument manufacturer.  For operation  with organic solvents, use
of the auxiliary argon inlet is recommended,  as are  solvent-resistant  tubing,
increased plasma (coolant) argon flow, decreased nebulizer flow,  and increased
RF power  to obtain  stable  operation  and  precise measurements.  Sensitivity,
instrumental detection limit, precision, linear dynamic range, and interference
effects must be established  for  each  individual analyte line on that particular
instrument.  All measurements must be  within the instrument  linear range where
spectral  interference correction factors are valid. The analyst must (1)  verify
that the instrument configuration and operating conditions satisfy the analytical
requirements  and  (2)  maintain  quality control  data  confirming  instrument
performance and analytical  results.

      4.3  Class A volumetric  flasks

      4.4  Class A volumetric  pipets
                                  6010A  - 5                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
      4.5   Analytical  balance - capable of accurate measurement to 4 significant
figures.


5.0  REAGENTS

      5.1  Reagent grade chemicals  shall  be used in all tests. Unless otherwise
indicated, it is intended that all  reagents shall conform to the specifications
of the Committee on Analytical Reagents  of the American Chemical Society, where
such specifications are available. Other grades may be used,  provided it is first
ascertained that the reagent is  of sufficiently high  purity to permit its use
without lessening the accuracy of the determination. If the purity of a reagent
is in question analyze  for contamination.  If the concentration is less than the
MDL then the reagent is acceptable.

            5.1.1  Hydrochloric acid (cone), HC1.

            5.1.2  Hydrochloric  acid (1:1),  HC1. Add 500 ml concentrated HC1 to
      400 ml water and dilute to 1 liter in an appropriate beaker.

            5.1.3  Nitric acid (cone),  HN03.

            5.1.4  Nitric  acid  (1:1),   HN03. Add  500  ml concentrated  HN03 to
      400 ml water and dilute to 1 liter in an appropriate beaker.

      5.2   Reagent Water. All references to water  in the method refer to reagent
water unless otherwise  specified.  Reagent water will  be interference free.
Refer to Chapter One for a definition of reagent water.

      5.3   Standard stock  solutions may be  purchased or prepared from ultra-
high purity grade chemicals or metals (99.99 to 99.999% pure). All  salts must be
dried for 1 hour at  105°C, unless otherwise specified.

      CAUTION:   Many metal  salts are  extremely toxic  if inhaled or  swallowed.
                 Wash hands thoroughly after handling.

      Typical  stock  solution preparation procedures follow.  Concentrations are
calculated based upon the weight  of pure metal  added, or with the use of the mole
fraction  and  the weight  of the metal salt added.

Metal
          Concentration  (pp.) -

Metal salts
                 ...    ,    ,    weight (nig) x mole fraction
          Concentration (ppm) =  	y	)Jume (L)	

             5.3.1   Aluminum  solution, stock, 1 ml  = 1000 ug Al:  Dissolve  1.0  g
      of aluminum  metal, weighed accurately  to at least  four  significant
      figures,  in  an acid mixture  of 4 ml of (1:1) HC1 and  1 ml of concentrated
      HNO,  in  a beaker.  Warm  gently  to  effect  solution.  When  solution  is
      complete,  transfer quantitatively to  a liter  flask,  add an  additional

                                   6010A - 6                       Revision  1
                                                                   July  1992

-------
10 ml of  (1:1)  HC1  and dilute to volume in  a  1,000 ml volumetric flask
with water.

      5.3.2  Antimony  solution,  stock,  1  ml  =  1000  ug  Sb:   Dissolve
2.70 g K(SbO)C4H,06  (mole fraction Sb = 0.3749), weighed accurately to at
least four significant figures,  in  water, add 10 mL  (1:1) HC1, and dilute
to volume in a 1,000 ml volumetric flask with water.

      5.3.3  Arsenic solution, stock, 1 ml = 1000 ug As: Dissolve 1.30 g
of AsJDj  (mole fraction As = 0.7574), weighed accurately to at least four
significant figures, in 100 ml of water containing 0.4 g NaOH. Acidify the
solution with 2 ml  concentrated HN03 and dilute to volume in  a 1,000 ml
volumetric flask with water

      5.3.4  Barium solution, stock, 1 ml =  1000 ug Ba:  Dissolve 1.50 g
BaCl2 (mole fraction  Ba  =  0.6595), dried at 250°C  for 2  hours, weighed
accurately to at least four significant figures, in 10 ml water with  1 ml
(1:1) HC1.  Add  10.0  ml  (1:1) HC1  and  dilute  to  volume  in a  1,000 ml
volumetric flask with water.

      5.3.5  Beryllium solution, stock,  1 ml = 1000 ug Be:   Do not dry.
Dissolve 19.7 g  BeS04'4H20 (mole  fraction  Be = 0.0509),  weighed accurately
to at least four significant figures, in water, add 10.0 ml concentrated
HN03, and dilute to volume  in a  1,000 ml volumetric flask with   water.

      5.3.6  Cadmium solution, stock, 1  ml  =  1000  ug Cd:  Dissolve 1.10 g
CdO  (mole  fraction Cd  = 0.8754),  weighed  accurately to at  least  four
significant figures, in  a minimum amount of  (1:1) HN03. Heat to increase
rate of dissolution. Add  10.0 ml concentrated HN03 and dilute  to  volume in
a 1,000 ml volumetric flask with water.

      5.3.7  Calcium solution, stock, 1 ml = 1000 ug Ca:  Suspend 2.50 g
CaCO, (mole  Ca  fraction =  0.4005),  dried  at   180°C  for  1  hour  before
weighing,  weighed  accurately to at  least  four  significant  figures,  in
water and dissolve  cautiously with a minimum amount of  (1:1) HN03. Add 10.0
ml concentrated HN03 and dilute  to volume in a  1,000 ml volumetric flask
with water.

      5.3.8  Chromium  solution,  stock,  1  ml  =  1000  ug  Cr:   Dissolve
1.90 g CrO, (mole fraction Cr =  0.5200), weighed  accurately to at least
four significant figures,  in water. When  solution  is complete, acidify
with 10 ml concentrated HN03 and dilute to volume in a 1,000 ml volumetric
flask with water.

      5.3.9  Cobalt solution, stock, 1 ml =  1000  ug  Co:  Dissolve  1.00 g
of cobalt metal, weighed accurately to at least four significant figures,
in a minimum  amount of  (1:1) HNO,. Add 10.0 ml  (1:1)  HC1  and  dilute to
volume in a 1,000 ml volumetric flask with water.

      5.3.10  Copper solution, stock, 1 ml = 1000 ug Cu: Dissolve 1.30 g
CuO  (mole  fraction Cu  = 0.7989),  weighed  accurately to at  least  four
significant figures),  in a  minimum amount  of (1:1)  HN03.  Add 10.0 ml


                             6010A  -  7                      Revision 1
                                                            July 1992

-------
concentrated HN03  and dilute to volume in a 1,000 ml volumetric flask with
water.

      5.3.11  Iron solution, stock,  1 ml  = 1000  ug  Fe:   Dissolve 1.40 g
Fe203  (mole fraction Fe =  0.6994),  weighed accurately to  at least four
significant figures,  in  a  warm mixture of 20  ml (1:1)  HC1  and  2 ml of
concentrated HN03. Cool, add an  additional  5.0 ml of concentrated HN03, and
dilute to volume in a 1,000 ml volumetric flask with water.

      5.3.12  Lead solution, stock,  1 ml  = 1000  ug  Pb:   Dissolve 1.60 g
Pb(NO,)2  (mole fraction Pb  = 0.6256), weighed accurately to at least four
significant figures, in a  minimum  amount  of (1:1) HN03.  Add 10 ml (1:1)
HN03 and  dilute  to volume in a  1,000 ml  volumetric flask with water.

      5.3.13  Lithium solution, stock, 1 mL = 1000 ug  Li: Dissolve  5.324 g
lithium carbonate (mole fraction Li  = 0.1878),  weighed  accurately to at
least four significant figures, in  a minimum  amount  of  (1:1)  HC1  and
dilute to volume in a 1,000 mL volumetric  flask with water.

      5.3.14   Magnesium solution,   stock,  1 mL  = 1000 ug  Mg:  Dissolve
1.70 g MgO  (mole  fraction  Mg = 0.6030), weighed  accurately to at least
four significant figures, in a  minimum amount  of  (1:1) HN03.  Add   10.0 mL
(1:1) concentrated HN03 and dilute to volume in a 1,000 mL volumetric flask
with water.

      5.3.15  Manganese  solution,  stock,  1 mL  = 1000 ug  Mn:   Dissolve
1.00 g of manganese metal,  weighed accurately to at least four significant
figures,   in  acid  mixture  (10 mL concentrated HC1 and  1  mL  concentrated
HN03)  and dilute to  volume  in a 1,000 mL volumetric  flask with water.

      5.3.16  Molybdenum solution,  stock, 1 mL = 1000  ug  Mo:   Dissolve
2.00 g (NH,)6Mo7024.4H20 (mole fraction Mo = 0.5772), weighed  accurately to
at  least  four  significant  figures,  in  water  and dilute to  volume in a
1,000 mL volumetric flask with water.

      5.3.17  Nickel  solution,  stock,  1 mL  = 1000 ug  Ni:  Dissolve   1.00 g
of nickel metal, weighed accurately to at  least four  significant figures,
in 10.0 mL hot  concentrated HN03, cool, and dilute to volume in  a  1,000 mL
volumetric flask with water.

      5.3.18   Phosphate solution,  stock,  1  mL  =  1000 ug  P:  Dissolve
4.393 g anhydrous KH2P04 (mole fraction P = 0.2276), weighed  accurately to
at least four significant figures,  in water.  Dilute  to volume  in  a 1,000
mL volumetric flask with water.

      5.3.19  Potassium solution, stock, 1  mL = 1000  ug K: Dissolve 1.90 g
KC1 (mole  fraction  K = 0.5244)  dried at 110°C,  weighed  accurately to at
least four significant figures,  in  water,  and  dilute  to volume  in  a 1,000
mL volumetric flask with water.

      5.3.20  Selenium  solution, stock,  1  mL  = 1000 ug  Se:  Do not dry.
Dissolve  1.70 g H2Se03  (mole  fraction Se =  0.6123), weighed  accurately to


                             6010A  - 8                       Revision 1
                                                             July  1992

-------
      at least  four  significant figures, in water  and dilute to volume  in a
      1,000 ml volumetric flask with water.

            5.3.21  Silver solution, stock,  1 ml = 1000 ug Ag:  Dissolve
      1.60 g AgN03 (mole fraction Ag = 0.6350),  weighed accurately to at least
      four significant figures, in water and  10  ml concentrated HN03. Dilute to
      volume in a 1,000 ml volumetric flask with water.

            5.3.22  Sodium solution, stock,  1 ml = 1000 ug Na:  Dissolve 2.50 g
      NaCl  (mole  fraction  Na =  0.3934),  weighed  accurately to  at  least  four
      significant figures,  in water. Add  10.0 ml concentrated HN03 and dilute to
      volume in a 1,000 ml volumetric flask with water.

            5.3.23   Strontium  solution,  stock,  1  ml  =  1000 ug  Sr:  Dissolve
      2.415 g of  strontium  nitrate (Sr(NO,)2) (mole  fraction 0.4140),  weighed
      accurately  to  at  least  four  significant figures,  in a  1-liter  flask
      containing 10 ml of concentrated HC1 and 700 ml of water. Dilute to volume
      in a 1,000 ml volumetric flask with water.

            5.3.24   Thallium  solution,  stock,  1 ml =  1000 ug Tl:  Dissolve
      1.30 g T1NO, (mole fraction Tl = 0.7672),  weighed accurately to at least
      four  significant  figures,  in water. Add  10.0 ml  concentrated  HN03 and
      dilute to volume in a 1,000 ml volumetric flask with water.

            5.3.25  Vanadium solution, stock, 1 ml =  1000  ug   V: Dissolve 2.30 g
      NH403  (mole fraction  V  = 0.4356),  weighed  accurately to  at  least  four
      significant figures,  in  a minimum  amount of  concentrated  HNO,.  Heat to
      increase rate of dissolution. Add  10.0  ml  concentrated HN03 ana dilute to
      volume in a 1,000 ml volumetric flask with water.

            5.3.26  Zinc solution,  stock, 1 ml  =  1000  ug Zn:  Dissolve 1.20 g
      ZnO  (mole  fraction Zn =  0.8034),  weighed  accurately to  at  least  four
      significant figures,  in  a  minimum amount of  dilute  HNO,. Add  10.0 ml
      concentrated HN03 and  dilute  to volume in  a 1,000  ml volumetric flask with
      water.

      5.4    Mixed calibration  standard  solutions -  Prepare mixed calibration
standard solutions by  combining  appropriate  volumes  of the  stock solutions in
volumetric flasks (see Table 3).   Matrix match  with  the  appropriate acids and
dilute to 100 ml with  water. Prior to preparing  the mixed standards,  each stock
solution  should  be   analyzed   separately   to   determine  possible  spectral
interference or the presence of impurities. Care should be taken when preparing
the mixed  standards  to  ensure  that  the elements  are compatible  and  stable
together. Transfer the mixed standard solutions to FEP fluorocarbon or previously
unused polyethylene or polypropylene bottles  for storage.  Fresh mixed standards
should be prepared, as needed, with the realization that  concentration can change
on aging.  Calibration standards  must  be initially  verified using a  quality
control sample (see Step 5.8) and monitored weekly for stability. Some typical
calibration standard combinations are listed in Table 3.  All mixtures should then
be scanned using a sequential spectrometer to verify  the absence of interelement
spectral interference in the recommended mixed standard solutions.
                                   6010A  -  9                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
      NOTE:  If the  addition of  silver  to  the  recommended  acid  combination
            results  in  an initial precipitation, add 15 ml of water and warm the
            flask until the solution clears.  Cool  and dilute  to 100 ml
            with  water.  For this acid  combination,  the silver  concentration
            should be limited to 2 mg/L.  Silver  under  these conditions is stable
            in a  tap-water  matrix for 30 days.  Higher concentrations of silver
            require  additional  HC1.
                                   TABLE 3.
                           MIXED STANDARD SOLUTIONS
      Solution                      Elements
         I                    Be,  Cd,  Mn,  Pb,  Se and Zn
         II                   Ba,  Co,  Cu,  Fe,  and V
         III                  As,  Mo
         IV                   Al,  Ca,  Cr,  K,  Na, Ni,Li,& Sr
         V                    Ag (see  Note to Step 5.4), Mg,  Sb,  and Tl
         VI                   P
      5.5  Two types of blanks are  required  for  the  analysis.  The calibration
blank is used in establishing the  analytical curve, and the reagent  blank is used
to correct for possible contamination resulting from varying amounts of the acids
used in the sample processing.

            5.5.1  The calibration blank is prepared by acidifying reagent water
      to  the  same  concentrations  of  the  acids  found   in  the standards  and
      samples.    Prepare  a  sufficient quantity  to  flush  the system  between
      standards and samples.

            5.5.2  The method blank  must  contain all the reagents  and  in  the
      same volumes as used  in the processing of  the  samples.  The  method blank
      must be carried through the complete  procedure  and  contain the  same acid
      concentration  in  the  final  solution  as  the  sample  solution used  for
      analysis.

      5.6  The  instrument  check standard is prepared by the analyst by combining
compatible  elements  at  concentrations equivalent to the  midpoint of  their
respective calibration curves (see Step 8.6.1.1 for use).  The instrument check
standard  should  be  prepared from a  source  independent  from that  used  in  the
calibration standards.

      5.7   The  interference  check  solution  is  prepared to  contain  known
concentrations of interfering elements  that will  provide  an adequate test of the
correction factors.  Spike  the sample  with the elements  of  interest at approximate

                                  6010A - 10                      Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
      5.7   The  interference  check  solution  is  prepared  to  contain  known
concentrations of interfering  elements that will provide an  adequate test of the
correction factors.  Spike the sample with the elements of interest at approximate
concentrations of 10 times  the instrumental detection limits. In the absence of
measurable analyte,  overcorrection could go undetected  because a negative value
could  be  reported  as  zero.  If  the  particular  instrument  will   display
overcorrection  as  a  negative  number,  this  spiking  procedure  will  not  be
necessary.

      5.8  The quality control  sample should be prepared in  the same acid matrix
as the calibration standards at 10 times the instrumental detection limits and
in accordance with the instructions provided by the supplier.


6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

      6.1   See the  material  in  Chapter  Three,  Metallic  Analytes,  Steps 3.1
through 3.3.


7.0  PROCEDURE

      7.1   Preliminary treatment  of most  matrices is necessary because of the
complexity  and variability  of sample matrices.   Water  samples  which have been
prefiltered and acidified will  not need acid digestion as long as the samples and
standards  are matrix matched.    Solubilization  and digestion  procedures are
presented  in  Sample Preparation Methods (Methods 3005A-3050A).

      7.2  Set up the instrument with proper operating parameters established in
Step  4.2.  The instrument  must be  allowed  to become  thermally  stable before
beginning   (usually  requiring  at  least  30  minutes  of  operation  prior  to
calibration).

      7.3   Profile and calibrate the instrument  according  to  the instrument
manufacturer's  recommended procedures,  using  the typical  mixed calibration
standard solutions described in Step 5.4.  Flush the system  with the calibration
blank (Step 5.5.1) between  each standard or as the manufacturer recommends. (Use
the average intensity of multiple exposures for both standardization and sample
analysis  to reduce  random error.)   The calibration curve  should  consist of  a
blank and  three  standards.

      7.4    Before   beginning  the  sample run,  reanalyze  the highest   mixed
calibration standard as if  it were a sample. Concentration values obtained should
not deviate from  the actual values  by more than  5% (or the established control
limits,  whichever is lower).  If they do,  follow  the recommendations of the
instrument  manufacturer to  correct  for this condition.

      7.5   Flush the system with  the  calibration  blank solution  for at  least
1 minute  (Step 5.5.1) before the analysis  of each sample (see Note  to Step  7.3).
Analyze the instrument check standard (Step 5.6) and the calibration  blank  (Step
5.5.1) after  each 10 samples.
                                   6010A  -  11                       Revision  1
                                                                   July  1992

-------
8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

      8.1  All  quality control  data  should be maintained and available for easy
reference or inspection.   Refer  to  Chapter  One  for additional  quality control
procedures.

      8.2   Dilute and reanalyze samples that  are more concentrated  than the
linear calibration  limit  or use an  alternate,  less sensitive line  for which
quality control data is already established.

      8.3  Employ a  minimum of one method blank per sample batch to determine if
contamination or any memory effects are occurring.  A method blank is a volume
of reagent water acidified with the  same amounts of acids as were the standards
and samples.

      8.4   Analyze  one  replicate  sample  for  every  twenty  samples or  per
analytical batch, whichever is more frequent.  A  replicate  sample is a sample
brought through the whole sample preparation and analytical process  in duplicate..
Refer to Chapter One for a more detailed description of an  analytical batch.

      8.5   It  is  recommended  that  whenever  a new or unusual sample  matrix is
encountered, a  series of tests  be performed prior to reporting concentration data
for analyte elements. These tests,  as outlined  in Steps 8.5.1  and 8.5.2,  will
ensure the analyst that neither positive nor negative interferences  are operating
on any of the analyte elements to distort  the accuracy of  the reported values".

            8.5.1  Serial  dilution:  If the analyte  concentration is sufficiently
      high  (minimally, a  factor of  10 above the  instrumental  detection  limit
      after dilution), an analysis  of a 1:4  dilution should  agree within + 10%
      of the original determination. If not,  a chemical or physical interference
      effect should be suspected.

            8.5.2  Post digestion spike addition:  An analyte spike  added  to a
      portion of  a  prepared sample, or its  dilution,  should be  recovered to
      within 75% to 125% of the known value.  The spike addition should produce
      a minimum level of  10 times and a maximum of  100 times the instrumental
      detection  limit.  If  the  spike is not  recovered within the  specified
      limits, a matrix effect  should be suspected.

            CAUTION:    If spectral  overlap  is suspected, use  of computerized
                        compensation,  an alternate  wavelength, or  comparison
                        with an alternate method is recommended.

      8.6  Check the instrument standardization  by analyzing appropriate check
standards as follows.

            8.6.1  Verify calibration every 10  samples and  at  the end  of the
      analytical  run,  using  a  calibration   blank  (Step  5.5.1)   and  a  check
      standard  (Step 5.6).

                  8.6.1.1   The results of the check standard are to agree within
            10% of the expected value;  if not, terminate the analysis, correct
            the problem,  and reanalyze the previous ten samples.

                                  6010A - 12                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
                  8.6.1.2  The results  of  the calibration blank are  to  agree
            within three standard deviations of the mean  blank  value.  If not,
            repeat the analysis two more times and average the results.  If the
            average is not within three standard  deviations  of  the  background
            mean,  terminate the analysis, correct the problem, recalibrate, and
            reanalyze the previous 10 samples.

            8.6.2    Verify the  interelement and background  correction factors at
      the beginning and end of an analytical  run  or twice during  every  8-hour
      work  shift,  whichever   is  more  frequent.   Do  this  by  analyzing  the
      interference check solution (Step  5.7).  Results should be within + 20% of
      the true value obtained in  Step 8.6.1.1.

            8.6.3    Spiked replicate samples are to be  analyzed at a frequency
      of 5% or per analytical  batch, whichever is  more  frequent.

                  8.6.3.1  The relative percent  difference  between  replicate
            determinations is to be calculated as  follows:


                              Dl  ' D2
                       RPD =
                             (D  + D2)/2
            where:

                  RPD = relative percent difference.
                   D1 = first sample  value.
                   D2 = second sample value  (replicate).


                  (A control limit of +  20%  RPD shall be used for sample values
            greater than ten times the instrument detection limit.)

                  8.6.3.2  The spiked replicate sample recovery is to be within
            + 20% of the actual value.
9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

      9.1   In an EPA round-robin Phase  1  study, seven laboratories applied the
ICP technique to  acid-distilled water matrices that had been spiked with various
metal concentrates. Table 4  lists the true values,  the mean reported values, and
the mean percent relative standard deviations.

      9.2   In a single laboratory evaluation, seven wastes were  analyzed for 22
elements by  this  method. The mean percent  relative standard  deviation  from
triplicate analyses  for all  elements  and wastes was  9 ± 2%.  The mean percent
recovery of spiked elements  for all wastes was 93 + 6%. Spike levels ranged from
100 ug/L to 100 mg/L. The wastes included sludges and industrial wastewaters.
                                  6010A - 13                      Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
10.0  REFERENCES

1.    Winge, R.K.; Peterson, V.J.; Fassel, V.A. Inductively Coupled Plasma-Atomic
Emission Spectroscopy:  Prominent Lines (final  report, March 1977 -February 1978);"
EPA-600/4-79-017, Environmental Research Laboratory, Athens, GA, March 1979; Ames
Laboratory: Ames IA.


2.    Test  Methods:  Methods for  Organic Chemical Analysis  of Municipal  and
Industrial Wastewater;  U.S.  Environmental  Protection agency. Office of Research
and Development.  Environmental Monitoring and Support Laboratory. ORD Publication
Offices of Center for Environmental  Research  Information: Cincinnati, OH, 1982;
EPA-600/4-82-057.

3.    Patel, B.K.; Raab, G.A.; et al. Report on a Single Laboratory Evaluation
of Inductively Coupled Optical Emission Method 6010; EPA Contract No. 68-03-3050"
December 1984.

4.    Sampling  and   Analysis  Methods  for  Hazardous   Waste  Combustion;  U.S.
Environmental Protection Agency; Air and Energy Engineering Research Laboratory,
Office of Research and  Development: Research Triangle Park,  NC, 1986; Prepared
by Arthur D. Little, Inc.

5.    Bowmand, P.W.J.M. Line Coincidence Tables for Inductively Coupled Plasma
Atomic Emission Spectrometry, 2nd ed.; Pergamon: 1984.

6.    Rohrbough,  W.G.;  et  al.  Reagent  Chemicals,  American  Chemical  Society
Specifications,  7th ed.; American Chemical Society:  Washington, DC, 1986.

7.    1985 Annual Book of ASTM Standards. Vol. 11.01; "Standard Specification for
Reagent Water";  ASTM: Philadelphia, PA,  1985; D1193-77.
                                  6010A - 14                      Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
                                  TABLE 4.
                      ICP PRECISION AND ACCURACY DATA*
        Sample No. 1
Sample No. 2
Sample No. 3
Mean Re-
Ele-
ment
Be
Mn
V
As
Cr
Cu
Fe
Al
Cd
Co
N1
Pb
Zn
Sec
True
Value
(ug/L)
750
350
750
200
150
250
600
700
50
700
250
250
200
40
ported
Value
(ug/L)
733
345
749
208
149
235
594
696
48
512
245
236
201
32
Mean.
SDb
(%)
6.2
2.7
1.8
7.5
3.8
5.1
3.0
5.6
12
10
5.8
16
5.6
21.9
True
Value
(ug/L)
20
15
70
22
10
11
20
60
2.5
20
30
24
16
6
ported
Value
(ug/L)
20
15
69
19
10
11
19
62
2.9
20
28
30
19
8.5
Mean Re-
Mean.
SDb
(%)
9.8
6.7
2.9
23
18
40
15
33
16
4.1
11
32
45
42
True
Value
(ug/L)
180
100
170
60
50
70
180
160
14
120
60
80
80
10
Mean Re-
ported
Value
(ug/L)
176
99
169
63
50
67
178
161
13
108
55
80
82
8.5
Mean.
SD b
(%)
5.2
3.3
1.1
17
3.3
7.9
6.0
13
16
21
14
14
9.4
8.3
     all  elements  were analyzed  by all  laboratories.

    = standard deviation.

°Results  for Se are from two laboratories.
                                  6010A - 15
                            Revision 1
                            July 1992

-------
                                                 METHOD 6010A
                      INDUCTIVELY  COUPLED  PLASMA-ATOMIC  EMISSION SPECTROSCOPY
                       I. H.O
                     acidified,  \  No
                    pra-filt.r.d?
                      7.1 U»«
                    M.thod 3005
                                                            7.2 S.t up
                                                            nd stabilize
                                                            in»trum.nt
  I*  sample
oil*,gr.as.s
   wax.s?
  7.1  Use
M.thod 3040
                         I.
                       •ample
                     analyzed by
                     FLAA/ICP o
                        CFAA?
                      7.1 U*«
                    Method 3020
                    and M.thod
                       7000
    sampla
aqueou* or
  solid?
  7.1 Us.
Method 3050
                      7.1 Us.
                    M.thod 3010
 7.3  Profil.
and calibrat.
 instrum.nt
                                                                              7.4 R.analyz.
                                                                              high.st mix.d
                                                                              calibration
                                                                                standard
                       Adjust
                   instrum.nt  per
                    manufacturer
                   r.commendat ions
                                                                               7.5 Flush
                                                                              syst.m and
                                                                                analyz.
                                                                                sanpl.
                                                                               7.5  Analyze
                                                                             ch.ck  standard
                                                                             and  calibration
                                                                               blank aft.r
                                                                             •ach 10 sampl.s
                                                                              7.6  Calculate
                                                                             concentrations
                                                                                 Stop
                                                    6010A  -  16
                                                                        Revision  1
                                                                        July  1992

-------
                                 METHOD 6020

                INDUCTIVELY COUPLED PLASMA - MASS SPECTROMETRY


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

      1.1  Inductively coupled plasma-mass spectrometry (ICP-MS) is applicable
to the determination of sub-/yg/L concentrations of a large  number of elements in
water  samples  and  in waste  extracts  or  digests  [1,2].     When  dissolved
constituents are required, samples  must be  filtered  and acid-preserved prior to
analysis.  No digestion is required prior to analysis for  dissolved elements in
water samples.  Acid digestion prior to filtration  and analysis  is required for
groundwater, aqueous samples,  industrial wastes,  soils, sludges, sediments, and
other solid wastes for which total   (acid-leachable) elements are required.

      1.2  ICP-MS has  been applied  to the determination of over 60 elements in
various matrices.  Analytes for which EPA  has  demonstrated the acceptability of
Method 6020  in a multi -laboratory study on solid wastes are listed in Table 1.
Acceptability of the method for an  element was based upon the multi -laboratory
performance compared with that of either furnace  atomic absorption spectroscopy
or inductively coupled plasma-atomic emission spectroscopy.   It  should be noted
that  the  multi -laboratory study  was conducted in  1986.    Multi -laboratory
performance data for the listed elements (and others) are provided  in Section 9.
Instrument detection limits, sensitivities, and linear ranges will vary with the
matrices,  instrumentation, and  operating conditions.    In  relatively  simple
matrices, detection  limits will generally be  below  0.02
      1.3   If Method 6020  is used to determine any analyte not listed  in Table
1,  it  is the  responsibility  of the  analyst  to demonstrate  the accuracy  and
precision of  the Method in the  waste  to be analyzed.   The  analyst is always
required  to monitor potential  sources of  interferences  and  take  appropriate
action to ensure data of known quality  (see Section 8.4).

      1.4    Use of this  method  is   restricted  to  spectroscopists  who   are
knowledgeable in the recognition  and in the correction of spectral, chemical,  and
physical  interferences  in  ICP-MS.

      1.5   An  appropriate  internal   standard  is required  for  each  analyte
determined  by  ICP-MS.   Recommended  internal standards are 6Li,   Sc,   Y,    Rh,
115In,  159Tb,  165Ho, and  209Bi .    The  lithium internal standard  should have  an
enriched abundance of 6Li ,  so that interference from lithium native to the sample
is  minimized.   Other elements may  need  to  be used  as internal  standards when
samples contain  significant amounts of the  recommended internal  standards.

2.0 SUMMARY  OF  METHOD

      2.1  Prior to  analysis,  samples which  require total  ("acid-leachable")
values must be  digested using  appropriate sample  preparation  methods (such   as
Methods 3005  -  3051).


                                    6020-1                         Revision   0
                                                                   September  1994

-------
       2.2   Method  6020  describes  the multi-elemental determination  of analytes
 by  ICP-MS.   The  method  measures  ions produced  by  a  radio-frequency  inductively
 coupled  plasma.  Analyte  species  originating in a liquid  are  nebulized and  the
 resulting  aerosol  transported by  argon  gas into  the  plasma  torch.   The  ions
 produced are  entrained  in  the   plasma  gas and  introduced,  by means  of  an
 interface,  into  a mass spectrometer.  The ions  produced in the plasma are sorted
 according to their mass-to-charge ratios and quantified with a channel  electron
 multiplier.  Interferences must be assessed  and valid corrections applied or  the
 data  flagged  to  indicate  problems.     Interference  correction  must  include
 compensation for background  ions  contributed by the plasma gas,  reagents,  and
 constituents of  the  sample matrix.

 3.0   INTERFERENCES

      3.1   Isobaric elemental interferences in  ICP-MS  are  caused by  isotopes of
 different elements  forming atomic ions with the same nominal mass-to-charge ratio
 (m/z). A data  system must be  used to  correct for  these  interferences.  This
 involves determining the  signal for another isotope of the  interfering element
 and subtracting  the  appropriate signal  from the analyte isotope  signal.  Since
 commercial  ICP-MS  instruments  nominally  provide unit  resolution at 10%  of  the
 peak height, very high ion currents at adjacent  masses can also contribute to  ion
 signals at the  mass of interest. Although this type of  interference is uncommon,
 it is not easily  corrected, and samples exhibiting  a  significant problem of this
 type could require  resolution improvement, matrix  separation,  or  analysis using
 another  verified and documented isoptope, or use of another method.

      3.2  Isobaric molecular and doubly-charged ion  interferences in ICP-MS  are
 caused by ions consisting of more than  one atom or charge, respectively.  Most
 isobaric  interferences  that could  affect  ICP-MS  determinations   have been
 identified  in  the  literature [3,4].   Examples include  ArCl +  ions  on  the  75As
 signal and  MoO+  ions on  the  cadmium  isotopes.   While  the  approach  used   to
 correct  for  molecular  isobaric interferences is  demonstrated  below using   the
 natural isotope abundances from the literature [5],  the most precise coefficients
 for an instrument can be  determined from the ratio  of  the net isotope signals
 observed for  a  standard  solution at  a  concentration  providing  suitable   (<1
 percent)  counting  statistics.    Because   the 35C1  natural  abundance  of 75.77
 percent  is  3.13  times  the  37C1   abundance of  24.23   percent,   the   chloride
correction for arsenic can be calculated  (approximately) as follows (where  the
38Ar37Cl+ contribution at  m/z 75  is a  negligible 0.06 percent  of the 40Ar35Cl +
signal) :

      corrected  arsenic  signal   (using  natural  isotopes   abundances  for
      coefficient approximations)  =

      (m/z 75 signal) -  (3.13)  (m/z 77  signal)  +  (2.73)  (m/z 82 signal),
      (where the  final  term adjusts for  any selenium contribution at 77 m/z),

      NOTE:  Arsenic values can  be  biased  high by this type of equation when  the
      net signal  at m/z 82 is caused by ions other than  SiSe+ ,  (e.g.,  81BrH+ from
      bromine wastes [6]) .
                                    6020-2                         Revision 0
                                                                  September 1994

-------
Similarly,

      corrected  cadmium   signal   (using  natural   isotopes   abundances  for
      coefficient approximations) =

      (m/z 114 signal) - (0.027)(m/z 118 signal) - (1.63)(m/z 108 signal),
      (where last 2 terms adjust for  any  tin or MoO+  contributions at m/z 114).

      NOTE: Cadmium  values will be  biased  low  by this type  of  equation when
      S2ZrO+  ions  contribute  at m/z 108,  but  use of  m/z  111 for  Cd  is even
      subject to direct  (94ZrOH+) and indirect  (90ZrO+) additive interferences
      when Zr is present.

      NOTE: As  for  the  arsenic equation  above,  the  coefficients  in  the  Cd
      equation are ONLY illustrative. The  most  appropriate coefficients  for an
      instrument can  be  determined from the ratio of  the  net isotope signals
      observed for a standard  solution at a concentration providing suitable (<1
      percent) counting precision.

The  accuracy  of these types  of equations  is  based  upon the  constancy of the
OBSERVED isotopic ratios for the interfering species.   Corrections that presume
a constant fraction of a molecular ion relative to the "parent" ion have  not been
found [7] to be reliable,  e.g., oxide levels can vary.  If a  correction  for an
oxide  ion is  based upon  the ratio of  parent-to-oxide ion  intensities,  the
correction must be  adjusted for the  degree of oxide  formation by the use of an
appropriate oxide  internal  standard  previously  demonstrated  to form a similar
level of oxide as the  interferant.  This  type of correction has been reported [7]
for  oxide-ion  corrections  using ThO+/Th+  for the  determination  of rare earth
elements.  The use  of  aerosol desolvation  and/or mixed  plasmas have been shown
to greatly  reduce  molecular  interferences  [8].    These techniques  can be used
provided that method detection limits,  accuracy,  and  precision requirements for
analysis  of the samples  can be  met.

      3.3  Physical interferences are associated  with  the sample nebulization and
transport processes as well as with ion-transmission efficiencies.  Nebulization
and  transport processes can be affected  if  a matrix component  causes  a change in
surface  tension  or  viscosity.   Changes  in  matrix  composition  can  cause
significant signal suppression or enhancement [9].  Dissolved  solids  can deposit
on the  nebulizer tip  of a pneumatic nebulizer and  on the interface  skimmers
(reducing the orifice  size and the instrument  performance).   Total solid  levels
below 0.2%  (2,000  mg/L)  have  been  currently recommended [10]  to minimize solid
deposition.    An  internal  standard can  be  used  to  correct   for   physical
interferences, if it is carefully matched to the  analyte so that the two  elements
are  similarly  affected by  matrix changes  [11].  When the intensity  level  of an
internal  standard  is less than 30 percent  or greater  than 120 percent  of the
intensity of  the  first  standard  used during calibration, the  sample must be
reanalyzed  after a fivefold  (1+4)  or greater dilution  has  been performed.

      3.4  Memory interferences  can occur when there  are large concentration
differences between samples or standards which  are analyzed sequentially.  Sample


                                     6020-3                       Revision  0
                                                                  September 1994

-------
 deposition  on the sampler and skimmer cones, spray chamber design, and the type
 of  nebulizer affect  the  extent  of  the memory  interferences  which  are observed.
 The rinse  period between samples must be long enough to  eliminate  significant
 memory  interference.

 4.0 APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

      4.1   Inductively coupled  plasma-mass  spectrometer:

            4.1.1   A system  capable  of providing  resolution,  better than  or
      equal to amu at 10% peak height is required.  The  system must  have  a mass
      range from at least 6  to 240  amu and a data system  that allows  corrections
      for  isobaric  interferences and  the application of  the  internal  standard
      technique.  Use of a  mass-flow controller for the  nebulizer  argon  and  a
      peristaltic pump for  the  sample solution are  recommended.

            4.1.2  Argon gas  supply:  high-purity grade (99.99%).

 5.0  REAGENTS

      5.1  Acids used in  the preparation of  standards  and  for  sample processing
 must be of  high purity.   Redistilled acids  are recommended  because  of  the high
 sensitivity of ICP-MS.  Nitric acid at less than 2 per cent (v/v) is required for
 ICP-MS to minimize damage to the  interface and to minimize isobaric  molecular-ion
 interferences with  the  analytes.   Many more molecular-ion interferences are
 observed on the  analytes when hydrochloric  and  sulfuric acids are  used  [3,4].
 Concentrations of antimony  and  silver between 50-500/yg/L require 1% (v/v) HC1
 for  stability;  for  concentrations above 500  /yg/L Ag, additional HC1  will be
 needed.

      5.2  Reagent water:  All  references to  water in the  method refer to reagent
water unless otherwise  specified.   Refer to  Chapter One for  a  definition of
 reagent water.

      5.3  Standard stock solutions may be purchased  or prepared from ultra-high
purity grade chemicals or metals (99.99  or greater purity  ).  See  Method 6010A,
Section  5.3, for instructions on preparing  standard solutions from  solids.

            5.3.1  Bismuth internal standard solution, stock,  1 mL = 100/yg Bi:
      Dissolve  0.1115 g Bi203 in a minimum  amount of dilute  HN03.   Add   10 mL
      cone. HN03  and  dilute  to 1,000  mL  with reagent water.

            5.3.2  Holmium internal standard solution, stock,  1 mL = 100 /yg Ho:
      Dissolve  0.1757 g Ho2(C03)2-5H20  in 10 mL reagent water  and  10 mL  HN03.
      After dissolution  is  complete,  warm   the  solution  to  degas.   Add   10 mL
      cone.  HN03  and  dilute  to 1,000 mL  with reagent water.

            5.3.3  Indium internal  standard  solution,  stock, 1 mL =  100 //g In:
      Dissolve  0.1000 g  indium metal in  10  mL cone.  HN03.   Dilute to 1,000 mL
      with  reagent  water.


                                    6020-4                         Revision 0
                                                                  September 1994

-------
            5.3.4  Lithium  internal standard solution, stock, 1 ml = 100//g 6Li:
      Dissolve 0.6312  g 95-atom-% 6Li, Li2C03 in 10 ml of reagent water  and 10 ml
      HN03.   After dissolution  is  complete,  warm the solution to  degas.   Add
      10 ml cone. HN03 and  dilute  to  1,000 ml  with reagent water.

            5.3.5  Rhodium  internal  standard  solution,  stock,  1 ml  = 100 fjg Rh:
      Dissolve 0.3593 g ammonium  hexachlororhodate (III)  (NH4)3RhCl6  in 10 ml
      reagent water.   Add 100 ml cone. HC1 and dilute to 1,000 ml with reagent
      water.

            5.3.6  Scandium internal  standard solution, stock, 1 ml = 100fjg Sc:
      Dissolve 0.15343 g  Sc203 in 10 mL (1+1) hot HN03.   Add 5  ml  cone.  HN03 and
      dilute to 1,000 ml  with reagent water.

            5.3.7  Terbium  internal  standard  solution,  stock,  1 ml  = 100//g Tb:
      Dissolve 0.1828 g Tb2(C03)3-5H20 in  10 ml (1+1) HN03.  After  dissolution is
      complete, warm the  solution to degas.  Add 5 ml cone. HN03 and dilute to
      1,000 ml with reagent water.

            5.3.8  Yttrium internal standard solution, stock,  1  ml =  100 fjg Y:
      Dissolve 0.2316 g Y2(C03)3.3H20  in  10 ml  (1+1)  HN03.   Add 5 ml cone. HN03
      and dilute to 1,000 mL with reagent water.

            5.3.9  Titanium solution,  stock, 1 mL = 100fjg Ti:  Dissolve  0.4133  g
      (NH4)2TiF6  in reagent water.  Add 2  drops cone. HF  and dilute to  1,000 mL
      with reagent water.

            5.3.10   Molybdenum  solution, stock,  1 mL  =  100 /yg  Mo:    Dissolve
      0.2043 g  (NH4)2Mo04  in reagent  water.   Dilute to  1,000 mL with reagent
      water.

      5.4  Mixed calibration  standard solutions  are prepared by diluting  the
stock-standard solutions  to levels in the linear range for  the instrument in  a
solvent consisting of 1 percent (v/v) HN03  in reagent water.   The calibration
standard  solutions  must  contain  a  suitable  concentration of  an appropriate
internal standard for each  analyte.   Internal  standards  may be added on-line at
the time  of analysis using  a second channel  of the peristaltic  pump and an
appropriate mixing manifold.)  Generally,  an internal standard should be no more
than 50 amu  removed  from the  analyte.  Recommended internal  standards  include
6Li,  45Sc, 89Y,  103Rh,  115In,  159Tb, f69Ho, and 209Bi.   Prior to preparing  the mixed
standards, each stock solution must be analyzed separately to determine possible
spectral interferences or the presence of impurities.  Care must be taken when
preparing  the  mixed  standards  that  the  elements are  compatible  and  stable.
Transfer the mixed standard solutions to  freshly  acid-cleaned  FEP  fluorocarbon
bottles for storage.   Fresh mixed standards must be prepared as needed with the
realization that concentrations  can change on aging.  Calibration  standards must
be initially  verified using a quality control  standard  (see Section  5.7) and
monitored weekly for  stability.
                                    6020-5                         Revision  0
                                                                   September 1994

-------
      5.5   Blanks:  Three types of blanks  are  required  for the analysis.   The
calibration  blank  is  used  in  establishing  the  calibration   curve.     The
preparation blank is used to monitor for possible  contamination resulting  from
the sample preparation procedure.  The rinse blank is used to  flush the  system
between all samples and  standards.

            5.5.1  The calibration blank consists  of the same  concentration(s)
      of the same acid(s) used to prepare the  final dilution of the calibrating
      solutions  of  the  analytes [often 1 percent HN03  (v/v)  in reagent  water]
      along with the  selected concentrations  of  internal  standards  such  that
      there  is  an  appropriate  internal  standard element  for  each  of   the
      analytes.  Use of HC1 for antimony and silver is cited in Section  5.1

            5.5.2  The  preparation  (or reagent)  blank  must be carried through
      the  complete  preparation procedure  and contain  the  same volumes of
      reagents as the sample solutions.

            5.5.3   The  rinse blank consists  of  1 to 2  percent  HN03  (v/v) in
      reagent water.  Prepare a sufficient  quantity to flush the system between
      standards  and samples.

            NOTE: The   ICS  solutions  in  Table   2  are  intended  to  evaluate
            corrections for known  interferences on only the analytes in Table 1.
            If Method 6020 is used to determine an element not listed in Table
            1,  it  is  the responsibility  of   the  analyst to  modify the   ICS
            solutions,  or prepare  an alternative ICS solution, to allow adequate
            verification of correction  of interferences on the  unlisted element
            (see section 8.4).

      5.6  The interference check solution  (ICS)  is  prepared  to  contain known
concentrations of interfering elements that will  demonstrate  the  magnitude of
interferences and provide an adequate test  of any  corrections.  Chloride  in the
ICS provides  a  means  to evaluate  software  corrections  for  chloride-related
interferences such as 35C1160+  on  5V  and  40Ar35Cl+ on  75As+.   Iron  is used to
demonstrate adequate resolution  of  the spectrometer  for  the  determination of
manganese.  Molybdenum serves to indicate  oxide  effects on cadmium isotopes.  The
other components are present to evaluate the ability  of the measurement  system
to correct  for  various molecular-ion isobaric interferences. The ICS is used to
verify that the  interference  levels are corrected by  the data system  within
quality control limits.

            5.6.1  These solutions must  be  prepared  from ultra-pure  reagents.
      They  can be obtained commercially or prepared by the following procedure.

                  5.6.1.1   Mixed ICS  solution I  may  be  prepared  by  adding
            13.903 g A1(N03)3-9H20,  2.498 g CaC03 (dried at 180  C for 1 h before
            weighing),  1.000 g Fe, 1.658 g MgO,  2.305  g Na2C03,  and  1.767  g K2C03
            to 25 ml of reagent water.   Slowly add 40 ml of (1+1)  HN03.   After
            dissolution   is  complete,  warm the solution to degas.    Cool  and
            dilute to  1,000  ml with  reagent water.


                                    6020-6                         Revision   0
                                                                  September  1994

-------
                  5.6.1.2   Mixed  ICS solution  II  may  be  prepared by  slowly
            adding 7.444 g 85 % H3P04, 6.373 g 96% H2S04, 40.024 g 37% HC1,  and
            10.664 g  citric acid C607H8 to 100 ml of  reagent  water.   Dilute to
            1,000  ml  with  reagent  water.

                  5.6.1.3   Mixed  ICS solution III may  be prepared by  adding
            1.00 ml  each  of  100-/yg/mL   arsenic,  cadmium,  chromium,  cobalt,
            copper, manganese, nickel, silver, and zinc stock  solutions to about
            50 ml   reagent water.  Add 2.0 ml concentrated HN03,  and  dilute to
            100.0  ml  with  reagent  water.

                  5.6.1.4   Working ICS Solutions

                        5.6.1.4.1   ICS-A may be prepared  by  adding  10.0 ml of
                  mixed ICS  solution I  (5.7.1.1),   2.0 ml  each  of  100-/yg/mL
                  titanium stock solution (5.3.9) and molybdenum stock solution
                  (5.3.10),   and  5.0 ml   of  mixed ICS  solution  II  (5.7.1.2).
                  Dilute  to 100 ml with  reagent water.  ICS solution A must be
                  prepared fresh weekly.

                        5.6.1.4.2   ICS-AB may be prepared by adding 10.0 ml of
                  mixed ICS  solution I  (5.7.1.1),   2.0 ml  each  of  100-//g/mL
                  titanium stock solution (5.3.9) and molybdenum stock solution
                   (5.3.10),  5.0 ml  of mixed  ICS solution  II  (5.7.1.2),  and
                  2.0 ml  of Mixed  ICS solution  III (5.7.1.3).  Dilute to 100 ml
                  with reagent  water.   Although the  ICS  solution AB  must be
                  prepared fresh weekly, the analyst  should  be aware that the
                  solution may precipitate silver more quickly.

      5.7  The quality control  standard is the initial calibration verification
solution (ICV),  which must be prepared in  the same acid matrix  as the calibration
standards.  This solution must be an independent standard near the midpoint of
the  linear range  at  a  concentration  other  than  that  used for  instrument
calibration.  An independent standard is defined as a standard composed of the
analytes from a source different from those used in the standards  for instrument
calibration.

      5.8  Mass spectrometer tuning  solution.   A solution containing elements
representing all of the mass regions of interest (for example, 10/yg/L of  Li, Co,
In, and Tl) must be prepared  to verify that the resolution and mass calibration
of the instrument  are within the required  specifications  (see Section 7.5).  This
solution is also used to verify that the instrument has reached thermal stability
(See Section 7.4).

6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

      6.1   Sample  collection  procedures  should  address the  considerations
described  in Chapter Nine of this Manual.
                                    6020-7                        Revision  0
                                                                  September 1994

-------
       6.2   See  the  introductory  material  in  Chapter  Three,  Inorganic  Analytes,
 Sections  3.1.3  for information  on  sample  handling and  preservation.    Only
 polyethylene  or fluorocarbon  (TFE or PFA) containers are recommended for use in
 Method 6020.

 7.0    PROCEDURE

       7.1   Solubilization  and digestion  procedures are  presented  in the  Sample
 Preparation Methods (e.g., Methods 3005  - 3051).

       7.2   Initiate  appropriate operating  configuration  of  the  instruments
 computer according  to the  instrument manufacturer's  instructions.

       7.3   Set  up the instrument with the proper  operating  parameters  according
 to the instrument manufacturer's  instructions.

       7.4   Operating conditions:  The analyst  should follow the  instructions
 provided by the instrument manufacturer.   Allow at  least  30  minutes for  the
 instrument  to equilibrate  before  analyzing any samples.  This must be verified
 by analyzing  a  tuning solution (Section  5.8) at  least four  times with relative
 standard deviations of < 5% for the analytes contained  in the tuning  solution..

            NOTE:   Precautions  must  be  taken to protect  the channel  electron
            multiplier from high ion  currents.  The channel  electron multiplier
            suffers from fatigue after  being  exposed to high ion  currents.  This
            fatigue  can  last  from several  seconds  to  hours depending  on  the
            extent  of exposure.  During  this time period, response factors  are
            constantly changing,  which  invalidates the calibration  curve, causes
            instability, and  invalidates sample  analyses.

       7.5  Conduct mass calibration and resolution checks in the  mass regions of
 interest.  The mass  calibration  and resolution parameters are required criteria
which must be met prior to  any samples  being  analyzed.   If the mass calibration
differs more than 0.1  amu from the true value, then the mass  calibration must be
adjusted to the correct value.  The resolution must also be  verified to be less
than 0.9 amu full width at 10 percent peak height.

       7.6   Calibrate the instrument  for  the  analytes of interest (recommended
isotopes for  the analytes  in Table  1  are  provided in  Table  3), using  the
calibration blank and at least a single  initial  calibration standard according
to the  instrument manufacturer's  procedure.  Flush  the system  with the rinse
blank  (5.5.3)  between each  standard solution.  Use the average of at leastthree
integrations for both calibration and sample analyses.

      7.7   All  masses  which  could affect data quality  should  be  monitored to
determine potential  effects from matrix  components on the  analyte peaks.  The
recommended isotopes to be  monitored  are  liste in Table  3.

      7.8    Immediately  after   the  calibration  has   been  established,  the
calibration must be  verified and documented for every  analyte by  the analysis of
the calibration verification solution (Section 5.7).   When measurements exceed

                                    6020-8                        Revision  0
                                                                  September 1994

-------
±  10%  of the  accepted value,  the  analyses must  be terminated,  the problem
corrected, the instrument recalibrated, and the new calibration verified.  Any
samples analyzed under an out-of-control calibration must be reanalyzed.  During
the course of an analytical run,  the  instrument may be "resloped" or recalibrated
to  correct   for  instrument  drift.    A  recalibration  must  then  be  followed
immediately by a new analysis of a CCV and CCB before any further  samples may be
analyzed.

      7.9   Flush  the system  with the  rinse blank  solution  (5.5.3)  until  the
signal  levels return  to the  method's  levels of quantitation (usually about 30
seconds) before the analysis  of each sample (see Section 7.7).   Nebulize each
sample until a steady-state signal  is  achieved  (usually  about 30 seconds) prior
to collecting data.  Analyze the calibration verification solution (Section 5.6)
and the calibration blank (Section  5.5.1)  at a  frequency of at least once every
10 analytical samples.  Flow- injection systems may be used as long as they can
meet the performance criteria of this method.

      7.10   Dilute  and reanalyze  samples that are  more concentrated  than the
linear range for an analyte  (or species needed for a correction) or measure an
alternate less-abundant isotope.  The  linearity  at  the  alternate mass must be
confirmed by appropriate calibration (see Sec. 7.6 and 7.8).

      7.11   Calculations:    The  quantitative values  shall  be  reported  in
appropriate units, such as micrograms per liter (//g/L) for aqueous samples and
milligrams per kilogram (mg/kg)  for  solid samples.   If dilutions were performed,
the appropriate corrections must be applied to the sample values.

            7.11.1  If appropriate,  or required, calculate results for  solids on
      a dry-weight basis as follows:

                  (1)   A  separate  determination  of percent  solids must  be
                        performed.

                  (2)   The concentrations  determined in  the digest  are to be
                        reported on the basis of the dry weight of the sample.

                                                       r y v
                  Concentration (dry weight) (mg/kg) =  rj A *
                        Where,

                  C = Digest Concentration (mg/L)
                  V = Final volume in liters after sample preparation
                  W = Weight in kg of wet sample

                       % Solids
                          100

      Calculations  should  include  appropriate  interference  corrections  (see
      Section  3.2  for  examples),  internal -standard  normalization,  and  the


                                    6020-9                        Revision  0
                                                                  September 1994

-------
      summation of signals at 206, 207, and 208 m/z  for  lead  (to compensate  for
      any differences  in  the abundances  of these isotopes between samples  and
      standards).

8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

      8.1  All  quality control  data  should be maintained and be available  for
easy reference or inspection.

      8.2   Instrument  Detection  Limits  (IDLs)  in jjg/l  can be  estimated by
calculating the average of  the  standard  deviations  of the three runs on three
non-consecutive days from the analysis of a reagent blank solution with seven
consecutive measurements per day.   Each measurement  must be performed as though
it were a separate analytical sample (i.e., each measurement must be followed by
a rinse  and/or  any other  procedure  normally performed between the analysis of
separate samples).  IDLs must be determined at least every three months and kept
with the instrument log book.  Refer to Chapter One for additional guidance.

      8.3  The intensities of all  internal standards must be monitored for every
analysis.  When the  intensity of any  internal  standard fails  to fall between 30
and  120  percent  of  the intensity of  that  internal  standard in  the  initial
calibration standard, the following procedure is followed.  The sample must be
diluted fivefold  (1+4) and reanalyzed with the addition of appropriate amounts
of  internal  standards.   This procedure  must be repeated  until  the  internal-
standard intensities  fall within the prescribed window.  The intensity levels of
the internal  standards for the calibration blank  (Section 5.5.1) and instrument
check standard  (Section 5.6)  must agree  within ± 20  percent of the  intensity
level of the  internal standard of the original calibration solution.  If they do
not agree,  terminate  the analysis, correct the problem,  recalibrate, verify the
new calibration, and reanalyze the affected samples.

      8.4  To obtain analyte data of known quality,  it  is necessary to measure
more than the  analytes  of interest in order to apply  corrections or to determine
whether  interference  corrections  are  necessary.   If  the  concentrations  of
interference sources  (such as C, Cl, Mo, Zr, W) are such  that, at the correction
factor,   the  analyte  is  less  than   the  limit  of  quantification  and  the
concentration  of  interferents   are  insignificant,  then  the  data  may  go
uncorrected.   Note that monitoring the interference sources does not necessarily
require monitoring the interferant itself, but that a molecular species may be
monitored to  indicate  the   presence  of   the interferent.   When  correcttion
equations are  used,   all  QC  criteria  must  also be  met.    Extensive QC  for
interference corrections are required at  all times.   The monitored masses must
include those elements  whose hydrogen, oxygen,  hydroxyl,  chlorine,  nitrogen,
carbon  and  sulfur  molecular  ions  could impact  the  analytes  of  interest.
Unsuspected  interferences may be detected by adding pure  major matrix components
to a sample  to observe  any impact  on the analyte signals.  When an interference
source is present, the  sample elements  impacted must be  flagged to indicate  (a)
the percentage interference correction applied to the data or  (b) an uncorrected
interference by virtue  of the  elemental  equation used  for quantitation.   The
isotope proportions for an element or molecular-ion cluster provide information
useful  for quality assurance.

                                   6020-10                        Revision  0
                                                                  September  1994

-------
      NOTE:  Only isobaric elemental, molecular,  and doubly charged interference
      corrections which use the observed  isotopic-response ratios or parent-to-
      oxide ratios (provided an oxide internal standard  is used as described in
      Section 3.2) for each  instrument system are acceptable corrections for use
      in Method 6020.

      8.5  Dilution  Test:   If the analyte concentration  is  within  the linear
dynamic range of the  instrument and sufficiently high  (minimally,  a factor of at
least 100 times greater than  the  concentration  in  the reagent blank,  refer to
Section 5.5.2), an analysis  of a fivefold (1+4)  dilution must  agree within ± 10%
of the original determination.  If not, an interference effect  must be suspected.
One dilution  test  must be  included for each twenty  samples  (or  less)  of each
matrix in a batch.

      8.6  Post-Digestion Spike Addition:  An analyte spike added to a portion
of a prepared sample, or its dilution, should be recovered to within 75 to 125
percent of the known  value or within the laboratory  derived acceptance criteria.
The spike  addition  should  be based on  the  indigenous concentration  of each
element of interest  in the  sample.   If the  spike  is  not  recovered  within the
specified limits,  the sample must be diluted and reanalyzed to  compensate for the
matrix effect.  Results must agree to within  10% of the original determination.
The use of a standard-addition analysis procedure  may also be  used to compensate
for this effect (Refer to Method 7000).

      8.7  A  Laboratory Control Sample (LCS)  should  be analyzed  for each analyte
using the  same sample preparations,  analytical  methods and  QA/QC  procedures
employed for the test samples. One LCS should be prepared and analyzed for each
sample batch at a frequency of one LCS for each 20  samples or less.

      8.8  Check  the instrument calibration by  analyzing  appropriate  quality
control solutions as follows:

            8.8.1  Check  instrument  calibration   using  a  calibration  blank
      (Section  5.5.1)  and  the  initial  calibration  verification  solution
      (Sections 5.7 and 7.9).

            8.8.2   Verify  calibration at a  frequency of every  10  analytical
      samples  with  the  instrument  check   standard   (Section  5.6)  and  the
      calibration blank (Section 5.5.1).  These solutions must also be analyzed
      for each  analyte at  the  beginning of the analysis  and after the last
      sample.

            8.8.3  The results of  the initial calibration verification solution
      and the instrument check standard must  agree  within ± 10% of the expected
      value.     If not,  terminate  the  analysis,  correct   the  problem,  and
      recalibrate the instrument.   Any sample analyzed under  an out-of-control
      calibration must be reanalyzed .

            8.8.4  The results  of the calibration blank  must be less than  3
      times the current  IDL for each element.    If this is  not  the  case,  the
      reason  for the out-of-control condition must  be found and corrected,  and

                                    6020-11                        Revision 0
                                                                  September  1994

-------
      affected samples must be reanalyzed.  If the laboratory consistently has
      concentrations greater than 3 times the  IDL,  the  IDL may be indicative of
      an estimated IDL and should be re-evaluated.

      8.9    Verify the  magnitude  of  elemental   and  molecular-ion  isobaric
interferences  and  the  adequacy  of  any  corrections  at the  beginning  of an
analytical run or once every 12 hours, whichever is more frequent.  Do this by
analyzing the interference  check solutions A and AB.  The analyst  should be aware
that precipitation from solution AB may occur with some elements, specifically
silver. Refer to Section 3.0 for  a discussion on  intereferences and  potential
solutions to those intereferences if additional guidance is needed.

      8.10   Analyze one duplicate sample  for  every matrix  in a batch  at  a
frequency of one matrix duplicate for every 20 samples.

            8.10.1   The relative  percent difference  (RPD)  between   duplicate
      determinations must be calculated as follows:

                                |D1 -  D2 |
                   RPD =      	     x 100
                               (D!  + D2)/2

            where:

            RPD = relative percent difference.
            DT = first  sample  value.
            D2 = second sample  value (duplicate)

      A control  limit  of  20%  RPD  should not  be  exceeded for  analyte  values
      greater than 100  times the instrumental detection limit.  If this limit is
      exceeded, the reason for the  out-of-control  situation  must be   found and
      corrected, and any samples analyzed during  the out-of-control   condition
      must be reanalyzed.

9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

      9.1  In an EPA multi-laboratory study, 10 laboratories applied  the
ICP-MS technique to  both aqueous and  solid  samples.   TABLE  4  summarizes the
method performance data for aqueous samples.  Performance data  for solid samples
is provided in TABLE 5.

10.0  REFERENCES

1. Horlick, G., et al., Spectrochim. Acta 40B, 1555 (1985).

2. Gray, A.L., Spectrochim. Acta 40B, 1525  (1985); 41B, 151 (1986).

3. Tan, S.H., and Horlick,  G.,  Appl. Spectrosc. 40, 445 (1986).

4. Vaughan, M.A., and Horlick,  G., Appl. Spectrosc. 40, 434 (1986).


                                    6020-12                        Revision 0
                                                                  September 1994

-------
5. Holden, N.E.,  "Table  of  the Isotopes,"  in Lide, D.R., Ed., CRC Handbook  of
Chemistry and Physics, 74th Ed., CRC Press,  Boca Raton,  FL,  1993.
6. Hinners, T.A., Heithmar, E., Rissmann, E., and  Smith, D., Winter Conference
on Plasma Spectrochemistry, Abstract THP18;  p. 237, San  Diego, CA  (1994).
7. Lichte, F.E., et al., Anal. Chem. 59, 1150 (1987).
8. Evans E.H., and Ebdon, L., J. Anal. At. Spectrom. 4,  299  (1989).
9. Beauchemin, D., et al., Spectrochim. Acta 42B,  467  (1987).
10. Houk, R.S., Anal. Chem. 58, 97A (1986).
11. Thompson, J.J., and Houk, R.S., Appl. Spectrosc. 41, 801  (1987).
                                    6020-13                        Revision  0
                                                                   September 1994

-------
TABLE 1. ELEMENTS APPROVED FOR  ICP-MS DETERMINATION
            Element                      CAS* #
            Aluminum                   7429-90-5
            Antimony                   7440-36-0
            Arsenic                    7440-38-2
            Barium                     7440-39-3
            Beryllium                  7440-41-7
            Cadmium                    7440-43-9
            Chromium                   7440-47-3
            Cobalt                     7440-48-4
            Copper                     7440-50-8
            Lead                       7439-92-1
            Manganese                  7439-96-5
            Nickel                     7440-02-0
            Silver                     7440-22-4
            Thallium                   7440-28-0
            Zinc                       7440-66-6
                                   6020-14                        Revision  0
                                                                  September 1994

-------
TABLE 2.  RECOMMENDED  INTERFERENCE  CHECK SAMPLE COMPONENTS AND CONCENTRATIONS
Solution
component
Al
Ca
Fe
Mg
Na
P
K
S
C
Cl
Mo
Ti
As
Cd
Cr
Co
Cu
Mn
Ni
Ag
Zn
Solution A
Concentration (mg/L)
100.0
100.0
100.0
100.0
100.0
100.0
100.0
100.0
200.0
1000.0
2.0
2.0
0.0
0.0
0.0
0.0
0.0
0.0
0.0
0.0
0.0
Solution AB
Concentrat i on (mg/L)
100.0
100.0
100.0
100.0
100.0
100.0
100.0
100.0
200.0
1000.0
2.0
2.0
0.0200
0.0200
0.0200
0.0200
0.0200
0.0200
0.0200
0.0200
0.0200
                                    6020-15                        Revision  0
                                                                   September 1994

-------
TABLE 3.  RECOMMENDED  ISOTOPES FOR SELECTED  ELEMENTS
Mass                                           Element of  interest


27                                                   Aluminum
121, 123                                             Antimony
75                                                   Arsenic
138, 137,  136,  135.  134                              Barium
9                                                    Beryllium
209                                                  Bismuth (IS)
114. 112,  111,  110,  113,  116, 106                    Cadmium
42, 43, 44, 46, 48                                   Calcium (I)
35, 37, (77, 82)a                                    Chlorine (I)
52, 53, 50, 54                                       Chromium
59                                                   Cobalt
63, 65                                               Copper
165                                                  Holmium (IS)
115, 113                                             Indium (IS)
56, 54, 57, 58                                       Iron  (I)
139                                                  Lanthanum (I)
208, 207,  206,  204                                   Lead
6*7 7                                                Lithium (IS)
24, 25, 26                                           Magnesium (I)
55                                                   Manganese
98, 96, 92, 97, 94,  (108)a                           Molybdenum (I)
58, 60, 62, 61, 64                                   Nickel
39                                                   Potassium (I)
103                                                  Rhodium (IS)
45                                                   Scandium (IS)
107, 109                                             Silver
23                                                   Sodium (I)
159                                                  Terbium (IS)
205, 203                                             Thallium
120, 118                                             Tin (I)
89                                                   Yttrium (IS)
64, 66, 68, 67, 70                                   Zinc

      NOTE:  Method 6020 is recommended for only  those analytes listed  in Table
1.   Other  elements  are  included  in  this table  because  they  are potential
interferents (labeled I) in the determination of recommended analytes, or because
they are commonly used internal  standards  (labeled  IS).   Isotopes  are listed in
descending order of natural abundance.  The most generally useful isotopes are
underlined and  in  boldface,  although certain matrices may require  the use of
alternative isotopes. a These masses are also useful for interference correction
(Section 3.2).  b Internal standard must be enriched in the 6Li  isotope.  This
minimizes  interference from indigenous lithium.
                                    6020-16                        Revision  0
                                                                  September 1994

-------
TABLE  4.
SOLUTIONS
ICP-MS MULTI-LABORATORY  PRECISION AND  ACCURACY DATA  FOR AQUEOUS
Element
Comparability3
Range
%RSD
Range
Nb Sc
Aluminum
Antimony
Arsenic
Barium
Beryl 1i urn
Cadmium
Calcium
Chromium
Cobalt
Copper
Iron
Lead
Magnesium
Manganese
Nickel
Potassium
Selenium
Silver
Sodium
Thallium
Vanadium
Zinc
        95  -  100
           d
        97  -  114
        91  -  99
       103  -  107
        98  -  102
        99  -  107
        95  -  105
       101  -  104
        85  -  101
        91  -  900
        71  -  137
        98  -  102
        95  -  101
        98  -  101
       101  -  114
       102  -  107
       104  -  105
        82  -  104
        88  -  97
       107  -  142
        93  -  102
11
5.0
7.1
4.3
8.6
4.6
5.7
13
8.2
6.1
11
11
10
8.8
6.1
9.9
15
5.2
24
9.7
23
6.8
- 14
- 7.6
- 48
- 9.0
- 14
- 7.2
- 23
- 27
- 8.5
- 27
- 150
- 23
- 15
- 15
- 6.7
- 19
- 25
- 7.7
- 43
- 12
- 68
- 17
14 -
16 -
12 -
16 -
13 -
18 -
17 -
16 -
18 -
17 -
10 -
17 -
16 -
18 -
18 -
11 -
12 -
13 -
9 -
18 -
8 -
16 -
14
16
14
16
14
20
18
18
18
18
12
18
16
18
18
12
12
16
10
18
13
18
4
3
4
5
3
3
5
4
3
5
5
6
5
4
2
5
3
2
5
3
3
5
a Comparability refers to the percent agreement of mean ICP-MS values to those
of  the  reference  technique.   b  N  is  the  range  of  the  number  of  ICP-MS
measurements where the analyte values exceed the limit of quantitation (3.3 times
the average  IDL value).      c S is the number of samples with results greater
than  the limit of quantitation.   d No comparability values  are provided for
antimony  because  of evidence  that  the  reference  data  is  affected  by  an
interference.
                                    6020-17
                                                       Revision  0
                                                       September 1994

-------
TABLE 5.  ICP-MS MULTI-LABORATORY PRECISION AND ACCURACY DATA FOR SOLID MATRICES
Element
Comparability8
Range
%RSD
Range Nb
Sc
Aluminum
Antimony
Arsenic
Barium
Beryl 1i urn
Cadmium
Calcium
Chromium
Cobalt
Copper
Iron
Lead
Magnesium
Manganese
Nickel
Potassium
Selenium
Silver
Sodium
Thallium
Vanadium
Zinc
 83 - 101
    d
 79 - 102
100 - 102
 50 - 87
 93 - 100
 95 - 109
 77 - 98
 43 - 102
 90 - 109
 87 - 99
 90 - 104
 89 - 111
 80 - 108
 87 - 117
 97 - 137
   81
 43 - 112
100 - 146
   91
 83 - 147
 84 - 124
                                         11  -  39
                                         12  -  21
                                         12  -  23
                                        4.3  -  17
                                         19  -  34
                                        6.2  -  25
                                        4.1  -  27
                                         11  -  32
                                         15  -  30
                                        9.0  -  25
                                        6.7  -  21
                                        5.9  -  28
                                        7.6  -  37
                                         11  -  40
                                        9.2  -  29
                                         11  -  62
                                          39
                                         12  -  33
                                         14  -  77
                                          33
                                         20  -  70
                                         14  -  42
13 - 14
15 - 16
16 - 16
15 - 16
12 - 14
19 - 20
15 - 17
17 - 18
17 - 18
18 - 18
12 - 12
15 - 18
15 - 16
16 - 18
16 - 18
10 - 12
  12
15 - 15
 8 - 10
  18
 6 - 14
18 - 18
7
2
7
7
5
5
7
7
6
7
7
7
7
7
7
5
1
3
5
1
7
7
a Comparability refers  to the
of  the  reference  technique.
           percent
              b  N
                                      agreement of mean ICP-MS values to those
                                      is  the  range of  the  number  of  ICP-MS
measurements where the analyte values exceed the limit of quantitation  (3.3 times
the average IDL value).       c S is the number of samples with results greater
than the  limit  of quantitation.   d  No comparability values  are  provided for
antimony  because  of  evidence  that  the  reference  data  is  affected  by  an
interference.
                                   6020-18
                                               Revision  0
                                               September 1994

-------
                  METHOD 6020
INDUCTIVELY COUPLED PLASMA  - MASS  SPECTROMETRY
7.1 Analyze
by Method
7000 or
Method 6010.
	

7.1 Uee
Method 3040.
                    6020-19
Revision  0
September 1994

-------
                                 METHOD 7000A

                           ATOMIC ABSORPTION  METHODS
1.0   SCOPE AND APPLICATION

      1.1   Metals in solution may be  readily  determined  by atomic absorption
spectroscopy. The method is simple, rapid, and applicable to a large number of
metals  in  drinking,  surface,  and  saline waters  and domestic  and industrial
wastes. While drinking water free of particulate matter may be analyzed directly,
ground  water,  other  aqueous samples,  EP extracts,  industrial  wastes,  soils,
sludges, sediments, and other solid wastes require digestion prior to analysis
for both total and acid  Teachable metals.  Analysis for dissolved elements does
not require digestion if the sample has been filtered and acidified.

      1.2   Detection limits,  sensitivity, and optimum ranges of the metals will
vary with the matrices and models of atomic absorption spectrophotometers. The
data shown in Table 1 provide some indication of the detection limits obtainable
by direct aspiration and by furnace techniques. For clean aqueous  samples, the
detection limits shown in the table  by direct aspiration may be extended downward
with  scale  expansion and  upward by  using  a  less sensitive wavelength  or by
rotating the  burner  head. Detection limits  by direct aspiration  may  also be
extended through concentration of the sample and/or through solvent extraction
techniques.  For  certain  samples, lower concentrations may  also be determined
using the furnace techniques. The detection limits given in Table 1  are somewhat
dependent  on equipment  (such  as  the  type  of spectrophotometer  and  furnace
accessory, the energy source, the degree of electrical expansion of the output
signal), and are greatly  dependent on sample matrix.  Detection  limits should be
established,  empirically,  for  each matrix type analyzed.   When using  furnace
techniques,  however, the analyst should be cautioned  as  to possible chemical
reactions  occurring  at   elevated  temperatures  which  may  result  in  either
suppression or enhancement of  the  analysis  element.  To ensure valid data with
furnace techniques, the analyst must examine  each matrix for interference effects
(see  Step  3.2.1)  and,  if  detected,  treat  them  accordingly,  using  either
successive dilution, matrix modification, or method of standard additions  (see
Step 8.7).

      1.3   Where direct-aspiration atomic absorption techniques do not provide
adequate sensitivity, reference  is made to specialized procedures  (in addition
to the  furnace  procedure) such  as the gaseous-hydride  method  for arsenic and
selenium and  the cold-vapor technique for mercury.


2.0   SUMMARY OF METHOD

      2.1   Although methods have  been  reported for the analysis of solids by
atomic  absorption spectroscopy, the technique generally is limited  to metals in
solution or solubilized  through  some form of sample processing.

      2.2   Preliminary treatment of waste water, ground water,  EP extracts, and
industrial waste is always necessary because of the complexity  and variability
of sample matrix. Solids, slurries, and suspended  material  must  be  subjected to
a solubilization process  before  analysis. This  process may  vary because of the

                                   7000A - 1                       Revision 1
                                                                   July 1992

-------
metals to be determined and the  nature of the sample being analyzed.  Solubili-
zation and digestion procedures are presented  in  Step  3.2  (Sample Preparation
Methods).

      2.3   In direct-aspiration  atomic  absorption  spectroscopy,  a  sample  is;
aspirated and atomized  in  a flame. A light beam from  a hollow cathode lamp or an
electrodeless discharge lamp is directed through the  flame into a monochromator,
and onto  a detector that  measures  the amount  of absorbed light.  Absorption
depends upon  the  presence  of free unexcited ground-state atoms  in the flame.
Because the wavelength  of  the light  beam is characteristic of  only  the metal
being determined, the  light energy absorbed by the  flame is a  measure of the
concentration of that metal  in the sample.  This principle is the basis of atomic:
absorption spectroscopy.

      2.4   When  using  the  furnace technique  in conjunction  with  an  atomic
absorption spectrophotometer, a  representative  aliquot of a sample  is placed in
the graphite tube in the furnace,  evaporated to dryness, charred, and atomized.
As a greater percentage of available analyte atoms is vaporized and dissociated
for absorption  in  the  tube rather than the  flame,  the use of  smaller sample
volumes  or detection   of  lower concentrations  of  elements  is  possible.  The
principle is essentially the same as  with  direct aspiration  atomic absorption,
except that  a furnace, rather  than  a  flame,  is  used  to  atomize  the  sample.
Radiation from a given  excited  element is passed  through the  vapor containing
ground-state atoms of  that element.  The intensity of the  transmitted radiation
decreases in proportion to the amount of the ground-state element in the vapor.
The metal  atoms  to be measured are placed  in  the beam of radiation by increasing
the temperature  of  the furnace,  thereby causing  the  injected  specimen  to  be
volatilized.  A  monochromator isolates the  characteristic  radiation from  the
hollow cathode lamp  or electrodeless discharge lamp,  and a photosensitive device
measures the attenuated transmitted radiation.


3.0   INTERFERENCES

      3.1   Direct aspiration

            3.1.1   The  most  troublesome   type  of  interference  in   atomic:
      absorption spectrophotometry is usually termed  "chemical"  and  is caused by
      lack of absorption of atoms bound in  molecular combination in the flame.
      This  phenomenon  can  occur  when  the  flame  is not  sufficiently   hot  to
      dissociate the molecule,  as in  the  case of phosphate  interference with
      magnesium, or when   the dissociated  atom is  immediately oxidized to  a
      compound that  will not dissociate further at  the temperature of the flame.
      The  addition  of lanthanum will  overcome  phosphate  interference  in
      magnesium,  calcium,   and  barium   determinations.   Similarly,   silica
      interference in  the  determination of manganese can be eliminated by the
      addition of calcium.

            3.1.2   Chemical interferences may  also be eliminated by separating
      the metal  from the  interfering material.  Although complexing agents  are
      employed primarily to increase  the  sensitivity of the  analysis, they may
      also be used to  eliminate  or reduce  interferences.
                                  7000A  - 2                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
      3.1.3    The presence of  high  dissolved  solids in the  sample  may
result  in  an   interference  from  nonatomic absorbance  such  as  light
scattering.  If  background correction  is  not available, a  nonabsorbing
wavelength should be checked.  Preferably,  samples containing high solids
should be extracted.

      3.1.4  lonization interferences occur when the  flame temperature is
sufficiently high to generate the  removal  of an electron  from a neutral
atom, giving  a positively  charged ion. This  type of  interference  can
generally  be  controlled  by the addition,   to  both standard  and sample
solutions, of  a large  excess  (1,000 mg/L)   of an  easily  ionized element
such as K, Na,   Li or Cs.

      3.1.5  Spectral  interference can occur when  an absorbing wavelength
of an element present in the sample but  not  being determined falls within
the width of the absorption line of the element of interest. The results
of  the  determination  will  then  be  erroneously  high,   due  to  the
contribution of the interfering element to the atomic absorption signal.
Interference can also occur when resonant energy from another element in
a multielement  lamp, or from a metal  impurity in the lamp cathode, falls
within the bandpass of the slit setting when that other metal is present
in  the  sample. This type of  interference  may  sometimes be  reduced by
narrowing the slit width.

      3.1.6  Samples  and  standards  should  be  monitored for  viscosity
differences that may alter the aspiration rate.

      3.1.7  All  metals  are  not  equally  stable  in  the  digestate,
especially  if  it  contains  only nitric   acid,   not  nitric  acid  and
hydrochloric acid.  The digestate should be analyzed  as soon as possible,
with preference given to  Sn, Sb, Mo,  Ba, and Ag.

3.2   Furnace procedure

      3.2.1   Although the problem of oxide formation is greatly reduced
with furnace procedures because atomization occurs in  an inert atmosphere,
the technique is still  subject to chemical  interferences. The composition
of the sample matrix can have  a  major effect on  the analysis. It  is those
effects  which  must  be  determined and  taken into consideration  in  the
analysis of each different matrix encountered. To  help verify the absence
of  matrix  or chemical  interference,  the serial  dilution  technique  (see
Step  8.6)  may  be used.  Those  samples which  indicate  the  presence of
interference should be treated in  one or more of the following ways:

      1.    Successively  dilute  and  reanalyze  the samples  to eliminate
            interferences.

      2.    Modify the sample  matrix  either to remove interferences or to
            stabilize the analyte. Examples  are the addition of  ammonium
            nitrate  to  remove   alkali  chlorides  and   the   addition of
            ammonium phosphate to  retain cadmium. The mixing of  hydrogen
            with  the  inert purge gas  has  also  been  used  to   suppress
            chemical interference. The  hydrogen acts as a reducing agent
            and aids in molecular  dissociation.

                            7000A -  3                      Revision 1
                                                            July 1992

-------
      3.    Analyze  the  sample  by  method  of  standard  additions  while
            noticing the precautions and  limitations of its use (see Step
            8.7.2).

      3.2.2   Gases generated in the furnace during atomization may have
molecular absorption bands  encompassing  the analytical  wavelength. When
this  occurs,  use  either  background correction  or choose an  alternate
wavelength.  Background  correction may  also compensate  for  nonspecific
broad-band absorption interference.

      3.2.3   Continuum background correction cannot correct for all types
of background  interference.  When the background  interference  cannot  be
compensated for,  chemically  remove the analyte or use an alternate form of
background correction,  e.g., Zeeman  background correction.

      3.2.4     Interference from a smoke-producing  sample  matrix  can
sometimes  be  reduced   by  extending  the   charring  time  at  a  higher
temperature or utilizing  an ashing  cycle in the  presence of  air.   Care
must be taken, however,  to prevent loss  of the analyte.

      3.2.5   Samples containing large amounts of organic materials should
be oxidized  by conventional acid digestion before being placed  in  the
furnace. In this way, broad-band absorption will be minimized.

      3.2.6   Anion interference  studies  in  the graphite furnace indicate
that,  under   conditions  other  than isothermal,  the  nitrate  anion  is
preferred. Therefore,  nitric acid  is  preferable  for  any digestion  or
solubilization  step.  If  another acid  in  addition  to  nitric acid  is
required, a minimum  amount  should be used.  This applies  particularly to
hydrochloric and, to a lesser extent,  to sulfuric and  phosphoric acids.

      3.2.7   Carbide formation resulting from the chemical environment of
the furnace has been  observed. Molybdenum may be cited as an example. When
carbides form, the metal  is  released very slowly  from the resulting metal
carbide as atomization  continues. Molybdenum may  require 30  seconds  or
more  atomization time  before  the  signal   returns  to  baseline  levels.
Carbide formation  is greatly reduced and  the sensitivity increased with
the  use of pyrolytically  coated graphite.  Elements  that readily form
carbides are noted with the symbol  (p)  in Table 1.

      3.2.8   For comments on spectral  interference,  see Step 3.1.5.

      3.2.9   Cross-contamination and contamination of the sample can be
major sources of error because of the extreme sensitivities achieved with
the furnace.  The  sample  preparation  work area should be kept scrupulously
clean. All glassware should be  cleaned  as directed in Step  4.8.   Pipet
tips are a frequent source of contamination.  If suspected, they should be
acid  soaked  with  1:5  nitric acid  and  rinsed  thoroughly with tap  and
reagent water. The use of a better grade of pipet tip  can greatly reduce
this problem.  Special attention  should be given to  reagent blanks in both
analysis and  in  the  correction of analytical  results.  Lastly,  pyrolytic
graphite,  because  of the  production  process  and handling,  can  become
contaminated.  As many  as  five  to  ten  high-temperature  burns  may  be
required to clean the tube before use.

                             7000A - 4                       Revision 1
                                                            July 1992

-------
4.0   APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

      4.1   Atomic  absorption spectrophotometer  -  Single-  or  dual-channel,
single- or double-beam instrument  having a grating monochromator, photomultipl ier
detector, adjustable slits,  a wavelength  range of 190 to 800 nm, and provisions
for interfacing with a graphical  display.

      4.2   Burner  -   The  burner  recommended  by  the  particular  instrument
manufacturer should be used.  For certain  elements  the  nitrous  oxide burner  is
required.

      4.3   Hollow  cathode   lamps  -  Single-element  lamps  are preferred  but
multielement lamps may be used. Electrodeless discharge lamps may also be used
when available.  Other types of lamps meeting the performance criteria of this
method may be used.

      4.4   Graphite  furnace  -  Any  furnace  device  capable  of  reaching  the
specified temperatures is satisfactory.

      4.5   Graphical   display and  recorder  -   A recorder is  recommended  for
furnace work so that there will be a permanent record  and that any problems with
the analysis  such as  drift,  incomplete  atomization, losses  during charring,
changes in sensitivity, peak shape, etc., can be easily recognized.

      4.6   Pipets - Microliter,  with  disposable tips. Sizes can range from 5 to
100 uL  as  required.  Pipet  tips  should   be  checked  as  a possible  source  of
contamination  prior to their  use.  The accuracy of  automatic  pipets  must  be
verified daily.  Class A pipets can  be  used for the measurement of volumes larger
than 1 ml.

      4.7   Pressure-reducing  valves  - The supplies of fuel and oxidant should
be maintained at pressures somewhat higher than the controlled operating pressure
of the instrument by suitable  valves.

      4.8   Glassware  -  All  glassware,  polypropylene,  or  Teflon containers,
including sample bottles, flasks and  pipets, should be washed in the following
sequence:  detergent,  tap water,  1:1  nitric  acid,  tap  water,  1:1 hydrochloric
acid,   tap water, and  reagent water.  (Chromic  acid  should not be  used  as  a
cleaning  agent  for  glassware if  chromium is to be included  in the analytical
scheme.)  If it  can be documented through an active analytical  quality control
program  using   spiked  samples and  reagent  blanks  that  certain steps  in  the
cleaning  procedure  are not  required  for  routine  samples, those  steps  may  be
eliminated from  the procedure.


5.0   REAGENTS

      5.1  Reagent grade chemicals  shall  be  used in all tests. Unless otherwise
indicated, it is intended that all  reagents  shall conform  to the specifications
of the Committee on Analytical Reagents of the American Chemical Society, where
such specifications are available. Other grades may  be used, provided it is first
ascertained that the  reagent is  of sufficiently high purity to permit its use


                                   7000A  - 5                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
without lessening  the  accuracy  of the determination.  All  reagents  should be
analyzed to provide proof that all constituents are below the MDLs.

      5.2   Reagent water.   All  references to water  in  this method  refer to
reagent water unless otherwise  specified.   Reagent grade water will  be of at
least 16 Mega Ohm quality.

      5.3  Nitric acid  (concentrated),  HN03.  Use a spectrograde acid certified
for AA use.  Prepare a 1:1 dilution with water by adding the concentrated  acid to
an equal volume of water.  If the reagent blank is less than the IDL, the acid
may be used.

      5.4  Hydrochloric acid  (1:1),  HC1.  Use a spectrograde acid certified for
AA use. Prepare a 1:1 dilution with  water by adding the concentrated acid to an
equal volume of water.   If the reagent  blank is less than the IDL, the acid may
be used.

      5.5  Fuel  and oxidant - High purity acetylene  is generally acceptable. Air
may  be  supplied from  a compressed  air  line,  a  laboratory compressor,  or  a
cylinder of compressed air and should be clean and dry.   Nitrous oxide  is also
required for certain determinations.  Standard,  commercially  available argon and
nitrogen are required for furnace work.

      5.6 Stock standard metal solutions  - Stock standard  solutions are prepared
from  high   purity  metals, oxides,  or  nonhygroscopic  salts  using water  and
redistilled nitric or hydrochloric acids. (See individual methods for specific
instructions.)  Sulfuric or phosphoric acids should be avoided as they  produce
an  adverse  effect  on   many   elements.  The stock  solutions  are prepared  at
concentrations  of  1,000  mg  of  the  metal   per liter.  Commercially  available
standard solutions  may also be used. Where the sample viscosity, surface tension,
and  components  cannot  be accurately  matched  with  standards,  the  method  of
standard addition  (MSA) may be used (see Step 8.7).

      5.7  Calibration standards - For those instruments  which do not read out
directly  in  concentration,   a  calibration curve  is  prepared  to  cover  the
appropriate  concentration range.    Usually,   this  means  the  preparation  of
standards which produce an absorbance of 0.0 to 0.7.  Calibration standards are
prepared by diluting the stock metal solutions at  the  time of analysis. For best
results, calibration standards  should  be prepared fresh  each time  a batch of
samples is  analyzed. Prepare  a blank and at  least  three calibration standards in
graduated amounts in the appropriate range  of the linear  part of the curve. The
calibration  standards   should  be  prepared  using  the  same type  of acid  or
combination of acids and at the same concentration as  will result in the  samples
following processing.  Beginning  with the blank and working toward  the  highest
standard, aspirate the solutions and record the readings. Repeat the operation
with both the  calibration standards and the samples  a  sufficient number of times
to secure a  reliable average reading  for each solution. Calibration standards for
furnace procedures should be  prepared as  described  on the individual sheets for
that metal.   Calibration curves  are always required.
                                   7000A -  6                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
6.0   SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

      6.1  See the introductory material in Chapter Three,  Metallic Analytes.


7.0   PROCEDURE

      7.1  Preliminary treatment of waste water, ground water, EP extracts, and
industrial waste is always necessary because of the complexity and variability
of sample matrices. Solids, slurries, and suspended material  must be subjected
to a solubilization process before analysis.  This process may vary because of the
metals  to  be  determined  and   the   nature  of  the  sample  being  analyzed.
Solubilization and digestion procedures are presented in Chapter Three, Step 3.2,
Sample Preparation Methods.   Samples which  are  to be analyzed  for dissolved
constituents need not be digested if they have been filtered  and acidified.

      7.2  Direct aspiration (flame)  procedure

            7.2.1  Differences  between  the   various  makes  and  models  of
      satisfactory atomic absorption  spectrophotometers prevent the formulation
      of  detailed instructions  applicable  to every  instrument.  The  analyst
      should follow the manufacturer's operating  instructions for a particular
      instrument. In general, after choosing the  proper lamp  for the analysis,
      allow the lamp  to warm up  for a minimum of 15 minutes, unless operated in
      a double-beam mode.  During this period, align  the instrument, position the
      monochromator at the correct wavelength,  select the proper monochromator
      slit  width, and  adjust  the  current  according to  the  manufacturer's
      recommendation. Subsequently,  light  the  flame and regulate  the  flow  of
      fuel and oxidant. Adjust  the burner and  nebulizer  flow  rate for maximum
      percent absorption and stability.  Balance the photometer. Run a series of
      standards of the element  under  analysis.  Construct a calibration curve by
      plotting the concentrations of  the standards against absorbances. Set the
      curve corrector  of  a direct reading  instrument  to read out  the proper
      concentration.    Aspirate  the  samples  and  determine the  concentrations
      either directly or from the calibration curve. Standards must be run each
      time a sample or series of samples is run.

      7.3   Furnace procedure

            7.3.1  Furnace  devices (flameless  atomization) are  a most useful
      means  of  extending  detection   limits.  Because  of differences  between
      various  makes   and   models   of satisfactory  instruments,  no  detailed
      operating  instructions  can be  given  for each instrument.  Instead,  the
      analyst should follow the instructions provided by the  manufacturer of a
      particular instrument.

            7.3.2   Background  correction  is  important  when using  flameless
      atomization, especially below 350  nm.  Certain samples, when atomized, may
      absorb or scatter light from the lamp. This can be caused by the presence
      of gaseous molecular species, salt particles,  or smoke in the sample beam.
      If no correction  is made, sample absorbance  will  be greater than it should
      be, and the analytical  result will be erroneously high.  Zeeman background
      correction is effective in overcoming  composition or structured background


                                   7000A - 7                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
interferences. It  is  particularly useful when  analyzing  for As  in  the
presence of Al and when analyzing for Se in  the presence of Fe.

      7.3.3   Memory  effects  occur  when  the  analyte is  not  totally
volatilized during atomization. This condition depends on several factors:
volatility  of the  element  and   its  chemical  form,  whether  pyrolytic
graphite  is  used,  the  rate of  atomization,  and  furnace design.  This
situation is detected through blank burns.  The tube should be cleaned by
operating the  furnace at  full  power for the required time  period,  as
needed, at regular intervals during the series of determinations.

      7.3.4  Inject  a measured  microliter  aliquot of  sample  into  the
furnace  and  atomize.  If  the  concentration  found  is  greater  than  the
highest standard,  the sample  should be diluted in the same acid matrix and
reanalyzed. The use of multiple injections  can improve  accuracy and help
detect furnace pipetting errors.

      7.3.5   To  verify the  absence  of interference,  follow  the  serial
dilution procedure given in Step 8.6.

      7.3.6  A check standard should  be run  after approximately every 10
sample  injections.  Standards are  run  in part  to  monitor the  life  and
performance of the graphite tube. Lack of reproducibility or significant
change in the signal  for the standard  indicates that the  tube should be
replaced. Tube life depends on  sample matrix and atomization temperature.
A  conservative  estimate would be that  a  tube will   last  at  least  50
firings. A pyrolytic coating will extend that estimated life by a factor
of three.

7.4   Calculation

      7.4.1  For determination of metal  concentration by direct aspiration
and furnace:  Read the metal  value from the calibration curve or directly
from the read-out system of the instrument.

      7.4.2  If dilution of sample was required:

    ug/L metal in sample = A (C + B)
                                C
where:

      A =   ug/L of metal  in diluted  aliquot from calibration curve.
      B =   Acid blank matrix used for dilution, mL.
      C =   Sample aliquot, mL.

      7.4.3  For  solid  samples,  report  all  concentrations in consistent
units based on wet weight.  Hence:

   ug metal/kg sample = A x V
                          w
where:

      A =   ug/L of metal  in processed sample from calibration curve.
      V =   Final volume of the processed sample, mL.
      W =   Weight of sample, grams.

                             7000A -  8                       Revision 1
                                                            July 1992

-------
            7.4.4  Different injection volumes must  not be used for samples and
      standards.  Instead,  the  sample  should  be diluted  and  the same  size
      injection volume be used  for  both samples  and standards.  If dilution of
      the sample was required:

          ug/L of metal in sample = Z ( C + B)
                                         C
      where:

            Z =   ug/L of metal  read from calibration curve or read-out system.
            B =   Acid blank matrix used for dilution ml.
            C =   Sample aliquot, ml.


8.0   QUALITY CONTROL

      8.1  All quality control data  should be maintained  and available for easy
reference or inspection.

      8.2  A  calibration  curve  must be prepared each day with  a  minimum of a
calibration blank and three  standards.  After calibration, the calibration curve
must be verified by use of at  least  a  calibration blank and a calibration check
standard (made from a reference material or other  independent standard material)
at or near the  mid-range. The calibration reference standard  must be measured
within 10 % of it's true value for the curve to be considered valid.

      8.3  If more  than  10  samples  per day are analyzed, the  working standard
curve must  be verified by measuring  satisfactorily a mid-range  standard   or
reference standard after every 10 samples.  This sample value must be within 20%
of the true value, or the previous ten samples need  to be reanalyzed.

      8.4  At  least one matrix spike and one matrix spike  duplicate sample shall
be included in each analytical batch.  A laboratory control sample  shall also be
processed with each sample batch.  Refer to Chapter  One for more information.

      8.5  Where the sample matrix is so complex that  viscosity, surface tension,
and  components  cannot  be  accurately  matched  with   standards,  the method  of
standard addition  (MSA)  is  recommended (see Section 8.7 below).   Section  8.6
provides tests to evaluate the need for using the MSA.

8.6   Interference tests

      8.6.1  Dilution test - For each analytical batch select one typical sample
for  serial  dilution  to determine  whether  interferences  are  present.    The
concentration of the analyte should be at least 25 times the estimated detection
limit.  Determine  the apparent concentration in  the undiluted sample.  Dilute the
sample by a minimum of five  fold (1+4)  and  reanalyze.  If all of the samples in
the batch are below  10  times  the detection limits,  perform  the  spike recovery
analysis described below.  Agreement within 10% between the concentration for the
undiluted  sample   and  five  times  the  concentration for  the diluted  sample
indicates the  absence of interferences, and such samples may be analyzed without
using the method of standard additions.
                                   7000A  - 9                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
      8.6.2  Recovery test - If results from the dilution test do not agree, a
matrix interference may be suspected and a spiked sample should be analyzed to
help confirm the finding from the dilution test.  Withdraw another aliquot of the
test sample and add a known amount  of analyte to bring the concentration of the
analyte to 2 to 5 times the original  concentration.  If all of the samples in the
batch have analyte concentrations below the detection limit, spike the selected
sample at 20 times  the detection limit.   Analyze the spiked sample and calculate
the spike recovery.  If the recovery is less than 85% or greater than 115%, the
method of standard additions shall be used for all  samples in the batch.

      8.7   Method  of standard  additions  - The  standard  addition  technique
involves  adding  known  amounts  of  standard  to  one  or  more  aliquots  of the
processed sample solution. This technique compensates for a sample constituent
that enhances or depresses the analyte  signal,  thus producing a different slope
from  that  of  the calibration  standards.  It  will  not  correct  for additive
interferences  which  cause  a  baseline shift.   The method of standard additions
shall be used for  analysis  of all EP extracts,  on all analyses submitted as part
of a delisting petition, and whenever  a new sample matrix is being analyzed.

            8.7.1  The simplest version of this technique is  the  single-addition
      method,  in which  two identical aliquots  of the  sample solution, each of
      volume Vx,  are taken. To the first (labeled A) is  added a  known volume Vs
      of  a  standard analyte solution of concentration  Cs. To the  second aliquot
      (labeled B)  is added the same volume Vs  of the  solvent.  The  analytical
      signals  of A and B are measured and corrected for nonanalyte signals. The
      unknown  sample concentration  Cx is calculated:


             C,, =
                      (sA-sB)vx

      where  SA  and  SB are  the analytical  signals (corrected for the blank) of
      solutions A and B, respectively. Vs and Cs  should  be  chosen so  that  SA is
      roughly twice  SB on the average, avoiding  excess  dilution of the  sample.
      If a separation or concentration step  is used, the additions are best made
      first  and carried  through the entire  procedure.

             8.7.2   Improved  results  can be  obtained  by employing  a series of
      standard  additions. To  equal volumes  of the  sample are added a series of
      standard  solutions containing different known quantities of the  analyte,
      and  all  solutions are  diluted to  the same final  volume.  For  example,
      addition  1  should be  prepared  so  that the resulting  concentration is
      approximately  50 percent  of the expected  absorbance from the  endogenous
      analyte  in  the sample.  Additions 2 and 3  should  be  prepared so  that the
      concentrations are  approximately  100 and  150  percent  of  the  expected
      endogenous  sample  absorbance.  The   absorbance  of each  solution  is
      determined  and then  plotted on the vertical axis of  a  graph, with the
      concentrations of the known standards  plotted on the horizontal  axis. When
      the  resulting  line  is extrapolated  to zero  absorbance,  the point of
      interception   of  the abscissa  is  the  endogenous concentration  of the
      analyte  in  the sample.  The abscissa on the left of the ordinate is scaled
      the  same as on the  right side, but  in  the  opposite direction  from the
                                   7000A -  10                       Revision 1
                                                                   July 1992

-------
      ordinate. An example of a  plot so obtained is shown in Figure  1.  A linear
      regression program may be used to obtain the intercept concentration.
            8.7.3  For  the  results  of this  MSA  technique  to  be  valid,
      following limitations must be taken into consideration:
                                                               the
      8.8
followed.
 1.    The apparent concentrations from the calibration curve must be
      linear over the concentration range of concern. For  the best
      results, the slope of the MSA plot should be nearly  the same
      as  the  slope  of  the  standard   curve.   If   the  slope  is
      significantly different (greater than  20%),  caution should be
      exercised.

 2.    The effect of the  interference should not vary as the  ratio of
      analyte  concentration  to   sample  matrix  changes,   and  the
      standard addition  should respond  in  a similar manner as the
      analyte.

 3.    The determination  must  be  free  of spectral  interference and
      corrected for nonspecific background interference.

All quality  control  measures described  in  Chapter  One  should be
9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

      9.1  See individual methods.


10.0 REFERENCES

1.    Methods for  Chemical  Analysis of  Water  and Wastes;  U.S.  Environmental
Protection Agency.  Office of Research and Development. Environmental Monitoring
and Support  Laboratory.  ORD Publication Offices  of Center  for  Environmental
Research Information:  Cincinnati, OH,  1983; EPA-600/4-79-020.
2.    Rohrbough, W.G.;
Specifications, 7th ed.
            et  al.  Reagent  Chemicals,  American  Chemical  Society
            ; American Chemical Society: Washington, DC, 1986.
3.    1985 Annual Book of ASTM Standards. Vol. 11.01;  "Standard Specification for
Reagent Water"; ASTM: Philadelphia, PA, 1985; D1193-77.
                                  7000A - 11
                                                      Revision 1
                                                      July 1992

-------
                                  TABLE 1.
                   ATOMIC ABSORPTION CONCENTRATION RANGES
Metal
Aluminum
Antimony
Arsenic
Barium
Beryl 1 i urn
Cadmium
Calcium
Chromium
Cobalt
Copper
Iron
Lead
Lithium
Magnesium
Manganese
Mercury
Molybdenum(p)
Nickel
Osmium
Potassium
Selenium
Silver
Sodium
Strontium
Thallium
Tin
Vanadium(p)
Zinc

Detection Limit
(mg/L)
0.1
0.2
0.002
0.1
0.005
0.005
0.01
0.05
0.05
0.02
0.03
0.1
0.002
0.001
0.01
0.0002
0.1
0.04
0.03
0.01
0.002
0.01
0.002
0.03
0.1
0.8
0.2
0.005

Sensitivity
(mg/L)
1
0.5
0.4
0.025
0.025
0.08
0.25
0.2
0.1
0.12
0.5
0.04
0.007
0.05
0.4
0.15
1
0.04
0.06
0.015
0.15
0.5
4
0.8
0.02
Furnace Procedure3' c
Detection Limit
(ug/L)
..
3
1
2
0.2
0.1

1
1
1
1
1
--
0.2
1
--
2
0.2
--
--
1
--
4
0.05
      NOTE:
The symbol (p) indicates the  use  of  pyrolytic graphite with
the furnace procedure.
aFor furnace sensitivity values,  consult instrument  operating  manual.

 Gaseous hydride method.

'The listed furnace values are those expected when using a 20-uL injection and
normal  gas  flow, except in the cases of arsenic and selenium, where gas interrupt
is used.

      vapor technique.
                                  7000A - 12
                                                Revision 1
                                                July 1992

-------
                                FIGURE 1.
                         STANDARD ADDITION PLOT
               8
               CO
               .g
               o
               CO
  Zero
Absorbance
                                                            Concentration
      Cone, of    Addn 0      Addn 1       Addn 2      Addn 3
      Sample     No Addn     Addn of 50%   Addn of 100% Addn of 150%
                             of Expected   of Expected   of Expected
                             Amount      Amount      Amount
                               7000A -  13
Revision 1
July 1992

-------
                                    METHOD 7000A
                           ATOMIC  ABSORPTION METHODS
                        f   Start    J
                        7.1 Solubilize
                          and digeat
                          •ample (•••
                          Chapter 3,
                         Section 3.2)
 7.2.1 Chooae
  and prepare
  hollow tube
 cathode lamp
 7.2.1 Adjust
   and align
   equipment
  7.2.1 Light
   flame and
   regulate
   7.2.1 Run
   •tandard*
  7.3.3 Clean
     tube
7.2.1  Construct
  calibration
 curve and aet
curve  corrector
     7.2.1
   Aipirate
    aample
  7.2.1 Hun
     check
   standard
 7.4 Determine
concentration*
                              Stop
                         7.3.1 Follow
                           operating
                         instruction*
                        from inatrument
                         manufacturer
                          7.3.2 Make
                          background
                          correction
7.3.4  Inject
 and atomize
   part  of
   •ample
                                               7.3.4 Dilute
                                                  •ample
                            7.3.5 U..
                          interference
                         te«t> to verify
                           abaence of
                          interference
 73.6 Run a
    check
  •tandard
                                           7000A -  14
                                                             Revision  1
                                                             July  1992

-------
                                 METHOD 7020

               ALUMINUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION,  DIRECT ASPIRATION)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  See Section 1.0 of Method 7000


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  See Section 3.0 of Method 7000 if interferences are suspected.

     3.2  Aluminum may be as much  as 15% ionized in a nitrous-oxide/acetylene
flame.  Use of an ionization  suppressor  (1,000  ug/mL K as KC1)  as in Method
7000, Paragraph 3.1.4, will eliminate this interference.

     3.3  Aluminum is a  very  common  contaminant,  and  great care should be
taken to avoid contamination.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1  For basic apparatus, see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.

     4.2  Instrument parameters  (general):

          4.2.1  Aluminum hollow cathode lamp.
          4.2.2  Wavelength:  324.7 nm.
          4.2.3  Fuel:  Acetylene.
          4.2.4  Oxidant:  Nitrous oxide.
          4.2.5  Type of flame:  Fuel rich.
          4.2.6  Background correction:  Not required.


5.0  REAGENTS

     5.1  See Section 5.0 of Method 7000.

     5.2  Preparation of standards;

          5.2.1  Stock solution:   Dissolve  1.000 g of aluminum metal in dilute
     HC1 with gentle warming.  Dilute to 1  liter with Type  II water.  Alterna-
     tively, procure  a  certified  standard  from  a   supplier  and verify by
     comparison with a second standard.
                                  7020 - 1
                                                         Revision
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
          5.2.2  Prepare   dilutions   of   the   stock   solution   to   be   used  as
     calibration standards at  the  time of analysis.   The  calibration standards
     should  be  prepared  using   the same   type  of  acid  and   at   the  same
     concentration  as will   result   in   the  sample  to be   analyzed after-
     processing.  Samples and  standards   should also  contain  2 mL KC1/100  ml.
     solution (Paragraph  3.2 above).

     5.3  Potassium chloride solution;   Dissolve 95  g potassium chloride (KC1)
in Type II water and dilute to 1  liter.


6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

     6.1  See Chapter Three,  Section  3.1.3,  Sample Handling  and Preservation.


7.0  PROCEDURE

     7.1  Sample preparation;   The  procedures  for  preparation  of the sample
are given in Chapter Three, Section 3.2.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

     8.1  See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.


9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

     9.1  Precision and accuracy data are available in Method 202.1 of Methods
for Chemical Analysis of Water and Wastes.

     9.2  The  performance  characteristics  for  an  aqueous  sample  free of
interferences are:

     Optimum concentration range:  5-50 mg/L, with a wavelength of 309.3 nm.
     Sensitivity:   1 mg/L.
     Detection  limit:  0.1 mg/L.


10.0   REFERENCES

1.   Methods for   Chemical  Analysis  of  Water  and Wastes, EPA-600/4-82-055,
Method 202.1,  December 1982.
                                   7020 -  2
                                                          Revision
                                                         Date  September  1986

-------
                METHOD 702O

ALUMINUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION.  DIRECT ASPIRATION)
5.0

Prepare
standards


	 '• 	 1 For
sample
preparation see
chapter 3.
section 3.2


7.2 1
Analyze using
Method 7OOO.
Section 7.2
             f    Stop      J
            7020 - 3
                                    Revision      Q
                                    Date  September  1986

-------
                                 METHOD 7040

               ANTIMONY (ATOMIC ABSORPTION,  DIRECT ASPIRATION)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  See Section 1.0 of Method 7000


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  See Section 3.0 of Method 7000 if interferences are suspected.

     3.2  In the presence of  lead  (1,000  mg/L), a spectral interference may
occur at the 217.6-nm resonance  line.    In  this case, the 231.1-nm antimony
line should be used.

     3.3  Increasing   the   acid   concentrations   decreases   the  antimony
absorption.  To avoid this effect,  the  acid concentration in the samples and
in the standards should be matched.

     3.4  Excess concentrations  of  copper  and  nickel  (and  possibly other
elements), as well as acids,  can  interfere  with  antimony analyses.  If the
sample contains these matrix types, either matrices of the standards should be
matched to those of  the  sample  or  the  sample  should  be analyzed using a
nitrous oxide/acetylene flame.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1  For basic apparatus, see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.

     4.2  Instrument parameters  (general):

          4.2.1  Antimony hollow cathode lamp or electrode!ess discharge lamp.
          4.2.2  Wavelength:  217.6 nm  (primary); 231.1 nm (secondary).
          4.2.3  Fuel:  Acetylene.
          4.2.4  Oxldant:  Air.
          4.2.5  Type of flame:  Fuel lean.
          4.2.6  Background correction:  Required.


5.0  REAGENTS

     5.1  See Section 5.0 of Method 7000.
                                  7040 - 1
                                                         Revision      0
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
     5.2   Preparation  of  standards:

          5.2.1   Stock solution:    Carefully  weigh  2.7426  g  of  antimony
     potassium tartrate,  K(SbO)04^05'1/2^0   (analytical  reagent grade), and
     dissolve in  Type  II  water.  Dilute to  1  liter with Type II water; 1 ml =
     1  mg Sb (1,000 mg/L).   Alternatively, procure a certified standard from a
     supplier and verify  by comparison with a  second standard.

          5.2.2   Prepare   dilutions  of   the   stock  solution  to  be  used as
     calibration  standards at the  time of analysis.  The calibration standards
     should contain 0.2%  (v/v) HN03  and   1-2%  v/v HC1, prepared using the same
     types of acid and  at  the   same  concentrations  as  in the sample  after
     processing.


6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION,  PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

     6.1  See Chapter Three, Section 3.1.3, Sample Handling  and Preservation.


7.0  PROCEDURE

     7.1  Sample preparation:  The  procedures  for   preparation  of the  sample
are given in Method 3005.Method  3005,   a soft digestion,  is  presently  the
only digestion procedure recommended for Sb.   It yields  better  recoveries than
either Method 3010 or Method 3050. There  is   no hard digestion  for Sb  at this
time.

     7.2  See Method 7000, Paragraph 7.2, Direct Aspiration  Procedure.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

     8.1  See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.
9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

     9.1  The  performance  characteristics  for  an  aqueous  sample  free of
interferences are:

     Optimum concentration range:  1-40 mg/L with a wavelength of 217.6 nm.
     Sensitivity:  0.5 mg/L.
     Detection limit:  0.2 mg/L.

     9.2  In a  single  laboratory,  analysis  of  a mixed industrial-domestic
waste effluent, digested with Method 3010,  at concentrations of 5.0 and 15 mg
Sb/L gave the standard deviations of +0.08 and +0.1, respectively.  Recoveries
at these levels were 96% and 97%, respectively.

     9.3  For  concentrations  of  antimony   below  0.35  mg/L,  the  furnace
procedure (Method 7041) is recommended.


                                  7040 - 2
                                                         Revision      0
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
10.0  REFERENCES

1.  Methods  for  Chemical  Analysis  of  Water  and Wastes, EPA-600/4-82-055,
December 1982, Method 204.1.
                                   7040 - 3
                                                          Revision
                                                         Date  September  1986

-------
                 METHOD 7040

ANTIMONY  (ATOMIC ABSORPTION.  DIRECT ASPIRATION)
                  5.0
                      Prepare
                     standards
                  7. 1
                       For
                      sample
                 preparation•see
                     chapter 3,
                  section 3.1.3
                  7.2
                  Analyze using
                  Method 7OOO.
                  Section 7.2
               (     Stop      J
               7040 - 4
                                         Revision       0
                                         Date   September 1986

-------
                                 METHOD 7041

               ANTIMONY (ATOMIC ABSORPTION,  FURNACE TECHNIQUE)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  See Section 3.0 of Method 7000 If Interferences are suspected.

     3.2  High lead concentration may cause a measurable spectral  Interference
on the  217.6-nm  line.    If  this  interference  1s  expected,  the secondary
wavelength should be employed or Zeeman background correction used.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1  For basic apparatus, see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.

     4.2  Instrument parameters  (general):

          4.2.1  Drying time and temp:  30 sec at 125*C.
          4.2.2  Ashing time and temp:  30 sec at 800*C.
          4.2.3  Atomizing time and temp:  10 sec at 2700*C.
          4.2.4  Purge gas:  Argon or nitrogen.
          4.2.5  Wavelength:  217.6 nm  (primary); 231.1 nm (alternate).
          4.2.6  Background correction:  Required.
          4.2.7  Other operating parameters should be  set as specified by the
     particular instrument manufacturer.
     NOTE:  The above concentration values and instrument conditions are for a
            Perkin-Elmer HGA-2100, based  on  the  use  of  a 20-uL Injection,
            continuous-flow purge  gas,  and  nonpyrolytlc  graphite.  Smaller
            sizes of  furnace  devices  or  those  employing  faster  rates of
            atomization can be  operated  using lower atomization temperatures
            for shorter time periods than the above-recommended settings.


5.0  REAGENTS

     5.1  See Section 5.0 of Method 7000.
                                  7041 - 1
                                                         Revision
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
     5.2   Preparation  of standards;

          5.2.1   Stock  solution:     Carefully  weigh   2.7426  g   of   antimony
     potassium tartrate (analytical   reagent  grade)   and   dissolve in Type  II
     water.    Dilute  to  1  liter  with   Type  II  water;   1  ml  =   1  mg  Sb
     (1,000   mg/L).     Alternatively,   procure  a   certified  standard  from a
     supplier and verify by comparison with a second  standard.

          5.2.2   Prepare  dilutions   of  the  stock  solution  to  be  used  as
     calibration standards at the  time of analysis.  The calibration  standards
     should  contain  0.2% (v/v)  HN03  and  1-2%  (v/v) HC1, prepared  using the
     same types  of acid and at the  same  concentrations as  in  the  sample after
     processing.


6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

     6.1  See Chapter Three, Section 3.1.3, Sample  Handling and  Preservation.,


7.0  PROCEDURE

     7.1  Sample preparation;  The  procedures   for  preparation of the sample
are given in Method 3005.Method  3005,  a soft  digestion,  is presently the
only digestion procedure recommended for Sb.   It  yields better recoveries than
either Method 3010 or Method 3050.  There  is no  hard digestion  for Sb at this
time.
     NOTE:  The addition of HC1  acid  to  the  digestate prevents the furnace
            analysis of this digestate for many other metals.

     7.2  See Method 7000,  Paragraph 7.3,  Furnace Procedure.   The calculation
is given  in Method  7000, Paragraph  7.4.


8.0  QUALITY  CONTROL

     8.1  See Section  8.0  of  Method 7000.


9.0  METHOD  PERFORMANCE

     9.1  Precision and accuracy  data are not  available at this time.

     9.2  The  performance  characteristics  for   an   aqueous   sample  free of
 interferences are:

     Optimum concentration range:   20-300 ug/L.
     Detection  limit:   3 ug/L.
                                   7041  - 2
                                                          Revision
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
10.0  REFERENCES

1.   Methods for  Chemical  Analysis  of  Water  and Wastes, EPA-600/4-82-055,
December 1982, Method 204.2.
                                  7041 - 3
                                                         Revision
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
                METHOD 7O41

ANTIMONY (ATOMIC ABSORPTION.  FURNACE TECHNIQUE)
             c
5.0

Prepare
standards

7.1
prepar
cf
sec

7.3


For
sample
•atlon see
lapter -3.
tlon 3.2



Analyze using
Method 7000.
Section 7.3.
calculation 7.4
             f     Stop      J
            7041 - 4
                                    Revision      0
                                    Date   September 1986

-------
                                 METHOD 7060A

                ARSENIC (ATOMIC ABSORPTION, FURNACE TECHNIQUE)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

      1.1   Method  7060  is  an  atomic  absorption  procedure  approved  for
determining the concentration of arsenic in wastes,  mobility procedure extracts,
soils,  and  ground water.   All  samples  must be  subjected  to  an  appropriate
dissolution step prior to analysis.

2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

      2.1   Prior to analysis  by  Method 7060,  samples must be prepared in order
to convert  organic  forms of arsenic  to  inorganic forms, to  minimize organic
interferences, and to convert  the  sample  to  a suitable solution for analysis.
The sample preparation procedure varies depending on the sample matrix.  Aqueous
samples are subjected to the acid digestion procedure described  in this method.
Sludge samples are prepared using the procedure described in Method 3050.

      2.2   Following the appropriate dissolution of the sample, a representative
aliquot of the digestate is  spiked  with a  nickel nitrate solution and is placed
manually or by means of  an automatic sampler  into a graphite tube furnace.  The
sample  aliquot is  then slowly  evaporated  to dryness,  charred  (ashed),  and
atomized.  The absorption of hollow cathode or EDL radiation during atomization
will  be proportional to  the  arsenic concentration.  Other modifiers may be used
in  place  of  nickel  nitrate   if   the  analyst  documents  the  chemical  and
concentration used.

      2.3   The typical  detection limit for water samples using this method is
1 ug/L.   This detection limit may  not be achievable when analyzing waste samples.

3.0  INTERFERENCES

      3.1   Elemental arsenic  and many of its  compounds are volatile; therefore,
samples may be subject  to losses of arsenic  during sample  preparation.   Spike
samples  and  relevant  standard  reference materials  should  be processed  to
determine if the chosen dissolution method is appropriate.

      3.2   Likewise,  caution  must  be  employed  during  the  selection  of
temperature and times for the dry and char (ash)  cycles.  A matrix modifier such
as nickel nitrate must  be added to all  digestates  prior to analysis to minimize
volatilization losses during drying and ashing.

      3.3   In addition  to the  normal interferences experienced during graphite
furnace analysis, arsenic analysis can suffer  from  severe nonspecific absorption
and light scattering caused by matrix  components  during atomization.   Arsenic
analysis  is particularly susceptible  to  these  problems because  of  its  low
analytical wavelength (193.7 nm).   Simultaneous  background  correction must be
employed  to  avoid erroneously high results.  Aluminum is  a  severe  positive
interferent  in the  analysis  of  arsenic,  especially  using D2  arc  background


                                   7060A  -  1                       Revision 1
                                                                  September 1994

-------
correction.   Although  Zeeman background  correction  is  very useful  in this
situation, use of any appropriate background correction technique  is acceptable.

      3.4   If the analyte  is not  completely volatilized and removed from the
furnace during atomization,  memory effects will occur.   If this situation is
detected by means of blank  burns,  the  tube should  be  cleaned by operating the
furnace at full power at regular intervals in the analytical scheme.

4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

      4.1   Griffin beaker or equivalent:  250 ml.

      4.2   Class A Volumetric flasks:   10-mL.

      4.3   Atomic absorption spectrophotometer:  Single or dual  channel, single-
or  double-beam instrument  having   a  grating monochromator,  photo-multiplier
detector, adjustable slits,  a wavelength range of 190  to  800 nm,  and provisions
for simultaneous  background correction and interfacing with a suitable recording
device.

      4.4   Arsenic hollow cathode  lamp,  or electrodeless discharge lamp  (EDL):
EDLs provide better sensitivity for arsenic analysis.

      4.5   Graphite furnace:  Any  graphite furnace device with the appropriate
temperature and timing controls.

      4.6   Data  systems  recorder:  A recorder is  strongly  recommended for
furnace work so that there will be a permanent record and so that any problems
with the analysis  such as drift, incomplete atomization, losses during charring,
changes in sensitivity,  etc., can easily be recognized.

      4.7   Pipets:  Microliter with disposable tips.   Sizes can range from
5 to 1,000 uL, as required.

5.0  REAGENTS

      5.1   Reagent water:  Water should be monitored for impurities.
All references to water will refer to reagent water.

      5.2   Concentrated nitric acid: Acid should be analyzed to determine levels
of impurities.  If a  method  blank using  the acid  is 
-------
      5.5   Nickel nitrate solution (5%):  Dissolve 24.780 g of ACS reagent grade
Ni(N03)26H20 or equivalent in reagent water and dilute to  100 ml.

      5.6   Nickel nitrate solution  (1%):  Dilute 20 ml of  the 5% nickel nitrate
to 100 ml with reagent water.

      5.7   Arsenic working standards:  Prepare dilutions  of  the stock solution
to be  used as calibration  standards at the  time  of the  analysis.   Withdraw
appropriate aliquots of the stock solution,  add concentrated  HN03,  30% H202, and
5% nickel nitrate solution or other appropriate matrix modifier.  Amounts added
should be representative of the concentrations found in  the samples.  Dilute to
100 ml with reagent water.

6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

      6.1   All  samples  must have been  collected  using  a sampling  plan that
addresses the considerations discussed in Chapter Nine of this manual.

      6.2   All sample containers must be prewashed  with detergents,  acids, and
reagent water.  Plastic and glass containers  are both suitable.

      6.3   Special  containers  (e.g.,  containers   used  for  volatile  organic
analysis)  may  have to be used if very  volatile  arsenic   compounds  are  to be
analyzed.

      6.4   Aqueous samples must be  acidified  to a pH of <2 with nitric acid and
refrigerated prior to analysis.

      6.5   Although waste samples do not need  to be refrigerated sample handling
and storage must  comply with the minimum requirements established in Chapter One.

7.0  PROCEDURE

      7.1   Sample preparation: Aqueous samples should be prepared in the manner
described  in  Paragraphs  7.1.1-7.1.3.  Sludge-type  samples should be prepared
according to Method 3050A.  The applicability  of a sample-preparation technique
to a  new matrix type must be  demonstrated  by analyzing spiked samples and/or
relevant standard reference materials.

            7.1.1    Transfer a known  volume  of well-mixed sample to a 250-mL
      Griffin  beaker  or  equivalent;  add  2   mL  of  30%   H202 and  sufficient
      concentrated HN03 to result in  an acid  concentration of  1%  (v/v).  Heat,
      until digestion is  complete, at 95°C or  until  the  volume  is  slightly less
      than  50 mL.

            7.1.2   Cool,  transfer to  a volumetric  flask,  and  bring  back to 50
      mL with reagent water.

            7.1.3   Pipet 5 mL of  this digested solution into  a 10-mL  volumetric
      flask,  add  1  mL of  the  1%  nickel  nitrate solution  or other appropriate
      matrix modifier, and dilute to 10 mL with reagent water.  The sample is
      now  ready  for injection  into the furnace.


                                   7060A - 3                       Revision 1
                                                                   September 1994

-------
      7.2   The 193.7-nm wavelength line and a  background correction system are
required.  Follow the manufacturer's suggestions for all other spectrophotometer
parameters.

      7.3   Furnace parameters suggested by the manufacturer should be employed
as  guidelines.     Because   temperature-sensing  mechanisms   and  temperature
controllers can  vary between  instruments  or with  time,  the validity  of the
furnace parameters must  be periodically confirmed by systematically altering the
furnace parameters while analyzing a standard.  In this manner,  losses of analyte
due to overly high temperature settings or losses in sensitivity due to less than
optimum settings can be minimized.  Similar verification of furnace parameters
may be required for complex sample matrices.

      7.4   Inject a measured microliter aliquot of sample  into the furnace and
atomize.  If the concentration found is greater than the highest standard, the
sample should  be  diluted in  the same acid matrix  and reanalyzed.   The use of
multiple  injections  can improve  accuracy   and  help detect  furnace  pipetting
errors.

8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

      8.1  Refer to section 8.0 of Method 7000.

9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

      9.1   Precision and accuracy data are available in Method 206.2 of Methods
for Chemical Analysis of Water and Wastes.

      9.2  The optimal concentration range for aqueous samples  using this method
is 5-100  ug/L.   Concentration  ranges  for  non-aqueous samples will  vary with
matrix type.

      9.3   The data shown in Table  1 were  obtained from  records of state and
contractor laboratories.  The  data  are intended to show the  precision  of the
combined sample preparation and analysis method.

10.0  REFERENCES

1.    Methods  for  Chemical  Analysis  of Water  and Wastes,  EPA-600/4-82-055,
December 1982,  Method 206.2.

2.    Gaskill,  A., Compilation and Evaluation of RCRA Method  Performance Data,
Work Assignment No. 2, EPA Contract No.  68-01-7075, September 1986.
                                  7060A  - 4                       Revision 1
                                                                  September 1994

-------
                       TABLE  1. METHOD PERFORMANCE DATA
Sample                      Preparation                 Laboratory
Matrix                        Method                    Replicates


Contaminated soil               3050                   2.0,  1.8  ug/g

Oily soil                       3050                   3.3,  3.8  ug/g

NBS SRM 1646 Estuarine sediment 3050                   8.1,  8.33 ug/ga

Emission control dust           3050                   430,  350  ug/g


aBias of -30 and -28% from expected, respectively.
                                   7060A - 5                       Revision 1
                                                                   September 1994

-------
                              METHOD 7060A
        ARSENIC  (ATOMIC  ABSORPTION,  FURNACE TECHNIQUE)
7.1.1 Tranafer
   •ample to
beaker,add H.O,
and cone. HMOi,
     h«»t
  7.1.2 Cool
 •nd bring to
  volume with
 reagent vater
  7.1.3 Pipot
 •olution into
  flaak, add
nickel nitrate,
    diluta
7.2 Sat up
instrument
 operating
 parameter
                    7.1 Prepare
                      •aaplei
                   according to
                   Method 3050
                        7.3
                   Periodically
                      verify
                      furnace
                    parameter*
                    7.4 Inject
                    aliquot of
                    •ample into
                     furnace,
                      atoaiie
                   7.4 Record A*
                   concentration
                                         7.4 Dilute
                                         aanple and
                                          reanalyze
                       Stop
                                7060A  -  6
                                                    Revision  1
                                                    September 1994

-------
                                 METHOD 7061A

                 ARSENIC (ATOMIC ABSORPTION, GASEOUS HYDRIDE)
1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

      1.1   Method 7061 is an atomic  absorption  procedure  for determining the
concentration of  arsenic  in wastes,  mobility  procedure extracts,  soils,  and
ground water.   Method  7061A  is  approved only for sample matrices  that  do not
contain high concentrations of chromium, copper, mercury, nickel, silver, cobalt,
and molybdenum.  All samples must be subjected to an appropriate dissolution step
prior to analysis.  Spiked samples and relevant  standard reference materials are
employed to determine the applicability of the method to a given waste.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

      2.1   Samples are prepared according to the nitric/sulfuric acid digestion
procedure  described  in this  method  (Step  7.1).   Next,   the  arsenic  in  the
digestate  is  reduced  to the  trivalent form with tin  chloride.   The trivalent
arsenic is then converted to a volatile hydride using hydrogen produced from a
zinc/hydrochloric acid reaction.

      2.2   The volatile hydride is swept into an argon-hydrogen flame located
in the optical  path of  an  atomic absorption spectrophotometer.   The resulting
absorption of the lamp radiation is proportional to the arsenic concentration.

      2.3   The typical detection limit for this method is 0.002 mg/L.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

      3.1   High concentrations  of chromium,  cobalt, copper,  mercury, molybdenum,
nickel, and silver can cause analytical interferences.

      3.2   Traces of nitric acid left following the sample work-up can result
in analytical interferences.  Nitric acid must be distilled off by heating the
sample until fumes of sulfur trioxide (S03)  are observed.

      3.3   Elemental  arsenic and many of its compounds are  volatile; therefore,
certain samples may be subject to losses of arsenic during sample preparation.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

      4.1   Beaker or equivalent - 100-mL.

      4.2   Electric  hot   plate or  equivalent  -  adjustable  and   capable  of
maintaining a temperature of 90-95°C.
                                   7061A -  1                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
            4.3.1    Medicine dropper - Capable of fitting  into a size "0" rubber
      stopper and  delivering 1.5 ml.

            4.3.2    Pear-shaped reaction flask  -  50-mL,  with two  14/20  necks
      (Scientific  Glass JM-5835 or equivalent).

            4.3.3    Gas inlet-outlet tube - Constructed from a micro cold-finger
      condenser (JM-3325) by cutting the portion  below the  14/20  ground-glass
      joint.

            4.3.4    Magnetic stirrer -  To homogenize the  zinc slurry.

            4.3.5    Polyethylene drying  tube -  10-cm,  filled  with glass  to
      prevent particulate matter from entering the burner.

            4.3.6    Flow meter - Capable of measuring 1 liter/min.

            4.3.7    Class A volumetric  flasks.

            4.3.8    Graduated cylinder  or equivalent.

      4.4   Atomic absorption spectrophotometer - Single or dual channel, single-
or  double-beam instrument  having  a grating monochromator,  photo-multiplier
detector, adjustable slits,  a wavelength  range of  190 to 800 nm, and provisions
for interfacing with a strip-chart recorder.

      4.5   Burner - Recommended by the particular instrument manufacturer for
the argon-hydrogen flame.

      4.6   Arsenic hollow cathode lamp or arsenic  electrode!ess discharge lamp..

      4.7   Strip-chart recorder.


5.0   REAGENTS

      5.1   Reagent grade chemicals shall be used in all tests. Unless otherwise
indicated, it is intended that all reagents  shall  conform to the specifications
of the Committee on Analytical  Reagents of the American Chemical Society, where
such specifications are available. Other grades may be used,  provided it  is first
ascertained that the reagent  is  of  sufficiently high purity  to permit  its use
without lessening  the accuracy of the determination.

      5.2   Reagent  Water.    Reagent water will   be interferent  free.    All
references  to  water  in the method  refer  to  reagent water unless otherwise
specified.

      5.3   Nitric  acid  (concentrated),  HNO,.    Acid should  be   analyzed  to
determine levels of  impurities.   If a  methocf blank  is < MDL,  the  acid can be
used.
                                   7061A -  2                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
       5.4    Sulfuric  acid (concentrated), H2S04.   Acid  should  be analyzed  to
determine  levels  of impurities.  If a method  blank  is  < MDL, the acid can  be
used.

       5.5    Hydrochloric  acid  (concentrated),  HC1.  Acid  should  be analyzed  to
determine  levels  of impurities.  If a method  blank  is  < MDL, the acid can  be
used.

       5.6    Diluent - Add 100 ml 18N H2SO, and 400 ml concentrated HC1  to 400  ml
water  and  dilute  to a final volume  of 1  liter  with water.

       5.7    Potassium iodide solution -  Dissolve  20 g KI  in  100  ml water.

       5.8    Stannous  chloride  solution   -  Dissolve  100  g   SnCl,  in  100  ml
concentrated HC1.

       5.9   Arsenic solutions

             5.9.1   Arsenic  standard solution  (1,000 mg/L)  - Either procure a
       certified aqueous standard from a  supplier  and verify  by comparison  with
       a second standard, or dissolve 1.320 g of arsenic trioxide As20,  in 100  ml
       of  water  containing  4   g  NaOH.    Acidify  the  solution with  20  ml
       concentrated HN03 and dilute to 1  liter.

            5.9.2   Intermediate arsenic  solution -  Pipet 1  ml  stock arsenic
       solution  into a  100-mL  volumetric  flask and bring  to  volume  with water
       containing  1.5 ml concentrated HN03/liter (1 ml = 10 ug As).

            5.9.3   Standard arsenic solution - Pipet 10  ml intermediate arsenic
       solution  into a  100-mL  volumetric  flask and bring  to  volume  with water
       containing  1.5 ml concentrated HN03/liter (1 ml = 1 ug  As).


6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

       6.1   All samples  must  have  been  collected using  a sampling  plan   that
addresses the considerations discussed in Chapter Nine of this manual.

       6.2   All sample containers  must be prewashed with detergents, acids, and
water.  Plastic and glass containers are both suitable.

       6.3   Special containers (e.g.  containers  used  for   volatile  organic
analysis)  may  have to be used if  very  volatile  arsenic compounds are to  be
analyzed.

      6.4   Aqueous samples must be acidified to a pH of < 2  with nitric acid.

      6.5   Nonaqueous samples  shall be refrigerated, when possible, and analyzed
as soon as possible.
                                   7061A  - 3                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
7.0  PROCEDURE
      7.1   Place a 50-mL aliquot of digested  sample (or, in the case of analysis
of EP extracts, 50 ml) of the material  to be analyzed in a 100-mL beaker.  Add
10 mL concentrated HNO, and 12 ml 18N H2S04.   Evaporate the sample in the hood
on an electric hot plate until white SO, fumes are observed (a volume of about
20 mL).  Do not let the sample char.  If charring occurs, immediately turn off
the heat, cool, and add an  additional 3  ml  of HN03.  Continue to add additional
HN03 in  order  to  maintain  an excess (as  evidenced  by the  formation  of brown
fumes).  Do not let the solution darken,  because arsenic may be reduced and lost.
When the sample remains colorless or straw yellow during evolution of S03 fumes,
the digestion  is complete.   Cool the sample,  add  about 25 mL  water,  and again
evaporate  until S03 fumes  are produced  in order to  expel  oxides of nitrogen.
Cool.  Transfer the digested sample to a 100-mL volumetric  flask.  Add 40 mL of
concentrated HC1 and bring to volume with water.

      7.2   Prepare  working  standards  from  the standard arsenic  solution.
Transfer 0,  0.5,  1.0, 1.5,  2.0, and 2.5 mL of standard  to 100-mL volumetric
flasks and bring to volume  with diluent.  These concentrations will  be 0,  5, 10,
15, 20,  and 25 ug As/liter.

      7.3   If  EP  extracts are  being analyzed or if a matrix  interference is
encountered, take  the 15-, 20-,  and 25-mg/liter  standards and quantitatively
transfer 25 mL of  each of these standards into separate 50-mL volumetric flasks.
Add  10  mL  of the prepared  sample  to each flask.   Bring  to volume with water
containing  1.5 mL HCl/liter.

      7.4   Add 10 mL of prepared sample to a 50-mL volumetric flask.  Bring to
volume  with water  containing 1.5  mL HCl/liter.   This  is the  zero addition
aliquot.

NOTE:       The absorbance from the zero addition aliquot will  be  one-fifth that
            produced  by the prepared sample.  The absorbance  from the  spiked
            samples will  be one-half that produced  by the standards plus the
            contribution from one-fifth of the prepared sample.  Keeping these
            absorbances in mind will assist in judging the correct dilutions to
            produce optimum  absorbance.

       7.5   Transfer  a 25-mL  portion of the  digested  sample or standard  to the
reaction vessel and add 1 mL  KI solution.  Add 0.5 mL SnCl2 solution.  Allow at
least  10 minutes for  the  metal  to be   reduced to  its lowest  oxidation  state.
Attach  the  reaction vessel to the special  gas inlet-outlet glassware.  Fill the
medicine dropper with  1.50 mL zinc slurry that has been kept in suspension with
the magnetic stirrer.  Firmly insert the stopper containing the medicine dropper
into the side  neck of the reaction vessel.  Squeeze  the bulb to  introduce the
zinc slurry into the sample or standard  solution.  The metal hydride will produce
a peak  almost  immediately.  After the recorder pen begins to return  to the base
line,  the  reaction  vessel  can be removed.

       CAUTION:     Arsine  is  very  toxic.   Precautions must be  taken to avoid
                   inhaling arsine  gas.
                                   7061A - 4                       Revision  1
                                                                   July  1992

-------
      7.6   Use  the  193.7-nm wavelength  and  background  correction  for the
 analysis of arsenic.

      7.7   Follow  the manufacturer's  instructions  for operating  an argon-
 hydrogen flame.   The argon-hydrogen flame  is  colorless;  therefore,  it may be
 useful  to  aspirate  a low concentration of  sodium  to  ensure that ignition has
 occurred.

      7.8   If  the  method  of  standard   additions  was employed,  plot  the
 absorbances of spiked samples and blank vs. the concentrations. The extrapolated
 value will be one-fifth the concentration of the original sample.  If  the plot
 does not result in a  straight line, a nonlinear interference is present.  This
 problem can sometimes be overcome by dilution or addition of other reagents if
 there is some  knowledge about the waste. If  the method of standard additions was
 not required, then the concentration can be part of the calibration curve.


 8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

      8.1  Refer to section 8.0 of Method 7000.


 9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

      9.1   Precision and accuracy data are available in Method 206.3 of Methods
 for Chemical  Analysis of Water and Wastes.


 10.0  REFERENCES

 1.    Methods  For  Chemical Analysis  of Water  and Wastes,  EPA-600/4-82-055,
December 1982, Method 206.3.

2.    Rohrbough, W.G.;  et  al.  Reagent Chemicals,  American Chemical  Society
Specifications. 7th ed.;  American Chemical  Society: Washington,  DC,  1986.

3-    1985 Annual Book of ASTM  Standards. Vol. 11.01; "Standard Specification for
Reagent Water"; ASTM: Philadelphia,  PA, 1985;  D1193-77.
                                  7061A - 5                       Revision  1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
                  METHOD  7061A
ARSENIC  (ATOMIC ABSORPTION, GASEOUS  HYDRIDE)
C
       st"t


7.1 Place
aliquot of
digested
aample in
beaker



7.1 Turn off Yea
heat.cool, « 	 1
and add HNO,


7 . 3 Tranaf er
atandarda to Yea
fla*k«,add < 	
•ample , bring
to voluma


7.1 Add
concentrated
HNO, and H.SO. ;
aample
/ Did ^V
aample )
V char? /
No
..
7.1 Continue
adding HNO,
to complete
digeation
1
7.1 Cool
•ample , add
reagent H,0,


7. 1 Tranafar
digaatad aample
to flaak.add
cone HC1 .bring
to volume

7 . 2 Prepare
•tandarda ,
tranafar to
f laaka , bring
to volume
X/I. matrix N.
•f interference )
N. detected? /
No
74 Add
prepared aampla
to volume ,uaa
aa blank
7 . 5 Tranaf er
portion of
— » digeated aample
or standard to
reaction ve»el
-




7.5 Add KI
•olution, and
SnCl.
•olution


7 . 5 Reduce
loweat
oxidation
• tate


7.5 Attach
veaiel to gaa
glaiiwara.fill
dropper with Zn
•lurry


7 . 5 Introduce
Zn a lurry
into a amp la
or atandard
•olution
,
,
7.6 Use
193. 7-nm wave-
length and
background
correction
,
7 7 T
1

argon hydrogen
flame , follow
instructions

                                                         7.8 Plot
                                                       abaorbaneaa of
                                                       •piked •ample*
                                                         blank v»
                                                       concentration*
                                       7.8 Have
                                     concentration
                                      be part of
                                      calibration
                                         curve
                                     C
                                      Stop
                            7061A -  6
                                                              Revision  1
                                                              July 1992

-------
                                 METHOD 7062

       ANTIMONY AND ARSENIC (ATOMIC ABSORPTION,  BOROHYDRIDE REDUCTION)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

      1.1  Method 7062 is an atomic absorption  procedure  for determining  1
to 400/yg/L concentrations of antimony and arsenic in wastes, mobility procedure
extracts, soils, and ground water.   Method 7062 is approved for sample matrices
that contain up to  a total of 4000 mg/L concentrations of cobalt, copper, iron,
mercury, or  nickel.  A  solid  sample can contain up  to  40% by  weight  of the
interferents  before exceeding  4000  mg/L  in a  digested  sample.    All  samples
including aqueous matrices must be  subjected to an appropriate dissolution step
prior to analysis.  Spiked samples and relevant  standard reference materials are
used to determine the applicability of the method to a given waste.

2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

      2.1  Samples are prepared according to the nitric acid digestion procedure
described   in  Method   3010   for   aqueous  and  extract   samples   and  the
nitric/peroxide/hydrochloric acid digestion procedure described  in Method 3050
(furnace AA  option) for  sediments,  soils,  and  sludges.  Excess  peroxide  is
removed  by  evaporating   samples  to  near dryness at  the  end of  the digestion
followed by  degassing the  samples  upon addition of urea.   L-cysteine is then
added as a  masking agent.   Next,  the  antimony and arsenic in the digest are
reduced to  the trivalent  forms with  potassium iodide.  The  trivalent  antimony and
arsenic are then converted to volatile hydrides  using  hydrogen produced from the
reaction of  the  acidified  sample with  sodium borohydride in a continuous-flow
hydride generator.

      2.2  The volatile hydrides  are  swept into,  and decompose in,  a heated
quartz   cell  located   in   the   optical   path  of   an   atomic   absorption
spectrophotometer.    The  resulting  absorption  of  the  lamp  radiation  is
proportional to the arsenic or antimony concentration.

      2.3  The typical detection limit for this method is 1.0/yg/L.

3.0  INTERFERENCES

      3.1    Very  high  (>4000  mg/L)  concentrations  of cobalt,  copper,  iron,
mercury, and nickel  can  cause analytical interferences through precipitation as
reduced metals and associated blockage of transfer lines  and fittings.

      3.2  Traces of peroxides left following the sample  work-up can result in
analytical  interferences.  Peroxides must  be removed by evaporating each sample
to near dryness followed by reaction with  urea  and allowing sufficient time for
degassing before analysis (see Sections 7.1 and 7.2).
                                    7062-1                        Revision 0
                                                                  September 1994

-------
      3.3   Even after  acid  digestion,  organic compounds  will  remain  in the
sample.   These  flame  gases  and  these organic  compounds can  absorb  at the
analytical wavelengths and background correction must be used.

4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

      4.1  Electric hot  plate:   Large enough to hold at  least  several  100 mL
Pyrex digestion beakers.

      4.2   A  continuous-flow hydride  generator:    A commercially  available
continuous-flow  sodium  borohydride/HCl  hydride   generator  or  a  generator
constructed similarly to that shown in Figure 1 (P.  S. Analytical or equivalent).

            4.2.1  Peristaltic Pump:  A four-channel, variable-speed peristaltic
      pump to permit regulation of liquid-stream flow rates (Ismatec Reglo-100
      or equivalent).    Pump  speed and tubing diameters should  be  adjusted to
      provide  the  following  flow rates:    sample/blank  flow  =  4.2  mL/min;
      borohydride flow =2.1 mL/min;  and potassium iodide  flow = 0.5 mL/min.

            4.2.2  Sampling Valve  (optional):    A sampling valve (found in the
      P. S.  Analytical  Hydride Generation System  or equivalent)  that  allows
      switching between  samples and blanks  (rinse solution) without introduction
      of air into the  system will  provide  more signal  stability.

            4.2.3  Transfer Tubing and Connectors:   Transfer tubing (1 mm I.D.),
      mixing T's, and connectors are made of a fluorocarbon  (PFA or TFM) and are
      of  compatible  sizes  to form  tight,  leak-proof  connections  (Latchat,
      Technicon, etc.  flow injection  apparatus accessories or equivalent).

            4.2.4  Mixing Coil:  A 20-turn  coil made by wrapping transfer tubing
      around a 1-cm diameter by 5-cm  long  plastic  or  glass rod (see Figure 1).

            4.2.5  Mixing  Coil  Heater,  if appropriate:   A  250-mL  Erlenmeyer
      flask containing 100 mL  of  water  heated to  boiling on  a  dedicated  one-
      beaker hotplate  (Corning PC-35  or  equivalent).   The  mixing coil  in 4.2.4
      is immersed in the  boiling water to speed kinetics of the hydride forming
      reactions  and   increase  solubility   of   interfering  reduced   metal
      precipitates.

            4.2.6  Gas-Liquid Separator:  A glass  apparatus for  collecting and
      separating liquid  and gaseous  products (P.T.   Analytical  accessory  or
      equivalent) which  allows the liquid fraction  to drain to waste and gaseous
      products above the liquid to be swept by a regulated carrier  gas (argon)
      out of the cell  for  analysis.  To avoid undue carrier  gas  dilution, the
      gas volume above  the  liquid  should not exceed 20 mL.   See Figure 1 for an
      acceptable separator shape.

            4.2.7  Condenser:  Moisture picked  up  by the carrier gas  must be
      removed before encountering the hot absorbance cell.   The  moist carrier
      gas with the  hydrides is dried by passing the  gasses through a small  (< 25

                                   7062-2                        Revision 0
                                                                  September 1994

-------
      ml) volume condenser coil  (Ace Glass Model 6020-02 or equivalent) that is
      cooled to 5°C by a water chiller (Neslab RTE-110 or equivalent).  Cool tap-
      water in place of a chiller is acceptable.

            4.2.8  Flow Meter/Regulator:  A meter capable of regulating up to 1
      L/min of argon carrier gas is recommended.

      4.3  Absorbance Cell:  A 17 cm or longer quartz tube T-cell (windowless is
strongly suggested)  is  recommended, as shown  in Figure 1  (Varian  Model  VGA-76
accessory or equivalent).  The  cell  is  held in place  by a holder that positions
the cell  about 1  cm over  a conventional  AA air-acetylene  burner head.   In
operation, the cell  is heated to around 900°C.

      4.4  Atomic  absorption spectrophotometer:  Single or dual channel, single-
or  double-beam  instrument  having  a  grating   monochromator,  photomultiplier
detector, adjustable slits, a wavelength  range of 190 to 800 nm, and provisions
for interfacing with  an appropriate recording device.

      4.5  Burner: As recommended by the  particular instrument manufacturer for
an air-acetylene flame.  An appropriate mounting bracket attached to the burner
that suspends the  quartz absorbance cell between  1 and 2 cm above the burner slot
is required.

      4.6   Antimony  and arsenic hollow cathode lamps or  antimony and arsenic
electrodeless  discharge  lamps  and  power  supply.  Super-charged hollow-cathode
lamps or EDL lamps are  recommended for maximum  sensitivity.

      4.7    Strip-chart  recorder  (optional):         Connect  to  output  of
spectrophotometer.

5.0  REAGENTS

      5.1   Reagent water:   Water must be monitored  for impurities.   Refer to
Chapter  1  for  definition of Reagent water.

      5.2  Concentrated nitric acid (HN03):   Acid must be analyzed to determine
levels of  impurities.   If a method blank is 
-------
                                  QUARTZ CELL

                                  A A  OURNER
                                                                        TO
                                                                      CHILLER
    •DISCONNECTS
     DURING S«/Sn
    .. ANALYSIS
                          THERNONETER
                         20 TURN COIL
                           (TEFLON)
                           HOTPLATE-
                           VALVE .
                          (•LANK)
Figure 1.  Continuous-flow sodium borohydride/hydride generator apparatus set-up
and an AAS sample introduction system.
                                    7062-4
Revision 0
September 1994

-------
      5.6  Urea (H2NCONH2):  A 5.00-g portion of reagent grade urea must be added
to  a  25-mL  aliquot  of  each sample  for removal  of excess  peroxide  through
degassing (see Section 7.2).

      5.7  L-cysteine (C6H12N204S2):  A 1.00-g portion of reagent grade L-cystine
must be  added to a  25-mL aliquot of each  sample for  masking  the  effects of
suppressing transition metals (see Section 7.2).

      5.8  20% Potassium iodide (KI):  A 20% KI  solution (20 g reagent-grade KI
dissolved and  brought to  volume  in  100  ml reagent water) must be prepared for
reduction of antimony and arsenic to their +3 valence states.

      5.9  4% Sodium borohydride (NaBHJ: A 4%  sodium  borohydride solution (20
g reagent-grade NaBH4 plus 2 g sodium hydroxide dissolved in 500 ml of reagent
water) must  be prepared  for  conversion of  the antimony  and  arsenic to their
hydrides.

      5.10 Analyte solutions:

            5.10.1  Antimony  and arsenic stock  standard solution (1,000 mg/L):
      Either procure certified aqueous  standards  from  a supplier and verify by
      comparison  with  a  second  standard,   or  dissolve  1.197  g  of antimony
      trioxide Sb203 and 1.320 g of arsenic  trioxide As203 in  100 ml of reagent
      water containing 4  g  NaOH.  Acidify the solution  with 20 ml concentrated
      HN03 and dilute to  1 liter.

            5.10.2   Intermediate antimony  and  arsenic  solution:   Pi pet 1 ml
      stock  antimony and arsenic solution  into a 100-mL volumetric flask and
      bring  to  volume  with  reagent   water  containing  1.5 ml concentrated
      HN03/liter (1 ml -  10 //g each of Sb and As).

            5.10.3    Standard antimony and arsenic solution:    Pi pet  10 ml
      intermediate antimony and arsenic  solution into a 100-mL volumetric  flask
      and  bring to  volume  with  reagent  water  containing 1.5 ml concentrated
      HN03/liter (1 ml =  1 fjg each of Sb  and As).

6.0 SAMPLE COLLECTION,  PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

      6.1   All  samples  must have  been collected using  a  sampling plan  that
addresses  the  considerations  discussed  in Chapter Nine of this  manual.

      6.2  All  sample containers  must be prewashed with detergents,  acids,  and
reagent  water.   Plastic  and glass  containers are  both  suitable.

      6.3    Special  containers  (e.g.,   containers used  for  volatile  organic
analysis) may have to be used  if very volatile antimony  and arsenic compounds are
suspected  to  be  present  in  the  samples.

      6.4  Aqueous  samples  must  be  acidified to a pH of <2  with nitric  acid.

                                     7062-5                         Revision 0
                                                                   September 1994

-------
       6.5  Nonaqueous samples shall  be refrigerated, when possible, and analyzed
 as  soon  as  possible.

 7.0  PROCEDURE

       7.1   Place a 100-mL portion of an aqueous sample or extract or 1.000 g of
 a dried  solid sample  in  a  250-mL  digestion  beaker.  Digest  aqueous  samples and
 extracts according to Method 3010.  Digest solid samples according to Method 3050
 (furnace AA option) with the following modifications:   add 5 ml of concentrated
 hydrochloric  acid  just  prior  to  the final  volume reduction  stage to aid  in
 antimony recovery; the final volume  reduction should be to less  than  5 ml but not
 to  dryness  to adequately  remove  excess hydrogen  peroxide  (see note).   After
 dilution to volume, further dilution with diluent  may be  necessary  if analytes
 are known to exceed 400/vg/L or  if interferents are expected to exceed 4000 mg/L
 in  the digestate.

            Note:  For solid digestions, the volume reduction stage  is critical
            to obtain  accurate  data, especially for arsenic.   Close monitoring
            of each sample  is necessary when this  critical  stage  is reached.

      7.2  Prepare samples for hydride analysis by  adding 5.00 g urea, 1.00 g L-
 cysteine, and 20 ml concentrated HC1 to  a 25-mL aliquot of digested  sample in  a
 50-mL volumetric flask.  Heat in a water bath until  the L-cysteine has dissolved
 and effervescence  has  subsided   (At   least  30  minutes  is  suggested.     If
 effervescense is still  seen,  repeat step 7.1  with more volume reduction.).  Bring
 flask to volume with reagent water before analyzing.   A 1:1  dilution correction
 must be made in the final concentration calculations.

      7.3   Prepare working  standards  from  the standard  antimony and  arsenic
 solution.   Transfer  0, 0.5, 1.0,  1.5,  2.0, and 2.5 ml  of  standard to 100-mL
 volumetric flasks and bring  to  volume with diluent.  These  concentrations  will
 be  0, 5, 10, 15, 20, and 25 //g Sb and As/liter.

      7.4   If  EP extracts  (Method  1310)  are being analyzed  for arsenic,  the
 method  of  standard  additions  must  be   used.   Spike  appropriate  amounts of
 intermediate or standard antimony and arsenic solution to three 25  ml  aliquots
 of  each  unknown.   Spiking  volumes should be kept  less than 0.250 mL to  avoid
 excessive spiking dilution errors.

      7.5   Set  up instrumentation  and  hydride generation  apparatus and   fill
 reagent containers. The  sample  and blank flows should  be  set around  4.2 mL/min,
 the borohydride  flow around  2.1  mL/min, and the potassium  iodide flow around 0.5
mL/min.  The argon carrier gas flow is  adjusted to about 200 mL/min.  For the AA,
 use the 217.6-nm wavelength  and 0.7-nm slit width (or manufacturer's recommended
 slit-width)  without background  correction if  analyzing for  antimony.  Use the
 193.7-nm wavelength and 0.7-nm slit width (or manufacturer's recommended slit-
width) with  background correction  for  the  analysis  of arsenic.  Begin all flows
and allow 10 minutes for warm-up.
                                    7062-6                        Revision 0
                                                                  September 1994

-------
      7.6  Place sample  feed line into a prepared sample solution and start pump
to begin  hydride generation.   Wait  for  a maximum steady-state signal  on the
strip-chart recorder  or output meter.   Switch  to blank sample and  watch for
signal to decline to baseline  before  switching to  the next sample and beginning
the next analysis.  Run standards first  (low to high),  then unknowns.  Include
appropriate QA/QC solutions, as required.   Prepare calibration curves and convert
absorbances to concentration.     If a heating coil  is  not being  used, KI must be
added to the samples and heated for thirty minutes to ensure reduction.

        CAUTION:  The  hydrides  of  antimony  and  arsenic  are  very  toxic.
                  Precautions must be taken to avoid inhaling the gas.

      7.7  If the method of standard additions was employed, plot the measured
concentration  of the  spiked  samples  and unspiked  sample  versus  the spiked
concentrations.  The spiked concentration axis intercept will be the method of
standard  additions  concentration.   If the plot does not  result  in  a straight
line,  a nonlinear  interference  is  present.   This  problem can  sometimes  be
overcome  by dilution  or  addition  of  other reagents if  there is some knowledge
about the waste.  If the method of standard additions  was not required, then the
concentration is determined from a standard calibration curve.

8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

      8.1  See  section 8.0 of Method 7000.

9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

      9.1  The relative standard deviations obtained  by a single laboratory for
7 replicates of a contaminated soil were 18% for antimony at 9.1 ug/L  in solution
and 4.6% for arsenic at 68 ug/L in solution.  The average percent recovery of the
analysis  of an 8 fjg/l  spike on ten different samples  is 103.7%  for arsenic and
95.6% for antimony.

10.0  REFERENCES

1.    Methods  for  Chemical  Analysis of Water and  Wastes, EPA-600/4-82-055,
      December  1982, Method 206.3.

2.    "Evaluation of  Hydride  Atomic  Absorption Methods for Antimony, Arsenic,
      Selenium,  and Tin", an EMSL-LV  internal  report  under Contract 68-03-3249,
      Job Order 70.16,  prepared  for T.  A. Hinners  by D.   E.  Dobb,  and  J.  D.
      Lindner of Lockheed  Engineering and Sciences Co., and L. V. Beach of the
      Varian Corporation.
                                     7062-7                         Revision  0
                                                                   September 1994

-------
                                    METHOD  7062
ANTIMONY  AND ARSENIC  (ATOMIC ABSORPTION,  BOROHYDRIDE  REDUCTION)
     7.1 Use Method
    3060 (furnace AA
    option) to digest
      1.0 o sample.
         7.1 Add
       concentrated
          HCI.
       7.1 Do final
         volume
       reduction and
       dilution, as
        described.
            Yes
        7.1 Further
        dilute with
         diluent.
  7.2 Add to
  aliquot urea;
 L-cysteine, HCI;
 heat H20  bath;
 bring to volume.
   7.3 Prepare
 standards from
 standard stock
 solutions of Sb
    and As.
7.6 - 7.6 Analyze
  the sample
  using hydride
  generation
  apparatus.
                                  7.6 - 7.7 Determine
                                   Sb and As cone.
                                    from standard
                                     calibration
                                       curve.
                                 7.1 Use
                               Method 3010
                               to digest 100
                                ml sample.
                                                                  7.4 Use the
                                                                   method of
                                                                   standard
                                                                addition* on EP
                                                                 extracts, only.
7.6 -7.6 Analyze
  the cample
 using hydride
  generation
   apparatus.
                               7.7 Determine
                                 Sb and As
                               concentrations
                               by Method of
                             Standard Additions.
                                       Stop
                                        7062-8
                                               Revision  0
                                               September 1994

-------
                                 METHOD 7080A

                BARIUM  (ATOMIC ABSORPTION, DIRECT ASPIRATION)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

      1.1   See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.

2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

      2.1   See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.

3.0  INTERFERENCES

      3.1   See Section 3.0 of Method 7000 if interferences are suspected.

      3.2   High hollow cathode current settings and a narrow spectral band pass
must  be  used,  because  both  barium  and  calcium  emit  strongly  at  barium's
analytical wavelength.

      3.3   Barium  undergoes  significant  ionization  in  the  nitrous  oxide/
acetylene flame, resulting in a significant decrease in sensitivity.  All
samples and standards must contain a ionization suppressant.  The type of
suppressant and concentration used must be documented.

4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

      4.1   For basic apparatus, see Section 4.0 of Method  7000.

      4.2   Instrument  parameters  (general):

            4.2.1  Barium  hollow cathode lamp.
            4.2.2  Wavelength:  553.6 nm.
            4.2.3  Fuel:   Acetylene.
            4.2.4  Oxidant:   Nitrous oxide.
            4.2.5  Type of flame:  Fuel rich.
            4.2.6  Background correction:  Not required.

5.0  REAGENTS

      5.1   See Section 5.0 of Method  7000.

      5.2   Preparation of standards:

            5.2.1     Stock solution:    Dissolve   1.7787   g   barium  chloride
      (BaCl22H20)   analytical reagent grade in  reagent  water and dilute to  1
      liter (1000 mg/L).  Alternatively,  procure  a certified  standard from  a
      supplier and verify  by  comparison with a second  standard.

            5.2.2     Prepare  dilutions  of the  stock  solution to  be  used  as
      calibration standards at the time of analysis.  The calibration standards


                                   7080A - 1                       Revision  1
                                                                   September 1994

-------
       should  be  prepared  using  the  same  type  of  acid  and  at  the  same
       concentration   as  will  result  in  the  sample  to  be  analyzed  after
       processing.   All   calibration  standards and samples  should  contain the
       ionization  suppressant.

 6.0    SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND  HANDLING

       6.1    See Chapter Three, Section 3.1.3, Sample  Handling and  Preservation.

 7.0    PROCEDURE


       7.1    Sample preparation:  The procedures for preparation of the sample are
 given  in Chapter Three, Section  3.2.

       7.2    See Method 7000, Section 7.2, Direct Aspiration.

 8.0  QUALITY  CONTROL

       8.1    See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.

 9.0  METHOD  PERFORMANCE


       9.1   The performance characteristics  for an aqueous sample free of inter-
 ferences are:


       Optimum concentration range:  1-20 mg/L with a wavelength of  553.6 nm.
       Sensitivity:  0.4 mg/L.
       Detection limit:  0.1 mg/L.


       9.2   In a single laboratory, analysis  of a mixed industrial-domestic waste
effluent, digested with Method 3010, at concentrations of 0.4 and 2 mg  Ba/L gave
standard deviations  of  ±0.043 and +0.13,  respectively.   Recoveries  at these
levels were 94% and 113%,  respectively.

10.0   REFERENCES


1.    Methods  for  Chemical Analysis  of Water  and Wastes,  EPA-600/4-82-055
December 1982, Method 208.1.
                                  7080A - 2                       Revision 1
                                                                  September 1994

-------
                   METHOD 7080A
BARIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION, DIRECT ASPIRATION)
            (    Start     j
               5.2 Prepare
                standards.
              7.1 For sample
              preparation see
             Chapter 3, Section
                   3.2.
              7.2 Analyze using
                Method 7000
                Section 7.2.
             (     Stop     J
                       7080A  -  3
Revision  1
September 1994

-------
                                  METHOD  7081
                 BARIUM  (ATOMIC  ABSORPTION.  FURNACE TECHNIQUE)
1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION
      1.1   See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.

2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD
      2.1   See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.

3.0  INTERFERENCES
      3.1   See Section 3.0 of Method 7000.
      3.2   Barium is known to  form  a  barium  carbide  in the graphite furnace.
This less volatile carbide can cause losses of sensitivity and memory effects.
      3.3   The long residence time and the high concentration of the analyte in
the optical  path  of the graphite  furnace can lead to severe physical and chemical
interferences.  Furnace  parameters must be  optimized to minimize these effects.
      3.4   Because of possible chemical interaction, nitrogen should not be used
as a purge gas.
      3.5   Halide acids should  not be used.
4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS
      4.1   For basic apparatus, see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.
      4.2   Instrument parameters (general):
            4.2.1   Drying time  and temp:  30 sec at 125°C.
            4.2.2   Ashing time  and temp:  30 sec at 1200°C.
            4.2.3   Atomizing time and temp:  10 sec at 2800°C.
            4.2.4   Purge gas:  Argon (nitrogen should not be used).
            4.2.5   Wavelength:   553.6 nm.
            4.2.6   Background correction:   Not required.
                                   7081 - 1                       Revision 0
                                                                  July 1992

-------
            4.2.7   Other operating parameters should be set as specified by the
      particular instrument manufacturer.

      NOTE:  The above concentration  values and instrument conditions are for a
            Perkin-Elmer  HGA-2100,  based  on  the  use  of a  20-uL  injection,
            continuous-flow purge gas, and  nonpyrolytic graphite.  Smaller size
            furnace devices or those employing faster rates  of atomization can
            be operated using lower  atomization  temperatures  for  shorter time
            periods than the above-recommended settings.


5.0  REAGENTS

      5.1   See Section 5.0 of Method 7000.

      5.2   Preparation of standards

            5.2.1   Stock solution - Dissolve 1.7787 g barium chloride
      (BaCl2 2H20,  analytical  reagent grade)  in  water and dilute  to  1  liter.
      Alternatively, procure a certified  standard from  a supplier and verify by
      comparison with a second standard.

            5.2.2   Prepare dilutions  of  the stock  solution to  be used  as
      calibration standards at the time of  analysis.  The calibration standards
      should  be  prepared  using the  same  type  of  acid   and  at  the  same
      concentrations as in the sample after processing (0.5% v/v HN03).


6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

      6.1   See Chapter Three, Step 3.1.3, Sample Handling and Preservation.


7.0  PROCEDURE

      7.1   Sample Preparation - The procedures for preparation of the sample are
given in Chapter Three, Step 3.2.

      7.2   See Method 7000, Step 7.3, Furnace Technique.


8.0  QUALITY ASSURANCE

      8.1   See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.
9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

      9.1   Precision and accuracy data are not available at this time.
                                   7081 - 2                       Revision 0
                                                                  July 1992

-------
10.0  REFERENCES

1.    Methods for  Chemical  Analysis of  Water and Wastes;  U.S.  Environmental
Protection Agency.  Office of Research and Development. Environmental Monitoring
and Support  Laboratory.  ORD Publication  Offices of Center  for  Environmental
Research Information:  Cincinnati, OH,  1983; EPA-600/4-79-020.
                                   7081 - 3                       Revision 0
                                                                  July 1992

-------
                    METHOD  7081
BARIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION,  FURNACE TECHNIQUE)
                       Start
                     5.0 Pr«par«
                      »tandard*
                   7.1 For »ampl«
                   preparation >••
                  Chapter 3, Section
                        3.2
                   7.2 Analyze using
                    Method 7000
                     Section 7.3
                        Stop
                        7081  - 4
Revision 0
July  1992

-------
                                 METHOD 7090

              BERYLLIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION. DIRECT ASPIRATION)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  See Section 3.0 of Method 7000 if interferences are suspected.

     3.2  Background correction may be required because nonspecific absorption
and light scattering can be significant at the analytical wavelength.

     3.3  Concentrations  of  aluminum  greater  than  500  ppm  may  suppress
beryllium absorbance.  The addition of  0.1% fluoride has been found effective
in eliminating  this  interference.    High  concentrations  of  magnesium and
silicon cause similar problems and require  the  use of the method of standard
additions.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1  For basic apparatus, see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.

     4.2  Instrument parameters (general):

          4.2.1  Beryllium hollow cathode lamp.
          4.2.2  Wavelength:  234.9 nm.
          4.2.3  Fuel:  Acetylene.
          4.2.4  Oxldant:   Nitrous oxide.
          4.2.5  Type of flame:  Fuel  rich.
          4.2.6  Background correction:  Required.


5.0  REAGENTS

     5.1  See Section 5.0 of Method 7000.

     5.2  Preparation of standards;

          5.2.1  Stock solution:  Dissolve 11.6586 g beryllium sulfate,  BeSOa,
     in Type II water  containing  2  mL  nitric  acid  and dilute to 1  liter.
                                  7090 - 1
                                                         Revision      Q
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
     Beryllium metal can also be dissolved 1n ^04.  Alternatively, procure a
     certified standard from a  supplier and verify by comparison with a second
     standard.

          5.2.2   Prepare   dilutions  of   the  stock  solution  to   be  used as
     calibration standards at the  time of analysis.  The  calibration standards
     should  be   prepared   using   the  same  type  of   add  and   at  the  same
     concentration  as will  result   In  the   sample   to be  analyzed  after-
     processing  (0.5%  v/v  HN03).


6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION,  PRESERVATION,  AND HANDLING

     6.1  See Chapter Three,  Section  3.1.3,  Sample Handling  and  Preservation.


7.0  PROCEDURE

     7.1  Sample Preparation;   The  procedures  for  preparation of the sample
are given 1n Chapter Three, Section 3.2.

     7.2  See Method 7000, Paragraph 7.2, Direct Aspiration.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

     8.1  See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.


9.0  METHOD  PERFORMANCE

     9.1  The performance characteristics for an aqueous sample free of Inter-
ferences  are:

     Optimum concentration range:  0.05-2 mg/L with a wavelength  of 234.9 nm.
     Sensitivity:   0.025  mg/L.
     Detection  limit:  0.005 mg/L.

     9.2   In a   single  laboratory,  analysis  of  a mixed  industrial-domestic
waste  effluent, digested  with  Method 3010,  at concentrations of  0.01 and 0.25
mg/L gave standard deviations  of   +0.001 and +0.002, respectively. Recoveries
at these  levels were  100% and  97%, respectively.

      9.3   For  concentrations of beryllium below   0.02  mg/L, the  furnace proce-
dure (Method 7091) is recommended.


 10.0  REFERENCES

 1.   Methods for  Chemical  Analysis  of Water  and Wastes,  EPA-600/4-82-055,
 December 1982,  Method 210.1.
                                   7090 - 2
                                                          Revision
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
                  METHOD 709O

BERYLLIUM  (ATOMIC ABSORPTION. DIRECT ASPIRATION)
5.
O

Prepare
•tandards
7. 1
prepar
ct
• ec
For
•ample
•atlon
lapter
tlon 3
• ea
3.
.2
                7.2
                Analyze using
                 Method 7000.
                 Section 7.2
              (     Stop      J
            7090 - 3
                                      Revision       0
                                      Date  September 1986

-------
                                 METHOD 7091

              BERYLLIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION,  FURNACE TECHNIQUE)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  See Section 3.0 of Method 7000 if Interferences are suspected.

     3.2  The long residence  time  and  high  concentrations  of the atomized
sample 1n the  optical  path  of  the  graphite  furnace  can result 1n severe
physical and chemical interferences.   Furnace parameters must be optimized to
minimize these effects.

     3.3  In addition to the  normal interferences experienced during graphite
furnace analysis, beryllium analysis  can  suffer  from severe nonspecific ab-
sorption and light scattering caused  by matrix components during atomlzatlon.
Simultaneous background  correction  is  required  to  avoid  erroneously high
results.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1  For basic  apparatus,  see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.

     4.2  Instrument parameters  (general):

          4.2.1  Drying time and temp:  30 sec at 125*C.
          4.2.2  Ashing time and temp:  30 sec at 1000*C.
          4.2.3  Atomizing time and temp:  10 sec at 2800*C.
          4.2.4  Purge gas:  Argon.
          4.2.5  Wavelength:  234.9 nm.
          4.2.6  Background correction:  Required.
          4.2.7  Other operating parameters should be  set as specified by the
     particular  instrument manufacturer.
     NOTE:  The  above concentration values and instrument conditions are for a
            Perkin-Elmer HGA-2100, based  on  the  use  of  a 20-uL Injection,
            continuous-flow purge  gas,  and  nonpyrolytic  graphite.  Smaller
            sizes of furnace   devices  or  those  employing  faster  rates of
            atomlzatlon can be  operated  using lower atomlzatlon temperatures
            for  shorter time periods than the above-recommended settings.
                                   7091 -  1
                                                         Revision
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
5.0  REAGENTS

     5.1  See Section 5.0 of Method 7000.

     5.2  Preparation of standards;

          5.2.1  Stock solution:  Dissolve 11.6586 g beryllium sulfate, BeSO/j,
     In Type II water containing 2 mL concentrated nitric acid and dilute to
     1 liter.  Beryllium metal can  also be dissolved in acid.  Alternatively,
     procure a certified standard  from  a  supplier  and verify by comparison
     with a second standard.

          5.2.2  Prepare dilutions of the stock  solution  to be used as cali-
     bration standards at the  time  of  analysis.   The calibration standards
     should  be  prepared  using  the  same  type  of  acid  and  at  the same
     concentrations as in the sample after processing (0.5% v/v
6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

     6.1  See Chapter Three, Section 3.1.3, Sample Handling and Preservation.

7.0  PROCEDURE

     7.1  Sample  Preparation;  The  procedures  for  preparation of the sample
are given in Chapter Three, Section 3.2.

     7.2  See Method 7000,  Paragraph 7.3,  Furnace Procedure.  The calculation
is given in Method  7000,  Paragraph 7.4.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

     8.1  See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.

9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

     9.1  Precision and accuracy data are not available at this time.

     9.2  The performance characteristics for an aqueous sample free of inter-
ferences are:

     Optimum concentration  range:  1-30 ug/L.
     Detection  limit:  0.2  ug/L.


10.0   REFERENCES

1.   Methods for  Chemical  Analysis  of  Water  and Wastes, EPA-600/4-82-055,
December 1982,  Method 210.2.


                                  7091 - 2
                                                         Revision      0
                                                         Date  September  1986

-------
                  METHOD 7O91

BERYLLIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION.  FURNACE  TECHNIQUE)
                  S.O
                     Prepare
                    •tendarda
7. t
prepar
cf
aec
For •
•ample
atlon aee
apter 3.
tion 3.Z
                 7.Z
                 Analyze using
                  Method 7000.
                  Section 7.3.
                calculation 7.4
               (     Stop      j
           7091 - 3
                                     Revision       0
                                     Date  September 1986

-------
                                 METHOD 7130

               CADMIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION.  DIRECT ASPIRATION)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  See Section 3.0 of Method 7000 1f Interferences are suspected.

     3.2  Nonspecific absorption and  light  scattering  can be significant at
the analytical wavelength.  Thus background correction 1s required.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1  For basic  apparatus, see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.

     4.2  Instrument parameters  (general):

          4.2.1   Cadmium hollow  cathode lamp.
          4.2.2   Wavelength:   228.8 nm.
          4.2.3   Fuel:   Acetylene.
          4.2.4   Oxldant:   A1r.
          4.2.5   Type of flame:  Oxidizing  (fuel  lean).
          4.2.6   Background correction:  Required.


 5.0  REAGENTS

     5.1  See  Section 5.0 of Method 7000.

     5.2   Preparation of standards;

           5.2.1   Stock  solution:  Dissolve   1.000  g  cadmium  metal  (analytical
     reagent grade)  in  20 mL of  1:1   HN03   and   dilute to  1 liter  with  Type  II
     water.   Alternatively, procure a  certified  standard from a  supplier and
     verify  by comparison with a second standard.

           5.2.2   Prepare dilutions of the  stock   solution  to be used as  cali-
     bration standards  at the time   of  analysis.    The calibration standards
     should   be   prepared  using  the  same  type  of add   and   at  the same
                                   7130 - 1
                                                          Revision       0
                                                          Date   September 1986

-------
     concentration  as  will   result  1n  the  sample  to  be  analyzed  after
     processing.


6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION,  AND HANDLING

     6.1  See Chapter Three,  Section 3.1.3,  Sample Handling and Preservation.,


7.0  PROCEDURE

     7.1  Sample preparation;  The  procedures  for  preparation of the sample
are given 1n Chapter Three, Section 3.2.

     7.2  See Method 7000, Paragraph 7.2, Direct Aspiration.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

     8.1  See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.


9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

     9.1  The performance characteristics for an aqueous sample free of Inter-
ferences are:

     Optimum concentration range: 0.05-2 mg/L with a wavelength of 228.8 nm.
     Sensitivity:  0.025 mg/L.
     Detection limit:  0.005 mg/L.

     9.2  For concentrations of cadmium below 0.02 mg/L, the furnace procedure
(Method 7131) 1s recommended.

     9.3  Precision and accuracy data are available 1n Method 213.1 of Methods
for Chemical Analysis of Water and Wastes.

     9.4  The data shown 1n Table  1  were  obtained from records of state and
contractor laboratories.  The data are  Intended  to show the precision of the
combined sample preparation and analysis method.


10.0  REFERENCES

1.   Methods for  Chemical  Analysis  of  Water  and Wastes, EPA-600/4-82-055,
December 1982, Method 213.1.

2.   GaskUl, A., Compilation and Evaluation  of RCRA Method Performance Data,
Work Assignment No. 2, EPA Contract No. 68-01-7075, September 1986.
                                  7130 - 2
                                                         Revision
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
                 METHOD 7190

CHROMIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION.  DIRECT ASPIRATION)
                5.0
                    Prepare
                   standards
                7. t I
               	1 For
                     •ampla
               preparation sea
                   chapter 3.
                  section 3.2
                7.Z
                AnalyzH  using
                 Method  7000.
                 Section 7.Z
              f      Stop       J
          7190 -  5
                                    Revision       0
                                    Date   September 1986

-------
10.0  REFERENCES
1.    Methods for Chemical  Analysis  of  Water  and Wastes, EPA-600/4-82-055,
December 1982, Method 218.1.
2.    Gasklll, A., Compilation and Evaluation of RCRA Method Performance Data,
Work Assignment No. 2, EPA Contract No. 68-01-7075, September 1986.
                                  7190 - 3
                                                         Revision
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
                          TABLE 1.  METHOD PERFORMANCE DATA
       Sample                      Preparation                Laboratory
       Matrix                        Method                   Replicates


Wastewater treatment sludge          3050                    6,100,  6,000 ug/g

Emission control dust                3050                    2.0, 2.8 ug/g
                                   7190 - 4
                                                          Revision      0
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
                                 METHOD 7190

               CHROMIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION,  DIRECT ASPIRATION)
1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  See Section 3.0 of Method 7000 if interferences are suspected.

     3.2  An ionization interference may occur  if the samples have a signifi-
cantly higher alkali metal content  than  the standards.  If this interference
is encountered,  an  ionization  suppressant  (KC1)  should  be  added to both
samples and standards.

     3.3  Background correction may be required because nonspecific absorption
and scattering can be  significant  at  the analytical wavelength.  Background
correction with certain instruments may be difficult at this wavelength due to
low-intensity output from hydrogen or  deuterium  lamps.  Consult the specific
instrument manufacturer's literature for details.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1  For basic apparatus, see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.

     4.2  Instrument parameters (general):

          4.2.1  Chromium hollow cathode lamp.
          4.2.2  Wavelength:  357.9 nm.
          4.2.3  Fuel:  Acetylene.
          4.2.4  Oxtdant:  Nitrous oxide.
          4.2.5  Type of flame:  Fuel rich.
          4.2.6  Background correction:  Not required.


5.0  REAGENTS

     5.1  See Section 5.0 of Method 7000.
                                  7190 - 1
                                                         Revision
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
     5.2  Preparation of standards;

          5.2.1  Stock solution:   Dissolve 1.923  g  of  chromium tr1oxide
     analytical reagent grade)   1n  Type  II   water,   acidify  with  redistilled
     HN03,  and dilute to 1 liter.   Alternatively, procure  a  certified standard
     from a supplier and verify by comparison with  a second  standard.

          5.2.2  Prepare dilutions of the stock  solution  to  be  used as cali-
     bration standards at the  time  of  analysis.   The calibration standards
     should  be  prepared  using  the  same  type  of   add  and  at  the same
     concentration  as  will   result  1n  the  sample   to  be   analyzed  after
     processing.


6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

     6.1  See Chapter Three,  Section 3.1.3, Sample  Handling  and Preservation.


7.0  PROCEDURE

     7.1  Sample preparation;  The  procedures  for preparation  of the sample
are given In Chapter Three, Section 3.2.

     7.2  See Method 7000, Paragraph 7.2, Direct  Aspiration.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

     8.1  See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.
9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

     9.1  The  performance  characteristics  for  an  aqueous  sample  free of
Interferences are:

     Optimum concentration range:  0.5-10 mg/L with a wavelength of 357.9 nm.
     Sensitivity:  0.25 mg/L.
     Detection limit:  0.05 mg/L.

     9.2  For concentrations of chromium below 0.2 mg/L,  the furnace procedure
(Method 7191) 1s recommended.

     9.3  Precision and accuracy data are available in Method 218.1 of Methods
for Chemical Analysis of Water and Wastes.

     9.4  The data shown in Table  1  were  obtained from records of state and
contractor laboratories.  The data are  intended  to show the precision of the
combined sample preparation and analysis method.
                                  7190 - 2
                                                         Revision
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
                 METHOD 714O

CALCIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION.  DIRECT ASPIRATION)
                 5.0
                     Prepare
                    standards
                 7.,
                - 1  FOP
                      sample
                preparation see
                    chapter 3.
                   section 3.2
                 7.2
                 Analyze  using
                  Method  700O.
                  Section 7.2
               f      Stop       J
             7140  - 3
                                       Revision       0
                                       Date  September  1986

-------
                                 METHOD 7140

               CALCIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION,  DIRECT ASPIRATION)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  See Section 3.0 of Method 7000.

     3.2  All elements forming stable oxyanlons  (P,  B,  Si, Cr, S, V, Ti, Al,
etc.) will complex calcium and interfere  unless lanthanum is added.  Addition
of lanthanum to prepared samples  rarely  presents a problem because virtually
all environmental samples contain sufficient calcium to require dilution to be
in the  linear range of the method.

     3.3  P04, $04, and Al are  interferents.    High concentrations of Mg, Na,
and K interfere.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1  For basic apparatus, see Section  4.0 of Method 7000.

     4.2  Instrument  parameters  (general):

          4.2.1   Calcium  hollow cathode lamp.
          4.2.2   Wavelength:  422.7 nm.
          4.2.3   Fuel:  Acetylene.
          4.2.4   0x1dant:  Nitrous oxide.
          4.2.5   Type of  flame:  Stoichiometric.
          4.2.6   Background correction:  Not required.


5.0  REAGENTS

     5.1  See Section 5.0 of  Method 7000.

     5.2  Preparation of  standards;

          5.2.1   Stock solution:  Suspend 2.500  g of CaCOs  (analytical reagent
     grade,  dried for 1 hr at 180*C)  1n Type II  water  and dissolve by adding  a
                                   7140 - 1
                                                          Revision      0
                                                          Date  September  1986

-------
     minimum  of  dilute  HC1.     Dilute   to   1   liter  with   Type   II   water.
     Alternatively,  procure a certified standard  from a supplier  and verify  by
     comparison with a second standard.

          5.2.2  Prepare  dilutions   of   the   stock  solution   to  be  used  as
     calibration standards at the time of analysis.  The  calibration standards
     should  be  prepared  using  the same   type of  acid  and  at the  same
     concentration  as  will   result  in   the sample  to be   analyzed after
     processing, including 1  ml  of   lanthanum chloride   per   10 ml sample  or
     standard (see Paragraph  5.2.3).

          5.2.3  Lanthanum chloride solution: Dissolve   29  g 13203 in 250  ml
     concentrated HC1  -
          CAUTION:  REACTION  IS VIOLENT -
     and dilute to 500 mL with Type II water.


6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

     6.1  See Chapter Three,  Section  3.1.3,  Sample Handling  and Preservation.


7.0  PROCEDURE

     7.1  Sample preparation;  The procedures  for   preparation of the sample
are given in Chapter Three, Section  3.2.

     7.2  See Method 7000, Paragraph  7.2, Direct Aspiration.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

     8.1  See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.


9.0  METHOD  PERFORMANCE

     9.1  Precision and  accuracy data are available in Method 215.1 of Methods
for  Chemical Analysis of Water  and Wastes.

     9.2  The   performance  characteristics  for  an  aqueous  sample  free of
interferences are:

     Optimum concentration range:  0.2-7 mg/L with a wavelength of 422.7 nm.
     Sensitivity:   0.08  mg/L.
     Detection  limit:  0.01 mg/L.


10.0  REFERENCES

1.   Methods for  Chemical  Analysis  of  Water  and Wastes,  EPA-600/4-82-055,
December  1982,  Method 215.1.


                                  7140 - 2
                                                         Revision      0
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
                          TABLE 1. METHOD PERFORMANCE DATA
       Sample                      Preparation                Laboratory
       Matrix                        Method                   Replicates


Emission control dust                 3050                  2,770, 1,590 ug/g

Wastewater treatment sludge           3050                 12,000, 13,000 ug/g
                                   7130 - 3
                                                          Revision      0
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
                  METHOD 713O

CADMIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION. DIRECT ASPIRATION)
                    Prepare
                   standards
                7.1 I
               	1 For
                     •ample
               preparation, see
                   chapter 3.
                  section 3.2
                7.2 |

                Analyze using
                 Method 70OO.
                 Section 7.2
              f     Stop      J
            7130 - 4
                                      Revision       0
                                      Date   September 1986

-------
                                 METHOD 7131A
                CADMIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION. FURNACE TECHNIQUE)

1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION
      1.1   See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.

2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD
      2.1   See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.

3.0  INTERFERENCES
      3.1   See Section 3.0 of Method 7000 if interferences are suspected.
      3.2   In addition to the normal  interferences experienced during graphite
furnace analysis,  cadmium analysis can suffer from severe nonspecific absorption
and light scattering caused by matrix components during atomization. Simultaneous
background correction is required to avoid erroneously high results.
      3.3   Excess  chloride  may  cause  premature  volatilization  of  cadmium.
Ammonium  phosphate used  as  a  matrix modifier  minimizes  this  loss.   Other
modifiers may be used as long as it is documented with the type of suppressant
and concentration.
      3.4   Many  plastic  pipet tips (yellow) contain  cadmium.   Use "cadmium-
free" tips.

4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS
      4.1   For basic apparatus, see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.
      4.2   Instrument parameters (general):
            4.2.1   Drying  time and temp:  30 sec at  125°C.
            4.2.2   Ashing  time and temp:  30 sec at  500°C.
            4.2.3   Atomizing time and temp:  10 sec  at 1900°C.
            4.2.4   Purge gas:  Argon.
            4.2.5   Wavelength:  228.8 nm.
            4.2.6   Background correction:   Required.
            4.2.7   Other operating  parameters should  be set as specified by the
      particular  instrument manufacturer.
                                   7131A - 1                       Revision 1
                                                                   September 1994

-------
             NOTE: The  above  concentration values  and  instrument  conditions  are
             for a Perkin-Elmer HGA-2100, based on the use of a 20-uL  injection,
             continuous-flow purge gas, and nonpyrolytic graphite.  Smaller sizes
             of furnace devices  or those employing faster rates  of atomization
             can  be  operated using lower atomization  temperatures for  shorter
             time periods than the  above-recommended settings.


5.0  REAGENTS

      5.1    See Section 5.0 of Method  7000.

      5.2    Preparation of standards:

             5.2.1      Stock  solution:   Dissolve 1.000  g  of  cadmium  metal
      (analytical reagent grade) in 20 ml of  1:1 HN03 and dilute to 1  liter with
      reagent  water.   Alternatively,  procure  a certified  standard  from  a
      supplier and verify by comparison with a second standard.

             5.2.2    Prepare dilutions  of the stock cadmium solution  to  be used
      as  calibration standards  at the time  of analysis.   To each  100 ml of
      standard and sample alike add 2.0 ml of the ammonium phosphate solution.
      The calibration  standards should be prepared to contain 0.5% (v/v)  HN03.

             5.2.3     Ammonium phosphate  solution (40%):    Dissolve 40  g  of
      ammonium phosphate,  (NH4)2HP04 (analytical reagent grade), in reagent  water
      and dilute to  100 ml.


6.0  SAMPLE  COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

      6.1    See Chapter Three, Section 3.1.3, Sample Handling  and  Preservation..


7.0  PROCEDURE

      7.1    Sample preparation:  The procedures  for preparation of the  sample are
provided in  Chapter Three,  Section 3.2.

      7.2    See Method 7000,  Section 7.3, Furnace Procedure.   The  calculation is
provided in Method 7000, Section 7.4.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

      8.1    Refer to Section 8.0 of Method  7000 .


9.0  METHOD  PERFORMANCE

      9.1   Precision and accuracy  data are available  in  Method 213.2  of Methods
for Chemical Analysis of Water and Wastes.
                                  7131A  - 2                       Revision 1
                                                                  September 1994

-------
      9.2   The performance characteristics for an aqueous sample free of inter-
ferences are:

      Optimum concentration range:  0.5-10 ug/L.
      Detection limit:  0.1 ug/L.

      9.3   The data shown  in Table  1 were obtained  from records of state and
contractor laboratories.   The  data are  intended to  show the  precision of the
combined sample preparation and analysis method.


10.0  REFERENCES

1.    Methods  for  Chemical  Analysis of  Water  and  Wastes,  EPA-600/4-82-055,
December 1982, Method 213.2.

2.    Gaskill, A., Compilation and Evaluation of RCRA Method Performance Data,
Work Assignment No. 2, EPA  Contract No.  68-01-7075, September 1986.
                                   7131A - 3                       Revision 1
                                                                   September 1994

-------
                        TABLE  1.  METHOD PERFORMANCE  DATA
Sample                       Preparation              Laboratory
Matrix                        Method                 Replicates


Lagoon soil                     3050            0.10,  0.095  ug/g

NBS SRM 1646 Estuarine sediment 3050                   0.35  ug/ga

Solvent extract of oily waste   3030             1.39,  1.09  ug/L



"Bias  of  -3% from expected value.
                                  7131A - 4                       Revision 1
                                                                  September 1994

-------
                    METHOD  7131A
CADMIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION, FURNACE  TECHNIQUE)
                 5.2 Prepare
                  standards.
                7.1  For sample
                preparation see
               Chapter 3, Section
                     3.2.
                7.2 Analyze using
                  Method 7000
                  Section 7.3.
                      1 r

               (     Stop     J
                     7131A  - 5
Revision 1
September 1994

-------
                                 METHOD 7191

               CHROMIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION. FURNACE TECHNIQUE)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.
                                                              •

3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  See Section 3.0 of Method 7000 1f interferences are suspected.

     3.2  Low  concentrations   of   calcium   and/or   phosphate   may  cause
interferences; at concentrations above 200  mg/L, calcium's effect is constant
and eliminates the effect of phosphate.  Calcium nitrate is therefore added to
ensure a known constant effect.

™ ^ 3:3. N1tr.°9en should not be used as  the  purge gas because of a possible
CN band interference.

     3.4  Background correction may be required because nonspecific absorption
and scattering can be  significant  at  the analytical wavelength.  Background
correct!on_with certain instruments may be difficult at this wavelength due to
low-intensity output from hydrogen or  deuterium  lamps.  Consult the specific
instrument manufacturer's literature for details.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1  For basic apparatus,  see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.

     4.2  Instrument parameters (general):

          4.2.1  Drying time and temp:   30 sec at 125*C.
          4.2.2  Ashing time and temp:   30 sec at 1000'C.
          4.2.3  Atomizing time and temp:   10 sec at 2700*C.
          4.2.4  Purge gas:   Argon (nitrogen should  not be  used).
          4.2.5  Wavelength:  357.9 nm.              	
          4.2.6  Background correction:   Not required.
          4.2.7  Other operating parameters should be  set  as  specified by  the
                 particular instrument  manufacturer.
     NOTE:   The above concentration values and instrument conditions  are for a
            Perkin-Elmer HGA-2100,  based  on  the use  of   a  20-uL injection
                                  7191 - 1
                                                         Revision       Q
                                                         Date   September  1986

-------
            continuous-flow purge  gas,   and   nonpyrolytlc   graphite.   Smaller
            sizes of  furnace  devices   or those   employing  faster  rates  of
            atomlzatlon can be  operated  using  lower  atomlzatlon  temperatures
            for shorter time periods than the above-recommended  settings.


5.0  REAGENTS

     5.1  See Section 5.0 of Method 7000.

     5.2  Preparation of standards;

          5.2.1  Stock solution:  Dissolve 1.923 g of chromium trloxlde (CrOs,
     analytical Veagent grade)  1n  Type  II   water,   acidify with redistilled
     HNOs, and dilute to 1 liter.  Alternatively,  procure a certified standard
     from a supplier and verify by comparison with a second standard.

          5.2.2  Prepare  dilutions  of  the  stock  solution  to  be  used as
     calibration standards at the time of analysis.  These standards should be
     prepared  to contain 0.5%  (v/v) HNOa; 1 mL of 30% ^02 and 1 ml of calcium
     nitrate solution, Section   5.2.3,  may  be  added to lessen interferences
     (see Section 3.0).

          5.2.3  Calcium  nitrate   solution:    Dissolve  11.8  g   of  calcium
     nitrate,  Ca(N03)2'4H20  (analytical  reagent  grade),  in  Type  II water  and
     dilute  to 1  liter.


 6.0 SAMPLE COLLECTION,  PRESERVATION,  AND HANDLING

     6.1  See  Chapter Three, Section 3.1.3,  Sample Handling and Preservation.


 7.0  PROCEDURE

      7.1  Sample preparation;  The  procedures   for   preparation  of the  sample
 are given in Chapter Three, Section 3.2.

      7.2  See Method 7000, Paragraph 7.3,  Furnace Procedure.  The calculation
 is given in Method 7000, Paragraph 7.4.


 8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

      8.1  See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.


 9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

      9.1  Precision and accuracy data are available in Method 218.2 of Methods
 for Chemical Analysis of Water and Wastes.
                                   7191 - 2
                                                          Revision
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
     9.2  The performance characteristics for an aqueous sample free of Inter-
ferences are:

     Optimum concentration range:  5-100 ug/L.
     Detection Hm1t:  1 ug/L.

     9.3  The data shown In Table  1  were  obtained from records of state and
contractor laboratories.  The data are  Intended  to show the precision of the
combined sample preparation and analysis method.


10.0  REFERENCES

1.   Methods for  Chemical  Analysis  of  Water  and Wastes, EPA-600/4-82-055,
December 1982, Method 218.2.

2.   Gaskill, A., Compilation and Evaluation  of RCRA Method Performance Data,
Work  Assignment  No.  2,   EPA   Contract  No.  68-01-7075,  September  1986.
                                  7191 - 3
                                                         Revision
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
                     TABLE  1. METHOD  PERFORMANCE DATA
Sampl e
Matrix
Paint primer
Contaminated soil
Oily lagoon soil
NBS SRM 1646 Estuarine sediment
EPA QC Sludge
NBS SRM 1085, Wear Metals in
lubricating oil
Preparation
Method
3050
3050
3050
3050
3050
3050
Laboratory
Replicates
2.7, 2.8 mg/g
12.0, 12.3 ug/g
69.6, 70.3 ug/g
42, 47 ug/ga
156 ug/gb
311, 356 ug/gc
aBias of -45 and -38% from expected,  respectively.

bfiias of -24% from expected.

cBias of +4 and +19% from expected, respectively.
                              7191 - 4
                                                     Revision
                                                     Date  September 1986

-------
                 METHOD 7191

CHROMIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION.  FURNACE TECHNIQUE)
                5.O
                    Prepare
                   •tandarda
7.1
prepar
cf
eec
For
cample
•atlon
tapter
tlon 3
•ea
3.
.Z
                Analyza using
                 Method 7000.
                 Section 7.3.
               calculation 7.4
              [     Stop      J
           7191 - 5
                                     Revision       0
                                     Date   September 1986

-------
                                 METHOD 7195

                   CHROMIUM.  HEXAVALENT (COPRECIPITATION)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  Method 7195 1s to  be  used  to  determine the concentration of dis-
solved hexavalent  chromium  [Cr(VI)]  1n  Extraction  Procedure (EP)  toxldty
characteristic extracts and ground waters.  This method may also be applicable
to certain  domestic  and  industrial  wastes,  provided  that  no interfering
substances are present (see Paragraph 3.1 below).

     1.2  Method 7195 may be used to analyze samples containing more than 5 ug
of Cr(VI) per liter.   Either  flame or furnace atomic absorption spectroscopy
(Methods 7190 and 7191) can be used with copredpitation.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  Method 7195 is based on  the  separation  of Cr(VI) from solution by
copredpitation of lead chromate  with  lead  sulfate  in a solution of acetic
acid.  After separation, the  supernate   [containing Cr(III)] is drawn off and
the precipitate is washed  to  remove  occluded  Cr(III).   The Cr(VI) 1s then
reduced and resolubilized in nitric  acid  and quantified as Cr(III) by either
flame or furnace atomic absorption spectroscopy  (Methods 7190 and 7191).


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  Extracts containing  either  sulfate  or  chloride 1n concentrations
above 1,000 mg/L should be diluted prior to analysis.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1  Filtering flask;  Heavy wall, 1-liter capacity.

     4.2  Centrifuge tubes;  Heavy  duty, conical, graduated, glass-stoppered,
10-mL capacity.

     4.3  Pasteur plpets;  Borosilicate glass, 6.8 cm.

     4.4  Centrifuge;   Any  centrifuge   capable  of  reaching  2,000  rpm and
accepting the centrifuge tubes described  in Section 4.2 may be used.

     4.5  pH meter;  A wide  variety of instruments are commercially available
and suitable for this work.

     4.6  Test tube mixer;  Any  mixer capable  of imparting a thorough vortex
1s acceptable.
                                   7195 -  1
                                                         Revision
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
5.0  REAGENTS

     5.1  ASTM Type II water  (ASTM  D1193):     Water  should be monitored for
Impurities.

     5.2  Lead nitrate solution:   Dissolve  33.1   g of lead nitrate,  Pb(N(h)2
(analytical reagent grade), In Type II water  and dilute to 100 ml.

     5.3  Ammonium sulfate solution:    Dissolve  2.7  g  of ammonium  sulfate,
(NH4)2S04 (analytical  reagent grade),  1n Type II water and dilute to 100 ml.

     5.4  Calcium nitrate  solution;    Dissolve  11.8  g  of calcium  nitrate,
Ca(N03)2-4H20 (analytical reagent grade), in  Type  II water and dilute  to
100 ml (1 ml = 20 mg Ca).

     5.5  Nitric acid;  Concentrated,   distilled reagent grade or spectrograde
quality.

     5.6  Acetic acid, glacial.  10% (v/v):    Dilute 10 ml glacial acetic acid
CHsCOOH (ACS reagent grade), to 100 mL with Type II water.

     5.7  Ammonium hydroxide. 10% (v/v):   Dilute 10 ml concentrated  ammonium
hydroxide, NfyOH (analytical reagent grade),  to 100 ml with Type II water.

     5.8  Hydrogen peroxide. 30%:  ACS reagent grade.

     5.9  Potassium dichromate standard solution;    Dissolve 28.285 g  of dried
potassium dichromate,  I^C^O/ (analytical reagent  grade), in Type II water and
dilute to 1 liter (1 ml = 10 mg Cr).

     5.10 Trivalent chromium working stock solution;    To 50 ml of the potas-
sium dichromate standard solution, add 1 ml  of 30% ^2 and 1 ml concentrated
HN03 and dilute to 100 ml with  Type  II  water (1 ml = 5.0 mg trivalent chro-
mium).  Prepare fresh monthly, or as needed.


6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

     6.1  All samples must  have  been  collected   using  a sampling plan that
addresses the considerations discussed in Chapter  Nine of this manual.

     6.2  Since the stability  of  Cr(VI)  in  EP   extracts  is not completely
understood at this  time,  the  analysis  should  be  carried  out  as soon as
possible.

     6.3  To retard the chemical activity  of hexavalent chromium, samples and
extracts should be stored at  4'C  until  analyzed.   The maximum holding time
prior to analysis is 24 hr.
                                  7195 - 2
                                                         Revision
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
7.0  PROCEDURE

     7.1  Transfer a 50-mL portion of  the  sample  to a 100-mL Griffin beaker
and adjust to a pH of 3.5 + 0.3 by adding volumes of 10% acetic acid dropwlse.
Proceed Immediately to Step 7.2,  taking  no  longer than 15 mln between these
steps.
     NOTE:  Care must be exercised not to take  the  pH below 3.  If the pH is
            inadvertently lowered to <3, 10%  NH40H should be used to readjust
            the pH to 3.5 + 0.3.

     7.2  Pi pet a 10-mL aliquot of the adjusted sample into a centrifuge tube.
Add 100 uL of the lead nitrate solution, stopper the tube, mix the sample,  and
allow to stand for 3 min.

     7.3  After the formation of lead chromate, to help retain Cr(III) complex
in solution, add 0.5 ml glacial acetic acid, stopper, and mix.

     7.4  To provide adequate lead sulfate  for coprecipitation, add 100 uL of
ammonium sulfate solution, stopper, and mix.

     7.5  Place the stoppered centrifuge  tube  in the centrifuge, making sure
that the tube is properly  counterbalanced.    Start the centrifuge and slowly
increase the speed to 2,000 rpm  in  small  Increments over a period of 5 min.
Hold at 2,000 rpm for 1 min.
     NOTE:  The speed of the  centrifuge  must  be  increased slowly to ensure
            complete coprecipitation.

     7.6  After centrifuging, remove  the  tube  and  withdraw and discard the
supernate  using  either  the  apparatus  detailed  in  Figure  1  or  careful
decantation.  If using the vacuum apparatus, the pasteur plpet is lowered into
the tube and the supernate  1s  sucked  over  Into  the filtering flask.  With
care, the supernate can be withdrawn  to within approximately 0.1 ml above the
precipitate.  Wash the precipitate with  5  ml  Type II water and repeat steps
7.5 and 7.6; then proceed to 7.7.

     7.7  To the remaining precipitate, add  0.5  ml concentrated HN03, 100 uL
30% H202, and 100 uL  calcium  nitrate  solution.    Stopper the tube and mix,
using a vortex  mixer  to  disrupt  the  precipitate  and  solubilize the lead
chromate.  Dilute to  10  ml,  mix,  and  analyze  in  the  same manner as the
calibration standard.

     7.8  Flame atomic absorption;  At  the  time of analysis, prepare a blank
and a series of at leastfour  calibration standards from the Cr(III) working
stock that will adequately bracket the  sample and cover a concentration range
of 1 to 10 mg Cr/L.   Add  to  the blank and each standard, before diluting to
final volume, 1 ml 30% H202, 5  ml concentrated HN03, and 1 ml calcium nitrate
solution for each 100 ml  of  prepared  solution.  These calibration  standards
should be prepared fresh weekly, or as  needed.  Refer to Method 7090 for more
detail.
                                  7195 - 3
                                                         Revision      0
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
     7.9  Furnace atomic absorption;   At the time of analysis,  prepare a blank
and a series of at leastfour  calibration standards from the  Cr(III) working
stock that will adequately bracket the  sample and cover a concentration range
of 5 to 100 ug Cr/L.  Add  to  the blank and each standard,  before diluting to
final volume, 1 ml 30% ^02, 5  ml concentrated HNOs, and 1  ml  calcium nitrate
solution for each 100 ml  of  prepared  solution.  These calibration standards
should be prepared fresh weekly, or as  needed.  Refer to Method 7191 for more
detail.

     7.10 Verification;

          7.10.1  For every sample  matrix  analyzed, verification is required
     to ensure that neither a  reducing condition nor chemical  interference is
     affecting precipitation.  This must be accomplished by analyzing a second
     10-mL aliquot of  the  pH-adjusted  filtrate  that  has been spiked with
     Cr(VI).  The amount of spike  added should double the concentration found
     in the original aliquot.   Under  no  circumstance should  the increase be
     less than 30 ug/L Cr(VI).  To  verify the absence of an interference, the
     spike recovery must be between 85% and 115%.

          7.10.2  If addition of  the  spike  extends the concentration beyond
     the calibration curve, the analysis solution should be diluted with blank
     solution and the calculated results adjusted accordingly.

          7.10.3  If  the  result  of  verification  indicates   a  suppressive
     interference, the sample should be diluted and reanalyzed.  If necessary,
     use furnace atomic absorption to achieve the optimal concentration range.

          7.10.4  If  the  interference  persists  after  sample  dilution, an
     alternative method (Method  7197,  Chelatlon/Extraction,   or Method 7196,
     Colorimetric) should be used.

     7.11  Acidic extracts that yield  recoveries  of  less than 85% should be
retested to determine if the  low  spike  recovery  is  due to  the presence of
residual reducing agent.    This  determination  shall  be  performed by first
making an aliquot  of  the  extract  alkaline  (pH  8.0-8.5) using 1 N sodium
hydroxide and then respiking and analyzing.  If a spike recovery of 85-115% is
obtained in the alkaline aliquot of an acidic extract that initially was found
to contain less than  5  mg/L  Cr(VI),  one  can  conclude that the analytical
method has been verified.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

     8.1  All quality control data should be maintained and available for easy
reference or inspection.

     8.2  Calibration curves must be  composed  of  a  minimum  of a blank and
three standards.   A  calibration  curve  should  be  made  for  every hour of
continuous sample analysis.
                                  7195 - 4
                                                         Revision      0
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
     8.3  Dilute samples  if  they  are  more  concentrated  than  the highest
standard or if they fall on the plateau of a calibration curve.

     8.4  Employ a minimum  of  one  blank  per  sample  batch to determine if
contamination or any memory effects are occurring.

     8.5  Verify calibration  with  an  independently  prepared check standard
every 15 samples.

     8.6  Run one spike duplicate sample  for  every  10 samples.  A duplicate
sample is a sample brought through the whole sample preparation and analytical
process.

     8.7  The method of  standard  additions   (see  Method  7000, Section 8.7)
shall be used for the analysis  of  all EP extracts, on all analyses submitted
as part of a deli sting  petition,  and  whenever  a new sample matrix is being
analyzed.


9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

     9.1  Precision and accuracy data are available in Method 218.5 of Methods
for  Chemical Analysis of Water and Wastes.


10.0 REFERENCES

1.   Methods for  Chemical  Analysis  of  Water   and Wastes,  EPA-600/4-82-055,
December 1982,  Method 218.5.
                                   7195 - 5
                                                          Revision
                                                          Date   September 1986

-------
                                            METHOD 7195

                            HEXAVAUENT CHROMIUM:  COPRECIPITATION METHOD
  (      Start     J
    7. 1
   Transfer sample
      to beaker:
      adjust OH
 7.2
                             7.6
                                   Remove
                              tube:  discard
                            supernate:  wash
                              precipitate:
                            repeat 7.5.  7.6
Pipet adjusted sample
Into centrifuge tube:
   add lead nitrate
 solution;  mix :  let
        stand
    7.3
                                                        7.7
                                   Add cone
                                    HNO ».
                               BOX HaOz and
                            .calcium nitrate
                             solution:  mix;
                            dilute:  analyze
     Add glacial
     acetic acid:
         mix
    7.4
                           7.3
 Prepare blank and
     series of
 standards covering
concentration range
  of 5 to iOO ug
     Cr/llter
    Add ammonium
      sulfate
   solution:  mix
                              7.9
                                                 Furnace
                                                                      Flame
                                                        Which type of
                                                      atomic absorption
                                                          is used?
                                                                               7.8
                                                                                              •nd
 Prepare blank
      series of
 standards covering
concentration range
   of 1 to 10 mg
     Cr/llter
                                    Add 30X
   cone HNOI.  and
  calcium nitrate
     solution to
    each;  analyze
                                                                                  7.8
                                                                                        Add 30X
           .t.
    cone HNOj  and
  calcium nitrate
     solution to
    each:  analyze
    7.3
    Place tube in
     centrifuge:
     centrifuge
                             7.1O.1
                                     verify
                               by analyzing
                             second aliquot
                                 of spiked
                                  filtrate
                                         7195 -  6
                                                                    Revision       0
                                                                    Date  September 1986

-------
                                        METHOD 7195

                        HEXAVALENT CHROMIUM:  COPRECIPITATION METHOD
                                        (Continued)
  Ooes cone.
extend bi
 calibrai
               Yes
                          7. 10.2
                           Dilute  bank
                            solution:
                          adjust results
                         Dilute sample
                         and reanalyze
                                                7.12
                                                      If no valid
                                               results,  and chromium
                                                 more than threshold
                                                amount of hexavalent
                                                   chromium,  sample
                                               exlhlblts EP toxlclty
      Analytic
       method
verified:  waste
  not hazardous
                                                 (      Stop       J
                                    7195 - 7
                                                              Revision        p
                                                              Date  September 1986

-------
                                 METHOD 7196A

                      CHROMIUM,  HEXAVALENT (COLORIMETRIC)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

      1.1   Method  7196  is used to  determine the concentration  of dissolved
hexavalent  chromium  [Cr(VI)]  in  EP/TCLP  characteristic  extracts  and  ground
waters.  This method may also be applicable to certain domestic and industrial
wastes, provided that no interfering substances are present (see Paragraph 3.1
below).

      1.2   Method 7196 may be used to analyze samples containing from 0.5 to
50 mg of Cr(VI) per liter.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

      2.1   Dissolved hexavalent chromium,  in the absence of interfering amounts
of  substances  such as  molybdenum,  vanadium,  and  mercury,  may  be  determined
colorimetrically by reaction with diphenylcarbazide  in  acid  solution.   A red-
violet color of unknown composition is produced.  The reaction  is very sensitive,
the absorbancy index  per  gram  atom of chromium being about  40,000  at  540 nm.
Addition of an excess of diphenylcarbazide yields the red-violet product, and its
absorbance is measured photometrically at 540 nm.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

      3.1   The chromium reaction with diphenylcarbazide  is  usually free from
interferences.   However,  certain  substances  may interfere  if the  chromium
concentration is relatively low.  Hexavalent molybdenum and mercury salts also
react  to  form color  with  the  reagent;   however,  the  red-violet  intensities
produced  are  much  lower  than those  for   chromium   at  the  specified  pH.
Concentrations of  up  to  200 mg/L  of molybdenum and  mercury  can  be tolerated.
Vanadium interferes strongly, but concentrations up to 10 times that of chromium
will not cause trouble.

      3.2   Iron in  concentrations  greater than  1  mg/L may produce a  yellow
color,  but the ferric  iron  color is  not strong and  difficulty is not normally
encountered if the absorbance  is  measured photometrically at the  appropriate
wavelength.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

      4.1   Colorimetric equipment:   One  of the following  is  required:   Either
a spectrophotometer,  for use at 540 nm, providing a light path  of  1 cm or longer,
or a filter photometer, providing a  light  path of  1  cm  or longer and equipped
with  a greenish-yellow filter  having  maximum  transmittance  near
540 nm.
                                   7196A  -  1                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
5.0  REAGENTS

      5.1   Reagent water:  Reagent water  should  be monitored  for
impurities.

      5.2   Potassium dichromate stock  solution:   Dissolve 141.4  mg  of dried
potassium dichromate, K2CrJ07  (analytical  reagent  grade),  in  reagent water and
dilute to 1 liter (1 ml = 50 ug Cr).

      5.3   Potassium dichromate standard solution:  Dilute 10.00 ml potassium
dichromate stock solution to 100 ml (1 ml = 5 ug Cr).

      5.4   Sulfuric acid, 10% (v/v):   Dilute 10 ml of distilled reagent grade
or spectrograde quality sulfuric acid, H2S04, to  100 ml with reagent water.

      5.5   Diphenylcarbazide solution:   Dissolve 250 mg 1,5-diphenylcarbazide
in 50 ml acetone.  Store in a brown bottle.  Discard when the solution becomes
discolored.

      5.6   Acetone (analytical reagent grade):  Avoid or redistill material that
comes in containers with metal or metal-lined caps.


6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION,  AND HANDLING

      6.1   All  samples  must  have been  collected using a sampling  plan that
addresses the considerations discussed in Chapter Nine of this manual.

      6.2   Since  the  stability  of  Cr(VI)  in  extracts  is  not  completely
understood at this time,  the analysis should be carried out  as soon  as possible.

      6.3   To retard the chemical  activity of hexavalent chromium, the samples
and extracts should be stored at 4°C until analyzed.  The maximum holding time
prior to analysis of the samples or extracts is 24 hr.  The 24 hr holding time
begins after extraction.


7.0  PROCEDURE

     7.1    Color development and measurement:  Transfer 95 mL of the extract to
be tested to a 100-mL volumetric flask.   Add 2.0 mL diphenylcarbazide solution
and mix.   Add H2SOA  solution  to  give  a  pH  of  2 + 0.5, dilute  to  100 mL with
reagent water, and let stand 5 to  10 min for full color development.  Transfer
an appropriate portion of the  solution to a 1-cm absorption  cell  and measure its
absorbance at 540 nm.   Use reagent water as a reference.  Correct the absorbance
reading of the sample by subtracting the absorbance of a blank carried through
the method (see Note below).  An aliquot of the sample containing  all reagents
except diphenylcarbazide should be prepared and used to correct the sample for
turbidity  (i.e., a turbidity blank).  From the corrected absorbance, determine
the mg/L of chromium present by reference to the calibration curve.

      NOTE: If the  solution  is turbid  after dilution  to 100 mL  in Step 7.1,
            above,  take  an  absorbance  reading   before  adding the  carbazide

                                   7196A - 2                       Revision 1
                                                                   July 1992

-------
            reagent  and correct  the  absorbance reading  of  the final  colored
            solution  by subtracting the  absorbance measured  previously.

      7.2    Preparation of calibration curve:

            7.2.1  To compensate  for  possible  slight  losses  of  chromium during
      digestion  or  other  operations of the  analysis,  treat  the  chromium
      standards  by the  same procedure  as  the sample.   Accordingly, pi pet  a
      chromium standard solution  in  measured volumes  into  250-mL  beakers  or
      conical  flasks   to generate standard  concentrations ranging from 0.5  to
      5  mg/L Cr(VI) when diluted  to the  appropriate volume.

            7.2.2   Develop the  color  of the  standards as  for the  samples.
      Transfer a suitable  portion of each colored solution to a  1-cm absorption
      cell  and measure  the absorbance  at 540 nm.  As reference,  use  reagent
      water.  Correct the  absorbance readings of the  standards  by subtracting
      the  absorbance  of a  reagent blank  carried  through the  method.  Construct
      a  calibration curve  by plotting corrected  absorbance values  against  mg/L
      of Cr(VI).

     7.3    Verification:

            7.3.1  For every sample matrix analyzed, verification is required to
      ensure that neither a reducing condition  nor  chemical  interference  is
      affecting  color development.   This must be accomplished  by  analyzing a
      second 10-mL aliquot of the pH-adjusted filtrate that has been spiked  with
      Cr(VI).  The amount  of spike added should  double the concentration found
      in the original aliquot.  Under no circumstances  should  the increase  be
      less than  30 /ng Cr(VI)/liter.  To  verify the absence of an interference,
      the  spike  recovery must be  between 85% and 115%.

            7.3.2  If addition of the  spike  extends the concentration beyond the
      calibration  curve,  the  analysis   solution  should  be  diluted  with blank
      solution and the calculated results adjusted accordingly.

            7.3.3     If  the  result  of  verification   indicates  a  suppressive
      interference,  the sample should be diluted and  reanalyzed.

            7.3.4    If  the interference persists  after  sample dilution,  an
      alternative   method   (Method  7195,  Coprecipitation,   or  Method  7197,
      Chelation/Extraction) should be used.

      7.4   Acidic extracts that yield  recoveries  of less than 85% should  be
retested to  determine  if  the  low spike recovery  is due to the  presence  of
residual reducing  agent.  This determination shall be performed by first making
an aliquot of the  extract  alkaline (pH 8.0-8.5)  using 1 N sodium hydroxide and
then respiking and analyzing.  If a spike recovery of  85-115%  is obtained in the
alkaline aliquot of an acidic extract that  initially  was found  to contain  less
than  5  mg/L  Cr(VI),  one  can  conclude   that  the analytical  method  has  been
verified.
                                   7196A  -  3                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
      7.5   Analyze all  extracts,  all  samples  analyzed as part of a delisting
petition, and all samples that  suffer from matrix interferences by the method of
standard additions (see  Method 7000, Section 8.7).


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

      8.1   All quality control data should be maintained and available  for easy
reference or inspection.  Refer to  Chapter One for more information.

      8.2   Dilute  samples  if  they are  more concentrated  than  the  highest
standard or if they fall on the plateau of a calibration curve.

      8.3   Employ a  minimum  of  one  blank per  sample batch  to  determine if
contamination or any memory effects are occurring.

      8.4   Verify calibration with an independently  prepared check standard
every 15 samples.

      8.5   Run one matrix spike replicate or one replicate sample  for every ten
samples.   A duplicate  sample  is  a sample brought  through the  whole sample
preparation and analytical process.  Refer to Chapter One for more information
concerning matrix spikes and matrix spike duplicates.

      8.6   The method of standard additions (see Method 7000, Section 8.7) shall
be used for the analysis of all extracts,  on all  analyses submitted as part of
a delisting petition,  and whenever a new sample matrix is being analyzed.


9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

      9.1   The data shown in  Table 1  were  obtained  from records of state and
contractor laboratories.  The  data are intended to  show  the  precision of the
combined sample preparation  and analysis method.


10.0  REFERENCES

1.    Methods  for  Chemical  Analysis  of Water  and  Wastes,  EPA-600/4-82-055,
December 1982,  Methods 218.4 and 218.5.

2.    Gaskill,  A.,  Compilation  and Evaluation of RCRA Method Performance Data,
Work Assignment No. 2, EPA Contract No. 68-01-7075, September 1986.
                                  7196A  - 4                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
                      TABLE 1. METHOD PERFORMANCE DATA
Sample
Matrix
Preparation
  Method
Laboratory
Replicates
Wastewater treatment
  sludge                    Not known

Sediment from chemical
 storage area                 3060
                    0.096,  0.107 ug/g
                        115, 117 ug/g
                                  7196A - 5
                                     Revision 1
                                     July 1992

-------
       Start
                                                    METHOD 7196A
                                    CHROMIUM,  HEXAVALENT  (COLORIMETRIC)
   7.1 Tran»fer
    extract to
     flask,add
 diphenylcarba*ide
 volution,and mix
     for color
    development
   7.1 Add H.SO,
solution,dilute,let
 s tand,measure the
correct  abaorbane*
    reading,and
   d«terrain* Cr
      present
  7.2.1  Treat Cr
 standard*  by the
 •am* procedure a*
  sample,pipet Cr
 standard solution
    into beaker
7.2.2  Develop color
  for  standards ,
measure  and correct
 reading,construct
 calibration curve
  7.3.1 Analyie a
 second aliquot of
    pK adjusted
  filtrate spiked
  with Cr(VI) for
   verification
7.3.2 Diluta
•pikad i»pla
with blank
•olution,
•djuat r«»ult»

Y..


                          I.
                      •upr«*tiv«
                     intarfarane
                       indicated
    Ha*
  •ampla
producad  an
  acidic
 axtract?
 7.3.3 Dilute
  aaapla  and
   raanaljrie
7.4 Prapare  an
   alkalina
aliquot  with IN
  NaOH,«pik«
  apla ,analy>«
                         7.4 Analytical
                       aathod is varifiad
                             Stop
                                                      7196A  - 6
                                                                     Revision 1
                                                                     July  1992

-------
                                 METHOD 7197

                 CHROMIUM. HEXAVALENT (CHELATION/EXTRACTION)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  Method  7197  1s  approved  for  determining  the  concentration  of
dissolved hexavalent chromium [Cr(VI)]  1n  Extraction Procedure (EP) toxicity
characteristic extracts and ground waters.  This method may also be applicable
to certain  domestic  and  industrial  wastes,  provided  that  no interfering
substances are present (see Paragraph 3.1).

     1.2  Method 7197 may be used  to analyze  samples containing  from 1.0 to
25 ug of Cr(VI) per liter.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  Method 7197 1s  based  on   the   chelation of hexavalent chromium with
ammonium  pyrrol1d1ne  dlthlocarbamate   (APDC)   and  extraction  with  methyl
Isobutyl ketone (MIBK).   The extract 1s   aspirated into the flame of an atomic
absorption spectrophotometer.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  High concentrations of  other metals may interfere.


4.0  APPARATUS AND  MATERIALS

     4.1  Atomic  absorption  spectrophotometer;    Single or  dual  channel,
single- ordouble-beaminstrument,having   a    grating  monochromator,
photomultiplier detector,  adjustable  slits,  and  provisions  for  background
correction.

     4.2  Chromium  hollow cathode lamp.

     4.3  Strip-chart recorder  (optional).


5.0  REAGENTS

     5.1  ASTM  Type II water  (ASTM  D1193):    Water  should be  monitored  for
impurities.

     5.2  Ammonium   pyrrolid1ne  dlthlocarbamate   (APDC)   solution:   Dissolve
1.0  g  APDC  in  Type  II water and dilute to 100 mL.  Prepare fresh  daily.

     5.3   Bromphenol  blue Indicator solution;  Dissolve  0.1  g  bromphenol blue
in 100 mL  50%  ethanol.
                                   7197 - 1
                                                          Revision      0
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
     5.4  Potassium dichromate standard  solution  I   (1.0  ml  =  100 ug Cr):
Dissolve 0.2829 g pure dried  potassium  dichromate,  I^C^O;,  in Type II water
and dilute to 1,000 ml.

     5.5  Potassium dichromate standard solution  II   (1.0  ml  = 10.0 ug Cr):
Dilute 100 ml chromium standard solution I to 1  liter with Type II water.

     5.6  Potassium dichromate standard solution  III  (1.0 ml = 0.10 ug Cr):
Dilute 10.0 ml chromium standard solution II to  1 liter with Type II water.

     5.7  Methyl isobutyl ketone (MIBK),  analytical   reagent  grade:  Avoid  or
redistill material that comes in contact with metal  or metal-lined caps.

     5.8  Sodium hydroxide solution, 1 M:   Dissolve to 40 g sodium hydroxide,
NaOH (ASC reagent grade), in Type II water and dilute to 1 liter.

     5.9  Sulfuric acid. 0.12 M:  Slowly add 6.5 ml distilled  reagent grade  or
spectrograde-quality sulfuric acid, ^SO/j, to  Type  II  water and dilute to 1
liter.
6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

     6.1  All samples must  have  been  collected  using  a sampling plan that
addresses the considerations discussed in Chapter Nine of this manual.

     6.2  Because the stability of  Cr(VI)  in  EP  extracts is not completely
understood at this time, the chelation and extraction should be carried out as
soon as possible.

     6.3  To retard the chemical activity  of hexavalent chromium, the samples
and extracts should be stored at 4*C until analyzed.


7.0  PROCEDURE

     7.1  Pipet  a volume  of extract containing  less  than  2.5 ug  chromium
(100 mL maximum) into  a  200-mL  volumetric  flask  and  adjust the volume to
approximately 100 mL.

     7.2  Prepare a blank and  sufficient  standards  and adjust the volume of
each to approximately 100 mL.

     7.3  Add 2 drops of bromphenol  blue indicator solution.  (The adjustment
of pH to 2.4, Step  7.4,  may  be  made  with  a  pH meter instead of using an
indicator.)

     7.4  Adjust the pH by addition of 1 M NaOH solution dropwise until a blue
color persists.  Add 0.12 M  H2S04  dropwise  until the blue color just disap-
pears in both the standards and sample.    Then  add 2.0 mL of 0.12 M H^SO* In
excess.  The pH at this point should be 2.4.


                                  7197 - 2
                                                         Revision      0
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
     7.5  Add 5.0 ml APDC solution and  mix.    The pH should then be approxi-
mately 2.8.

     7.6  Add 10.0 ml MIBK and shake vigorously for 3 m1n.

     7.7  Allow the layers to separate and  add Type II water until the ketone
layer is completely in the neck of the flask.

     7.8  Aspirate the ketone  layer  and  record  the  scale reading for each
sample and standard against  the  blank.    Repeat,  and average the duplicate
results.

     7.9  Determine the mg/liter of Cr(VI) in each sample from a plot of scale
readings of standards.  A  working  curve  must  be  prepared with each set of
samples.

    7.10  Verification:

          7.10.1  For every sample  matrix  analyzed, verification is required
     to ensure that neither a  reducing condition nor chemical interference is
     affecting chelation.  This must be accomplished by analyzing a second 10-
     ml_ aliquot of the pH-adjusted filtrate  that has been spiked with Cr(VI).
     The amount of spike added  should  double  the concentration found in the
     original aliquot.  Under  no  circumstances  should  the increase be less
     than 30  ug/L Cr(VI).  To verify the  absence of an interference, the spike
     recovery must be between 85% and 115%.

           7.10.2  If addition of  the   spike  extends the concentration beyond
     the calibration curve, the analysis  solution  should be  diluted with blank
     solution and the calculated  results  adjusted  accordingly.
           7.10.3  If  the  result  of  verification   Indicates   a
      Interference,  the sample should be diluted and  reanalyzed.
suppressive
           7.10.4  If  the  Interference  persists  after  sample  dilution,  an
      alternative  method  (Method  7195,    Coprecipitation,   or  Method  7196,
      Colorimetric) should be used.


      7.11  Acidic extracts that yield  recoveries  of  less  than 85% should be
 retested to determine if the  low  spike  recovery  is  due  to the presence of
 residual  reducing agent.    This  determination  shall  be  performed by first
 making an aliquot  of  the  extract  alkaline  (pH  8.0-8.5)  using 1 N sodium
 hydroxide and then resplking and analyzing.  If a spike recovery of 85-115% is
 obtained in the alkaline aliquot of an acidic extract that Initially was found
 to contain less than  5  mg/L  Cr(VI),  one  can  conclude that the analytical
 method has been verified.
                                   7197 - 3
                                                          Revision      0
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
8.0  QUALITY CONTROL


     8.1  All quality control data should be maintained and available for easy
reference or Inspection.


     8.2  Calibration curves must be  composed  of  a  minimum  of a blank and
three standards.   A  calibration  curve  should  be  made  for  every hour of
continuous sample analysis.


     8.3  Dilute samples  1f  they  are  more  concentrated  than  the highest
standard or 1f they fall on the plateau of a calibration curve.


     8.4  Employ a minimum  of  one  blank  per  sample  batch to determine If
contamination or any memory effects are occurring.


     8.5  Verify calibration  with  an  Independently  prepared check standard
every 15 samples.


     8.6  Run one spike duplicate sample  for  every  10 samples.  A duplicate
sample Is a sample brought through the whole sample preparation and analytical
process.


     8.7  The method of  standard  additions  (see  Method  7000, Section 8.7)
shall be used for the analysis  of  all  EP extracts,  on all  analyses submitted
as part of a dellstlng  petition,  and  whenever  a new sample matrix 1s belnq
analyzed.                                                                    •'



9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE


     9.1  Precision and accuracy data are available In Method 218.4 of Methods
for Chemical Analysis of Water and Wastes.



10.0  REFERENCES


1.   Methods for  Chemical  Analysis  of  Water  and Wastes,  EPA-600/4-82-055
December 1982,  Method 218.4.
                                  7197  - 4

                                                         Revision       p
                                                         Date   September 1986

-------
                           METHOD 7197

           HEXAVALENT CHROMIUM  (CHELATION/EXTRACTION)
7. 1
Plpet extract
 into flask:
adjust volume
7.2
                                                    7.5
   Add APDC
solution :  mix
      Prepare
     blank and
    standards:
 adjust volume
     of each
                                                    7.6
   Add MIBK;
     shake
7.3
Add brotnphenol
blue Indicator
   solution
7.4
                                                    7.7
Allow layers to
 separate:  add
 Type II water
Adjust pH by
adding NoOH;
 add HZS04
                                                    7.8
       Aspirate
       ketone
  layer;  record
scale readings:
repeat:  average
     results
                          7197 - 5
                                                     Revision       0
                                                     Date   September  1986

-------
                                        METHOD 7197

                         HEXAVAUENT CHROMIUM  (CHELATION /EXTRACTION)
                                         (Continued)
      Determine
 Cr (IV)  In each
sample;  prepare
 working curves
 7.10.1
         Verify
         every
  sample matrix
  by analyzing
 second aliquot
spiked filtrate
                           7.10.2
                                   Dilute
                                 analysis
                            solution  with
                          blank  solution;
                           adjust results
  Is cone.
   beyond
calibration
   curve?
                           Dilute  sample
                           and reanalyze
                                                                           Use alternative
                                                                               method
   Analytical
method verified
 -waste is not
   hazardous
                                                     If no valid
                                               results and chromium
                                                concentration over
                                                 threshold limits.
                                                  sample exhibits
                                                    EP toxlclty
                                                  (     Stop       J
                                      7197  - 6
                                                                 Revision       0
                                                                 Date   September 1986

-------
                                 METHOD 7198

           CHROMIUM. HEXAVALENT (DIFFERENTIAL PULSE POLAROGRAPHY)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  This method is  used  to  determine  the concentration of hexavalent
chromium [Cr(VI)] in natural and waste waters and in EP extracts.

     1.2  The method  can  quantitate  chromium  1n  concentrations  of  up to
1.0 mg/L to 5.0 mg/L, depending  on  the mercury drop size.  Higher concentra-
tions can be determined by dilution.

     1.3  The  lower  limit  of  detection  for  Cr(VI)  1s  10  ug/L  for the
instrumental conditions given in this method.  The limit of detection could be
easily lowered by changing these conditions.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  Method 7198 measures the peak current produced from the reduction of
Cr(VI) to Cr(III) at a dropping  mercury electrode during a differential pulse
voltage ramp.

     2.2  The method described herein uses 0.125  M NH4OH-0.125 M NH4C1 as the
supporting electrolyte.  In this electrolyte, Cr(VI) reduction results in peak
current occurring at the peak potential (Ep) of -0.250 V vs. Ag/AgCl.

     2.3  Alternative supporting electrolytes, such as those given In Table 1,
may be used.

     2.4  The technique of standard additions  must  be used to quantitate the
Cr(VI) content.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  Copper ion at concentrations higher than the Cr(VI) concentration is
a potential  Interference due to peak overlap when using the 0.125 M ammoniacal
electrolyte.  Increasing  the  ammoniacal   electrolyte  concentration to 0.5 M
shifts  the  copper  peak  cathodlcally   (Ep   =  -0.4  V),  eliminating  the
Interference at a copper-to-chrom1um ratio of 10:1 (Figure 1).

     3.2  Reductants such as ferrous  iron,   sulflte,  and sulfide will reduce
Cr(VI) to Cr(III); thus it  1s  Imperative  to  analyze the samples as soon as
possible.

4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1  Polarographic instrumentation;   Capable  of performing differential
pulse analyses, including recorder or plotter.


                                  7198 - 1
                                                         Revision      0
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
 2.0-
  1.5-
                  Current x 10^ nA
                  18 Jan 82  No. 1
                  Sample: DPP
                  Initial E: -0.100 V
                  Final E: -0.450V

                  Peak 1: -0.292 V
                         2.047 E2nA
                                                  4.0-
                                                   3.0-
                Current x 1Q2 nA
                18 Jan 82 No. 2
                Sample:  DPP
                Initial E: -0.100V
                Final E:  -0.450V

                Peak 1: -0.256 V
                       2.680E1 nA

                Peak 2: -0.396 V
                       9.740E1 nA
      -0.2    -0.4
      -0.2   -0.4
 A. 20 ppm Cu, 2.5 ppm Cr, 0.1 N buffer.
B. 20 ppm Cu, 2.5 ppm Cr, 0.5 N buffer.
     Figure 1. Two polarograms illustrating shift in copper peak at higher ammoniacal
electrolyte concentrations.
                              7198 - 2
                                                         Revision       0
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
                TABLE 1.  POLAROGRAPHY OF HEXAVALENT CHROMIUM
      Supporting electrolyte
Peak potential (vs. SCE)
1 M NaOH
1 M Pyr1d1ne, 1 M NaOH
1 M NH4OH, 1 M NH4C1
0.1 M NH4OH, 0.1 M (NH4)2 Tartrate
0.2 M KC1, 0.3 M Trlethanolamlne, pH 9
1 M Na2S04
0.1 M NH4OH, 0.1 M NH4C1
        -0.85
        -1.48
        -0.36
        -0.244
        -0.28
        -0.23
        -0.25
                                  7198 - 3
                                                         Revision      Q
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
     4.2  Dropping  mercury  electrode   assembly;      Capable  of  performing
differential pulse analyses.

     4.3  Counter electrode;  Platinum wire.

     4.4  Reference electrode;  Ag/AgCl  or  SCE,   with a slow-leakage fritted
tip (unfired Vycor).

     4.5  Nitrogen gas and cell outgassing assembly.

     4.6  Micropipets and disposable tips.


5.0  REAGENTS

     5.1  ASTM Type II water   (ASTM  D1193):    Water  should be monitored for
impurities.

     5.2  Chromium standard solution I, 1.0 ml  =  100  ug Cr:  Should be made
daily from  a 1,000-ppm standard stock  solution made with Type II water.

     5.3  Chromium standard solution II,  1.0 ml  =  10  ug Cr;  Should be made
daily from  a 1,000-ppm standard stock  solution made with Type II water.

     5.4  Chromium standard solution III,  1.0  ml  =   1  ug  Cr:  Dilute 10 ml
chromium  standard solution  II  to  100 ml with Type  II water.

     5.5  Ammom'acal  electrolyte,  2.5  N:   Dissolve 33.3  g of  NH/J.C1  in 150 mL
of Type II  water, add 42.2  ml of  concentrated NfyOH, and dilute to  250 ml.

     5.6  Concentrated nitric acid;    Acid should  be  analyzed to  determine
 levels  of impurities.ITimpurities  are detected,   all analyses  should be
 blank-corrected.
 6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION,  PRESERVATION,  AND HANDLING

      6.1  All samples must  have  been  collected  using  a sampling plan that
 addresses the considerations discussed in Chapter Nine of this manual.

      6.2  Stability of  Cr(VI)  is  not  completely  understood  at this time.
 Therefore, the analysis should be carried out as soon as possible.

      6.3  If the analysis cannot be performed within 24 hr, take an aliquot of
 the sample and add  a known amount of  Cr(VI)  (0.1 mg/L  for natural  waters,
 1 mg/L for wastewaters,  and  5  mg/L  for  EP  extracts).  Analyze this known
 additional sample at the same time the sample is analyzed to determine whether
 Cr(VI) was reduced during storage.

      6.4  To retard the  chemical  activity  of  Cr(VI),  the sample should be
 transported and stored at 4*C until time of analysis.
                                   7198 - 4
                                                          Revision
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
7.0  PROCEDURE

     7.1  Soak the voltammetrlc cells overnight  in  1  +  1 HN03 and/or 1+1
aqua regia.

     7.2  Rinse the electrode assembly with Type II water,  then with 1 N HN03,
and finally with Type II water prior to and in between sample analyses.

     7.3  The  instrument  should  be  set  using  the  following instrumental
parameters.

          7.3.1  Mode:  Differential pulse.
          7.3.2  Scan rate:  2 mV/sec.
          7.3.3  Drop time:  1 sec.
          7.3.4  Initial potential:  -0.05 V + 0.05 V vs. Ag/AgCl.
          7.3.5  Final potential:  -0.50 V + 0.10 V vs. Ag/AgCl.
          7.3.6  Pulse height:  0.05 V.
          7.3.7  Deaeratlon time:  240 sec  or  less initially, 30 sec between
                 standard additions.

     7.4  Analysis;

          7.4.1  Pipet a volume of  sample  containing  less than 10 ug Cr(VI)
     into a voltammetric cell (the  maximum volume depends on the voltammetric
     cell volume, usually 10 ml).

          7.4.2  Add 0.5 ml of the arnmoniacal electrolyte and adjust volume to
     10 ml with Type II water.

          7.4.3  Place the electrode assembly in  the solution and outgas with
     nitrogen for at least 120 sec.

          7.4.4  Engage the electrode  assembly  to the polarographic analyzer
     and displace at least 10 mercury drops before initiating the voltage ramp
     and obtaining the polarogram.

          7.4.5  Figure 2 gives  typical differential pulse polarograms.

     7.5  Prior to the  analysis   of  any  samples,  and  during analysis at a
 frequency of at least once every   10  samples, verify that the cell contamina-
 tion is  less than 10 ug/L  Cr  by  analyzing demineralized water  and the appro-
 priate volume of supporting electrolyte  in   a manner similar to the procedure
 described  in 7.4.3 and 7.4.4.

     7.6  Calibration;

          7.6.1  After running a differential  pulse  polarogram on the sample
     solution,  quantitate  the  chromium  using  the  technique  of   standard
     addition.
                                  7198 - 5
                                                         Revision      0
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
2.0-1
1.5-
                 Current x 102 nA
                 26 Oct 81  No. 1
                 Standard No. 1 DPP
                 Initial E: 0.000 V
                 Final E: -0.350 V

                 Peak 1: -0.160V
                       1.18lE2nA
                       250.0 ppb
                                                  2.0-
                                                  1.5-
                                                 Current x 10^ nA
                                                 26 Oct 81  No. 1
                                                 Standard No. 2 DPP
                                                 Initial E: 0.000 V
                                                 Final E: -0.350V

                                                 Peak 1: -0.154 V
                                                        1.146E3nA
                                                        2.500 ppm
     -0.1
-0.3
-0.1   -0.3
     Figure 2. Typical differential pulse polarogram at 0.25 ppm and 2.5 ppm Cr
in 0.1 N buffer.
                             7198 - 6
                                                        Revision       Q
                                                        Date  September  1986

-------
          7.6.2  Three standard additions  should   be   made   to  obtain  the best
     precision and accuracy.   The  first  standard addition  should  be  approxi-
     mately one-half the concentration of  the sample,  the second  equal  to that
     of the sample,  and the  third  about   1.5 times  the sample concentration.
     The total volume due  to  standard  additions  should  not  exceed  the cell
     value by more than 10%.
          7.6.3  Add an appropriate aliquot  of  chromium standard  solution I,
     II, or III to the sample 1n  the  cell.    Deaerate for 30 sec to mix  the
     solution and remove oxygen added with the known addition.
          7.6.4  Repeat the analysis procedure,  beginning  with Step 7.4.4  for
     each standard addition.
7.7  Calculations;
          7.7.1  Calculate  the concentration  of chromium  determined by each
     standard addition procedure as follows:
                         c             s          v
                            "
where:
     ij = Current peak height for the sample (nA);
     i'i = Current peak height for the sample plus standard (nA);
     Vu = Volume of sample in the cell (ml);
     \l] = Volume of standard taken for spiking (ml);
      V = Volume 1n cell prior to standard addition;
     Cs = Concentration of standard used to spike (mg/L); and
     Cu = Concentration of the unknown in the sample (mg/L).
          7.7.2  Some  microprocessor   polarographic   systems  will  perform
     these calculations automatically.
8.0  QUALITY CONTROL
     8.1  All quality control data should be maintained and available for easy
reference or inspection.
     8.2  If necessary, dilute samples  so  that  they fall within the working
range.
                                   7198 -  7
                                                         Revision      0
                                                         Date  September  1986

-------
     8.3  Quant1tat1on must be performed  by  the method of standard additions
(see Method 7000, Section 8.7).

     8.4  Verify calibration  with  an  Independently  prepared check standard
every 15 samples (see Chapter One, Section 1.1.8).

     8.5  Standards should be compared  to  a  reference standard on a routine
basis.
9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

     9.1  Precision and  accuracy  data  for  this  method  are  summarized 1n
Table 2.
10.0  REFERENCES

1.   Methods for  Chemical  Analysis  of  Water  and Wastes, EPA-600/4-82-055,
December 1982, Method 218.4 and 218.5.
                                   7198 - 8
                                                          Revision
                                                          Date   September 1986

-------
     TABLE 2.   PRECISION AND ACCURACY OF THE DPP OF HEXAVALENT CHROMIUM
2a.  Precision

       Sample type    No. of replicates       Average value      % RSD
       Leachate3
                            1.87
                              0.69
2b.  Accuracy (spike recovery data)
                  Spike level   No. of     Average %
     Sample type      (mg/L)     samples    recovery
                                        Standard
                                      deviation of
                                       % recovery
     EP extracts
5.0
8
92.8
6.4
2c.  Methods comparison
                      Diff. pulse
                      polarography
                APDC extrac-
               tion ICAP-OES
                   Ion chromatography
                  coupled to ICAP-OES
       Value3
   1.87
      1.84
                1.91
      aLeachate  sample  from  a  waste  disposal  site.
                                   7198 - 9
                                                          Revision      0
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
                             METHOD 7196

        HEXAVALENT CHROMIUM  (DIFFERENTIAL PULSE POLAROGRAPH)
C
  7. 1
       Soak
   voltemmetric
 cells overnight
7.4.3   Place
      elactrode
    assembly in
      solution:
    outgas with
     nitrogen
  7.2
 	.	1 Rinse
      electrode
 assembly before
    and between
 sample analyses
                        7.4.4
 Engage electrode
assembly:  displace
  mercury drops:
 initiate voltage
  ramp:  obtain
   polergrem
  Set Instrument
 7.4.1
                            7.5
                                                     7.6.3
                                   Ada
                                 al lauot
                              of chromium
                               standeru
                               solution;
                               deaerate
                                   Prior
                                  to and
during analysis
   verify that
 cell contamln.
is < 10 ug/1 Cr
                                                     7.6.4
                                   Repeat
                                  for each
                                  standard
                                  addition
                             starting with
                             section 7.4.4
        Plpet
        sample
 with hexavalent
   Chromium into
    voltammetric
        cell
                           7.6.1
       Run
   differential
      pulse
  polarogram on
sample solution
7.4.a[
Add ammoniacal
electrolyte;
adjust volume


                                                      7 .7
                              Calculate
                            concentretIon
                             of chromium
                               Quantitate
                            chromium using
                             technique of
                             standard add.
    o
                         f     Stop      J
   O
                          7198 - 10
                                                     Revision        Q
                                                     Date  September 1986

-------
                                 METHOD 7200

                COBALT (ATOMIC ABSORPTION.  DIRECT ASPIRATION)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  See Section 3.0 of Method 7000 1f Interferences are suspected.

     3.2  Excesses  of  other  transition  metals  may  slightly  depress  the
response of cobalt.  Matrix  matching  or  the method of standard additions is
recommended.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1   For basic  apparatus, see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.

     4.2   Instrument parameters  (general):

           4.2.1   Cobalt hollow cathode lamp.
           4.2.2   Wavelength:   240.7  nm.
           4.2.3   Fuel:   Acetylene.
           4.2.4   Oxldant:   Air.
           4.2.5   Type of flame:   Oxidizing (fuel  lean).
           4.2.6   Background correction:   Required.


 5.0   REAGENTS

      5.1   See Section 5.0 of Method  7000.

      5.2   Preparation of standards;

           5.2.1   Stock solution:  Dissolve 1.000 g  of cobalt metal  (analytical
      reagent grade)  in 20 mL of  1:1   HN03  and  dilute to  1 liter with Type II
      water.  Chloride or nitrate salts  of  cobalt  (II)  may be used.   Although
      numerous hydrated forms exist,  they  are not recommended unless  the exact
      composition of the compound is  known.  Alternatively,  procure a  certified
      standard from a supplier and verify by comparison with a second  standard.
                                   7200 - 1
                                                          Revision
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
          5.2.2  Prepare  dilutions  of  the  stock  solution  to  be  used as
     calibration standards at the time of analysis.  The calibration standards
     should  be  prepared  using  the  same  type  of  acid  and  at  the same
     concentration  as  will  result  in  the  sample  to  be  analyzed  after
     processing.



6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING


     6.1  See Chapter Three, Section 3.1.3, Sample Handling and Preservation.

7.0  PROCEDURE


     7'1  Sample preparation;  The  procedures  for  preparation of the sample
are given in Chapter Three, Section 3.2.

     7.2  See Method 7000, Paragraph 7.2, Direct Aspiration.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

     8.1  See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.



9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE


     9.1  The performance characteristics for an aqueous sample free of inter-
ferences are:


     Optimum concentration range:  0.5-5 mg/L with a wavelength of 240.7 nm.
     Sensitivity:  0.2 mg/L.
     Detection limit:  0.05 mg/L.


     9.2  In a  single  laboratory,  analysis  of  a mixed industrial-domestic
waste effluent, digested with Method 3010,  at concentrations of 0.2, 1, and 5
mg/L gave  standard  deviations  of  +0.013,  +0.01,  and +0.05, respectively
Recoveries at these levels were 98% and 97%, respectively."


/..  u9:3  For concentrations of cobalt  below  0.1 mg/L, the furnace procedure
(Method 7201) is recommended.



10.0  REFERENCES


1.   Methods for  Chemical  Analysis  of  Water  and Wastes,  EPA-600/4-82-055
December 1982, Method 219.1.                                                 '
                                  7200 - 2
                                                         Revision       0
                                                         Date   September 1986

-------
                METHOD 720O

COBALT (ATOMIC  ABSORPTION. DIRECT ASPIRATION)
                5.0
                    Prepare
                   standards
                7. 1
               	—J  FOP
                     sample
               preparation see
                   chapter 3.
                section  3.1.3
                7.2
                Analyze  using
                 Method  70OO.
                 Section 7.2
              f     Stop      J
            7200 - 3
                                       Revision       0
                                       Date  September  1986

-------
                                 METHOD 7201

                COBALT (ATOMIC ABSORPTION.  FURNACE TECHNIQUE)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  See Section 3.0 of Method 7000 1f Interferences are suspected.

     3.2  Excess chloride  may   Interfere.    It  Is  necessary  to  verify by
standard additions that the Interference Is absent.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1  For basic  apparatus, see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.

     4.2  Instrument parameters  (general):

          4.2.1  Drying  time  and temp:   30 sec at  125»C.
          4.2.2  Ashing  time  and temp:   30 sec at  900»C.
          4.2.3  Atomizing  time  and temp:  10 sec  at 2700*C.
          4.2.4  Purge gas:   Argon.
          4.2.5  Wavelength:   240.7 nm.
          4.2.6  Background correction:   Required.
          4.2.7  Other operating parameters  should be   set  as  specified by  the
      particular instrument  manufacturer.
      NOTE:   The above concentration values and  instrument conditions  are for a
             Perkin-Elmer HGA-2100,  based  on the  use  of   a  20-uL injection,
             continuous-flow purge  gas,   and nonpyrolytic   graphite.   Smaller
             sizes  of  furnace  devices  or  those  employing  faster  rates of
             atomization  can be  operated  using lower atomization temperatures
             for shorter time periods  than the above-recommended settings.


 5.0  REAGENTS

      5.1  See Section 5.0 of Method 7000.
                                   7201 - 1
                                                          Revision
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
     5.2  Preparation of standards;

          5.2.1  Stock solution:  Dissolve 1.000 g of cobalt metal (analytical
     reagent grade) 1n 20 ml of 1:1  HN03  and  dilute to 1 liter with Type II
     water.  Chloride or nitrate salts  of  cobalt (II) may be used.  Although
     numerous hydrated forms exist, they  are not recommended unless the exact
     composition of the compound 1s known.  Alternatively, procure a certified
     standard from a supplier and verify by comparison with a second standard.

          5.2.2  Prepare  dilutions  of  the  stock  solution  to  be  used as
     Cu 1f!iat!on standards at the t1"ie of analysis.  The calibration standards
     should  be  prepared  using  the  same  type  of  add  and  at  the same
     concentrations as 1n the sample after processing (0.5% v/v HNOs).
6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

     6.1  See Chapter Three, Section 3.1.3, Sample Handling and Preservation.


7.0  PROCEDURE

     7.1  Sample preparation;  The  procedures  for  preparation of the sample
are given in Chapter Three, Section 3.2.                                »a»ve

     7.2  See Method 7000, Paragraph 7.3,  Furnace Procedure.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

     8.1  See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.


9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

     9.1  Precision and accuracy data are  not available at this time.

     9.2  The  performance  characteristics  for  an  aqueous  sample   free of
interferences are:

     Optimum concentration range:  5-100 ug/L.
     Detection limit:  1 ug/L.


10.0  REFERENCES
                                  7201 - 2
                                                         Revision       o
                                                         Date   September 1986

-------
               METHOD 7201

COBALT  (ATOMIC ABSORPTION.  FURNACE TECHNIQUE)
Prepare
standards

7. 1
f
SI
preparat
chac
sectl

7.2

•or
mple
ion see
ter 3.
on 3.2


Analyze using
Method 7000.
Section 7.3.
            f     Stop      j
           7201 - 3
                                   Revision       0
                                   Date  September 1986

-------
                                 METHOD 7210

                COPPER (ATOMIC ABSORPTION.  DIRECT ASPIRATION)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  See Section 3.0 of Method 7000.

     3.2  Background correction may be required because nonspecific absorption
and scattering can be  significant  at  the analytical wavelength.  Background
correction with certain  Instruments may be difficult at this wavelength due to
low-Intensity output  from  hydrogen  or  deuterium  lamps.   Consult specific
instrument manufacturer's literature for details.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1  For basic apparatus, see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.

     4.2  Instrument parameters  (general):

          4.2.1   Copper  hollow cathode  lamp.
          4.2.2   Wavelength:   324.7 nm.
          4.2.3   Fuel:   Acetylene.
          4.2.4   Oxldant:   A1r.
          4.2.5   Type of flame:   Oxidizing (fuel  lean).
          4.2.6   Background correction:  Recommended,  1f possible.


 5.0  REAGENTS

     5.1  See  Section 5.0 of  Method 7000.

     5.2   Preparation of standards;

           5.2.1  Stock  solution:   Dissolve  1.00   g  of   electrolytic copper
      (analytical  reagent grade)   1n   5 mL  of  redistilled   HNOs  and  dilute to
      1 liter with Type  II water.   Alternatively, procure  a certified standard
      from a supplier and verify by comparison with  a second standard.
                                   7210 - 1
                                                          Revision
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
          5.2.2  Prepare  dilutions  of  the  stock  solution  to  be  used as
     calibration standards at the time of analysis.  The calibration standards
     should be prepared using the same type of add and at the same concentra-
     tion as will result In the sample to be analyzed after processing.


6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

     6.1  See Chapter Three, Section 3.1.3, Sample Handling and Preservation.


7.0  PROCEDURE


     7-1  Sample preparation;  The  procedures  for  preparation of the sample
are given In Chapter Three, Section 3.2.

     7.2  See Method 7000, Paragraph 7.2, Direct Aspiration.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

     8.1  See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.


9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE


     9.1  The performance characteristics for an aqueous sample free of Inter-
ferences are:


     Optimum concentration range:  0.2-5 mg/L with a wavelength of 324.7 nm.
     Sensitivity:  0.1 mg/L.
     Detection limit:  0.02 mg/L.

     9.2  Precision and accuracy data are available 1n Method 220.1 of Methods
for Chemical Analysis of Water and Wastes.


10.0  REFERENCES


1.   Methods for  Chemical  Analysis  of  Water  and Wastes, EPA-600/4-82-Oei5
December 1982, Method 220.1.
                                  7210 - 2
                                                         Revision
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
               METHOD 7310

COPPER  (ATOMIC ABSORPTION. DIRECT ASPIRATION)
             C


s.o
Prepare
standards


7.1
	 1 For
sample
preparation see
chapter 3.
section 3.2


7.S j
Analyze using
Method 70OO.
Section 7.2


             {     Stop      J
             7210 - 3
                                     Revision      0
                                     Date   September 1986

-------
                                 METHOD 7211
                COPPER  (ATOMIC ABSORPTION. FURNACE TECHNIQUE)

1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION
      1.1   See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.

2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD
      2.1   See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.

3.0  INTERFERENCES
      3.1   If interferences are suspected,  see Section 3.0 of Method 7000.
      3.2   Background correction may be required since nonspecific absorption
and scattering  can be significant  at  the analytical wavelength.   Background
correction with certain instruments may be difficult at this wavelength due to
low  intensity output  from  hydrogen  or  deuterium  lamps.    Consult  specific
instrument manufacturer's literature for details.

4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS
      4.1   For basic apparatus, see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.
      4.2   Instrument parameters (general):
            4.2.1  Drying time and temp:  30 sec at 125°C.
            4.2.2  Ashing time and temp:  30 sec at 900°C.
            4.2.3  Atomizing time and temp:   10 sec at 2700°C.
            4.2.4  Purge gas:  Argon or nitrogen.
            4.2.5  Wavelength:  324.7 nm.
            4.2.6  Background correction:  Recommended.
            4.2.7   Other operating  parameters  should be  set  as specified by
      the particular  instrument manufacturer.
      NOTE: The above concentration values and instrument  conditions are for  a
            Perkin-Elmer  HGA-2100,   based  on  the  use  of a  20-uL injection,
            continuous-flow  purge gas, and nonpyrolytic graphite.  Smaller  size
            furnace devices  or those employing faster rates of  atomization can
            be  operated  using  lower atomization  temperatures for  shorter  time
            periods than the above-recommended settings.
                                   7211 - 1                        Revision 0
                                                                   July  1992

-------
5.0  REAGENTS

      5.1   See Section 5.0 of Method 7000.

      5.2   Preparation of standards

            5.2.1   Stock  solution  - Dissolve  1.00  g of  electrolytic copper
      (analytical regent grade) in 5 ml redistilled HNO, and dilute to 1 liter
      with water.  Alternatively, procure a certified standard from a supplier
      and verify by comparison with a second standard.

            5.2.2   Prepare  dilutions  of  the   stock  solution to  be  used  as
      calibration  standards  at  the  time  of  analysis.    The  calibration
      standards should be prepared using the same type of acid and at the same
      concentrations  as  in the sample  to  be analyzed after  processing (0.5%
      v/v HN03).


6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

      6.1   See Chapter Three, Step 3.1.3,  Sample Handling and Preservation.


7.0  PROCEDURE

      7.1   Sample Preparation - The procedures  for  preparation  of the sample
are given in Chapter Three, Step 3.2.

      7.2   See Method 7000,  Step 7.3,  Furnace  Technique.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

      8.1   See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.


9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

      9.1   Precision and accuracy data are not available at this time.

      9.2   The  performance  characteristics for an  aqueous  sample  free  of
interferences are:

      Optimum concentration range:   5-100  ug/L.
      Detection limit:  1  ug/L.
                                   7211  -  2                        Revision 0
                                                                  July 1992

-------
10.0  REFERENCES

1.    Methods for  Chemical  Analysis of  Water and Wastes;  U.S.  Environmental
Protection  Agency.   Office  of   Research  and   Development.   Environmental
Monitoring  and  Support  Laboratory. ORD  Publication  Offices  of Center  for
Environmental Research Information:  Cincinnati, OH,  1983; EPA-600/4-79-020.
                                    7211  -  3                        Revision  0
                                                                   July  1992

-------
                    METHOD 7211
COPPER (ATOMIC ABSORPTION, FURNACE  TECHNIQUE)
                     Start
                   S.0 Prepare
                   •tandardi
                 7.1 For •ample
                 praparation »ee
               Chapter 3, Section
                      3.2
                7.2 Analyze using
                  M.thod  7000
                  Section 7.3
                     Stop
                      7211  -  4
Revision  0
July 1992

-------
                                 METHOD  7380

                 IRON (ATOMIC ABSORPTION.  DIRECT ASPIRATION)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  See Section 3.0 of Method 7000  If interferences are suspected.

     3.2  Iron  is a  universal contaminant,  and  great care should be taken to
avoid  contamination.


4.0  APPARATUS  AND MATERIALS

     4.1   For basic  apparatus,  see Section 4.0  of Method 7000.

     4.2   Instrument parameters (general):

           4.2.1  Iron hollow cathode  lamp.
           4.2.2  Wavelength:   248.3 nm   (primary);  248.8,  271.9,  302.1,  252.7,
                  or  372.0 nm (alternates).
           4.2.3  Fuel:   Acetylene.
           4.2.4  Oxldant:  A1r.
           4.2.5  Type of flame:  Oxidizing  (fuel lean).
           4.2.6  Background correction:  Required.


 5.0  REAGENTS

      5.1   See Section 5.0 of Method 7000.

      5.2   Preparation of standards;

           5.2.1  Stock solution:    Dissolve  1.000  g  Iron  wire (analytical
      reagent grade)  in 10 mL redistilled HN03  and Type II water and dilute to
      1 liter with Type II  water.    Note that iron passivates in concentrated
      HNOs, and thus some water  should  be  present.  Alternatively, procure a
      certified standard from a supplier and verify by comparison with a second
      standard.
                                   7380 - 1
                                                          Revision
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
          5.2.2  Prepare  dilutions  of  the  stock  solution  to  be  used as
     calibration standards at the time of analysis.  The calibration standards
     should  be  prepared  using  the  same  type  of  add  and  at  the same
     concentration  as  will  result  1n  the  sample  to  be  analyzed  after
     processing.



6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING


     6.1  See Chapter Three, Section 3.1.3, Sample Handling and Preservation.

7.0  PROCEDURE


     7.1  Sample preparation:  The  procedures  for  preparation of the sample
are given In Chapter Three, Section 3.2.


     7.2  See Method 7000, Paragraph 7.2, Direct Aspiration.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL


     8.1  See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.



9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE


     9.1  The performance characteristics for an aqueous sample free of Inter-
Terences are:


     Optimum concentration range:  0.3-5 mg/L with a wavelength of 248.3 nm.
     Sensitivity:  0.12 mg/L.
     Detection limit:  0.03 mg/L.


<   r?'2, Pre
-------
               METHOD 738O

IRON (ATOMIC  ABSORPTION.  DIRECT ASPIRATION)
            c
              5.0
                  Prepare
                 standards
               7. 1
                    For
                   sample
              preparation see
                 chapter 3.
                section 3.2
               7.2
               Analyze using
                Method 7000.
                Section 7.2
             (      Stop       J
             7380  - 3
                                       Revision       0
                                       Date  September  1986

-------
                                 METHOD 7381
                  IRON  (ATOMIC ABSORPTION. FURNACE TECHNIQUE)

1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION
      1.1   See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.

2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD
      2.1   See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.

3.0  INTERFERENCES
      3.1   See Section 3.0 of Method 7000.
      3.2   Iron  is  a universal contaminant,  particularly at  the  low levels
determined by this method.  Great care should be taken to avoid contamination.

4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS
      4.1   For basic  apparatus, see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.
      4.2   Instrument parameters (general):
            4.2.1   Drying time  and temp:  30 sec at  125°C.
            4.2.2   Ashing time  and temp:  30 sec at  1000°C.
            4.2.3   Atomizing time and temp:  10 sec  at  2700°C.
            4.2.4   Purge gas: Argon or nitrogen.
            4.2.5   Wavelength:  248.3 nm.
            4.2.6  Background Correction:   Recommended.
            4.2.7  Other operating parameters should be  set as specified by the
       particular  instrument  manufacturer.
       NOTE: The  above concentration  values  and  instrument conditions are  for a
             Perkin-Elmer HGA-2100,  based on  the  use  of  a  20-uL  injection,
             continuous-flow  purge gas, and nonpyrolytic graphite.  Smaller size
             furnace devices  or  those  employing  faster rates of atomization can
             be operated  using lower atomization temperatures  for  shorter time
             periods  than the above-recommended  settings.
                                    7381 - 1                       Revision 0
                                                                   July 1992

-------
 5.0   REAGENTS

       5.1    See  Section  5.0  of Method  7000.

       5.2    Preparation  of standards

             5.2.1   Stock  solution -  Dissolve  1.000 g  iron  wire  (analytical
       reagent grade)  in  10 ml redistilled  HN03 and water and dilute to  1  liter
       with water.  Note that  iron passivates in concentrated HNO, and, thus, some
       water  should be present.  Alternatively, procure a certified standard from
       a supplier and  verify  by comparison  with a second standard.

             5.2.2   Prepare  dilutions  of  the stock solution  to be  used as
       calibration standards at the time of analysis.  The calibration standards
       should  be  prepared  using  the  same  type  of  acid  and  at  the   same
       concentrations  as  in the sample to be analyzed  after processing (0.5% v/v
       nil w^ i •


6.0  SAMPLE  COLLECTION,  PRESERVATION AND HANDLING

       6.1    See Chapter  Three, Step 3.1.3, Sample Handling and Preservation.


7.0  PROCEDURE

       7.1   Sample preparation - The procedures for preparation of the sample are
given  in Chapter Three,  Step 3.2.

       7.2   See Method 7000,  Step 7.3,  Furnace Technique.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

      8.1   See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.


9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

      9.1    Precision and accuracy data are not  available at this time.

      9.2   The  performance  characteristics  for an  aqueous  sample  free  of
interferences are:

      Optimum concentration range:   5-100 ug/L.
      Detection limit:  1 ug/L.
                                   7381  -  2                        Revision 0
                                                                  July 1992

-------
10.0  REFERENCES
1.     Methods for  Chemical  Analysis of  Water  and Wastes;  U.S.  Environmental
Protection Agency.  Office of Research and Development. Environmental Monitoring
and Support  Laboratory.  ORD Publication  Offices  of Center  for  Environmental
Research Information:  Cincinnati, OH,  1983; EPA-600/4-79-020.
                                    7381 - 3                       Revision 0
                                                                   July 1992

-------
                  METHOD  7381
IRON  (ATOMIC ABSORPTION,  FURNACE TECHNIQUE)
                     Start
                   S.0 Prepare
                   •tandard*
                 7.1 For (ample
                 preparation •••
               Chapter 3, Section
                      3.2
                7.2 Analyze u*ing
                 Method 7000
                  Section 7.3
                    Stop
                     7381  -  4
Revision  0
July 1992

-------
                                 METHOD 7420

                 LEAD (ATOMIC ABSORPTION.  DIRECT ASPIRATION)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  See Section 3.0 of Method 7000 if interferences are suspected.

     3.2  Background correction is required at either wavelength.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1  For basic apparatus, see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.

     4.2  Instrument parameters  (general):

          4.2.1   Lead hollow cathode  lamp.
          4.2.2   Wavelength:   283.3 nm (primary); 217.0 nm (alternate).
          4.2.3   Fuel:   Acetylene.
          4.2.4   Oxldant:   Air.
          4.2.5   Type of flame:   Oxidizing  (fuel lean).
          4.2.6   Background correction:   Required.


 5.0  REAGENTS

     5.1  See  Section 5.0 of Method 7000.

     5.2  Preparation of standards;

          5.2.1   Stock  solution:   Dissolve   1.599   g  of  lead  nitrate,
      (analytical   reagent  grade),  in Type  II  water,  acidify  with   10 mL
     redistilled  HNOs,  and dilute to   1   liter with   Type II water.  Alterna-
     tively,  procure  a  certified standard  from  a supplier and verify by
     comparison with  a  second  standard.

          5.2.2   Prepare  dilutions   of  the  stock  solution  to  be   used as
     calibration  standards at  the time of analysis.   The calibration standards
     should  be   prepared  using  the  same  type   of acid   and  at  the same
     concentration  as   will   result   in  the  sample to  be  analyzed   after
     processing.

                                   7420 -  1
                                                         Revision       0
                                                          Date   September  1986

-------
6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

     6.1  See Chapter Three, Section 3.1.3, Sample Handling and Preservation.


7.0  PROCEDURE

     7.1  Sample preparation;  The  procedures  for  preparation of the sample
are given In Chapter Three, Section 3.2.

     7.2  See Method 7000, Paragraph 7.2, Direct Aspiration.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

     8.1  See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.


9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

     9.1  The  performance  characteristics  for  an  aqueous  sample  free of
Interferences are:

     Optimum concentration range:  1-20 mg/L with a wavelength of 283.3 nm.
     Sensitivity:  0.5 mg/L.
     Detection limit:  0.1 mg/L.

     9.2  For concentrations of  lead  below  0.2  mg/L,  the furnace technique
(Method 7421) is recommended.

     9.3  Precision and accuracy data are available 1n Method 239.1 of Methods
for Chemical Analysis of Water and Wastes.

     9.4  The data shown in Table  1  were  obtained from records of state and
contractor laboratories.  The data are  Intended  to show the precision of the
combined sample preparation and analysis method.

10.0  REFERENCES

1.   Methods for  Chemical  Analysis  of  Water  and Wastes,  EPA-600/4-82-055.
December 1982, Method 239.1.

2.   Gaskill, A., Compilation and Evaluation  of RCRA Method Performance Data
Work Assignment No. 2, EPA Contract No. 68-01-7075, September 1986.
                                  7420 - 2
                                                         Revision      0
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
                      TABLE 1. METHOD PERFORMANCE DATA
       Sample                      Preparation                Laboratory
       Matrix                        Method                   Replicates


Wastewater treatment sludge           3050                450, 404 ug/g

Emission control dust                 3050                42,500, 63,600 ug/g
                                   7420 - 3
                                                          Revision
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
               METHOD 742O

LEAD (ATOMIC ABSORPTION. DIRECT ASPIRATION)
s
.O

Prepare
standards
7. 1
prepar
cr
sec
For
sample
•atlon see
lapter 3.
rtion 3.2
              7.2
              Analyze using
               Method 700O.
               Section 7.2
            (     Stop      J
           7420 - 4
                                    Revision       0
                                    Date  September 1986

-------
                                 METHOD 7421

                 LEAD (ATOMIC ABSORPTION.  FURNACE TECHNIQUE)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  See Section 3.0 of Method 7000 1f Interferences are suspected.

     3.2  Background correction 1s required.

     3.3  If poor recoveries are obtained, a matrix modifier may be necessary.
Add 10 uL of phosphoric add (Paragraph 5.3)  to 1 ml of prepared sample 1n the
furnace sampler cup and mix well.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1  For basic apparatus, see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.

     4.2  Instrument parameters (general):

          4.2.1  Drying time and temp:  30*sec at 125*C.
          4.2.2  Ashing time and temp:  30*sec at 500*C.
          4.2.3  Atomizing time and temp:   10 sec at 2700*C.
          4.2.4  Purge gas:  Argon.
          4.2.5  Wavelength:  283.3 nm.
          4.2.6  Background correction:  Required.
          4.2.7  Other operating parameters should be  set as specified by the
                 particular Instrument manufacturer.
     NOTE:  The above concentration values and instrument conditions are  for a
            Perkln-Elmer HGA-2100, based  on   the  use  of  a 20-uL Injection,
            continuous-flow purge  gas,  and   nonpyrolytic  graphite.  Smaller
            sizes of  furnace  devices  or  those  employing  faster  rates of
            atomlzatlon can be  operated  using lower atomlzatlon temperatures
            for shorter time periods than the above-recommended settings.


5.0  REAGENTS

     5.1  See Section 5.0 of Method 7000.
                                  7421 - 1
                                                         Revision
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
     5.2   Preparation  of  standards;

          5.2.1   Stock solution:   Dissolve   1.599  g of  lead nitrate,
     (analytical   reagent  grade),   in   Type  II  water,  acidify  with  %i6"inL
     redistilled  HNOs,  and  dilute  to  1   liter with  Type  II water.  Alterna-
     tively,  procure   a  certified  standard  from  a  supplier  and  verify  by
     comparison with  a second  standard.

          5.2.2   Prepare  dilutions   of   the  stock  solution  to  be  used  as
     calibration  standards  at  the  time of analysis.  The calibration  standards
     should  be   prepared  using   the same  type  of  add and   at  the same
     concentrations as in the  sample after  processing  (0.5% v/v HNOs).

     5.3   Phosphoric acid;   Reagent  grade.


6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

     6.1   See Chapter Three, Section 3.1.3, Sample  Handling and  Preservation.

7.0  PROCEDURE

     7.1   Sample preparation;   The  procedures  for  preparation  of the sample
are given in Chapter Three, Section  3.2.

     7.2  See Method 7000,  Paragraph 7.3,  Furnace  Procedure.   The calculation
is given in Method 7000,  Paragraph 7.4.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

     8.1   See Section 8.0 of Method  7000.


9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

     9.1  Precision and accuracy data are available in Method  239.2 of  Methods
for Chemical Analysis of Water and Wastes.

     9.2  The  performance   characteristics  for  an   aqueous   sample  free of
interferences are:

     Optimum concentration  range:   5-100 ug/L.
     Detection limit:  1 ug/L.

     9.3  The data shown in Table  1  were   obtained  from records of state and
contractor laboratories.  The data are  intended  to  show the  precision of the
combined sample preparation and analysis method.
                                  7421 - 2
                                                         Revision
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
10.0  REFERENCES

1.   Lead by Flame!ess Atomic  Absorption  with Phosphate Matrix Modification,
Atomic Spectroscopy, !_ (1980), no. 3, pp. 80-81.

2.   Gaskill, A., Compilation and Evaluation  of RCRA Method Performance Data,
Work Assignment No. 2, EPA Contract No. 68-01-7075, September 1986.
                                   7421 - 3
                                                          Revision       0
                                                          Date   September 1986

-------
                      TABLE 1. METHOD PERFORMANCE DATA
Sample
Matrix
Contaminated soil
Paint primer
Lagoon soil
NBS SRM 1646 Estuarine sediment
NBS SRM 1085 Wear metals in
lubricating oil
Solvent extracted oily waste
Preparation
Method
3050
3050
3050
3050

3030
3030
Laboratory
Replicates
163, 120 mg/g
0.55, 0.63 mg/g
10.1, 10.0 ug/g
23.7 ug/ga

274, 298 ug/gb
9, 18 ug/L
aBias of -16% from expected.

bBias of -10 and -2% from expected, respectively,
                                  7421 - 4
                                                         Revision      0
                                                         Date  September 1986J

-------
               METHOD -JAZ\

LEAD (ATOMIC  ABSORPTION.  FURNACE TECHNIQUE)
             5.0
                 Prepare
                standards
7. 1
prepar
ct
sec
For
sample
•ation see
lapter 3.
tlon 3.Z
             7.2
             Analyze using
              Method 7OOO.
              Section 7.3.
            calculation 7.4
           (     Stop      }
            7421 - 5
                                      Revision       0
                                      Date   September 1986

-------
                                 METHOD 7430
                LITHIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION,  DIRECT ASPIRATION)

1.0   SCOPE AND APPLICATION
      1.1   See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.

2.0   SUMMARY OF METHOD
      2.1   See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.

3.0   INTERFERENCES
      3.1   See Section 3.0 of Method 7000 if interferences are suspected.

4.0   APPARATUS AND MATERIALS
      4.1   For basic apparatus, see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.
      4.2   Instrument parameters (general):
            4.2.1   Lithium hollow cathode lamp.
            4.2.2   Wavelength:  670.8 nm.
            4.2.3   Fuel:  Acetylene.
            4.2.4   Oxidant:   Air.
            4.2.5   Type of flame:  Oxidizing (fuel lean).
            4.2.6   Background Correction:  Not required.

5.0   REAGENTS
      5.1   See Section 5.0 of Method 7000.
      5.2   Preparation of standards
            5.2.1   Stock  solution:  (1.0 mL  =  1.0 mg  Li).  Dissolve 5.324 g
      lithium carbonate,  LiX03, in  a minimum volume  of 1:1 HC1 and  dilute to
      1  liter with water.  Alternatively, procure  a  certified standard from a
      supplier  and verify  by  comparison with  a  second standard.

                                    7430  - 1                        Revision 0
                                                                   July 1992

-------
            5.2.2   Prepare  dilutions  of  the stock  solution to  be  used  as
      calibration standards at the time of  analysis.  The calibration standards
      should be  prepared  using the same type  of acid as the  samples  used  to
      prepare the samples and cover the range of  expected concentrations in the
      samples.


6.0   SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION,  AND HANDLING

      6.1   See Chapter Three, Step 3.1.3,  Sample Handling and Preservation.


7.0   PROCEDURE

      7.1   Sample preparation - The procedures  for preparation of the sample are
given in Chapter Three, Step 3.2.

      7.2   See Method 7000, Step 7.2,  Direct Aspiration.


8.0   QUALITY CONTROL

      8.1   See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.


9.0   METHOD PERFORMANCE

      9.1   The  performance characteristics  for an  aqueous  sample   free  of
interferences are:

      Optimum concentration range:  0.1-2 mg/L at a wavelength of 670.8 nm.
      Sensitivity: 0.04 mg/L.
      Detection limit: 0.002 mg/L.


10.0 REFERENCES

1.     Standard Methods for the Examination of  Water and Wastewater.  16th  ed.;
      Greenberg,  A.E.;  Trussell,  R.R.; Clesceri,  L.S.,  Eds.; American  Water
      Works Association, Water  Pollution  Control Federation,  American Public
      Health Association:   Washington,  DC,  1985.
                                   7430  -  2                        Revision 0
                                                                  July 1992

-------
                    METHOD 7430
LITHIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION, DIRECT ASPIRATION)
                        Start
                      5.0 Prepare
                       •tandardi
                    7.1 For vample
                    preparation, mmm
                   Ch.pt.r 3, St.p 3.2
                    7.2 Analyze using
                    Method  7000, Step
                          7.2
                         Stop
                       7430  - 3
Revision 0
July  1992

-------
                                 METHOD 7450

              MAGNESIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION.  DIRECT ASPIRATION)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  See Section 3.0 of Method 7000 1f interferences are suspected.

     3.2  All elements forming stable oxyanions (P,  B,  Si, Cr, S, V, Ti,  Al,
etc.) will complex magnesium and  interfere  unless  lanthanum is added.  (See
Method 7000, Paragraph  3.1.1.)    Addition  of  lanthanum to prepared samples
rarely presents a problem because  virtually all environmental samples contain
sufficient magnesium to require  dilution  to  be  in  the linear range of the
method.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1   For basic apparatus, see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.

     4.2   Instrument parameters  (general):

           4.2.1   Magnesium  hollow  cathode lamp.
           4.2.2   Wavelength:   285.2 nm.
           4.2.3   Fuel:   Acetylene.
           4.2.4   Oxidant:   Air.
           4.2.5   Type  of flame:  Oxidizing  (fuel  lean).
           4.2.6   Background correction:  Required.


 5.0  REAGENTS

     5.1   See Section  5.0 of Method  7000.

     5.2   Preparation  of standards:

           5.2.1   Stock  solution:     Dissolve    1.000   g  of  magnesium metal
      (analytical  reagent grade)  in 20 mL  1:1   HN03  and dilute to  1  liter with
     Type II  water.     Alternatively,  procure  a  certified  standard from a
     supplier and verify by comparison with a  second standard.


                                   7450 - 1
                                                          Revision       0
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
          5.2.2  Prepare  dilutions  of  the  stock  solution  to  be  used as
     calibration standards at the time of analysis.  The calibration standards
     should  be  prepared  using  the  same  type  of  add  and  at  the same
     concentration  as  will   result  1n  the  sample  to  be  analyzed  after
     processing, Including 1  ml  lanthanum  solution  per  10 ml solution (see
     Paragraph 3.2).

          5.2.3  Lanthanum chloride solution:  Dissolve  29  g LaoCh 1n 250 ml
     concentrated HC1 -
          (CAUTION:  REACTION IS VIOLENT!) -
     and dilute to 500 mL with Type II water.


6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

     6.1  See Chapter Three,  Section 3.1.3, Sample Handling and Preservation.

7.0  PROCEDURE

     7.1  Sample preparation;  The  procedures  for  preparation of the sample
are given In Chapter Three, Section 3.2.

     7.2  See Method 7000, Paragraph 7.2, Direct Aspiration.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

     8.1  See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.


9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

     9.1  The  performance  characteristics  for  an  aqueous  sample  free of
Interferences are:

     Optimum concentration range:  0.02-0.05 mg/L with  a wavelength  of 285.2
                                   nm.
     Sensitivity:  0.007 mg/L.
     Detection limit:  0.001 mg/L.

     9.2  In a  single  laboratory,  analysis  of  a mixed Industrial-domestic
waste effluent, digested with Method  3010,  at  concentrations of 2.1 and 8.2
mg/L gave standard deviations of  +0.1  and +0.2, respectively.  Recoveries at
both of these levels were 100%.


10.0  REFERENCES

1.   Methods for  Chemical  Analysis  of  Water  and Wastes, EPA-600/4-82-055,
December 1982, Method 242.1.
                                  7450 - 2
                                                         Revision
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
                 METHOD 745O

MAGNESIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION. DIRECT ASPIRATION)
5.O

Prepare
standards


7.1
1 For
sample
preparation see
chapter 3.
section 3.2

7.2


Analyze using
Method 7OOO.
Section 7.3
              f     Stop     J
            7450 - 3
                                    Revision       0
                                    Date  September  1986

-------
                                 METHOD 7460

              MANGANESE (ATOMIC ABSORPTION,  DIRECT ASPIRATION)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  See Section 3.0 of Method 7000 if interferences are suspected.

     3.2  Background correction is required.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1  For basic apparatus,  see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.

     4.2  Instrument parameters  (general):

          4.2.1  Manganese  hollow cathode lamp.
          4.2.2  Wavelength:   279.5 nm  (primary); 403.1 nm  (alternate).
          4.2.3  Fuel:  Acetylene.
          4.2.4  Oxldant:   Air.
          4.2.5  Type of  flame:    Slightly  oxidizing   (slightly fuel-lean to
                 stoichiometric).
          4.2.6  Background correction:  Required.


5.0  REAGENTS

     5.1  See  Section  5.0 of  Method 7000.

     5.2   Preparation  of standards;

           5.2.1  Stock solution:   Dissolve  1.000 g manganese metal  (analytical
     reagent grade)   1n 10  mL  redistilled   HN03  and dilute to  1  liter  with
     Type II  water.     Alternatively,   procure   a  certified   standard from  a
     supplier and  verify by comparison with a  second standard.

           5.2.2   Prepare  dilutions   of  the  stock  solution   to  be  used as
     calibration standards  at the time of analysis.  The calibration standards
      should  be   prepared  using  the  same  type  of  acid  and  at  the same
     concentration  as  will   result   in  the   sample  to  be   analyzed  after
     processing.

                                   7460 - 1
                                                          Revision      0
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION,  AND HANDLING

     6.1  See Chapter Three, Section 3.1.3,  Sample Handling and Preservation.


7.0  PROCEDURE

     7.1  Sample preparation;  The  procedures  for  preparation of the sample
are given 1n Chapter Three, Section 3.2.

     7.2  See Method 7000, Paragraph 7.2, Direct Aspiration.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

     8.1  See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.


9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

     9.1  The performance characteristics for an aqueous sample free of Inter-
ferences are:

     Optimum concentration range:  0.1-3 mg/L with a wavelength of 279.5 nm.
     Sensitivity:  0.05 mg/L.
     Detection limit:  0.01 mg/L.

     9.2  Precision and accuracy data are available 1n Method 243.1 of Methods
for Chemical Analysis of Water and Wastes.


10.0  REFERENCES

1.   Methods for  Chemical  Analysis  of  Water  and Wastes, EPA-600/4-82-055,
December 1982, Method 243.1.
                                   7460 - 2
                                                         Revision
                                                         Date  September  1986

-------
                 METHOD 7460

MANGANESE  (ATOMIC  ABSORPTION. DIRECT ASPIRATION)
                5.O
                    Prepare
                   standards
7.1
	 . 	 1 For
sample
preparation see
chapter 3.
section 3.2

7.3


Analyze using
Method 7OOO.
Section 7.3
               f     Stop      J
            7460  - 3
                                     Revision      0
                                     Date   September  1986

-------
                                 METHOD 7461
               MANGANESE (ATOMIC ABSORPTION,  FURNACE TECHNIQUE)

1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION
      1.1   See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.

2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD
      2.1   See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.

3.0  INTERFERENCES
      3.1   See Section 3.0 of Method 7000.
      3.2   Background correction must be used.

4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS
      4.1   For basic apparatus, see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.
      4.2   Instrument parameters (general):
            4.2.1   Drying time and temp:  30 sec at 125°C.
            4.2.2   Ashing time and temp:  30 sec at 1000°C.
            4.2.3   Atomizing time and temp:  10 sec at 2700°C.
            4.2.4   Purge gas:  Argon or nitrogen.
            4.2.5   Wavelength:  279.5 nm.
            4.2.6   Background correction:  Required.
            4.2.7   Other operating parameters should be set as specified by the
      particular  instrument manufacturer.
      NOTE: The above concentration values and  instrument  conditions  are  for  a
            Perkin-Elmer  HGA-2100,  based  on the  use  of  a  20  uL  injection,
            continuous-flow purge gas, and nonpyrolytic graphite.   Smaller size
            furnace devices or those  employing  faster  rates of  atomization can
            be  operated  using lower atomization temperatures for  shorter time
            periods than the  above-recommended  settings.
                                    7461  -  1                        Revision  0
                                                                   July  1992

-------
5.0  REAGENTS

      5.1   See Section 5.0 of Method 7000.

      5.2   Preparation of standards

            5.2.1   Stock  solution  -  Dissolve  1.000  g  manganese    metal
      (analytical reagent grade)  in 10 ml redistilled HN03 and  dilute to  1 liter
      with water.  Alternatively, procure a certified standard from  a supplier
      and verify by comparison with a second standard.

            5.2.2   Prepare  dilutions  of  the  stock  solution to  be  used as
      calibration standards at the time of analysis.  The  calibrations standards
      should  be  prepared  using  the  same  type  of  acid and  at the   same
      concentrations as in the sample after processing (0.5% v/v HN03).


6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

      6.1   See Chapter Three, Step 3.1.3,  Sample Handling and Preservation.


7.0  PROCEDURE

      7.1   Sample Preparation - The procedures  for preparation of the sample are
given in Chapter Three, Step 3.2.

      7.2   See Method 7000, Step 7.3,  Furnace Technique.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

      8.1   See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.


9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

      9.1   Precision and accuracy data are not available at this time.

      9.2   The  performance  characteristics  for an  aqueous  sample free of
interferences are:

      Optimum concentration range:   1-30 ug/L.
      Detection limit:  0.2 ug/L.


10.0  REFERENCES

1.     Methods for  Chemical  Analysis of Vlater  and Wastes:  U.S.  Environmental
Protection Agency.  Office  of Research and Development. Environmental Monitoring
and Support  Laboratory.  ORD Publication Offices  of Center for  Environmental
Research Information:   Cincinnati,  OH,  1983;  EPA-600/4-79-020.


                                   7461  -  2                       Revision 0
                                                                  July 1992

-------
                     METHOD  7461
MANGANESE  (ATOMIC  ABSORPTION,  FURNACE TECHNIQUE)
                        Start
                      S.0 Prepare
                       •tandard*
                    7.1 For sample
                    preparation •••
                   Chapter 3, Section
                         3.2
                    7.2 Analyze uiing
                     Method 7000
                      Section 7.3
                         Stop
                         7461  - 3
Revision 0
July  1992

-------
                                 METHOD 7470A

            MERCURY  IN  LIQUID  WASTE  (MANUAL  COLD-VAPOR TECHNIQUE)


1.0   SCOPE AND APPLICATION

      1.1   Method 7470  is  a cold-vapor atomic absorption  procedure approved for
determining the concentration of mercury in mobility-procedure extracts, aqueous
wastes, and ground waters.   (Method 7470  can  also be used for analyzing certain
solid and  sludge-type  wastes;  however,  Method  7471  is usually  the  method of
choice for these waste  types.)  All samples must be subjected to an appropriate
dissolution step prior to analysis.

2.0   SUMMARY OF METHOD

      2.1   Prior to analysis,  the liquid samples must be prepared according to
the procedure discussed in this method.

      2.2   Method 7470, a cold-vapor atomic absorption technique, is based on
the absorption of radiation at 253.7-nm by mercury vapor.  The mercury  is reduced
to the elemental state and  aerated from solution in a  closed  system. The mercury
vapor passes through a cell positioned in the light path of an atomic  absorption
spectrophotometer.  Absorbance  (peak height) is measured as a function  of mercury
concentration.

      2.3   The  typical detection limit  for  this method is 0.0002 mg/L.

3.0   INTERFERENCES

      3.1   Potassium permanganate is added  to eliminate possible interference
from sulfide.  Concentrations as  high as  20 mg/L of sulfide  as sodium  sulfide do
not interfere with the  recovery of added  inorganic mercury from reagent water.

      3.2   Copper has also been reported to  interfere; however,  copper concen-
trations  as  high as 10 mg/L had no effect on recovery  of mercury from spiked
samples.

      3.3   Seawaters, brines,  and industrial  effluents high in chlorides require
additional permanganate (as much as 25 ml) because, during the oxidation  step,
chlorides  are converted to free chlorine, which  also  absorbs radiation of  253.7
nm.  Care must therefore be taken to  ensure that free  chlorine  is  absent before
the mercury  is reduced  and swept into the cell.   This  may be accomplished by
using an excess of hydroxylamine  sulfate  reagent (25 mL).   In addition, the dead
air space  in the BOD bottle must be purged  before adding stannous  sulfate.   Both
inorganic  and organic  mercury spikes  have been quantitatively recovered  from
seawater  by using  this  technique.

      3.4   Certain volatile organic materials that absorb at this wavelength may
also cause interference.  A preliminary run without reagents should determine if
this type  of  interference  is present.
                                   7470A - 1                       Revision  1
                                                                   September 1994

-------
 4.0   APPARATUS  AND MATERIALS

       4.1    Atomic   absorption  spectrophotometer or  equivalent:   Any  atomic
 absorption  unit  with an  open  sample presentation area  in  which to mount  the
 absorption  cell  is  suitable.  Instrument settings recommended by the particular
 manufacturer should be  followed.    Instruments  designed  specifically for  the
 measurement of mercury using the cold-vapor technique are commercially available
 and may  be  substituted  for  the  atomic  absorption spectrophotometer.

       4.2    Mercury hollow  cathode  lamp or electrodeless discharge  lamp.

       4.3    Recorder:  Any multirange variable-speed recorder that is compatible
 with the UV detection system is  suitable.

       4.4    Absorption  cell:  Standard spectrophotometer cells  10 cm long with
 quartz end windows may be  used.  Suitable cells may be constructed from Plexiglas
 tubing,  1  in.  O.D. x  4.5  in.   The ends  are  ground perpendicular  to  the
 longitudinal axis,  and quartz windows (1  in.  diameter x 1/16 in.  thickness)  are
 cemented in  place.  The cell is strapped  to  a burner  for support and  aligned in
 the light beam by use of two 2-in. x  2-in. cards.  One-in.-diameter holes are  cut
 in  the middle of  each card.  The cards are then placed over each end of the cell.
 The cell is then  positioned  and  adjusted vertically and horizontally to give  the
 maximum transmittance.

       4.5    Air pump: Any peristaltic pump capable of del ivering 1 liter air/min
 may be used.  A Masterflex pump with electronic  speed  control  has been  found to
 be  satisfactory.

       4.6    Flowmeter:   Capable  of measuring an  air flow of 1 liter/min.

       4.7    Aeration tubing: A straight glass frit with a coarse  porosity. Tygon
 tubing is used for  passage  of  the mercury vapor from the sample bottle to  the
 absorption cell and  return.

       4.8    Drying tube:  6-in.  x 3/4-in.-diameter tube containing 20 g of mag-
 nesium perchlorate or a small reading lamp with 60-W bulb which may  be used  to
 prevent condensation of  moisture inside the cell.  The lamp should be  positioned
 to shine on the absorption cell  so that the  air temperature in  the cell  is about
 10°C above  ambient.

      4.9   The  cold-vapor  generator  is  assembled   as shown  in  Figure  1   of
 reference  1  or  according to the  instrument manufacturers  instructions.  The
 apparatus shown  in  Figure 1 is  a  closed system.   An open  system,  where  the
mercury vapor  is passed  through  the absorption  cell  only  once, may  be  used
 instead of the closed system.  Because mercury vapor is toxic, precaution must
be taken to avoid its inhalation.  Therefore, a  bypass  has been included in the
system either to  vent the mercury vapor  into an exhaust hood or to pass the vapor
through some absorbing  medium,  such  as:

            1.   Equal volumes of 0.1 M KMn04  and 10%  H2S04;  or

            2.   0.25% Iodine in a 3% KI solution.


                                  7470A - 2                       Revision  1
                                                                  September 1994

-------
      A specially  treated charcoal  that will  adsorb mercury  vapor  is  also
      available from  Barnebey  and Cheney,  East  8th  Avenue and  North Cassidy
      Street, Columbus, Ohio 43219, Cat. #580-13 or #580-22.

      4.10  Hot plate  or  equivalent  - Adjustable  and  capable  of maintaining a
temperature of 90-95°C.

      4.11  Graduated cylinder or equivalent.

5.0   REAGENTS

      5 1   Reagent  Water:    Reagent water  will  be  interference  free.   All
references to water in this  method will  refer to reagent water unless otherwise
specified.

      5.2   Sulfuric acid (H2S04), concentrated:   Reagent  grade.

      5.3   Sulfuric acid, 0.5 N:  Dilute 14.0 ml  of concentrated sulfuric acid
to 1.0 liter.

      5.4   Nitric  acid  (HN03),   concentrated:   Reagent grade  of  low mercury
content.  If a high  reagent blank is obtained, it may be necessary to distill the
nitric acid.

      5 5   Stannous  sulfate:   Add  25  g stannous sulfate  to 250  ml of 0.5 N
H2S04.  This mixture is a suspension and should be stirred  continuously during
use.   (Stannous chloride  may be  used in  place  of  stannous  sulfate.)

      5 6    Sodium  chloride-hydroxylamine  sulfate solution:  Dissolve 12 g  of
sodium chloride and 12 g of  hydroxylamine sulfate  in reagent water and dilute  to
100  ml.    (Hydroxylamine  hydrochloride  may  be used  in place of hydroxylamine
sulfate.)

       5.7    Potassium permanganate, mercury-free,  5%  solution  (w/v):  Dissolve
5  g  of potassium  permanganate  in 100 mL of  reagent water.

       5.8    Potassium persulfate,  5% solution  (w/v):  Dissolve 5 g  of potassium
persulfate in 100 ml of reagent  water.

       5  9    Stock mercury solution:  Dissolve 0.1354  g of mercuric chloride  in
75 ml of reagent water.  Add 10 ml of concentrated HN03 and adjust the volume  to
100.0 ml  (1  ml =  1  mg Hg).   Stock solutions may  also  be purchased.

       5.10  Mercury working standard:    Make successive dilutions  of the  stock
mercury'solution  to obtain a working standard containing  0.1 ug per mL.   This
working  standard  and  the dilutions of the  stock mercury solution  should  be
prepared  fresh daily.   Acidity of the  working standard should be maintained  at
0.15% nitric acid.  This acid should be added to the flask,  as  needed,  before
addition  of the aliquot.
                                    7470A  -  3                       Revision 1
                                                                   September 1994

-------
 6.0   SAMPLE COLLECTION,  PRESERVATION,  AND HANDLING

       6.1    All  samples must  have  been collected  using  a sampling  plan  that
 addresses  the considerations  discussed  in  Chapter  Nine  of this  manual.

       6.2    All  sample  containers must be prewashed with detergents, acids, and
 reagent  water.   Plastic and glass containers  are both suitable.

       6.3    Aqueous  samples  must  be  acidified  to  a  pH  <2  with  HN03.    The
 suggested  maximum  holding  times  for  mercury is 28  days.

       6.4    Nonaqueous  samples shall  be refrigerated, when  possible, and analyzed
 as  soon  as possible.

 7.0   PROCEDURE

       7.1    Sample preparation:  Transfer  100 mL,   or  an  aliquot  diluted  to
 100 mL, containing <1.0 g of mercury,  to a 300-mL BOD bottle or equivalent.   Add
 5 mL of  H2S04 and 2.5 mL of concentrated HN03, mixing after each  addition.   Add
 15  mL  of potassium permanganate solution to each  sample  bottle.   Sewage  samples
 may require  additional  permanganate.   Ensure that equal  amounts  of permanganate
 are added  to  standards and  blanks.   Shake  and  add  additional  portions  of
 potassium  permanganate  solution, if  necessary, until the  purple  color persists
 for at least 15  min.  Add  8 mL of potassium persulfate to  each  bottle and  heat
 for 2  hr  in a water bath maintained at 95°C.   Cool  and add  6 mL  of sodium
 chloride-hydroxylamine  sulfate to reduce the excess permanganate.  After a delay
 of  at  least  30 sec, add 5 mL of stannous  sulfate, immediately  attach  the bottle
 to  the aeration  apparatus, and continue as  described in Paragraph 7.3.

       7.2    Standard preparation: Transfer 0-, 0.5-,  1.0-, 2.0-, 5.0-, and 10.0-
 mL  aliquots  of the mercury working standard, containing  0-1.0  ug  of mercury,  to
 a series of 300-mL BOD bottles.  Add enough reagent  water to each bottle  to  make
 a total volume of 100 mL.   Mix thoroughly and add 5 mL of concentrated H2S04 and
 2.5 mL of concentrated HN03 to each bottle.  Add 15  mL of KMn04 solution  to  each
 bottle and allow to stand at  least 15 min.   Add 8 mL  of potassium persulfate  to
 each bottle  and heat for 2 hr  in a water bath  maintained  at 95°C.  Cool and  add
 6 mL  of sodium  chloride-hydroxylamine  sulfate  solution  to reduce  the excess
 permanganate.  When the solution has  been decolorized, wait 30 sec, add 5 mL  of
 the stannous sulfate  solution,  immediately attach  the  bottle to the aeration
 apparatus, and continue as described  in Paragraph 7.3.

       7.3    Analysis:   At  this point the  sample  is allowed  to  stand quietly
without  manual  agitation.   The  circulating  pump,  which  has  previously   been
 adjusted  to a  rate  of 1  liter/min,  is allowed  to run  continuously.   The
 absorbance will  increase  and  reach  a maximum within 30 sec.   As  soon  as  the
recorder pen levels off  (approximately 1 min), open the bypass valve and continue
the aeration until the absorbance returns to  its minimum value.  Close  the bypass
valve,  remove  the stopper and  frit  from  the  BOD  bottle,  and  continue  the
aeration.  Because of instrument variation refer to the manufacturers recommended
operating conditions when using this  method.
                                   7470A  - 4                       Revision 1
                                                                  September 1994

-------
      7.4   Construct a calibration curve by plotting the absorbances of stan-
dards versus micrograms of mercury.   Determine  the  peak height of the unknown
from the chart and read the mercury value  from the standard curve.  Duplicates,
spiked samples, and check standards should be routinely analyzed.

      7.5   Calculate  metal   concentrations  (1)  by  the  method of  standard
additions,  or  (2) from a  calibration curve.   All  dilution  or concentration
factors must be taken into  account. Concentrations  reported for  multiphased or
wet samples must be appropriately  qualified (e.g.,  5 ug/g dry weight).

8.0   QUALITY CONTROL

      8.1   Refer to section 8.0 of Method 7000.

9.0   METHOD PERFORMANCE

      9.1   Precision and accuracy data are available in Method 245.1 of Methods
for Chemical Analysis of Water and Wastes.

10.0  REFERENCES

1.    Methods  for Chemical  Analysis   of  Water and Wastes,   EPA-600/4-82-055,
December  1982, Method 245.1.
                                   7470A - 5                       Revision 1
                                                                   September 1994

-------
                             METHOD 7470A
MERCURY IN  LIQUID WASTE  (MANUAL  COLD-VAPOR  TECHNIQUE)
                                 (     Start     J
              Sample Preparation
                                                  Standard Preparation
  7.1 Transfer aliquot
  to bottle, add H2S04
  and HNOu, and mix.
    7.1 Add KMn04
      and shake.
                                                                      1
                                 7.2 Transfer aliquot
                                 of the Hg working
                                    standard to
                                      bottle.
                                  7.2 Add reagent
                                  water, mix, add
                                    concentrated
                                            HNO3.
                               7.1  Add more
                               permanganate
                               if necessary.
       7.1 Add
      potassium
   persulfate, heat
   for 2 hrs., cool.
                                   7.2 Add KMn04
                                     potasaium
                                   peraulfate, heat
                                 for 2 hrs. and cool.
                                   7.2 Add sodium
                                      chloride-
                                    hydroxylamine
                                   sulfate, wait 30
                                      seconds.
   7.1 Add sodium
       chloride-
    hydroxylamine
   sulfate, wait 30
       seconds.
   7.1  Add stannous
    sulfate, attach
      to aeration
      apparatus.
 7.3 Analyze
    sample.
7.2 Add stannous
 sulfate, attach
   to aeration
   apparatus.
 7.4 Construct
   calibration
curve, determine
peak height and
   Hg value.
                                7.4 Routinely
                              analyze duplicates,
                               spiked samples.
                                    I
                                7.5 Calculate
                                    metal
                                concentrations.
                               (     Stop     J
                              7470A  -  6
                                           Revision  1
                                           September 1994

-------
                                 METHOD 7471A

      MERCURY  IN SOLID OR SEMISOLID WASTE  (MANUAL COLD-VAPOR TECHNIQUE)


1.0   SCOPE AND APPLICATION

      1.1   Method 7471  is  approved  for measuring total mercury  (organic and
inorganic) in soils,  sediments,  bottom  deposits, and sludge-type materials. All
samples must be subjected to an  appropriate dissolution step prior to analysis.
If this dissolution procedure is not sufficient to  dissolve  a  specific matrix
type or sample, then this method is not applicable for that matrix.

2.0   SUMMARY OF METHOD

      2.1   Prior to analysis,  the  solid or semi-solid samples must be prepared
according to the procedures discussed in this method.

      2.2   Method 7471,  a  cold-vapor atomic  absorption method, is based on the
absorption of radiation at the 253.7-nm  wavelength by mercury vapor.  The mercury
is reduced to the elemental  state and aerated from solution in a closed system.
The mercury vapor passes through a cell  positioned in the light path  of an atomic
absorption spectrophotometer. Absorbance (peak height) is measured as a function
of mercury concentration.

      2.3   The  typical  instrument detection  limit  (IDL)  for this  method is
0.0002 mg/L.

3.0   INTERFERENCES

      3.1   Potassium permanganate is  added  to eliminate possible interference
from sulfide.  Concentrations as high as 20 mg/Kg  of  sulfide,  as sodium sulfide,
do not interfere with the recovery  of added inorganic mercury in reagent water.

      3.2   Copper has also been reported  to  interfere; however, copper concen-
trations  as high as  10 mg/Kg had no  effect on recovery of mercury from spiked
samples.

      3.3   Samples high in  chlorides  require  additional permanganate (as much
as 25 ml)  because,  during  the  oxidation step,  chlorides are converted to free
chlorine, which also absorbs radiation  of 253 nm.  Care must  therefore be  taken
to ensure that  free chlorine is  absent  before  the mercury  is reduced and  swept
into the  cell.   This may be accomplished  by using  an excess of hydroxylamine
sulfate reagent (25 ml).   In addition,  the dead air space in the BOD bottle must
be purged before adding  stannous sulfate.

      3.4   Certain volatile organic materials that absorb at this  wavelength may
also cause interference.  A  preliminary run without reagents should  determine if
this type of  interference is present.

4.0   APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

      4.1   Atomic  absorption   spectrophotometer  or  equivalent:    Any atomic
absorption  unit with an open  sample  presentation area  in which  to mount the

                                   7471A - 1                        Revision 1
                                                                   September 1994

-------
 absorption  cell  is suitable.  Instrument settings recommended by the particular
 manufacturer should be  followed.   Instruments  designed  specifically  for  the
 measurement of mercury using the cold-vapor technique are commercially available
 and  may  be  substituted  for  the  atomic  absorption spectrophotometer.

       4.2    Mercury  hollow  cathode  lamp  or electrodeless discharge  lamp.

       4.3    Recorder:  Any multirange variable-speed recorder that is compatible
 with the UV detection system  is  suitable.

       4.4    Absorption  cell:  Standard spectrophotometer cells  10 cm long with
 quartz end windows may be used.  Suitable  cells may be constructed from Plexiglas
 tubing,  1   in.  O.D. x   4.5  in.   The ends  are  ground perpendicular  to  the
 longitudinal axis, and quartz windows (1  in.  diameter x 1/16  in.  thickness)  are
 cemented in  place.  The cell is strapped  to  a burner  for support  and  aligned in
 the  light beam by use of  two 2-in. x  2-in. cards.  One-in.-diameter holes are  cut
 in the middle of each card.  The cards  are then placed over each end of the cell.
 The  cell  is then positioned  and  adjusted vertically and horizontally to give  the
 maximum  transmittance.

       4.5    Air pump: Any peristaltic pump capable of delivering 1 L/min air  may
 be used.  A  Masterflex pump with electronic  speed control has been found to be
 satisfactory.

       4.6    Flowmeter:    Capable of measuring an  air flow of 1 L/min.

       4.7    Aeration tubing: A straight glass frit with a coarse porosity. Tygon
 tubing is used  for passage  of  the mercury vapor from the sample bottle to  the
 absorption cell and return.

       4.8    Drying tube:    6-in.  x  3/4-in.-diameter  tube  containing  20  g   of
 magnesium perchlorate or a small reading lamp with 60-W bulb which may be used
 to prevent   condensation of moisture  inside the cell.   The  lamp  should   be
 positioned to shine  on  the  absorption  cell so  that  the air  temperature in  the
 cell  is  about 10°C above ambient.

      4.9   The  cold-vapor  generator  is  assembled   as  shown in  Figure  1   of
 reference 1  or  according to  the  instrument  manufacturers instructions.    The
 apparatus shown  in  Figure   1  is  a  closed system.   An open system,  where   the
mercury  vapor  is passed through  the  absorption cell  only  once, may  be  used
 instead of  the closed system. Because mercury  vapor is  toxic, precaution must  be
taken  to avoid  its  inhalation.   Therefore,  a bypass has been included in   the
system either to  vent  the  mercury  vapor into an exhaust hood or  to pass  the
vapor through some absorbing medium, such as:

            1.     equal  volumes of 0.1  M  KMn04  and 10% H2S04,  or
            2.     0.25% iodine in a  3% KI solution.


      A  specially  treated   charcoal  that will  adsorb mercury  vapor  is  also
      available  from Barneby  and Cheney, East  8th Avenue  and   North  Cassidy
      Street, Columbus,  Ohio 43219,  Cat.  #580-13 or  #580-22.
                                  7471A - 2                       Revision 1
                                                                  September 1994

-------
      4.10  Hot plate or equivalent  - Adjustable  and  capable  of maintaining a
temperature of 90-95°C.

      4.11  Graduated cylinder or equivalent.

5.0   REAGENTS

      5.1   Reagent  Water:    Reagent water  will  be  interference  free.   All
references to  water in this  method refer  to  reagent water  unless  otherwise
specified.

      5.2   Aqua regia:  Prepare immediately before use by carefully  adding three
volumes of concentrated HC1 to one volume of concentrated HN03.

      5.3   Sulfuric acid, 0.5 N:  Dilute 14.0  ml  of concentrated sulfuric acid
to 1 liter.

      5.4   Stannous sulfate:   Add  25 g  stannous sulfate to  250  ml  of 0.5 N
sulfuric acid.  This mixture is a suspension and should be stirred  continuously
during use.  A 10% solution  of stannous chloride can  be substituted  for stannous
sulfate.

      5.5   Sodium  chloride-hydroxylamine  sulfate solution:   Dissolve 12 g of
sodium chloride and 12  g of  hydroxylamine sulfate  in  reagent water and dilute to
100  ml.    Hydroxylamine hydrochloride  may  be  used  in  place  of hydroxylamine
sulfate.

      5.6   Potassium permanganate,  mercury-free, 5% solution (w/v):  Dissolve
5 g  of potassium  permanganate  in  100 mL  of  reagent water.

      5.7   Mercury stock solution:  Dissolve  0.1354  g of mercuric chloride in
75 ml of reagent  water.  Add 10 ml  of concentrated nitric acid and adjust  the
volume to  100.0 ml  (1.0 ml  =  1.0  mg  Hg).

      5.8   Mercury working standard:   Make successive dilutions  of the  stock
mercury  solution to obtain a working  standard containing 0.1 ug/mL.  This  working
standard and the dilution  of the stock mercury solutions should be prepared fresh
daily.   Acidity of the working  standard should  be  maintained at  0.15%  nitric
acid.   This acid  should  be added to the  flask,  as  needed,  before adding  the
aliquot.

6.0   SAMPLE  COLLECTION,  PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

      6.1   All  samples must  have been  collected using  a sampling plan  that
addresses  the  considerations  discussed  in  Chapter Nine of this manual.

      6.2   All  sample  containers must be prewashed with detergents,  acids,  and
reagent  water.   Plastic and glass containers are  both suitable.

      6.3    Non-aqueous  samples   shall  be  refrigerated,  when  possible,  and
analyzed as  soon  as possible."
                                   7471A  - 3                       Revision 1
                                                                   September 1994

-------
 7.0   PROCEDURE

       7.1   Sample preparation:  Weigh  triplicate  0.2-g  portions of untreated
 sample and place in the bottom of a BOD bottle.  Add 5 ml of reagent water and
 5 ml of aqua regia.  Heat 2 min in a water bath at 95°C.   Cool; then add 50 ml
 reagent water and 15 ml potassium permanganate solution to each sample bottle
 Mix thoroughly and place in the water bath for 30 min at 95°C.   Cool and add 6
 ml of sodium chloride-hydroxylamine  sulfate to  reduce the excess permanganate.

             CAUTION:  Do this addition  under a hood,  as C12 could be evolved.
             Add 55 ml of reagent water.  Treating each bottle individually, add
             5 ml of stannous sulfate and  immediately  attach  the  bottle to the
             aeration  apparatus.   Continue  as  described under step 7.4.

       7.2   An alternate digestion procedure employing an autoclave may also be
 used.   In this method,  5 mL  of  concentrated H2S04 and 2 ml of concentrated HNO,
 are added to the 0.2 g of sample.  Add 5 ml  of  saturated KMn04 solution and cover
 the bottle with a piece of aluminum foil.   The samples are autoclaved at 121°C
 and 15 Ib for 15 min.   Cool,  dilute to a volume of 100 ml with reagent water, and
 add 6 ml  of sodium chloride-hydroxylamine sulfate solution to reduce the excess
 permanganate.   Purge the dead air space and  continue  as  described under step 7.4.
 Refer to  the caution statement in section 7.1 for the proper protocol in reducing
 the excess permanganate solution  and  adding stannous  sulfate.

      7.3   Standard preparation: Transfer 0.0-, 0.5-, 1.0-,  2.0-, 5.0-, and 10-
 ml_  aliquots of  the mercury working standard, containing 0-1.0 ug of mercury,  to
 a series  of 300-mL BOD bottles or equivalent.   Add enough  reagent  water  to each
 bottle to make  a  total  volume of  10 ml.  Add  5  ml of  aqua  regia and  heat  2  min
 in  a water bath at 95°C.  Allow the  sample  to  cool;  add 50  ml  reagent water  and
 15  ml of  KMn04  solution   to  each  bottle  and  return  to the water bath for  30
 min.   Cool and add 6 ml  of  sodium  chloride-hydroxylamine sulfate solution  to
 reduce the excess permanganate.  Add  50 ml of  reagent water.   Treating  each
 bottle individually,  add  5 mL of stannous  sulfate solution,  immediately attach
 the bottle to the  aeration apparatus, and  continue as  described in
 Step 7.4.

      7.4  Analysis:   At this  point, the sample  is  allowed to stand quietly
 without manual  agitation.   The circulating  pump,  which  has  previously been
 adjusted  to a rate of 1 L/min, is  allowed to run continuously.  The absorbance,
 as exhibited either on the spectrophotometer or the  recorder, will  increase and
 reach  maximum  within  30 sec.   As  soon as  the  recorder  pen  levels off
 (approximately 1 min), open the bypass valve and continue the  aeration until the
 absorbance returns  to  its minimum value.  Close  the  bypass  valve,  remove the
 fritted tubing  from the BOD  bottle,  and continue the aeration.

      7.5   Construct a calibration curve by plotting the absorbances of  stan-
dards versus micrograms  of mercury.   Determine  the  peak height of the unknown
from the chart and read the mercury value from the standard curve.  Duplicates,
spiked samples, and check standards should  be routinely analyzed.

      7.6   Calculate metal  concentrations:    (1)  by  the  method  of standard
additions, (2) from a calibration curve,  or (3) directly from the instrument's
concentration read-out.  All dilution or concentration factors must  be  taken into


                                  7471A  -  4                       Revision 1
                                                                  September 1994

-------
account.   Concentrations  reported for  multiphased  or wet  samples  must  be
appropriately qualified (e.g., 5 ug/g dry weight).
8.0   QUALITY CONTROL
      8.1  Refer to section 8.0 of Method 7000.
9.0   METHOD PERFORMANCE
      9.1   Precision and accuracy data are available in Method 245.5 of Methods
for Chemical Analysis of Water and Wastes.
      9 2   The data shown  in Table  1 were  obtained from records of state  and
contractor  laboratories.   The data are  intended  to  show the precision of  the
combined sample preparation and analysis method.
10.0  REFERENCES
1.    Methods  for Chemical  Analysis of Water and  Wastes,  EPA-600/4-82-055,
December 1982, Method 245.5.
2     Gaskill  A  , Compilation  and Evaluation of  RCRA  Method  Performance  Data,
Work Assignment No.  2,  EPA  Contract No.  68-01-7075,  September 1986.
                                    7471A -  5                      Revision  1
                                                                   September 1994

-------
                      TABLE  1. METHOD  PERFORMANCE  DATA
Sample                         Preparation            Laboratory
Matnx                           Method               Replicates


Emission control dust          Not known              12,  12  ug/g

Wastewater treatment sludge    Not known          0.4, 0.28  ug/g
                                7471A  - 6                       Revision 1
                                                                September 1994

-------
                                     METHOD  7471A
MERCURY  IN  SOLID  OR SEMISOLID WASTE  (MANUAL  COLD-VAPOR TECHNIQUE)
                                [     Start     J
              Sample Preparation
                                                  Standard Preparation
 7.1 Weigh triplicate
samples, and reagent
     water and
     aqua regia.
   7.1 Heat, cool,
  add reagent water
     and KMnO. .
    7.1 Heat, cool,
     add sodium
       chlonde-
    hydroxylamine
       sulfate.
    7.1 Add reagent
    water, stannous
     sulfate, attach
      to aeration
      apparatus.
   7.2 Add
KMn04, cover,
heat and cool,
  dilute with
reagent water.
7.2 Add sodium
   chloride-
 hydroxylamina
 sulfate, purge
dead air space.
  7.4 Analyze
    sample.
                                     7.5 Construct
                                      calibration
                                    curve;  determine
                                    peak height and
                                       Hg value.
                                                              7.3 Transfer aliquots
                                                                  of Hg working
                                                                  standards to
                                                                    bottles.
                             7.3 Add reagent
                             water to volume,
                              and aqua regia,
                              heat and cool.
7.3 Add reagent
water and KMnO4
 solution, heat
   and cool.
 7.3 Add sodium
     chloride-
  hydroxylamine
   sulfate and
  reagent water.
     7.3 Add
 stannous sulfate,
 attach to aeration
    apparatus.
                                      7.5 Routinely
                                    analyze duplicates,
                                     spiked samples.
                                      7.6 Calculate
                                          metal
                                     concentrations.
                                    (     Stop     J

                                       7471A -  7
                                               Revision  1
                                               September 1994

-------
                                 METHOD 7480

              MOLYBDENUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION, DIRECT ASPIRATION)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  See Section 3.0 of Method 7000 if interferences are suspected.

     3.2  Interferences in an air/acetylene flame from Ca, Sr, $04, and Fe are
severe.  These interferences are  greatly   reduced  in the nitrous oxide flame
and by addition of 1,000 mg/L aluminum to samples and standards.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1  For basic apparatus,  see Section  4.0 of Method 7000.

     4.2  Instrument parameters  (general):

          4.2.1  Molybdenum hollow cathode  lamp.
          4.2.2  Wavelength:  313.3 nm.
          4.2.3  Fuel:  Acetylene.
          4.2.4  Oxidant:  Nitrous oxide.
          4.2.5  Type of flame:  Fuel rich.
          4.2.6  Background correction:  Required.


5.0  REAGENTS

     5.1  See Section 5.0 of Method 7000.

     5.2  Preparation of standards;

          5.2.1  Stock  solution:    Dissolve  1.840  g  of ammonium molybdate,
     (NH4)fiMo7024*4H20  (analytical reagent  grade), in Type II water and dilute
     to 1 liter; 1  mL  =  1  mg  Mo   (1,000  mg/L).  Alternatively, procure a
     certified standard from a  supplier  and verify by comparison with a second
     standard.
                                  7480 - 1
                                                         Revision
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
          5.2.2  Prepare  dilutions   of  the   stock   solution   to   be   used  as
     calibration standards at the time  of analysis.   The  calibration standards
     should  be  prepared  using  the  same   type  of  acid  and   at   the same
     concentration  as  will   result   in   the  sample  to be   analyzed  after
     processing.  The samples  and standards  should  also  contain 1,000 mg/L
     aluminum (see Paragraph  5.2.3).

          5.2.3  Aluminum nitrate solution:    Dissolve  139 g aluminum  nitrate,
     Al(N03)3'9H20,  in 150 ml  of Type   II   water;  heat to  effect solution.
     Allow to cool and make up  to 200  ml.     To each 100  ml of  standard and
     sample alike, add 2 ml of the aluminum nitrate  solution.


6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

     6.1  See Chapter Three,  Section  3.1.3, Sample Handling  and Preservation.


7.0  PROCEDURE

     7.1  Sample preparation;  The  procedures  for   preparation of the sample
are given in Chapter Three, Section 3.2.

     7.2  See Method 7000, Paragraph 7.2, Direct Aspiration.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

     8.1  See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.
9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

     9.1  The performance characteristics for an aqueous sample free of inter-
ferences are:

     Optimum concentration range:  1-40 mg/L with a wavelength of 313.3 nm.
     Sensitivity:  0.4 mg/L.
     Detection  limit:  0.1 mg/L.

     9.2  In a   single  laboratory,  analysis  of  a mixed Industrial-domestic
waste effluent,  digested with Method 3010,  at concentrations of 0.3, 1.5, and
7.5 mg/L gave standard deviations  of  +0.007, +0.02, and +0.07, respectively.
Recoveries at these  levels were 100%, 96%, and 95%, respectively.

     9.3  For   concentrations  of  molybdenum  below  0.2  mg/L,  the  furnace
technique (Method  7481) is recommended.


10.0 REFERENCES

1.   Methods for  Chemical  Analysis  of  Water  and Wastes, EPA-600/4-82-055,
December 1982,  Method 246.1.

                                  7480 - 2
                                                         Revision      0
                                                         Date  September  1986

-------
                  METHOD 748O

MOLYBDENUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION.  DIRECT ASPIRATION)
                C
                  S.O
                      Prepare
                     standards
                  7.1
                      1  For
                       sample
                 preparation see
                     chapter 3.
                    section 3.2
                  7.2
                  Analyze using
                   Method 700O.
                   Section 7.2
                (     Stop      J
              7480 - 3
                                        Revision       0
                                        Date  September 1986

-------
                                 METHOD 7481

              MOLYBDENUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION,  FURNACE TECHNIQUE)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  See Section 3.0 of Method 7000 if interferences are suspected.

     3.2  Molybdenum is  prone  to  carbide  formation.    Use a pyrolytically
coated graphite tube.

     3.3  Memory effects are  possible,  and  cleaning  of  the furnace may be
required after analysis of more concentrated samples or standards.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1  For basic  apparatus,  see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.

     4.2  Instrument parameters  (general):

          4.2.1  Drying time and  temp:   30 sec at 125*C.
          4.2.2  Ashing time and  temp:   30 sec at 1400*C.
          4.2.3  Atomizing  time and temp:  5 sec at 2800*C.
          4.2.4  Purge  gas:  Argon  (nitrogen should not be used).
          4.2.5  Wavelength:   313.3 nm.
          4.2.6  Background correction:   Required.
          4.2.7  Other  operating  parameters  should  be  set as  specified by the
                 particular instrument manufacturer.
          4.2.8  Pyrolytically coated graphite tube.
          NOTE:  The above  concentration values  and instrument  conditions are
                 for a  Perkin-Elmer   HGA-2100,  based  on  the  use  of a  20-uL
                 injection,  continuous-flow  purge  gas,   and  nonpyrolytic
                 graphite.     Smaller  sizes  of   furnace   devices   or  those
                 employing  faster rates of   atomization  can be  operated  using
                 lower  atomization  temperatures for shorter time periods than
                 the above-recommended settings.
                                   7481  - 1
                                                          Revision
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
5.0  REAGENTS

     5.1  See Section 5.0 of Method 7000.

     5.2  Preparation of standards;

          5.2.1  Stock solution:    Dissolve  1.840  g  of ammonium molybdate,
     (NH4)6M07024'4H20  (analytical  reagent  grade),  1n  Type  II  water and
     dilute to 1 liter; 1 ml = 1 mg Mo (1,000 mg/L).   Alternatively, procure a
     certified standard from a supplier and verify by comparison with a second
     standard.

          5.2.2  Prepare  dilutions  of  the  stock  solution  to  be  used as
     calibration standards at the time of analysis.  The calibration standards
     should  be  prepared  using  the  same  type  of  acid  and  at  the same
     concentrations as In the sample after processing (0.5% v/v
6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION,  AND HANDLING

     6.1  See Chapter Three, Section 3.1.3,  Sample Handling and Preservation.


7.0  PROCEDURE

     7.1  Sample preparation;  The  procedures  for  preparation of the sample
are given In Chapter Three, Section 3.2.

     7.2  See Method 7000, Paragraph 7.3,  Furnace Procedure.   The calculation
Is given In Method 7000, Paragraph 7.4.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

     8.1  See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.


9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

     9.1  Precision and accuracy data are not available at this time.

     9.2  The performance characteristics for an aqueous sample free of Inter-
ferences are:

     Optimum concentration range:  3-60 ug/L.
     Detection limit:  1 ug/L.


10.0 REFERENCES

1.   Methods for  Chemical  Analysis  of  Water  and Wastes, EPA-600/4-82-055
December 1982, Method 246.2.


                                  7481 - 2
                                                         Revision      0
                                                         Date   September 1986

-------
                  METHOD 7481

MOLYBDENUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION.  FURNACE  TECHNIQUE)
                  1.0
                     Prepare
                    calibration
                     standard
                  7. 1

                    For sample
                 preparation see
                  Chapter Three;
                   Section 3.2
7.2
Met
Sec
calc
Sect
Analyze
us Ing
.hod 7OOO.
:tlon 7.3;
:ulat Ions
.Ion 7.4
               f     Stop      J
             7481 -  3
                                       Revision       0
                                       Date   September 1986

-------
                                 METHOD 7520

                NICKEL (ATOMIC ABSORPTION,  DIRECT ASPIRATION)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  See Section 3.0 of Method 7000 If interferences are suspected.

     3.2  Background correction 1s required.

     3.3  High concentrations  of  Iron,  cobalt,  or  chromium may interfere,
requiring either matrix matching or use of a nitrous-oxide/acetylene flame.

     3.4  A nonresonance line of N1  at 232.14 nm causes nonlinear calibration
curves at moderate to high nickel concentrations, requiring sample dilution or
use of the 352.4-nm line.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1  For basic apparatus, see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.

     4.2  Instrument  parameters  (general):

          4.2.1   Nickel  hollow cathode lamp.
          4.2.2   Wavelength:   232.0 nm (primary); 352.4 nm  (alternate).
          4.2.3   Fuel:   Acetylene.
          4.2.4   Oxldant:   A1r.
          4.2.5   Type of flame:   Oxidizing (fuel  lean).
          4.2.6   Background correction:   Required.


 5.0  REAGENTS

      5.1   See Section 5.0 of Method 7000.

      5.2   Preparation of standards;

           5.2.1  Stock solution:   Dissolve  1.000  g nickel  metal  (analytical
      reagent grade)   or  4.953  g  nickel   nitrate,   N1(N03)2'6H£0 (analytical
      reagent grade), in 10 mL HN03 and  dilute  to 1 liter with Type II water.


                                   7520 - 1
                                                          Revision      0
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
     Alternatively, procure a certified standard from a supplier and verify by
     comparison with a second standard.

          5.2.2  Prepare  dilutions  of  the  stock  solution  to  be  used as
     calibration standards at the time of analysis.  The calibration standards
     should  be  prepared  using  the  same  type  of  acid  and  at  the same
     concentration  as  will  result  in  the  sample  to  be  analyzed  aft<°r
     processing.


6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

     6.1  See Chapter Three, Section 3.1.3, Sample Handling and Preservation.


7.0  PROCEDURE

     1-l  Sample preparation;  The  procedures  for  preparation of the sample
are given in Chapter Three, Section 3.2.

     7.2  See Method 7000, Paragraph 7.2, Direct Aspiration.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

     8.1  See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.


9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

     9.1  The performance characteristics for an aqueous sample free of inter-
ferences are:

     Optimum concentration range:  0.3-5 mg/L with a wavelength of 232.0 nm.
     Sensitivity:  0.15 mg/L.
     Detection limit:  0.04 mg/L.

   . 9*L,In a  s1"9le  laboratory,  analysis  of  a mixed industrial-domestic
waste effluent,  digested with Method 3010,   at concentrations of 0.2,  1.0  and
5.0 mg/L gave standard deviations  of  +0.011, +0.02,  and +0.04  respectively
Recoveries at these levels were 100%, 97%,  and 93%, respectively.

     9.3  The data shown in Table  1  were   obtained from records  of state and
contractor laboratories.  The data are  intended  to show the precision of the
combined sample preparation and analysis method.
                                  7520 - 2
                                                         Revision      o
                                                         Date  September 1986"

-------
10.0 REFERENCES

1.   Methods for  Chemical  Analysis  of  Water  and Wastes, EPA-600/4-82-055,
December 1982, Method 249.1

2.   Gasklll, A., Compilation and Evaluation  of RCRA Method Performance Data,
Work Assignment No. 2, EPA Contract No. 68-01-7075, September 1986.
                                   7520 - 3
                                                          Revision
                                                          Date   September 1986

-------
                      TABLE 1. METHOD PERFORMANCE DATA
       Sample                      Preparation                Laboratory
       Matrix	Method                   Replicates


Wastewater treatment sludge           3050                 13,000,  10,400 ug/g
                                  7520 -  4
                                                         Revision       0
                                                         Date  September  1986

-------
                METHOD 752O

NICKEL  (ATOMIC ABSORPTION.  DIRECT ASPIRATION)
                  Start
              5.0
                  Prepare
                 s tandards
7. 1
prepar
cf
sec
For
samp 1 e
•at Ion
lapter
:tion 3
see
3.
.2
              7.2
              Analyze  using
               Method  7OOO.
               Section 7.2
                  Stop
           7520 - 5
                                     Revision       0	
                                     Date  September 1986

-------
                                 METHOD  7550

                OSMIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION.  DIRECT ASPIRATION)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  Method  7550  is  an   atomic    absorption  procedure  approved  for
determining  the  concentration  of   osmium  in  wastes,  mobility  procedure
extracts, soils, and  ground  water.    All  samples  must  be subjected to an
appropriate dissolution step prior to analysis.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  Prior to analysis  by  Method  7550,  samples  must  be prepared for
direct aspiration.  The method  of  sample  preparation will vary according to
the sample matrix.    Aqueous  samples  are  subjected  to  the acid digestion
procedure discussed in this  method.    Sludge  samples are prepared using the
procedure described in Method 3050.   For  samples containing oils, greases, or
waxes, the procedure described in Method   3040  may be applicable.  Due to the
very volatile nature of some  osmium  compounds, the applicability of a method
to a sample must be verified by  means of  spiked samples or standard reference
materials, or both.

     2.2  Following the appropriate dissolution  of  the sample, a representa-
tive aliquot  is aspirated  into a nitrous oxide/acetylene flame.  The resulting
absorption of hollow  cathode  radiation   will  be  proportional to the osmium
concentration.  Background correction must be  employed for all analyses.

     2.3  The typical detection  limit   for this  method  is 0.3 mg/L; typical
sensitivity  is  1 mg/L.


3.0   INTERFERENCES

      3.1   Background  correction  is  required because nonspecific  absorption and
light  scattering  can  be  significant at  the analytical wavelength.

      3.2  Due to  the  volatility  of  osmium, standards  must be made on  a  daily
basis,  and  the  applicability of  sample-preparation  techniques  must be verified
for  the sample  matrices  of interest.

      3.3  Samples and standards  should   be monitored  for viscosity differences
that may alter the aspiration rate.

      3.4  Osmium and its  compounds  are  extremely  toxic;  therefore,  extreme
 care must be taken to ensure  that  samples and standards are handled properly
 and that all exhaust gases are properly vented.
                                   7550 - 1
                                                          Revision      0
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1  Atomic  absorption  spectrophotometer;     Single-   or  dual-channel,
single- or  double-beam  Instrument  with  a  grating monochromator,  photomul-
tipller detector, adjustable slits, and provisions for background correction.

     4.2  Osmium hollow cathode lamp.

     4.3  Strip-chart recorder (optional).


5.0  REAGENTS

     5-l  ASTM Type II water  (ASTM  D1193):    Water  should be monitored for
Impurities.

     5-2  Concentrated  nitric  add  (HN03) :     Add  should  be  analyzed to
determine levels of impurities.  TT a  method  blank using  the acide 1s 
-------
     6.4  Nonaqueous  samples  shall   be   refrigerated,   when  possible,   and
analyzed as soon as possible.


7.0  PROCEDURE

     7.1  Sample preparation;  Aqueous samples should be prepared according to
the procedure describedTTT Paragraph  7.2.    Sludge-type  samples should be
prepared according to Method 3050;  samples containing oils, greases, or waxes
may be prepared according  to  Method  3040.    The  applicability of a sample
preparation technique to a new  matrix  type must be demonstrated by analyzing
spiked samples, relevant standard reference materials, or both.

     7.2  Sample preparation of aqueous samples;

          7.2.1  Transfer a  representative  100-mL  aliquot  of the well-mixed
     sample to a Griffin beaker and add 1 ml of concentrated HN03.

          7.2.2  Place the beaker on  a steam bath or hot plate and warm for 15
     m1n.  Cool the  beaker and,   1f   necessary, filter or centrifuge to remove
     Insoluble material.

           7.2.3  Add 1 ml of concentrated H2S04  and adjust the volume back to
     100  ml.   The  sample 1s  now ready for analysis.

     7.3   The 290.0-nm  wavelength   line  and  background   correction  shall be
 employed.

     7.4   A  fuel-rich nitrous  oxide/acetylene  flame  shall  be  used.

     7.5   Follow  the  manufacturer's  operating   Instructions  for  all  other
 Instrument parameters.

     7.6   Either  (1)  run   a   series  of  osmium   standards   and  construct  a
 calibration  curve  by plotting  the  concentrations  of the standards  against the
 absorbances,   or  (2)  for   the  method  of  standard  additions,  plot   added
 concentration versus  absorbance.    For  Instruments  that  read  directly in
 concentration,  set the curve corrector to read out the proper concentration.

      7.7   Analyze  all EP extracts,  all  samples analyzed as part of  a deli sting
 petition, and all  samples  that suffer  from matrix interferences by the  method
 of standard  additions.

      7.8  Duplicates, spiked samples, and  check standards should be routinely
 analyzed.

      7.9  Calculate metal   concentrations;     (1)   by  the  method  of standard
 additions, (2) from a calibration curve,  or (3)  directly from the instrument's
 concentration read-out.  All dilution  or  concentration factors must be taken
 into account.
                                   7550 - 3
                                                          Revision
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

     8.1  All quality control data should be maintained and available for easv
reference or Inspection.                                                     J

     8.2  Calibration curves must be  composed  of  a  minimum  of a blank and
three standards.   A  calibration  curve  should  be  made  for  every hour of
continuous sample analysis.

     8.3  Dilute samples  1f  they  are  more  concentrated  than  the highest
standard or 1f they fall on the plateau of a calibration curve.

     8.4  Employ a minimum  of  one  blank  per  sample  batch to determine 11 f
contamination or any memory effects are occurring.

     8.5  Verify calibration  with  an  Independently  prepared check standard
every 15 samples.


     8.6  Run one spike duplicate sample  for  every  10 samples.  A duplicate
sample  1s  a  sample  brought  through  the  entire  sample  preparation  arid
analytical process.


 u n8:7  Th! method of  standard  additions  (see  Method  7000, Section 8.7)
shall be used for the analysis  of  all EP extracts, on all analyses submitted
as part of a deli sting  petition,  and  whenever  a new sample matrix 1s belnq
analyzed.                                                                    a


9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

     9.1  Precision and accuracy data are not available at this time.


10.0 REFERENCES


                "         	                   :, EPA-600/4-82-055,
                                 7550 - 4
                                                        Revision      o
                                                        Date  September 1986

-------
                                         METHOD 7550

                    OSMIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION.  DIRECT  ASPIRATION  METHOD)
        Samples containing
          oils,  greases.   .-
        	or Maxes   ^  Type of
                             for sample
                            preparation
                  Sludge-type
                    samples
 7. 1 I


Use Method 3O40
7.2.1
     I  Transfer
     aliquot of
      sample to
    beaker:  add
     cone. HN0.3
                          7.2.2
                                                     7.3-5
                                                         Adjust
                                                       Instrument
                                                       parameters
 7.1 I


Use Method 3050
                            Harm Beaker;
                          cool and filter
                            if necessary
                          7.2.3
                              Add cone.
                           HjSO.,:  adjust
                               volume
                                                                               7.6
                                Plot
                            calibration
                               curve
                                                                               7.7
                                                           Analyze
                                                       by method of
                                                          standard
                                                         additions
                                                                               7.8
                                                         (Routinely
                                                         1  analyze
                                                        duplicates.
                                                     spiked samples
                                                         and check
                                                         standards
   o
                                                                               7.9
                                                                              Calculate metal
                                                                              concentrations
                                                                             (     Stop      J
                                      7550 - 5
                                                                 Revision       0
                                                                 Date   September  1986

-------
                                 METHOD  7610

              POTASSIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION. DIRECT  ASPIRATION)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  See Section 3.0 of Method 7000 if interferences are suspected.

     3  2  In air/acetylene or  other  high-temperature flames (>2800»C), potas-
sium can  experience  partial   ionization,  which indirectly affects absorption
sensitivity.  The presence of  other alkali salts in the sample can reduce this
ionization  and  thereby  enhance analytical results.  The ionization-suppressive
effect  of sodium is  small  if the ratio   of  Na to  K is under 10.  Any enhance-
ment due  to sodium can  be stabilized  by adding excess sodium  (1,000 ug/mL) to
both sample and standard solutions.     If more stringent  control of ionization
is required,  the addition  of   cesium   should  be  considered.   Reagent b anks
should  be analyzed to  correct  for potassium  impurities in the  buffer stock.


 4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

      4.1  For basic apparatus, see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.

      4.2  Instrument parameters  (general):

           4.2.1  Potassium hollow cathode lamp.
           4.2.2  Wavelength:   766.5 nm.
           4.2.3  Fuel:  Acetylene.
           4.2.4  Oxldant:  Air.
           4.2.5  Type  of flame:  Slightly oxidizing (fuel lean).
           4.2.6  Background correction:  Not required.


  5.0  REAGENTS

      5.1  See  Section  5.0  of  Method 7000.
                                    7610 - 1
                                                           Revision
                                                           Date  September 1986

-------
     5.2   Preparation of standards;


     /   T5:?'1, Stock Solut1on:  Dissolve 1.907  g of potassium chloride, KC1
     (analytical reagent grade), dried at litre in Type II water and dilute to
     1 liter with Type II water.   Alternatively, procure a certified standard
     from  a supplier and verify by comparison with a second standard.


       nu5'?:2  RrePare  dilutions  of  the  stock  solution  to  be  used as
     Cu  ?ratlon standards at the time of analysis.  The calibration standards
     should  be  prepared  using  the  same  type  of  acid  and  at  the same
     concentration  as  will  result  in  the  sample  to  be  analyzed  after
     processing.                                                   J



6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING


     6.1   See Chapter Three, Section 3.1.3,  Sample Handling and Preservation.



7.0  PROCEDURE


     7.1   Sample preparation:  The  procedures  for  preparation of the sample
are given  m Chapter Three,  Section 3.2.                                 »«ivie


     7.2   See Method 7000,  Paragraph 7.2, Direct Aspiration.



8.0  QUALITY CONTROL


     8.1   See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.



9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE


     9.1   The performance characteristics for an aqueous sample free of inter-
TGPGnCcS cllTC I


     Optimum concentration  range:   0.1-2  mg/L with a wavelength of 766.5 nm.
     Sensitivity:  0.04 mg/L.
     Detection limit:  0.01  mg/L.


   + 9*?*iln *  single  laboratory,   analysis  of  a mixed industrial-domestic
waste effluent  digested with Method  3010,   at  concentrations of 1.6 and 6.3
mg/L gave  standard deviations of  +0.2  and  +0.5,  respectively.  Recoveries at
these levels were 103% and  102%, respectively.                       vci .« du



10.0 REFERENCES


                                                           '  ™-600/4-82-055.
                                  7610 - 2

                                                         Revision       0
                                                         Date   September  1986

-------
                 METHOD 761O

POTASSIUM  (ATOMIC ABSORPTION. DIRECT  ASPIRATION)
               C
5.0 j
Prepare
standards


7.1 1
1 For
sample
preparation 'see
chapter 3.
section 3.2

7.2


Analyze using
Method 7OOO.
Section 7.2
                f     Stop      J
               7610 - 3
                                        Revision       0
                                        Date  September 1986

-------
                                 METHOD 7740

               SELENIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION.  FURNACE TECHNIQUE)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  Method  7740  1s  an   atomic   absorption  procedure  approved  for
determining  the  concentration  of  selenium  in  wastes,   mobility-procedure
extracts, soils, and  ground  water.    All   samples  must   be subjected to an
appropriate dissolution step prior to analysis.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  Prior to analysis by Method 7740,   samples must be prepared 1n order
to convert organic forms of  selenium  to inorganic forms,  to minimize organic
interferences, and to convert samples to suitable solutions for analysis.  The
sample-preparation procedure varies, depending on  the sample matrix.  Aqueous
samples are  subjected  to  the  acid-digestion  procedure  described  in this
method.  Sludge samples are  prepared  using the procedure described in Method
3050.

     2.2  Following the appropriate dissolution  of  the sample, a representa-
tive aliquot 1s placed manually  or  by  means  of an automatic sampler Into a
graphite tube  furnace.    The  sample  aliquot  is  then  slowly evaporated to
dryness, charred  (ashed),  and   atomized.    The  absorption of lamp radiation
during  atomization will be proportional to  the selenium concentration.

     2.3  The  typical detection  limit  for this method is 2 ug/L.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1   Elemental   selenium  and many    of    its  compounds  are  volatile;
therefore,   samples   may  be   subject   to   losses   of   selenium during  sample
preparation.   Spike  samples   and  relevant  standard reference materials  should
be processed to determine if  the chosen dissolution method  is  appropriate.

     3.2  Likewise,   caution   must  be   employed    during   the selection  of
temperature and times for the  dry  and  char   (ash)  cycles.   A nickel  nitrate
solution must  be  added   to   all   dlgestates   prior  to  analysis to  minimize
volatilization losses during  drying and ashing.

      3.3  In addition to  the   normal  interferences experienced during  graphite
 furnace  analysis,   selenium   analysis  can  suffer  from   severe   nonspecific
 absorption  and  light   scattering   caused   by    matrix  components  during
 atomization.  Selenium analysis is  particularly susceptible to these  problems
 because of its low analytical  wavelength (196.0 nm).   Simultaneous background
 correction is required to avoid  erroneously  high  results.   High iron levels
 can   give  overcorrectlon  with   deuterium  background.    Zeeman  background
 correction can be useful  in this situation.
                                   7740 - 1
                                                          Revision      0
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
     3.4  If the analyte is  not  completely  volatilized and removed from the
furnace during atomlzatlon, memory effects  will   occur.   If this situation 1s
detected, the tube should be cleaned by operating the furnace at full power at
regular intervals 1n the analytical scheme.

     3.5  Selenium analysis suffers  Interference  from  chlorides (>800 mg/L)
and sulfate (>200 mg/L).  The  addition  of nickel nitrate such that the final
concentration is 1% nickel will lessen this interference.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1  250-mL Griffin beaker.

     4.2  10-mL volumetric flasks.

     4.3  Atomic  absorption  spectrophotometer;     Single-  or  dual-channel,
single- or double-beam  instrument  with  a grating monochromator, photomulti-
plier detector,  adjustable  slits,  a  wavelength  range  of  190-800 nm, and
provisions for  simultaneous  background  correction  and  interfacing  with a
strip-chart recorder.

     4.4  Selenium hollow cathode lamp, or electrode! ess  discharge lamp (EDL) ;
EDLs provide better sensitivity for the analysis  of Se.                  -

     4.5  Graphite furnace;  Any graphite  furnace device with the appropriate
temperature and timing controls.

     4.6  Strip-chart  recorder;    A  recorder  is  strongly  recommended for
furnace work so that there will be a permanent record and so that any problems
with the  analysis,  such  as  drift,  incomplete  atomlzation,  losses during
charring, changes in sensitivity, etc., can easily be recognized.

     4.7  Pi pets;  Microliter with disposable tips.  Sizes can range from
5 to 1,000 uL, as required.


5.0  REAGENTS

     5.1  ASTM Type II water  (ASTM  D1193):   Water  should be monitored for
impurities.
     5.2  Concentrated  nitric  acid  (HNOa) :     Acid  should  be  analyzed to
determine levels of impurities.  TTa method blank made with the acid is 
-------
     5.4  Selenium standard stock  solution  (1,000  mg/L):    Either procure a
certified aqueous standard fromasupplier  and  verify by comparison with a
second standard, or dissolve 0.3453  g  of  selenlous add (actual  assay 94.6%
H2Se03, analyticaT~reagent grade) or equivalent 1n Type II water and dilute to
200 ml.

     5.5  Nickel nitrate solution  (5%):    Dissolve  24.780  g of ACS reagent
grade Ni(N03)2'6H20 or equivalent in Type II water and dilute to 100 ml.

     5.6  Nickel nitrate solution (1%):  Dilute 20 mL of the 5% nickel nitrate
to 100 ml with Type II water.

     5.7  Selenium working standards;  Prepare dilutions of the stock solution
to be used as calibration  standards  at  the  time of the analysis.  Withdraw
appropriate aliquots  of the stock solution,  add  1 ml of  concentrated HNO?,
2 ml  of 30% H202,  and 2 mL  of the 5%  nickel nitrate  solution.   Dilute to
100 ml with Type II water.

     5.8  Air;  Cleaned and  dried  through  a  suitable filter to remove oil,
water, and other foreign substances.    The  source  may  be a compressor or a
cylinder of industrial-grade compressed air.

     5.9  Hydrogen;  Suitable for instrumental analysis.


6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

     6.1  All samples must  have  been  collected  using  a sampling plan that
addresses the considerations discussed in Chapter Nine of this manual.

     6.2  All sample containers must be  prewashed with detergents, acids,  and
Type II water.  Plastic and glass containers are both suitable.

     6.3  Special  containers  (e.g.,  containers  used  for  volatile organic
analysis) may have to be used  if  very  volatile selenium compounds are to be
analyzed.

     6.4  Aqueous samples must be acidified to a pH of <2 with nitric acid.

     6.5  Nonaqueous  samples  shall  be   refrigerated,  when  possible,  and
analyzed as soon as possible.


7.0  PROCEDURE

     7.1  Sample preparation;    Aqueous  samples  should  be  prepared in the
manner described inSteps7.1.1  to  7.1.3.    Sludge-type samples should be
prepared according to Method 3050.   The applicability of a sample-preparation
technique to a  new  matrix  type  must  be  demonstrated  by analyzing spiked
samples and/or relevant standard reference materials.
                                  7740 - 3
                                                         Revision
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
          7.1.1   Transfer 100 ml  of  well-mixed   sample   to   a  250-mL  Griffin
     beaker;  add 2 ml of 30%  ^02  and  sufficient concentrated  HNOs  to result
     in an acid  concentration of 1%  (v/v).   Heat  for  1  hr  at  95'C  or  until  the
     volume is slightly less than 50 ml.

          7.1.2   Cool and bring back to  50 ml with Type II water.

          7.1.3   Pi pet 5 ml of this   digested solution  into a 10-mL volumetric
     flask, add  1 ml of the  1%  nickel   nitrate  solution, and dilute to 10 ml.
     with Type II water.    The  sample   is  now   ready for injection into  the
     furnace.

     7.2  The 196.0-nm wavelength line and a background correction system must
be employed.  Follow the  manufacturer's suggestions  for all  other spectropho-
tometer parameters.

     7.3  Furnace parameters suggested by  the manufacturer should be employed
as  guidelines.     Because   temperature-sensing   mechanisms   and   temperature
controllers can vary between  instruments  or  with  time, the validity of  the
furnace parameters must be  periodically  confirmed by  systematically altering
the furnace parameters while analyzing a  standard.  In this  manner,  losses of
analyte due to overly high  temperature  settings or losses in sensitivity  due
to less than  optimum  settings  can  be  minimized.    Similar verification of
furnace parameters may be required for complex sample matrices.

     7.4  Inject a measured uL-aliquot of sample  into the furnace  and atomize.
If the concentration found is  greater  than  the highest standard, the sample
should be diluted in the same acid matrix and reanalyzed.   The use of multiple
injections can improve accuracy and help detect furnace pipetting  errors.

     7.5  Analyze all EP extracts, all samples analyzed as part  of a  deli sting
petition, and all samples that suffer  from matrix interferences by the method
of standard additions.

     7.6  Run a check standard after approximately every 10 sample injections.
Standards are run in part to monitor  the life and performance of  the graphite
tube.  Lack of reproducibility  or  significant  change  in the  signal  for  the
standard indicates that the tube should be replaced.

     7.7  Duplicates, spiked samples, and  check   standards should be analyzed
every 20 samples.

     7.8  Calculate metal  concentrations:    (1)  by  the method of standard
additions, (2) from a calibration curve, or (3) directly from the  instrument's
concentration read-out.  All dilution  or  concentration factors must be taken
into account.
                                  7740 - 4
                                                         Revision      0
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

     8.1  All quality control data should be maintained and available for easy
reference or inspection.

     8.2  Calibration curves must be  composed  of  a  minimum  of a blank and
three standards.   A  calibration  curve  should  be  made  for  every hour of
continuous sample analysis.

     8.3  Dilute samples  if  they  are  more  concentrated  than  the highest
standard or if they fall on the plateau of a calibration curve.

     8.4  Employ a minimum  of  one  blank  per  sample  batch to determine if
contamination or any memory effects are occurring.

     8.5  Verify calibration  with  an  independently  prepared check standard
every 15 samples.

     8.6  Run one spike duplicate sample  for  every  10 samples.  A duplicate
sample  is  a  sample  brought  through  the  entire  sample  preparation  and
analytical process.

     8.7  The method of  standard  additions  (see  Method  7000, Section 8.7)
shall be used for the analysis  of  all EP extracts, on all analyses submitted
as part of a deli sting  petition,  and  whenever  a new sample matrix is being
analyzed.


9.0  METHOD  PERFORMANCE

     9.1  Precision and accuracy data are available in Method 270.2 of Methods
for  Chemical Analysis of Water  and Wastes.

     9.2  The data shown in  Table  1  were  obtained from  records of state and
contractor laboratories.   The data are  intended  to show  the precision of the
combined sample preparation  and analysis method.


10.0 REFERENCES

1.   Methods for  Chemical   Analysis  of  Water   and Wastes, EPA-600/4-82-055,
December 1982, Method 270.2.

2.   Gaskill, A., Compilation and Evaluation  of  RCRA Method Performance Data,
Work Assignment No. 2,  EPA Contract No. 68-01-7075, September 1986.
                                   7740 - 5
                                                         Revision
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
                      TABLE 1.  METHOD PERFORMANCE DATA
       Sample                      Preparation                Laboratory
       Matrix                        Method                   Replicates


Emission control dust                 3050                    14,  11 ug/g
                                  7740 - 6
                                                         Revision
                                                         Date  September  1986

-------
                 METHOD 7740

SELENIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION.  FURNACE  METHOO)
                Type of  sample
                  for sample
                 preparat ion
                                 Sludge-type
                                   samples
               7. 1 . 11  Transfer
              	—I  portion
                 of  sample  to
               beaker:  add 30X
                HzOi  and  cone.
                   HNO,
                         neat
7. 1
Prepare sample
 according to
 Method 3OSO
               7.1.2
                Cool:  bring  to
                    volume
               7.1.3
                       Plpet
                      digested
                      solution
               into  flask:  add
                nickel  nitrate
               solution:dilute
                7740 -  7
                                           Revision       0
                                           Date   September  1986

-------
                                        METHOD  7740

                       SELENIUM (ATOMIC  ABSORPTION.  FURNACE METHOD)
                                        (ContInued)
7.2
Set Instrument
  parameters
7.3
                                                                             7.5
                                                                               by
                                                          Analyze
                                                         method  of
                                                         standard
                                                         addition
  Periodically
check validity
   of furnace
   parameters
                                                                             7.6
                                                          Run
                                                    check  standard
                                                   after  10  sample
                                                      In)ections
7.4
Inject sample
into furnace:
   atomize
     Is
concentration
  > highest
  standard?
Dilute sample
and reanalyze
                                                                             7.7
                                                         Routinely
                                                        '  analyze
                                                       duplicates.
                                                   spiked  samples.
                                                       and check
                                                       standards
                                                                             7.8
Calculate metal
 concentrations
                                                                           f     Stop       J
                                     7740 - 8
                                                                Revision       0
                                                                Date  September  1986

-------
                                 METHOD 7741A

                 SELENIUM  (ATOMIC  ABSORPTION,  GASEOUS  HYDRIDE)


1.0   SCOPE AND APPLICATION

      1.1   Method 7741 is an atomic absorption procedure that is approved for
determining the concentration of selenium in wastes, mobility-procedure extracts,
soils, and ground water, provided that the sample matrix does not contain high
concentrations of chromium, copper, mercury, silver,  cobalt,  or molybdenum.  All
samples must be subjected  to  an  appropriate dissolution step prior to analysis.
Spiked  samples  and  relevant  standard reference  materials  are employed  to
determine applicability of the  method  to  a given waste.   If interferences are
present the analyst should consider using Method 7740.

2.0   SUMMARY OF METHOD

      2.1   Samples are prepared according to the nitric/sulfuric  acid digestion
procedure described  in this  method.   Next,  the selenium in  the digestate is
reduced to Se(IV) with  tin chloride.  The Se(IV) is then converted to a volatile
hydride  with  hydrogen produced  from a  zinc/HCl   or sodium  borohydrate/HCl
reaction.

      2.2   The volatile hydride  is swept into an argon-hydrogen flame located
in the  optical  path  of an atomic  absorption  spectrophotometer;  the resulting
absorbance is proportional to the selenium concentration.

      2.3   The typical detection limit for this method is 0.002 mg/L.

3.0   INTERFERENCES

      3.1   High concentrations  of chromium, cobalt, copper, mercury, molybdenum,
nickel, and silver can cause analytical interferences.

      3.2   Traces of  nitric acid left following the sample work-up can result
in analytical  interferences.  Nitric  acid  must be distilled off the sample by
heating the sample until fumes  of S03 are observed.

      3.3   Elemental selenium and many of its compounds are volatile; therefore,
certain samples may be subject to  losses of selenium during sample preparation.

4.0   APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

      4.1   100-mL beaker.

      4.2   Electric  hot  plate or  equivalent -  Adjustable  and   capable  of
maintaining a temperature of 90-95°C.

      4.3   A commercially available zinc slurry hydride generator or  a generator
constructed from the following  material (see Figure 1):
                                   7741A -  1                       Revision 1
                                                                  September 1994

-------
            4.3.1    Medicine dropper:  Fitted  into  a  size "0" rubber  stopper
      capable of delivering  1.5 ml.

            4.3.2    Reaction flask:   50-mL,  pear-shaped, with two 14/20  necks
      (Scientific Glass, JM-5835).

            4.3.3   Gas inlet-outlet tube:  Constructed from a  micro cold-finger
      condenser  (JM-3325)  by cutting  the  portion below the 14/20 ground-glass
      joint.

            4.3.4   Magnetic stirrer:  To homogenize the zinc slurry.

            4.3.5   Polyethylene drying tube:   10-cm,  filled with glass  wool to
      prevent particulate matter from entering the burner.

            4.3.6   Flow meter:  Capable of measuring 1 liter/min.

      4.4   Atomic absorption spectrophotometer:  Single or dual channel,  single-
or double-beam instrument with a grating monochromator, photomultipl ier detector,
adjustable  slits,   a  wavelength  range  of  190-800  nm,   and provisions for
interfacing with a  strip-chart recorder  and simultaneous background correction.

      4.5   Burner:  Recommended by the particular instrument manufacturer for
the argon-hydrogen flame.

      4.6   Selenium hollow cathode lamp or electrodeless discharge lamp.

      4.7   Strip-chart recorder (optional).

5.0   REAGENTS

      5.1   Reagent water:  Water should be monitored for impurities.   Reagent
water will  be interference  free.   All  references to  water will refer to  reagent
water.

      5.2   Concentrated nitric  acid:   Acid  should be  analyzed  to  determine
levels of impurities.   If a method blank  made with the acid is 
-------
      5.7   Stannous chloride  solution:    Dissolve  100 g  SnCl2  in 100  ml  of
concentrated HC1.

      5.8   Selenium standard  stock  solution:    1,000 mg/L  solution may  be
purchased, or prepared as follows:  Dissolve 0.3453 g of selenious acid  (assay
94.6% of H2Se03) in  reagent  water.  Add to a 200-mL volumetric flask and bring
to volume (1 ml = 1 mg Se).

6.0   SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

      6.1   All samples  must have  been  collected  using a  sampling  plan that
addresses the considerations discussed in Chapter Nine of this manual.

      6.2   All sample containers must be prewashed with detergents, acids, and
reagent water.  Plastic and glass containers are both suitable.

      6.3   Special  containers  (e.g.,  containers  used  for  volatile organic
analysis) may  have  to  be used  if very volatile selenium  compounds  are  to be
analyzed.

      6.4   Aqueous samples must  be acidified to a pH of <2 with nitric  acid.

      6.5   Nonaqueous samples  shall be refrigerated, when possible, and analyzed
as soon as possible.

7.0   PROCEDURE

      7.1   Sample preparation:

            7.1.1   To  a  50-mL aliquot of digested sample (or, in the case of
      extracts, a 50-mL sample)   add  10 mL of  concentrated HN03   and 12 mL of
      18 N H2S04.   Evaporate the  sample on a hot plate until white S03  fumes are
      observed  (a  volume  of about 20 mL).  Do  not let it  char.    If  it  chars,
      stop the  digestion, cool, and add additional  HN03.  Maintain  an  excess of
      HN03 (evidence of brown fumes) and do not  let the solution darken because
      selenium  may  be  reduced  and lost.   When the sample remains  colorless or
      straw yellow during evolution of S03 fumes, the digestion is complete.

            Caution: Venting reaction  vessels should be done  with
            caution and only under  a  fume  hood  or well ventilated
            area.

            7.1.2    Cool  the sample,  add about 25 mL reagent  water,  and again
      evaporate to S03 fumes just to expel  oxides of nitrogen.  Cool.   Add 40 mL
      concentrated HC1  and  bring  to a  volume  of 100 mL with  reagent water.

      7.2   Prepare working standards from the standard stock solutions.  The
following procedures provide standards  in  the optimum  range.

            7.2.1    To prepare  a working  stock solution,  pipet 1 mL  standard
      stock solution (see Paragraph 5.8)  into  a  1-liter volumetric flask.  Bring
      to  volume with  reagent water containing  1.5 mL  concentrated HN03/liter.
      The  concentration  of this solution  is  1  mg Se/L  (1  mL =  1  ug  Se).

                                   7741A - 3                       Revision  1
                                                                   September 1994

-------
             7.2.2   Prepare six working standards  by transferring 0,  0.5, 1.0,
       1.5,  2.0,  and 2.5 ml of the working stock solution (see Paragraph 7.2.1)
       into   100-mL  volumetric  flasks.    Bring  to  volume  with  diluent.    The
       concentrations of these working standards are 0, 5, 10, 15, 20,  and 25 ug
       Se/L.

       7.3    Standard additions:

             7.3.1     Take the  15-,  20-,  and  25-ug standards  and  transfer
       quantitatively 25 ml from each into separate 50-mL volumetric flasks.  Add
       10 ml  of the  prepared sample to each.  Bring to volume with reagent  water
       containing  1.5 ml  HN03/liter.

             7.3.2   Add 10 ml of prepared sample to  a 50-mL  volumetric flask.
       Bring  to volume with reagent water containing 1.5 ml HN03/liter.   This is
       the blank.

       7.4    Follow  the  manufacturer's   instructions  for operating  an  argon-
 hydrogen flame.   The argon-hydrogen flame  is  colorless;  therefore,  it may  be
 useful  to  aspirate  a low  concentration  of  sodium  to ensure that ignition  has
 occurred.

       7.5    The 196.0-nm wavelength shall be used for the analysis of selenium.

       7.6    Transfer  a 25-mL  portion of  the digested  sample or standard to  the
 reaction vessel.   Add 0.5 ml SnCl2 solution.  Allow at  least 10 min for the  metal
 to be reduced to  its lowest oxidation state.  Attach the  reaction  vessel to  the
 special gas  inlet-outlet glassware.  Fill  the medicine dropper  with   1.50  ml
 sodium  borohydrate  or zinc slurry  that  has been kept in  suspension  with  the
 magnetic stirrer.  Firmly insert the stopper containing the medicine dropper into
 the side neck of  the reaction vessel.   Squeeze the bulb  to introduce the zinc
 slurry  or sodium  borohydrate  into the sample or standard solution.   The  metal
 hydride will produce a peak almost immediately.  When the recorder pen  returns
 partway to the base line,  remove  the reaction vessel.

 8.0   QUALITY CONTROL

      8tl  Refer  to section 8.0 of Method 7000.

 9.0   METHOD PERFORMANCE

      9.1   Precision and accuracy data are available in Method 270.3 of Methods
 for Chemical Analysis of Water and Wastes.

 10.0  REFERENCES

 1.    Methods for Chemical Analysis  of  Water  and  Wastes,  EPA-600/4-82-055
December 1982,  Method 270.3.
                                  7741A - 4                       Revision 1
                                                                  September 1994

-------
                         METHOD 7741A
    SELENIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION, GASEOUS HYDRIDE)
                       C
Standard Preparation
;

7.2.1 Pipet
stock
solution into
flask; bring
to volume


7.2.2 Prepare 6
Se working
standards from
stock; bring to
volume




7.3.1 Transfer
3 standard
portions , add
sample, bring to
volume

Sample

7.1.1 Stop
digestion , cool ,
add HNO.


Preparation
i
Yes


7.1.1 Add
concentrated
H.SO. and HNO,
to sample and
evaporate
/ Did >v
^ sample j
^. char? /
JNo
7.1.2 Cool
sample, add
evaporate, cool
   7.3.2 To
 prepare blank
add sample to a
flask and bring
   to volume
  7.4 Follow
 instructions
 for operating
argon-hydrogen
    flame
 7.5 Use 196.0
 nm wavelength
                          7.1.2 Add
                        concentrated
                        HC1 and bring
                          to volume
 7.6 Transfer
digested sampli
  to reaction
  vessel,add
    SnCl.
                         7.6 Allow to
                         stand,attach
                          vessel to
                         glassware,add
                          2n slurry
                         7.6 Record  Se
                         concentration
                        C  Stop
                           7741A  - 5
                                           Revision  1
                                           Septenter 1994

-------
                                 METHOD  7742

              SELENIUM  (ATOMIC ABSORPTION,  BOROHYDRIDE  REDUCTION)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

      1.1  Method 7742  is an atomic  absorption procedure for determining 3/vg/L
to 750 fjg/l concentrations of selenium in wastes, mobility procedure extracts,
soils, and  ground water.   Method  7742  is  approved for  sample  matrices  that
contain  a  total  of up  to 1000 mg/L  concentrations of cobalt,  copper,  iron,
mercury,  and  nickel.  A solid sample  can contain up  to  10% by  weight  of the
interferents  before  exceeding  1000 mg/L in a  digested  sample.    All  samples
including aqueous matrices must  be  subjected to  an appropriate dissolution step
prior to  analysis. Spiked samples and relevant standard reference materials are
employed to determine the applicability of the method to a given waste.

2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

      2.1  Samples are  prepared according to the  nitric acid digestion procedure
described   in  Method   3010   for   aqueous  and  extract  samples   and   the
nitric/peroxide/hydrochloric acid digestion procedure described in Method 3050
(furnace AA option)  for  sediments,  soils, and  sludges.   Excess  peroxide is
removed  by  evaporating  samples  to  near-dryness at  the  end of  the digestion
followed by dilution to volume  and  degassing the samples upon addition of urea.
The selenium  is  converted to the +4 oxidation  state  during  digestion in HC1.
After a 1:10 dilution,  selenium is  then converted to its volatile hydride using
hydrogen  produced  from  the  reaction  of  the   acidified  sample  with  sodium
borohydride in a  continuous-flow hydride generator.

      2.2   The volatile hydrides are   swept into,  and decompose in,  a heated
quartz absorption cell  located  in  the  optical  path of  an  atomic absorption
spectrophotometer.    The   resulting   absorption  of  the  lamp  radiation  is
proportional  to the selenium concentration.

      2.3   The typical  detection limit for  this  method is 3 /vg/L.

3.0   INTERFERENCES

      3.1   Very  high  (>1000  mg/L) concentrations  of cobalt,  copper,   iron,
mercury, and, nickel  can cause analytical interferences through  precipitation as
reduced metals and associated blockage of  transfer  lines  and fittings.

      3.2   Traces of peroxides left following the sample  work-up can  result in
analytical  interferences.  Peroxides must be removed by evaporating each sample
to  near-dryness  followed  by  reacting  each  sample  with  urea  and  allowing
sufficient  time  for degassing before analysis (see  Sections 7.1  and 7.2).

      3.3   Even  after  acid digestion, flame gases  and  organic compounds may
remain  in  the sample.   Flame  gases  and organic compounds can  absorb at the
analytical  wavelengths  and  background  correction should be used.

                                    7742-1                         Revision 0
                                                                   September 1994

-------
4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

      4.1  Electric  hot  plate:   Large enough to hold at  least  several  100 ml
Pyrex digestion beakers.

      4.2   A  continuous-flow hydride  generator:    A commercially  available
continuous-flow  sodium  borohydride/HCl  hydride  generator  or  a  generator-
constructed similarly to that shown in  Figure 1 (P. S. Analytical or equivalent).

            4.2.1  Peristaltic Pump: A four-channel, variable-speed peristaltic
      pump to permit regulation of liquid-stream flow rates (Ismatec Reglo-100
      or equivalent).  Pump  speed and tubing diameters should be  adjusted to
      provide  the  following  flow rates:   sample/blank  flow =  4.2  mL/min;
      borohydride flow  =  2.1  mL/min.

            4.2.2  Sampling Valve  (optional):    A sampling valve (found in the
      P.  S.  Analytical Hydride Generation System  or equivalent)  that  allows
      switching between samples and blanks (rinse solution) without  introduction
      of air into the system  will  provide more  signal  stability.

            4.2.3  Transfer Tubing and  Connectors:  Transfer tubing (1 mm I.D.),
      mixing  T's,  and connectors  are made of  fluorocarbon  (PFA or  TFM)  and are
      of compatible  sizes to  form tight,  leak-proof  connections  (Latchat,
      Technicon,  etc. flow injection apparatus  accessories or  equivalent).

            4.2.4  Mixing Coil:  A 20-turn coil made by wrapping transfer tubing
      around  a  1-cm diameter  by  5-cm long plastic or  glass rod (see  Figure 1).

            4.2.5   Mixing Coil  Heater,  if appropriate:   A 250-mL  Erlenmeyer
      flask containing  100 mL of  water  heated  to boiling  on  a dedicated  one-
      beaker  hotplate (Corning  PC-35 or  equivalent).   The  mixing coil in 4.2.4
      is  immersed in the boiling water to speed  kinetics of the hydride  forming
      reactions  and  increase   solubility   of  interfering   reduced  metal
      precipitates.

           4.2.6   Gas-Liquid Separator:   A glass apparatus for collecting  and
      separating  liquid  and gaseous products  (P. S.  Analytical  accessory or
      equivalent) which allows the liquid fraction to drain to waste and gaseous
      products  above the liquid to be  swept by a regulated carrier gas  (argon)
      out of  the  cell for  analysis.  To  avoid undue carrier gas dilution,  the
      gas volume above the liquid should  not  exceed  20 mL.   See Figure 1 for an
      acceptable separator shape.

           4.2.7   Condenser:   Moisture  picked up by  the  carrier  gas must be
      removed before  encountering  the  hot absorbance  cell.  The  moist carrier
      gas with the hydrides is dried by passing the gasses  through a small (< 25
      mL) volume condenser coil  (Ace Glass Model  6020-02 or equivalent) that is
      cooled to 5°C  by a  water  chiller (Neslab RTE-110 or equivalent).  Cool tap-
      water in  place of a chiller  is acceptable.
                                   7742-2                        Revision 0
                                                                 September 1994

-------
            4.2.8  Flow Meter/Regulator:  A meter capable of regulating up to 1
      L/min of argon carrier gas is recommended.

      4.3  Absorbance Cell:  A 17-cm or longer quartz tube T-cell (windowless is
strongly suggested) is recommended, as shown  in  Figure  1  (Varian  Model  VGA-76
accessory or equivalent).   The  cell  is  held in place by a holder that positions
the cell  about 1  cm  over a conventional  AA air-acetylene  burner head.   In
operation, the cell is heated to around 900°C.

      4.4   Atomic  absorption  spectrophotometer:    Single-  or  dual-  channel,
single-'or double-beam instrument having a grating monochromator, photomultiplier
detector, adjustable slits, a wavelength  range of 190 to 800 nm, and provisions
for interfacing with  an appropriate recording device.

      4.5  Burner:  As recommended by the  particular instrument manufacturer for
an air-acetylene flame.  An appropriate mounting  bracket attached  to the burner
that suspends the quartz absorbance cell between  1 and 2 cm above the burner slot
is required.

      4 6  Selenium hollow cathode lamp or selenium  electrodeless discharge lamp
and  power  supply.    Super-charged  hollow-cathode  lamps  or  EDL lamps  are
recommended  for maximum sensitivity.

      4.7     Strip-chart   recorder  (optional):       Connect  to  output  of
spectrophotometer.

5.0  REAGENTS

      5.1   Reagent water  :  Water must be monitored for impurities.  Refer to
Chapter  1  for  definition  of  Reagent water.

      5.2   Concentrated nitric  acid (HN03):   Acid must  be  analyzed to  determine
levels  of impurities.   If a  method  blank is  
-------
                                QUARTZ CEUL


                                A A  OURHER
                                                                      TO
                                                                    CHILLER
   NaOH,
    OLANK
   SAMPLE
    Kl
  •DISCONNECTS
   OUR INO  S«/So
  .  AMALV8IS
D
                                                               _—» DRAIN
                       20 TURN COIL
                         (TEFLON)
                         HOTPLATE
                         WALWI .
                        (•LANK)
Figure 1.  Continuous-flow sodium borohydride/hydride generator apparatus  setup
and an AAS sample introduction  system
                                     7742-4
                                                     Revision 0
                                                     September 1994

-------
      5.7  4% Sodium Borohydride  (NaBH4):   A 4 % sodium borohydride solution (20
g reagent-grade NaBH4 plus 2 g sodium hydroxide dissolved in 500 ml of reagent
water) must be prepared for conversion of the selenium to its hydride.

      5.8  Selenium solutions:

            5.8.1   Selenium  standard stock solution  (1,000  mg/L):   Either
      procure  certified  aqueous  standards  from  a  supplier   and  verify  by
      comparison with a second standard,  or dissolve  0.3453  g of selemous acid
      (assay 96.6% of H2Se03)  in  200 ml of reagent water (1  ml  =  1  mg Se).

            582    Selenium  working  stock solution:    Pipet  1  ml selenium
      standard stock solution  into  a 1 L volumetric  flask and bring to volume
      with  reagent  water  containing  1.5  ml  concentrated  HN03/liter.   The
      concentration of  this solution  is  1 mg Se/L  (1 ml = 1 fjg Se).

6.0   SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION,  AND HANDLING

      6.1   All  samples must  have  been  collected using  a  sampling plan that
addresses  the  considerations discussed in Chapter  Nine  of this manual.

      6.2  All sample containers must  be prewashed with detergents,  acids, and
reagent'water.   Plastic and glass containers are  both suitable.

      6.3    Special  containers  (e.g.,  containers  used  for  volatile  organic
analysis)  may  have to be used if very volatile  selenium  compounds  are suspected
to  be present  in the samples.

      6.4  Aqueous  samples  must  be  acidified to a pH of <2  with  nitric  acid.

      6.5  Nonaqueous samples shall  be refrigerated, when possible, and analyzed
 as  soon  as possible.

 7.0  PROCEDURE

      7.1  Place a  100-mL portion of  an  aqueous sample or extract or 1.000 g  of
 a dried  solid sample in a 250-mL digestion beaker.   Digest  aqueous samples  and
 extracts according to Method 3010.   Digest solid samples  according to Method 3050
 (furnace AA  option)  with  the following modifications:  add 5 mL of concentrated
 hydrochloric  acid  just prior to the final volume  reduction  stage to aid  in
 conversion of selenium  to its plus four state;  the final volume reduction should
 be to less than  5  mL  but not to dryness to adequately remove  excess hydrogen
 peroxide (see note).  After dilution to volume,  further dilution with diluent may
 be necessary if the analyte is known to  exceed 750 jjg/l or  if interferents are
 expected to  exceed  a  total of 1000 mg/L in the digestate.

             Note:  For  solid digestions, the volume reduction stage is critical
             to  obtain  accurate  data.   Close monitoring  of  each  sample  is
             necessary when this critical stage in the digestion is reached.
                                     7742-5                        Revision 0
                                                                   September 1994

-------
       7.2  Prepare samples for hydride analysis by adding 1.00 g urea,  and 20 ml
 concentrated HC1 to a 5.00 ml aliquot of digested sample in a 50-mL volumetric
 flask.  Heat in a water bath  to dissolve  salts and reduce selenium  (at least 30
 minutes  is suggested).    Bring  flask  to volume  with  reagent water  before
 analyzing.    A  ten-fold  dilution   correction  must  be  made  in  the  final
 concentration calculations.

       7.3  Prepare working standards  from the standard stock selenium solution
 Transfer 0, 0.5,  1.0,  1.5, 2.0,  and 2.5 ml  of standard to  100-mL volumetric
 flasks and bring to volume with diluent.   These concentrations  will  be 0  5  10
 15,  20,  and 25 jjg Se/L.                                                '  '    '

   *u J'l  IfEP  extracts  (Method  1310)  are  being analyzed  for selenium,  the
 method of standard  additions must be used. Spike appropriate amounts of working
 standard selenium  solution to three  25  ml aliquots of each  unknown.   Spiking
 volumes  should be kept less than 0.250 ml to avoid excessive  spikinq  dilution
 errors.

       7.5  Set  up  instrumentation  and hydride  generation  apparatus  and  fill
 reagent  containers.  The sample and  blank  flows should be set around 4.2 mL/min
 and  the  borohydride  flow around  2.1 mL/min.   The argon carrier  gas flow  is
 adjusted to about 200 mL/min.  For the AA,  use the 196.0-nm wavelength and 2 0-nm
 slit width (or manufacturer's recommended slit-width) with background correction
 Begin  all  flows  and allow the instrument to warm-up according  to the instrument
 manufacturer's instructions.

       7.6  Place sample feed line  into a prepared sample solution and start pump
 to  begin hydride generation.  Wait  for  a maximum  steady-state signal on the
 strip-chart recorder.  Switch to blank sample and watch for signal to decline to
 baseline before  switching to  the  next sample  and beginning the  next analysis;
 Run  standards  first (low to high), then  unknowns.   Include appropriate QA/QC
 solutions,  as  required.   Prepare calibration curves and convert  absorbances to
 concentration.   See following analytical  flowchart.

       CAUTION: The hydride of selenium is  very toxic.  Precautions must  be taken
       to  avoid inhaling the gas.

       7.7   If  the method of standard  additions was employed, plot the measured
 concentration  of the  spiked  samples and unspiked sample  versus  the spiked
 concentrations.  The spiked concentration axis intercept will  be the method of
 standard  additions  concentration.   If the plot does not  result in  a straight
 line,  a  nonlinear  interference  is  present.   This problem can  sometimes  be
 overcome  by dilution or addition of other reagents  if  there is some knowledge
 about the waste.   If the method of standard additions was not required, then the
 concentration  is determined from a standard calibration curve.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

      8.1  Refer to Section 8.0 of Method 7000.
                                    7742-6                        Revision 0
                                                                  September 1994

-------
9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

      9.1  The relative standard deviation obtained by a single laboratory for
7 replicates of a contaminated soil was 18% for selenium at 8.2 ug/L  in solution.
The average percent recovery of  the analysis of an 2 jjg/l  spike on ten different
samples is 100.5% for selenium.

10.0  REFERENCES

1.    Methods  for  Chemical  Analysis  of  Water  and  Wastes,   EPA-600/4-82-055,
      December 1982, Method 206.3.

2     "Evaluation of Hydride  Atomic Absorption  Methods for Antimony, Arsenic,
      Selenium, and Tin",  an EMSL-LV internal report  under Contract 68-03-3249,
      Job  Order  70.16,  prepared  for  T.  A.  Hinners  by D.  E.  Dobb,  and J. D.
      Lindner of Lockheed Engineering and Sciences Co., and  L. V.  Beach of the
      Varian Corporation.
                                     7742-7                        Revision 0
                                                                   September 1994

-------
                                 METHOD  7742
SELENIUM  (ATOMIC  ABSORPTION,  BOROHYDRIDE  REDUCTION)
    7.1 Use Method
   3050 (furnace AA
   option) to digest
     1.0 g sample.
       7.1 - 7.4
      Digest with
       H203 as
     described in
     Method 3060.
        7.5 Add
      concentrated
         HCI.
      7.6 Do final
        volume
      reduction and
      dilution, as
       described.
       7.1 Further
       dilute with
        diluent.
                                 7.1 Use
                               Method  3010
                               to digest 100
                                ml sample.
  7.2 Add urea
 and cone. HCI to
  aliquot; heat in
   H2O bath;
 bring to volume.
                                      I
   7.3 Prepare
    working
 standards from
 standard stock
   Se solution.
                                7.4 Use the
                                method of
                                 standard
                                additions on
                               extract*, only.
                                    7.4 Spike 3
                                   aliquot* with
                                     working
                                   standard Se
                                     solution.
                              7.5 -7.6 Analyze
                                the sample
                               using hydride
                                generation
                                apparatus.
7.5 -  7.6 Analyze
  the sample
  using hydride
  generation
  apparatus.
7.7 Determine
     Se
concentrations
  from linear
    plot.
                                  7.7 Determine
                                  Se cone, from
                                    standard
                                   calibration
                                     curve.
                                     Stop
                                       7742-8
                                               Revision 0
                                               September 1994.

-------
                                 METHOD 7760A

                SILVER  (ATOMIC ABSORPTION. DIRECT ASPIRATION)
1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

      1.1 Method 7760 is an atomic absorption procedure approved for determining
the concentration of silver  (CAS  Registry Number 7440-22-4) in wastes, mobility
procedure extracts,  soils, and ground water. All samples must  be subjected to an
appropriate dissolution step prior to analysis.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

      2.1   Prior to analysis by Method 7760,  samples must be prepared  for direct
aspiration. The method of sample preparation will  vary according to the sample
matrix. Aqueous samples are  subjected  to the  acid-digestion procedure described
in this method.

      2.2   Following the appropriate dissolution of the sample, a representative
aliquot  is aspirated  into an  air/acetylene flame.  The resulting absorption of
hollow  cathode radiation will  be proportional to  the  silver  concentration.
Background correction must be employed for all analyses.

      2.3   The typical  detection limit for  this  method is 0.01 mg/L; typical
sensitivity is 0.06 mg/L.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

      3.1  Background correction  is required  because nonspecific absorption and
light scattering may occur at the analytical wavelength.

      3.2  Silver nitrate solutions are light-sensitive and have  the tendency to
plate out on  container walls.  Thus silver  standards  should be stored in brown
bottles.

      3.3  Silver chloride is  insoluble; therefore, hydrochloric acid should be
avoided  unless the  silver is already  in solution as a chloride complex.

      3.4  Samples  and  standards should be monitored for viscosity differences
that may alter the  aspiration rate.


4.0  APPARATUS AND  MATERIALS

      4.1  Atomic absorption spectrophotometer: Single-or dual-channel, single-
or double-beam instrument with a grating monochromator,  photomultiplier detector,
adjustable slits, and  provisions for  background correction.

      4.2  Silver hollow cathode lamp.


                                   7760A -  1                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
      4.3  Strip-chart recorder (optional).

      4.4  Graduated cylinder or equivalent.

      4.5  Hot  plate  or equivalent - adjustable and  capable  of maintaining a
temperature of 90-95°C.

      4.6   Ribbed watchglasses or equivalent.


5.0  REAGENTS

      5.1  Reagent grade chemicals  shall  be used in all tests. Unless otherwise
indicated, it is intended that all  reagents shall conform to the specifications
of the Committee on Analytical  Reagents of  the American Chemical Society, where
such specifications are available. Other grades may be used,  provided it  is first
ascertained that the reagent  is of sufficiently high  purity  to permit its use
without lessening the accuracy of the determination.

      5.2  Reagent Water.  Reagent water is interference free.  All references to
water in the method refer to reagent water unless  otherwise specified.

      5.3  Nitric Acid (concentrated), HN03.

      5.4  Ammonium Hydroxide (concentrated), NH4OH.

      5.5  Silver Stock Standard Solution  (1,000 mg/L), AgNO,. Dissolve 0.7874
g anhydrous silver nitrate in  water. Add  5 ml HNO, and  bring to volume in a 500-
mL volumetric flask (1 ml  = 1 mg Ag). Alternatively, procure a certified aqueous
standard from a supplier and verify by comparison  with a second standard.

      5.6  Silver working  standards - These standards should  be prepared from
silver  stock  solution  to be  used as calibration  standards  at  the  time  of
analysis. These standards  should be prepared  with nitric acid and  at the same
concentrations as the analytical solution.

      5.7  Iodine solution (IN). Dissolve 20 g potassium iodide (KI), in 50 mil
of water. Add 12.7 g iodine (I2) and dilute  to 100 ml.  Store in a brown bottle.

      5.8   Cyanogen iodide  solution. Add  4.0  ml ammonium  hydroxide,  6.5  g
potassium cyanide (KCN),  and 5.0 ml of  iodine solution to 50  ml  of water. Mix and
dilute to 100 ml with water. Do not keep longer than  2 weeks.

      CAUTION:    This reagent cannot be mixed with  any acid  solutions because
                  toxic hydrogen cyanide will be produced.

      5.9  Air.

      5.10  Acetylene.
                                   7760A  - 2                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

      6.1   All  samples must  have been collected  using  a sampling  plan  that
addresses the considerations discussed in Chapter Nine of this manual.

      6.2  All sample containers must be prewashed with detergents, acids, and
reagent water. Plastic and glass containers are both suitable.

      6.3  Aqueous samples must be acidified to a pH < 2 with nitric acid.

      6.4  When  possible,  standards and samples should be  stored  in  the dark and
in brown bottles.

      6.5  Nonaqueous samples shall be refrigerated, when  possible,  and analyzed
as soon as possible.


7.0  PROCEDURE

      7.1  Sample preparation  -  Aqueous  samples should be prepared  according to
Steps 7.2 and 7.3. The applicability  of  a sample preparation technique to a new
matrix type  must  be demonstrated by analyzing spiked  samples and/or relevant
standard reference materials.

      7.2  Preparation of aqueous samples

            7.2.1  Transfer  a representative aliquot of the well-mixed sample to
      a beaker and add 3 mL  of concentrated HNO,.  Cover the beaker with a ribbed
      watch glass. Place the beaker on a hot plate and cautiously evaporate to
      near dryness, making certain that the sample does not boil. DO NOT BAKE.
      Cool the beaker and add another 3-mL portion of concentrated HN03. Cover
      the beaker with a watch glass  and  return to  the hot  plate.   Increase the
      temperature of the hot plate so that a gentle reflux action occurs.

      NOTE: If  the  sample  contains  thiosulfates, this  step  may result  in
            splatter  of  sample  out  of  the  beaker  as  the  sample approaches
            dryness. This has been reported to occur with certain photographic
            types of samples.

            7.2.2  Continue  heating, adding additional  acid, as necessary, until
      the digestion is complete  (generally indicated when  the digestate is light
      in  color  or does  not change  in  appearance with  continued  refluxing).
      Again, evaporate to near dryness and cool the beaker. Add a small quantity
      of HN03 so that the final  dilution contains 0.5% (v/v)  HN03 and warm the
      beaker to dissolve  any precipitate or residue resulting  from evaporation.

            7.2.3  Wash down the  beaker walls  and  watch  glass with water and,
      when necessary, filter the sample  to remove silicates and other insoluble
      material  that  could  clog  the nebulizer.  Adjust  the  volume  to  some
      predetermined value based  on the expected metal concentrations. The sample
      is now ready for analysis.


                                   7760A  - 3                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
      7.3   If  plating  out  of  AgCl   is  suspected,  the  precipitate  can  be
redissolved by adding  cyanogen iodide to the sample.  This  can be done only after
digestion and  after neutralization of the sample to a pH >  7  to prevent formation
of toxic cyanide under acid conditions. In this case  do  not  adjust the sample
volume to the  predetermined value  until  the sample has been neutralized to pH >
7 and cyanogen iodide  has been added. If cyanogen iodide addition to the sample
is necessary,  then the standards must  be treated in the  same  manner.  Cyanogen
iodide must not be added to the  acidified silver standards. New standards must
be made, as directed  in  Steps 5.5 and  5.6, except that the acid addition step
must be omitted.  For example, to obtain a 100 mg/L working standard, transfer 10
ml of stock solution to a small beaker.  Add water to make about 70 ml.  Make the
solution  basic  (pH  above 7)  with  ammonium  hydroxide.  Rinse  the  pH  meter
electrodes into the solution  with water. Add  1 ml  cyanogen iodide and  allow to
stand 1 hour.  Transfer quantitatively to a 100-mL volumetric flask and bring to
volume with water.

      CAUTION:    CNI   reagent can be  added  only after  digestion to  prevent
                  formation of  toxic  cyanide  under  acidic  conditions.    CNI
                  reagent must not be added to the  acidified silver standards.

      NOTE:       Once the sample or sample aliquot has  been  treated  with the
                  CNI  reagent and diluted per  instruction,  the  solution  has a
                  cyanide concentration of approximately 260 mg/L. A solution of
                  that cyanide  concentration  must  be considered  a  potential
                  hazardous waste and  must be  disposed  of using  an  approved
                  safety plan in accordance with local authority requirements.
                  Until  such time that a  detailed  disposal plan can  be  fully
                  documented  and  approved,  the  use of  the CNI reagent should be
                  avoided.

      7.4   The  328.1  nm wavelength line  and  background  correction  shall  be
employed.

      7.5   An oxidizing air-acetylene flame  shall  be  used.

      7.6   Follow the  manufacturer's  operating  instructions  for all  other
spectrophotometer parameters.


8.0   QUALITY CONTROL

      8.1  Refer to section 8.0  of Method 7000.
9.0   METHOD PERFORMANCE

      9.1   Precision and accuracy data are available in Method 272.1 of "Methods
for Chemical Analysis of Water and Wastes."

      9.2   The data shown in Table  1  were obtained  from records of state and
contractor  laboratories.  The  data are  intended  to  show the  precision  of the
combined sample preparation and analysis method.


                                   7760A -  4                      Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
10.0  REFERENCES

1.    Methods for  Chemical  Analysis of  Water and Wastes;  U.S.  Environmental
Protection Agency.  Office of Research and Development. Environmental Monitoring
and Support  Laboratory.  ORD  Publication  Offices of Center  for  Environmental
Research Information:  Cincinnati, OH,  1983; EPA-600/4-79-020.

2.    Gaskill, A.,  Compilation and Evaluation of RCRA Method Performance Data,
Work Assignment No. 2, EPA Contract No. 68-01-7075, December 1987.

3.    Rohrbough, W.G.;  et  al.  Reagent  Chemicals,  American  Chemical  Society
Specifications,  7th ed.; American Chemical Society: Washington, DC, 1986.

4.    1985 Annual Book of ASTM Standards. Vol. 11.01; "Standard Specification for
Reagent Water";  ATSM: Philadelphia, PA, 1985; D1193-77.
                                  7760A - 5                       Revision 1
                                                                  July 1992

-------
                                TABLE 1.
                         METHOD PERFORMANCE DATA
    Sample
    Matrix
Preparation
  Method
Laboratory
Replicates
Wastewater treatment sludge
   3050
 2.3, 1.6 mg/Kg
Emission control dust
   3050
 1.8, 4.2 mg/Kg
                                 7760A - 6
                               Revision  1
                               July  1992

-------
                                         METHOD 7760A
                   SILVER  (ATOMIC ABSORPTION,  DIRECT ASPIRATION)
                              Sample
                              type for
                              >amp1•
                             preparation
                                 9
  7.2.1  Transfer
 sample  aliquot to
  beaker,add cone
 HNOt.evaporate to
naar dryness,cool,
add cone HNO.,heat
 mo gentle raflux
   action occur*
  7.2.2  Complata
diga*tion,evaporate
 to naar dryness,
cool,add cone HNOa,
 warm to dissolve
any pracipitata or
      residue
7.2.3 Filter .ample
if necessary , ad jua t
 voluma with water
  7.3 Neutraliza
sample,add  cyanogen
iodida to dissolve
pracipitata,ranaka
standard* omitting
   acid,transfer
 aliquot  of stock
solution  to beaker,
     add  water
7.1 Prepare sample
according  to Method
       3040
7.1 Prepare sample
according  to Method
       3050
7.3 Adjust  pH with
    NH,OH,rinse
  electrode into
   solution with
water.add cyanogen
   iodide,wait 1
 hour,transfer to
  flask,bring to
 volume  with water
                                                    7.4-7.6 Set
                                                    instrument
                                                    parameters
                                                    7.7 Construct
                                                  calibration curve
                                                                            7.8 Analyze by
                                                                         method of standard
                                                                             addition if
                                                                              necessary
                        7.9 Calculate metal
                           concentration
                                                                                Stop
                                            7760A -  7
                                                             Revision  1
                                                             July 1992

-------
                                  METHOD  7761

                 SILVER  (ATOMIC ABSORPTION,  FURNACE TECHNIQUE)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

      1.1   Method  7761  is  an  atomic  absorption  procedure  approved  for
determining the concentration of  silver  in wastes, mobility procedure extracts,
soils, and  ground water.   All  samples  must be  subjected to  an  appropriate
dissolution procedure.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

      2.1   See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

      3.1   See Section 3.0 of Method 7000 if interferences are suspected.

      3.2   In addition to the normal  interferences experienced during graphite
furnace analysis, silver analysis can  suffer from severe nonspecific absorption
and  light  scattering   caused  by  matrix   components   during  atomization.
Simultaneous background correction must  be  employed  to  avoid erroneously high
results.

      3.3   If the analyte  is  not  completely  volatilized  and removed from the
furnace during atomization,  memory effects  will occur.    If  this  situation is
detected,  the  tube  should  be cleaned  by  operating  the  furnace  at  higher
atomization temperatures.

      3.4   Silver nitrate solutions are light sensitive and have the tendency
to plate out on  container walls.  Thus, silver standards  should  be stored in
brown bottles.

      3.5   Silver chloride is insoluble; therefore,  hydrochloric acid should be
avoided unless the silver is already in solution as a chloride complex.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

      4.1   For basic apparatus,  see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.

      4.2   Instrument Parameters  (General):

            4.2.1  Drying Time and Temp:  30 sec at 125°C.

            4.2.2  Ashing Time and Temp:  30 sec at 400°C.

            4.2.3  Atomizing Time and Temp:   10 sec at 2700°C.

                                   7761 - 1                        Revision 0
                                                                  July 1992

-------
            4.2.4  Purge Gas Atmosphere:  Argon.

            4.2.5  Wavelength:   328.1  nm.

            4.2.6  Background Correction:   Required.

            4.2.7  Other operating parameters  should be set as specified by the
      particular instrument manufacturer.

            NOTE: The above concentration values and  instrument conditions are
                  for a  Perkin-Elmer  HGA-2100,  based  on  the  use  of a  20  uL
                  injection,  continuous   flow  purge   gas  and  non-pyrolytic
                  graphite and  are to  be used  as guidelines only.  Smaller size
                  furnace devices  or those employing faster rates of atomization
                  can be  operated  using  lower  atomization  temperatures  for
                  shorter time  periods than the  above  recommended settings.


5.0  REAGENTS

      5.1  See Section 5.0 of Method 7000.

      5.2  Silver Stock Standard Solution  (1,000 mg/L),  AgN03.  Dissolve 0.7874 g
anhydrous  silver nitrate  (AgN03),  analytical  reagent  grade,  water.   Add 5  ml
concentrated nitric acid (HN03) and bring  to volume  in  a 500 ml volumetric flask
(1 ml = 1 mg Ag).  Alternatively,  procure a certified  standard from a supplier
and verify by comparison with a second standard.

      5.3  Silver working  standards -  These standards should be prepared with
nitric acid such that the final acid concentration  is  0.5% (v/v) HN03.

      5.4  Ammonium hydroxide (concentrated),  (NH^OH).   Base should be analyzed
to determine  levels  of  impurities.   If impurities are detected,  all  analyses
should be blank-corrected.

      5.5  Iodine solution (IN). Dissolve  20 g  potassium iodide  (KI), analytical
reagent grade, in 50 ml water.  Add 12.7 g  iodine  (I2),  analytical reagent grade,
and dilute to 100 ml with water.  Store in a brown  bottle.

      5.6  Cyanogen  iodide  solution.   To 50 ml water  add 4.0 ml concentrated
NH,OH,  6.5 g potassium cyanide  (KCN),  and 5.0 ml of iodine  solution.   Mix and
dilute to 100 mL with water.  Do not keep longer than  2 weeks.

      CAUTION:    This reagent  cannot  be  mixed  with  any  acid  solutions since
                  highly toxic hydrogen cyanide  will  be produced.


6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION,  PRESERVATION,  AND HANDLING

      6.1   See Chapter Three,  Step 3.1.3, Sample Handling and Preservation.
                                   7761 - 2                       Revision 0
                                                                  July 1992

-------
      6.2   Standards and samples should be stored in the dark,  in brown bottles,
and refrigerated.


7.0  PROCEDURE

      7.1   Sample preparation - Aqueous samples should be prepared according to
Steps 7.2 and 7.3.  The applicability of a sample preparation technique to a new
matrix type  must  be  demonstrated by analyzing  spiked  samples and/or relevant
standard reference materials.

      7.2   Preparation of aqueous samples

            7.2.1  Transfer a representative aliquot of the well-mixed sample to
      a beaker and add 3  ml of concentrated HN03. Cover the beaker with a watch
      glass.  Place the beaker on the hot plate and  cautiously  evaporate to near
      dryness, making certain that the sample does not boil.  DO NOT BAKE.  Cool
      the beaker and add another 3-mL portion of concentrated HN03.   Cover the
      beaker  with  a  watch glass  and  return to the  hot plate.   Increase  the
      temperature of the hot  plate so that a gentle reflux action occurs.

            NOTE: If the sample contains thiosulfates, this step may result in
                  splatter of sample out of the  beaker  as the  sample approaches
                  dryness.  This has been reported to occur with certain types
                  of  photographic wastes.

            7.2.2  Continue heating, adding additional acid,  as necessary, until
      the digestion is complete (generally indicated when the digestate is light
      in  color  or does  not   change in  appearance  with continued  refluxing).
      Again,  evaporate to near  dryness  and  cool   the beaker.   Add a  small
      quantity of HN03 so that the final dilution contains 0.5% (v/v) HN03 and
      warm  the  beaker to dissolve  any  precipitate or  residue  resulting from
      evaporation.

            7.2.3  Wash  down  the  beaker walls  and  watch glass with  water and,
      when necessary, filter the  sample  to remove silicates and other insoluble
      material  that   could  clog  the nebulizer.  Adjust  the  volume to  some
      predetermined value based on the expected metal  concentrations.  The sample
      is now  ready for analysis.

      7.3    If  plating  out   of  AgCl   is suspected,  the   precipitate  can  be
redissolved by adding cyanogen iodide to the sample.  This can be done  only after
digestion and after neutralization of the sample to  a pH > 7 to  prevent formation
of toxic cyanide under acid conditions.   In  this case,  do not  adjust the sample
volume to the predetermined value until  the sample  has  been neutralized to pH >
7 and cyanogen iodide has been added.  If cyanogen  iodide addition to  the sample
is necessary, then the standards must be treated  in the same manner. Cyanogen
iodide must not be added  to the acidified silver standards.  New standards must
be made,  as  directed in  Step 5.2, except that  the  acid addition  step  must be
omitted.  For example, to obtain  a 100 mg/L working  standard,  transfer 10 ml of
stock solution  to  a  small beaker.  Add water to  make  about  70 ml.   Make the
solution basic  (pH above  7) with NH4OH.  Rinse the pH meter electrodes into the

                                   7761 - 3                       Revision 0
                                                                  July 1992

-------
solution with  water.   Add  1  ml cyanogen  iodide and  allow  to stand  1  hour.
Transfer quantitatively to a 100-mL volumetric  flask  and  bring to volume with
water.

      CAUTION:    CNI  reagent  can  be  added only  after  digestion  to  prevent
                  formation of  toxic  cyanide  under  acidic  conditions.    CNI
                  reagent must not  be added to the acidified silver standards.

NOTE: Once the sample  or sample aliquot  has  been treated  with  the CNI  reagent
      and diluted per  instruction,  the solution has a cyanide concentration of
      approximately 260 mg/L.  A solution of  that cyanide concentration must be
      considered a potential hazardous waste and must be  disposed of using an
      approved safety  plan in accordance  with local  authority requirements.
      Until such time that  a detailed  disposal plan can be fully documented and
      approved, the use of the CNI  reagent should be avoided.

      7.4  The 328.1-nm wavelength line and background  correction shall be used.

      7.5   Following  the  manufacturer's operating instructions for all  other
spectrophotometer parameters.

      7.6  Furnace parameters  suggested by the manufacturer should be employed
as guidelines. Since temperature-sensing mechanisms and temperature controllers
can vary between instruments or with time, the validity of the furnace parameters
must be periodically confirmed by systematically altering the furnace parameters
while analyzing a standard.  In this manner, losses of analyte due to  higher than
necessary temperature settings or losses in sensitivity due to less than optimum
settings can  be minimized.  Similar verification of  furnace  parameters may be
required for complex sample matrices.

      7.7  Inject a measured uL aliquot of  sample into the furnace and atomize.
If the  concentration  found is greater than  the highest  standard,  the sample
should be diluted in the same  acid  matrix and reanalyzed.   The use of multiple
injections can improve accuracy and help detect furnace pipetting  errors.

      7.8   Either  (1)  run  a  series  of silver  standards  and  construct  a
calibration curve by plotting the concentrations  of  the  standards against the
absorbances or (2) for the method of standard additions, plot added concentration
versus abosrbance.  For instruments that read directly  in concentration, set the
curve corrector to read out the proper concentration.

      7.9  Analyze, by the method of  standard  additions,  all  EP extracts, all
samples analyzed as part of a delisting  petition,  and all  samples that suffer
from matrix interferences.

      7.10  Calculate  metal  concentrations  by  (1)   the   method  of  standard
additions, or  (2) from  a calibration curve,  or (3) directly  from  the instrument's
concentration readout.  All dilution or concentration factors  must  be taken into
account.  Concentrations reported for  multiphased samples must  be appropriately
qualified.
                                   7761 - 4                       Revision 0
                                                                  July 1992

-------
8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

      8.1   All quality control data should be maintained and available for easy
reference or inspection.

      8.2   Calibration curves must be  composed  of  a  minimum  of a calibration
blank and three standards.  A calibration curve must be prepared each day.

      8.3   Dilute  samples if  they are  more concentrated  than  the  highest
standard or if they fall on the plateau of a calibration curve.

      8.4   Employ a minimum of one reagent blank per sample batch or every 20
samples to determine if contamination or any memory effects are occurring.

      8.5   Verify calibration with  an  independently  prepared quality control
reference sample every  10  samples.

      8.6   Run  one  spiked replicate  sample  for  every  10  samples  or per
analytical batch, whichever is more  frequent.   A replicate sample is a sample
brought through the entire sample preparation process.

      8.7   Duplicates, spiked samples,  and check standards should  be routinely
analyzed.  Refer to Chapter One for the proper protocol.

      8.8   The method  of  standard additions  (see Method 7000,  Step 8.7)  shall
be  used for the analysis of all EP extracts,  on  all analyses  submitted  as  part
of  a delisting petition, and whenever a new  sample  matrix  is  being analyzed.


9.0 METHOD PERFORMANCE

      9.1   Precision and  accuracy data  are available  in Method 272.2 of Methods
for Chemical Analysis  of Water and Wastes.

      9.2   The  performance  characteristics for  an  aqueous  sample  free  of
interferences  are:

      Optimum  concentration range:   1-25  ug/L.
      Detection limit:  0.2 ug/L.


10.0  REFERENCES

1.    Methods  for Chemical  Analysis  of Water  and  Wastes; U.S.  Environmental
Protection Agency. Office  of Research and Development. Environmental  Monitoring
and Support Laboratory.  ORD Publication  Offices of  Center  for  Environmental
Research  Information:   Cincinnati,  OH,  1983; EPA-600/4-79-020.
                                    7761 - 5                       Revision 0
                                                                   July 1992

-------
                                             METHOD 7761
                      SILVER  (ATOMIC ABSORPTION,  FURNACE  TECHNIQUE)
                                 demonstrate
                              applicability of
                                 preparation
                             technique to other
                               matrix type* by
                              analyzing spiked
                                 samples and
                             reference materials
          Aqueou*
   7.2.1 Tran.fer
 sample aliquot to
 beaker; add cone.
HNOi ; evaporate to
near dryne** ;  cool;
   add cone. HNO, ;
   heat »o gentle
   reflux action
      occur*
  7.2.2 Complete
    digestion ;
 evaporate to near
dryne**;  cool;  add
cone.  HNOt ;  warm  to
   diliolve  any
  precipitate or
      reaidue
7.2.3 Filter sample
   if nece»»ary;
adjust volume with
       water
                                      Ye*
   7.3  Neutralize
sample;  add cyanogen
 iodide  to dissolve
 precipitate; remake
 standards omitting
   acid;  transfer
  aliquot of stock
 solution to beaker;
     add water
7.3  Adju.t pH with
  NH.OH; rin*e
  electrode* into
 •oln  with water;
  add cyanogen
  iodide; wait 1
 hour;  transfer to
  fla*k; bring to
 volume with water
    7.4-7.6 Set
    instrument
    parameter*
                           7.7 Inject  sample
                          aliquot;  dilute  if
                               necessary
                              7.8 Construct
                            calibration curve
                           7.9-7.10 Analyze
                                (ample
                                                                                  7.10 Calculate
                                                                                metal concentration
                                                                                       Stop
                                       7761  -  6
                         Revision  0
                         July 1992

-------
                                 METHOD  7770

                SODIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION.  DIRECT ASPIRATION)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  See Section 3.0 of Method 7000 1f interferences are suspected.

     3.2  lonization  interferences can affect  analysis for sodium; therefore,
samples and  standards  must  be  matrix  matched  or an ionization suppressant
employed.

     3.3  Sodium is  a universal  contaminant, and  great care should be taken to
avoid  contamination.


4.0 APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1   For basic  apparatus, see Section 4.0 of Method  7000.

     4.2   Instrument parameters (general):

           4.2.1  Sodium hollow cathode lamp.
           4.2.2  Wavelength:  589.6 nm.
           4.2.3  Fuel:   Acetylene.
           4.2.4  Oxldant:  Air.
           4.2.5  Type of flame:  Oxidizing (fuel lean).
           4.2.6  Background correction:  Not required.


 5.0   REAGENTS

       5.1  See Section 5.0 of  Method 7000.

       5.2  Preparation of standards;

           5.2.1  Stock  solution:    Dissolve  2.542  g   sodium  chloride, NaCl
       (analytical  reagent   grade),  in  Type  II  water,  acidify  with  10 mL
       redistilled  HN03,  and  dilute   to   1    liter    with  Type  II  water.
       Alternatively,  procure a certified standard from a  supplier and verify by
       comparison with a  second standard.


                                    7770 -  1
                                                          Revision      0
                                                          Date  September  1986

-------
          5.2.2  Prepare  dilutions  of  the  stock  solution  to  be  used as
     calibration standards at the time of analysis.  The calibration standards
     should  be  prepared  using  the  same  type  of  add  and  at  the same
     concentration  as  will  result  1n  the  sample  to  be  analyzed  after
     processing.


6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

     6.1  See Chapter Three, Section 3.1.3, Sample Handling and Preservation,.


7.0  PROCEDURE

     7-1  Sample preparation;  The  procedures  for  preparation of the sample
are given In Chapter Three, Section 3.2.

     7.2  See Method 7000, Paragraph 7.2, Direct Aspiration.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

     8.1  See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.


9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

     9.1  The performance characteristics for an aqueous sample free of Inter-
ferences are:

     Optimum concentration range:  0.03-1 mg/L with a wavelength of 589.6 nm.
     Sensitivity:  0.015 mg/L.
     Detection limit:  0.002 mg/L:

     9.2  In a  single  laboratory,  analysis  of  a mixed Industrial-domestic
waste effluent, digested with  Method  3010,  at  concentrations of 8.2 and 52
mg/L gave standard deviations of  +0.1  and +0.8, respectively.  Recoveries at
these levels were 102% and 100%, respectively.


10.0 REFERENCES

1.   Methods for  Chemical  Analysis  of  Water  and Wastes,  EPA-600/4-82-05'5
December 1982, Method 273.1.                                                 '
                                  7770 - 2
                                                         Revision
                                                         Date  September 1986'

-------
                 METHOD 777O

SODIUM (ATOMIC  ABSORPTION. DIRECT ASPIRATION)
             C
               5.0
                   Prepare
                  standards
                7.1
              	1 For
                    s a mp 1 e
              preparation see
                  chapter 3.
                 section 3.2
                7.2
                Analyze using
                 Method 7OOO.
                 Section 7.3
             f     Stop      J
               7770 -  3
                                         Revision       0
                                         Date   September 1986

-------
                                 METHOD 7780

               STRONTIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION.  DIRECT ASPIRATION)


1.0   SCOPE AND APPLICATION

      1.1   See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.


2.0   SUMMARY OF METHOD

      2.1   See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0   INTERFERENCES

      3.1   See Section 3.0 of Method 7000.

      3.2   Chemical interference caused by silicon, aluminum,  and phosphate are
controlled by adding lanthanum chloride. Potassium chloride is  added to suppress
the ionization of  strontium. All samples  and  standards  should contain 1 ml of
lanthanum chloride/potassium chloride solution (Step 5.3) per 10 mL of solution.


4.0   APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

      4.1   For basic apparatus, see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.

      4.2   Instrument parameters (general):

            4.2.1   Strontium hollow cathode lamp.

            4.2.2   Wavelength:  460.7 nm.

            4.2.3   Fuel:  Acetylene.

            4.2.4   Oxidant:  Air.

            4.2.5   Type of flame:  Oxidizing (fuel lean).

            4.2.6   Background correction: not required.


5.0   REAGENTS

      5.1   See Section 5.0 of Method 7000.

      5.2   Preparation of standards


                                   7780 - 1                       Revision 0
                                                                  July  1992

-------
            5.2.1  Stock  solution:   (1.0  mL  = 1.0 mg Sr).  Dissolve 2.415 g of
      strontium nitrate,  Sr(N03)2, in 10 ml of concentrated  HC1  and 700 mL of
      water. Dilute to  1  liter  with  water.  Alternatively,  procure a certified
      standard from a supplier and verify  by comparison with a second standard.

            5.2.2   Prepare  dilutions  of  the stock  solution to  be  used  as
      calibration standards at the time of analysis. The calibration standards
      should be prepared  using  the same type  of  acid as  the samples and cover
      the range of expected concentrations in the  samples. Calibration standards
      should also contain  1 ml of lanthanum chloride/potassium chloride solution
      per 10 ml.

      5.3   Lanthanum Chloride/Potassium Chloride Solution. Dissolve 11.73 g of
lanthanum oxide,  La203,  in a minimum amount of concentrated  hydrochloric acid
(approximately 50 mL). Add 1.91  g of  potassium chloride, KC1. Allow solution to
cool to room temperature and dilute to 100 mL with water.

      CAUTION:    REACTION IS VIOLENT!  Add acid slowly and  in small portions to
                  control  the reaction rate upon  mixing.


6.0   SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION,  AND HANDLING

      6.1   See Chapter Three, Step 3.1.3, Sample Handling  and Preservation.


7.0   PROCEDURE

      7.1   Sample preparation - The procedures for preparation of  the sample are
given in Chapter Three,  Step 3.2.

      7.2   See Method 7000,  Step 7.2,  Direct  Aspiration.


8.0   QUALITY CONTROL

      8.1   See Section  8.0 of Method 7000.


9.0   METHOD PERFORMANCE

      9.1   The performance  characteristics  for an  aqueous  sample  free  of
interferences are:

      Optimum concentration range: 0.3  -  5 mg/L  at a wavelength  of 460.7 nm.
      Sensitivity: 0.15  mg/L.
      Detection limit: 0.03 mg/L.

            9.1.1   Recoveries  of known amounts  of strontium  in a series  of
      prepared standards were as given  in  Table 1.

                                   7780  -  2                        Revision 0
                                                                  July  1992

-------
10.0  REFERENCES

1.     Annual  Book of ASTM Standards;  ASTM:   Philadelphia,  PA,  1983;  D3920.
                                   7780 - 3                       Revision 0
                                                                  July  1992

-------
                              TABLE  1.
                              RECOVERY

Amount
added ,
mg/L

Amount
found,
mg/L
Significant
(95 %
% confidence
Bias Bias level)
        1.00
        0.50
        0.10
          Reagent Water Type II

      0.998        -0.002     -0.2
      0.503        +0.003     +0.6
      0.102        +0.002     +2

             Water of Choice
no
no
no
1.00
0.50
0.10
1.03
0.504
0.086
+0.03
+0.004
-0.014
+ 3
+ 0.8
-14
no
no
no
Reference:
Annual Book of ASTM Standards; ASTM: Philadelphia,  PA,
1983; D3920.
                              7780 - 4
                                           Revision 0
                                           July 1992

-------
                     METHOD  7780
STRONTIUM  (ATOMIC  ABSORPTION,  DIRECT  ASPIRATION)
                        Start
                      S.0 Prepare
                      •tandarda
                    7.1 For aample
                    preparation •••
                  Chapter 3,  Saction
                         3.2
                   7.2 Analyze uting
                     Method 7000
                      Section 7.2
                        Stop
                      7780 - 5
Revision  0
July 1992

-------
                                 METHOD 7840

               THALLIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION. DIRECT ASPIRATION)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  See Section 3.0 of Method 7000 if interferences are suspected.

     3.2  Background correction  is required.

     3.3  Hydrochloric acid should not be used.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1  For basic apparatus,  see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.

     4.2  Instrument parameters (general):

          4.2.1   Thallium hollow cathode lamp.
          4.2.2   Wavelength:   276.8 nm.
          4.2.3   Fuel:   Acetylene.
          4.2.4   Oxidant:   Air.
          4.2.5   Type  of flame:  Oxidizing (fuel  lean).
          4.2.6   Background correction:  Required.


 5.0  REAGENTS

      5.1   See Section  5.0 of Method  7000.

      5.2   Preparation  of standards;

           5.2.1  Stock solution:   Dissolve   1.303  g  thallium nitrate,
      (analytical  reagent  grade),  in  Type  II  water,  acidify  with  10 mL
      concentrated HNOs, and dilute to  1  liter  with Type II water.  Alterna-
      tively, procure  a  certified  standard  from  a  supplier  and verify by
      comparison with a second  standard.
                                   7840 - 1
                                                          Revision
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
       TU  ?:   Prepare  dilutions  of  the  stock  solution  to  be  used as
     calibration standards at the time of analysis.  The calibration standards
     should  be  prepared  using  the  same  type  of  acid  and  at  the

                                      1n  the  saraple  to  be
6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING



     6.1  See Chapter Three, Section 3.1.3, Sample Handling and Preservation.




7.0  PROCEDURE




                                                                 °f
are



     7.2  See Method 7000, Paragraph 7.2, Direct Aspiration.




8.0  QUALITY CONTROL


     8.1  See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.




9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE



interferences a?e:f0rmanCe  Character1st1cs  for  «•  aqueous  sample  free of



     Optimum concentration range:  1-20 mg/L with a wavelength of 276.8 nm.
     sensitivity:  0.5 mg/L.

     Detection limit:  0.1 mg/L.



   * 9*LiIn ?  Dingle  laboratory,   analysis  of  a mixed  industrial -domestic

mn/f'nf flUeJt'^d1fSied.WlJh Method 3010'  at concentrations of 0.6?  3,  and   5
mg/L gave  standard  deviations  of  +0.018,   +0.05,   and   +0.2  respectively

Recoveries at these levels were 100%,-g8%,  and-98%,  respectively.            Y*




                              f thall1um below °-2 mg/L' the furnace
10.0 REFERENCES
                                  7840 - 2

                                                        Revision      o

                                                        Date  September  1986

-------
                METHOD 784O

THALLIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION. DIRECT ASPIRATION)
              f     Start     J
5.O j
Prepare
standards


7.1 1
	 _-J For
sample
preparation- see
chapter 3.
section 3.2


7.2 [
Analyze using
Method 7000.
Section 7.2
              f     Stop      J
              7840 - 3
                                      Revision      0	
                                      Date   September 1986

-------
                                METHOD 7841

               THALLIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION. FURNACE TECHNIQUE)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  See Section  3.0 of Method 7000 if interferences are suspected.

     3.2  Background correction is required.

     3  3  Hydrochloric acid or excessive chloride will cause volatilization of
 thallium  at low temperatures.   Verification   that losses are not occurring, by
 spiked  samples  or standard  additions, must be made for each sample matrix.

     3.4   Palladium is a suitable matrix modifier for thallium  analysis.


 4.0 APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1   For basic apparatus, see Section 4.0  of Method  7000.

      4.2   Instrument parameters (general):

           4.2.1  Drying time and temp:   30  sec  at  125*C.
           4.2.2  Ashing time and temp:   30  sec  at  400*C.
           4.2.3  Atomizing time and temp:   10 sec  at 2400*C.
           4.2.4  Purge gas:  Argon or nitrogen.
           4.2.5  Wavelength:  276.8 nm.
           4.2.6  Background correction:   Required.
           4.2.7  Other operating parameters  should be  set as specified by the
                  particular instrument manufacturer.
      NOTE-  The  above concentration values and instrument conditions are for a
             Perkin-Elmer HGA-2100, based  on  the  use  of  a 20-uL injection,
             continuous-flow purge  gas,  and nonpyrolytic  graphite.  Smaller
             sizes  of   furnace  devices  or   those  employing  faster  rates of
             atomization  can be   operated  using lower atomization temperatures
             for shorter time  periods than the  above-recommended settings.
                                    7841 - 1
                                                           Revision
                                                           Date  September 1986

-------
 5.0   REAGENTS

      5.1  See Section 5.0 of Method 7000.

      5.2  Preparation of standards;


      r^iv^*1! St°Ck S?lut1o"=   Dissolve  1.303  g  thallium nitrate, T1N03
      (analytical  reagent  grade,  in  Type  II  water,   acidify  with  10 ml
      concentrated HN03, and dilute to  1  liter  with Type II water   Al tern -
      tively  procure  a  certified  standard  from  a  supplier  and verify by
      comparison with a second standard.                          a,,u veiny Dy

       Tu5'2.;2  PreP^e  dilutions  of  the  stock  solution  to  be  used as
      calibration standards at the time of analysis.  The  calibration standards
      should  be  prepared  using  the  same  type  of  acid  and  at  the same
      concentrations as in the sample after processing (0.5% v/v HN03).

      ?*3  Palladium chloride:  Weigh 0.25 g  of PdCl? to  the nearest 0 0001 n
 Dissolve in 10 ml of 1:1 HN03 and  dilute  to 1 lite? Jlth Type H Sate?   U li
 equal volumes of sample and palladium solution.
6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

     6.1  See Chapter Three, Section 3.1.3, Sample Handling and Preservation


7.0  PROCEDURE


                                                *"  ™™»°° °f «»
are
8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

     8.1  See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.


9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

     9.1  Precision and accuracy  data  are not available at this time.


Interfering a^forniance  characteristics  for  an  aqueous  sample  free of


     Optimum concentration range:   5-100 ug/L
     Detection limit:   1   ug/L.
                                 7841 - 2
                                                        Revision      p
                                                        Date  September 1986

-------
10.0 REFERENCES

1.   Application  of  Matrix-Modification  1n  Determination  of  Thallium  In
Wastewater by Graphite-Furnace  Atomic-Absorption Spectrometry,  Talanta,  31(2)
(1984), pp. 150-152.
                                   7841 - 3
                                                          Revision
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
                METHOD 7B41

THALLIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION. FURNACE TECHNIQUE)
5.0 |
Prepare
standards

7. 1
Si
preparat
chac
sect]

7.2

"or
imple
.ion see
)ter 3.
on 3 . 2


Analyze using
Method 700O.
Section 7.2;
Calculation 7.4
             (     Stop      J
           7841 - 4
                                   Revision       0
                                   Date  September 1986

-------
                                 METHOD  7870

                 TIN (ATOMIC ABSORPTION,  DIRECT ASPIRATION)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  See Section 3.0 of Method 7000 if interferences are suspected.


4.0  APPARATUS AND  MATERIALS

     4.1  For basic apparatus, see Section 4.0  of Method 7000.

     4.2  Instrument parameters  (general):

          4.2.1  Tin hollow cathode lamp.
          4.2.2  Wavelength:   286.3 nm.
          4.2.3  Fuel:   Acetylene.
          4.2.4  Oxidant:   Nitrous oxide.
          4.2.5  Type of flame:   Fuel rich.
          4.2.6  Background correction:  Not  required.


5.0  REAGENTS

     5.1  See  Section 5.0 of Method 7000.

     5.2   Preparation of standards:

           5.2.1  Stock solution:   Dissolve   1.000   g  of tin  metal  (analytical
     reagent grade) in 100  mL  of  concentrated  HC1 and dilute  to  1  liter with
     Type II  water.    Alternatively,   procure a  certified  standard from  a
     supplier and  verify by comparison  with  a second  standard.

           5.2.2   Prepare dilutions   of the   stock  solution  to   be   used as
     calibration standards  at  the time  of analysis.   The calibration standards
     should  be  prepared  using  the  same   type   of acid  and   at  the same
     concentration  as   will  result   in the  sample to   be  analyzed after
     processing.
                                   7870 - 1
                                                          Revision
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION,  AND HANDLING

     6.1  See Chapter Three, Section 3.1.3,  Sample Handling and Preservation.

7.0  PROCEDURE

     7.1  Sample preparation;  The  procedures  for  preparation of the sample
are given 1n Chapter Three, Section 3.2.

     7.2  See Method 7000, Paragraph 7.2, Direct Aspiration.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

     8.1  See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.


9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

     9.1  The  performance  characteristics  for  an  aqueous  sample  free of
interferences are:

     Optimum concentration  range:  10-300 mg/L with a wavelength of 286.3 nm.
     Sensitivity:  4 mg/L.
     Detection limit:  0.8  mg/L.

     9.2   In a   single  laboratory,  analysis  of  a mixed  industrial-domestic
waste  effluent,  digested  with Method 3010,  at concentrations of 4, 20, and 60
mg/L   gave  standard  deviations  of  +0.25,  +0.5,  and  +0.5,  respectively.
Recoveries  at these levels  were 96%, 101%, and 101%, respectively.


10.0 REFERENCES

1.   Methods for  Chemical  Analysis  of Water  and Wastes, EPA-600/4-82-055,
December  1982, Method  282.1.
                                   7870 - 2
                                                         Revision
                                                         Date  September  1986

-------
               METHOD 787O

TIN (ATOMIC  ABSORPTION.  DIRECT ASPIRATION)
             C    •-•••    )
                   Prepare
                  standards
               7.1
                   1  FOP
                   sample
              preparation see
                 chapter 3.
                 section 3.2
               Analyze using
                Method 7OOO.
                Section 7 .Z
             (      Stop       J
           7870  - 3
                                     Revision       0
                                     Date  September 1986

-------
                                 METHOD 7910

               VANADIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION. DIRECT  ASPIRATION)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  See Section 3.0 of Method 7000 if interferences are suspected.

     3.2  Background correction may be required.

     3.3  High concentrations of aluminum or  titanium, or the presence of Bi,
Cr, Co, Fe,  acetic acid,  phosphoric   acid, surfactants, detergents, or alkali
metals,  may interfere.    The  interference  can  be  controlled  by  adding
1,000 mg/L  aluminum  to  samples and standards.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1   For basic  apparatus,  see Section 4.0 of  Method 7000.

     4.2   Instrument parameters  (general):

           4.2.1   Vanadium hollow cathode  lamp.
           4.2.2   Wavelength:   318.4  nm.
           4.2.3   Fuel:   Acetylene.
           4.2.4   Oxldant:  Nitrous oxide.
           4.2.5   Type of flame:   Fuel  rich.
           4.2.6   Background correction:   Required.


 5.0  REAGENTS

      5.1   See Section 5.0 of Method 7000.

      5.2   Preparation of standards;

           5.2.1   Stock solution:   Dissolve   1.7854  g  of vanadium pentoxide,
      V20s  (analytical reagent grade),  in  10  mL of concentrated nitric acid and
      dilute to 1 liter with Type II water.  Alternatively, procure a certified
      standard from a supplier and verify  by  comparison with a second standard.
                                   7910 - 1
                                                          Revision      0
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
          5.2.2  Prepare  dilutions  of  the  stock  solution  to  be  used as
     calibration standards at the time of analysis.  The calibration standards
     should  be  prepared  using  the  same  type  of  acid  and  at  the same
     concentration  as  will  result  1n  the  sample  to  be  analyzed  after
     processing.  In addition, 2 ml of the aluminum nitrate solution described
     In Paragraph 5.2.3  should  be  added  to  each  100  ml of standards and
     samples.

          5.2.3  Aluminum nitrate solution:   Dissolve  139 g aluminum nitrate
     (A1[N03]3-9H20) In 150 ml  Type  II  water;  heat to complete dissolution.
     Allow to cool and dilute to 200  ml  with Type II water.  All  samples and
     standards should contain 2 ml of this solution per 100 ml.


6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

     6.1  See Chapter Three, Section 3.1.3, Sample Handling and Preservation.

7.0  PROCEDURE

     7.1  Sample preparation;  The  procedures  for  preparation of the sample
are given In Chapter Three, Section 3.2.

     7.2  See Method 7000, Paragraph 7.2, Direct  Aspiration.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

     8.1  See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.


9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

     9.1  The  performance  characteristics  for  an  aqueous  sample  free of
interferences are:

     Optimum concentration range:  2-100 mg/L with a wavelength of 318.4 nm.
     Sensitivity:  0.8 mg/L.
     Detection limit:  0.2 mg/L.

     9.2  In a single  laboratory),  analysis  of  a mixed Industrial-domestic
waste effluent, digested with Method 3010,  at concentrations of 2, 10, and 50
mg/L  gave  standard  deviations  of   +0.1,  +0.1,  and  +0.2,  respectively.
Recoveries at these levels were 100%, 95%, and 97%, respectively.

     9.3  For concentrations of vanadium below 0.5 mg/L, the furnace technique
(Method 7911) is recommended.
                                  7910 - 2
                                                         Revision
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
10.0 REFERENCES

1.   Methods for  Chemical  Analysis  of  Water  and Wastes,  EPA-600/4-82-055,
December 1982, Method 286.1.
                                   7910 - 3
                                                          Revision       0
                                                          Date  September  1986

-------
                 METHOD 791O

VANADIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION. DIRECT ASPIRATION)
                s.o
                    Prepare
                   standards
7.1
prepar
cr
sec
For
sample
atlon see
apter 3.
tlon 3.2
                7.2
                Analyze using
                 Method 7000.
                 Section 7.2
              (     Stop      J
                 7910 -  4
                                          Revision       0
                                          Date  September 1986

-------
                                 METHOD  7911

               VANADIUM (ATOMIC ABSORPTION.  FURNACE  TECHNIQUE)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  See Section 3.0 of Method 7000 if interferences are suspected.

     3.2  Background correction is required.

     3.3  Vanadium is refractory and  prone  to  form carbides.  Consequently,
memory effects are common,  and  care  should  be  taken  to clean the furnace
before and after analysis.

     3.4  Nitrogen should not be used as a purge gas.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1  For basic apparatus, see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.

     4.2  Instrument parameters  (general):

          4.2.1  Drying  time and temp:  30 sec at 125*C.
          4.2.2  Ashing  time and temp:  30 sec at 1400*C.
          4.2.3  Atomizing  time and temp:  15 sec at 2800*C.
          4.2.4  Purge gas:  Argon  (nitrogen should not be used).
          4.2.5  Wavelength:   318.4 nm.
          4.2.6  Background correction:   Required.
          4.2.7  Other operating parameters should  be  set as  specified by the
                 particular instrument  manufacturer.
     NOTE:   The  above  concentration values and instrument conditions  are  for  a
             Perkin-Elmer HGA-2100,  based  on  the   use  of   a  20-uL injection,
             continuous-flow purge   gas,   and  nonpyrolytic   graphite.   Smaller
             sizes  of  furnace   devices  or  those   employing  faster   rates of
             atomization  can be  operated  using  lower atomization  temperatures
             for  shorter  time periods  than the above-recommended  settings.
                                   7911 - 1
                                                          Revision
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
5.0  REAGENTS

     5.1  See Section 5.0 of Method 7000.

     5.2  Preparation of standards;

          5.2.1  Stock solution:   Dissolve  1.7854  g  of vanadium pentoxlde,
     V^Os (analytical reagent grade),  1n 10 ml of concentrated nitric add and
     dilute to 1 liter with Type II water.  Alternatively, procure a certified
     standard from a supplier and verify by comparison with a second standard.

          5.2.2  Prepare  dilutions  of  the  stock  solution  to  be  used as
     calibration standards at the time of analysis.  The calibration standards
     should  be  prepared  using  the  same  type  of  add  and  at  the same
     concentrations as in the sample after processing (0.5% v/v
6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

     6.1  See Chapter Three, Section 3.1.3, Sample Handling and Preservation.


7.0  PROCEDURE

     7.1  Sample preparation;  The  procedures  for  preparation of the sample
are given in Chapter Three, Section 3.2.

     7.2  See Method 7000, Paragraph 7.3,  Furnace Procedure.  The calculation
is given in Method 7000, Paragraph 7.4.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

     8.1  See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.


9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

     9.1  Precision and accuracy data are available in Method 286.2 of Methods
for Chemical Analysis of Water and Wastes.

     9.2  The  performance  characteristics  for  an  aqueous  sample  free of
interferences are:

     Optimum concentration range:  10-200 ug/L.
     Detection limit:  4 ug/L.


10.0 REFERENCES

1.   Methods for  Chemical  Analysis  of  Water  and Wastes, EPA-600/4-82-055
December 1982, Method 286.2.
                                  7911 - 2
                                                         Revision
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
                METHOD 7911

VANADIUM  (ATOMIC ABSORPTION. FURNACE TECHNIQUE)
5.O


Prepare
standards

7. 1
prepar
cl-
sec

7.2


For
sample
•atlon see
lapter 3.
tlon .3.2



Analyze using
Method 7OOO.
Section 7.Z:
calculation 7.4
             f     Stop      J
           7911 - 3
                                   Revision      0
                                   Date  September 1986

-------
                                 METHOD 7950

                 ZINC (ATOMIC ABSORPTION.  DIRECT ASPIRATION)


1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION

     1.1  See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.


2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD

     2.1  See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.


3.0  INTERFERENCES

     3.1  See Section 3.0 of Method 7000 if interferences are suspected.

     3.2  High levels of silicon, copper,   or  phosphate may interfere.  Addi-
tion of strontium  (1,500 mg/L) removes the copper and phosphate interference.

     3.3  Zinc is  a universal contaminant,  and  great care should be taken to
avoid contamination.


4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

     4.1  For basic apparatus, see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.

     4.2  Instrument parameters  (general):

          4.2.1  Zinc hollow cathode lamp.
          4.2.2  Wavelength:  213.9 nm.
          4.2.3  Fuel:  Acetylene.
          4.2.4  Oxldant:  Air.
          4.2.5  Type of flame:  Oxidizing  (fuel lean).
          4.2.6  Background correction:  Required.


5.0  REAGENTS

     5.1  See Section 5.0 of Method 7000.

     5.2  Preparation of standards;

          5.2.1  Stock solution:    Dissolve  1.000  g  zinc metal (analytical
     reagent grade) in 10 mL of  concentrated nitric acid and dilute to  1 liter
     with Type II  water.   Alternatively,  procure a certified standard from a
     supplier and  verify by comparison with a second standard.
                                   7950 -  1
                                                         Revision
                                                         Date  September  1986

-------
          5.2.2  Prepare  dilutions  of  the  stock  solution  to  be  used as
     calibration standards at the time of analysis.  The calibration standards
     should be prepared using the same type of acid and at the same concentra-
     tion as will result in the sample to be analyzed after processing.


6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION, AND HANDLING

     6.1  See Chapter Three, Section 3.1.3, Sample Handling and Preservation.


7.0  PROCEDURE

     7.1  Sample preparation;  The  procedures  for  preparation of the sample
are given in Chapter Three, Section 3.2.

     7.2  See Method 7000, Paragraph 7.2, Direct Aspiration.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

     8.1  See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.


9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

     9.1  The   performance  characteristics  for   an  aqueous  sample  free  of
interferences are:

     Optimum concentration  range:  0.05-1 mg/L with a wavelength of  213.9  nm.
     Sensitivity:  0.02 mg/L.
     Detection  limit:  0.005 mg/L.

     9.2   For concentrations of  zinc   below  0.01  mg/L,  the  furnace technique
 (Method 7951)  is recommended.

     9.3   Precision  and accuracy data  are  available  in  Method  289.1  of Methods
for  Chemical Analysis  of  Water and Wastes.


10.0 REFERENCES

1.   Methods  for  Chemical  Analysis   of  Water   and Wastes,  EPA-600/4-82-055,
December 1982,  Method  289.1.
                                   7950 - 2
                                                          Revision
                                                          Date   September 1986

-------
               METHOD 795O

ZINC  (ATOMIC ABSORPTION.  DIRECT ASPIRATION)
              5.0
                 Prepare
                standards
7.1
prepar
ch
sec
For
sample
atlon see
apter 3.
tlon 3.2
7.2
Analyze
Methoc
Sectlc

! using
1 7OOO.
in 7.2
           (      Stop      J
            7950 - 3
                                     Revision       0
                                     Date  September 1986

-------
                                 METHOD 7951
                 ZINC  (ATOMIC ABSORPTION. FURNACE TECHNIQUE)

1.0  SCOPE AND APPLICATION
      1.1   See Section 1.0 of Method 7000.

2.0  SUMMARY OF METHOD
      2.1   See Section 2.0 of Method 7000.

3.0  INTERFERENCES
      3.1   See Section 3.0 of Method 7000.
      3.2   Background correction should be used.
      3.3   Zinc  is  a universal contaminant.    Because  of this  and  the high
sensitivity of this method, great care should be taken to avoid contamination.

4.0  APPARATUS AND MATERIALS
      4.1   For basic  apparatus, see Section 4.0 of Method 7000.
      4.2   Instrument parameters (general):
            4.2.1  Drying time and temp:  30 sec at 125°C.
            4.2.2  Ashing time and temp:  30 sec at 400°C.
            4.2.3  Atomizing time and temp:  10  sec at 2500°C.
            4.2.4  Purge gas: Argon or nitrogen.
            4.2.5  Wavelength:   213.9 nm.
            4.2.6  Background correction:   Required.
            4.2.7  Other operating parameters should be set as specified by  the
      particular  instrument manufacturer.
            NOTE: The  above concentration values and  instrument conditions  are
                  for  a Perkin-Elmer  HGA-2100,  based on  the use  of a  20-uL
                  injection,   continuous-flow   purge  gas,   and   nonpyrolytic
                  graphite.   Smaller size  furnace  devices or those  employing
                  faster  rates  of  atomization  can  be  operated  using  lower

                                   7951  - 1                       Revision  0
                                                                   July 1992

-------
                  atomization temperatures  for  shorter time periods  than the
                  above-recommended settings.


5.0  REAGENTS

      5.1   See Section 5.0 of Method 7000.

      5.2   Preparation of standards

            5.2.1  Stock  solution  - Dissolve 1.000  g zinc  metal  (analytical
      reagent grade) in 10 ml  of  concentrated nitric acid and dilute to 1 liter
      with water.  Alternatively, procure a certified standard from a supplier
      and verify by comparison with a second standard.

            5.2.2  Prepare  dilutions  of  the stock   solution  to  be  used  as
      calibration standards at the  time  of  analysis.  The calibration standards
      should  be  prepared  using the  same  type  of  acid   and  at  the  same
      concentrations as in the sample after processing (0.5% v/v HN03).


6.0  SAMPLE COLLECTION, PRESERVATION,  AND HANDLING

      6.1   See Chapter Three, Step 3.1.3,  Sample Handling and Preservation.


7.0  PROCEDURE

      7.1   Sample Preparation - The procedures for preparation of the sample are
given in Chapter Three, Step 3.2.

      7.2   See Method 7000, Step 7.3,  Furnace  Technique.


8.0  QUALITY CONTROL

      8.1   See Section 8.0 of Method 7000.


9.0  METHOD PERFORMANCE

      9.1   Precision and accuracy data are not  available at this time.

      9.2   The  performance characteristics for an  aqueous  sample  free  of
interferences are:

      Optimum concentration range:   0.2-4 ug/L.
      Detection limit:  0.05 ug/L.
                                   7951 - 2                       Revision 0
                                                                  July 1992

-------
10.0  REFERENCES

1-    Methods for  Chemical  Analysis of  Water and Wastes;  U.S.  Environmental
Protection Agency.  Office of Research and Development. Environmental Monitoring
and Support  Laboratory.  ORD Publication Offices  of Center  for  Environmental
Research Information:  Cincinnati, OH,  1983; EPA-600/4-79-020.
                                  7951  - 3                       Revision 0
                                                                 July  1992

-------
                  METHOD  7951
ZINC  (ATOMIC ABSORPTION,  FURNACE TECHNIQUE)
                    Start
                 5.0 Prcpari
                  itandard*
                7.1 For »ampl«
                preparation •••
              Chapter 3, Section
                     32
               7.2 Analyze using
                 M.thod 7000
                 Saction 7.3
                    Stop
                 7951 - 4
Revision  0
July 1992

-------
                                  APPENDIX

                             COMPANY REFERENCES


The  following  listing  of frequently-used  addresses  Is  provided  for  the
convenience of users of this manual.   No endorsement  Is Intended or Implied.


Ace Glass Company
1342 N.W. Boulevard
P.O. Box 688
Vlneland, NJ  08360
(609) 692-3333

Aldrlch Chemical Company
Department T
P.O. Box 355
Milwaukee, WI  53201

Alpha Products
5570 - T W. 70th Place
Chicago, IL  60638
(312) 586-9810

Barneby and Cheney Company
E.  8th Avenue and N. Cassldy Street
P.O. Box 2526
Columbus, OH  43219
(614) 258-9501

Bio - Rad Laboratories
2200 Wright Avenue
Richmond, CA  94804
(415) 234-4130

Burdick  & Jackson  Lab  Inc.
1953 S.  Harvey  Street
Muskegon, MO  49442

Calgon  Corporation
P.O. Box 717
Pittsburgh,  PA   15230
 (412)  777-8000

Conostan Division
Conoco  Speciality  Products, Inc.
 P.O. Box 1267
 Ponca  City,  OK   74601
 (405)  767-3456
                                 COMPANIES - 1
                                                          Revision
                                                          Date  September 1986

-------
Corning Glass Works
Houghton  Park
Corning,  NY  14830
(315) 974-9000

Dohrmann, Division of Xertex Corporation
3240 - T  Scott Boulevard
Santa Clara, CA  95050
(408) 727-6000
(800) 538-7708

E. M. Laboratories, Inc.
500 Executive Boulevard
Elmsford, NY  10523

Fisher Scientific Co.
203 Fisher Building
Pittsburgh, PA  15219
(412) 562-8300

General Electric Corporation
3135 Easton Turnpike
Fairfield, CT  06431
(203) 373-2211

Graham Manufactory Co., Inc.
20 Florence Avenue
Batavia,  NY  14020
(716) 343-2216

Hamilton  Industries
1316 18th Street
Two Rivers, WI  54241
(414) 793-1121

ICN Life  Sciences Group
3300 Hyland Avenue
Costa Mesa, CA  92626

Johns - Manvllle Corporation
P.O. Box  5108
Denver, CO  80217

Kontes Glass Company
8000 Spruce Street
Vine!and,  NJ  08360

MllUpore Corporation
80 Ashby Road
Bedford, MA  01730
(617) 275-9200
(800) 225-1380
                                COMPANIES - 2
                                                         Revision
                                                         Date  September 1986

-------
       National  Bureau of Standards
       U.S.  Department of Commerce
       Washington, DC  20234
       (202) 921-1000

       Pierce Chemical Company
       Box 117
       Rockford, IL  61105
       (815) 968-0747

       Scientific Glass and Instrument,  Inc.
       7246 - T Wynnwood
       P.O.  Box 6
       Houston,  TX  77001
       (713) 868-1481

       Scientific Products Company
       1430 Waukegon Road
       McGaw Park, IL  60085
       (312) 689-8410

       Spex Industries
       3880 - T and Park Avenue
       Edison, NJ  08820

       Waters Associates
       34 - T Maple Street
       Mllford,  MA  01757
       (617) 478-2000
       (800) 252-4752

       Whatman Laboratory Products,  Inc.
       Clifton,  NJ  07015
       (201) 773-5800
                                        COMPANIES - 3
                                                                , Re vis-ion
                                                                 Qate  September  1986
v.   %
                                           •fe U.S. GOVERNMENT PRINTING OFFICE :  1987 O - 169-930

-------